1 /* Output routines for GCC for ARM.
2 Copyright (C) 1991, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
3 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Pieter `Tiggr' Schoenmakers (rcpieter@win.tue.nl)
5 and Martin Simmons (@harleqn.co.uk).
6 More major hacks by Richard Earnshaw (rearnsha@arm.com).
7
8 This file is part of GCC.
9
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
11 under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published
12 by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your
13 option) any later version.
14
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
16 ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
17 or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
18 License for more details.
19
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
22 the Free Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
23 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
24
25 #include "config.h"
26 #include "system.h"
27 #include "coretypes.h"
28 #include "tm.h"
29 #include "rtl.h"
30 #include "tree.h"
31 #include "obstack.h"
32 #include "regs.h"
33 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
34 #include "real.h"
35 #include "insn-config.h"
36 #include "conditions.h"
37 #include "output.h"
38 #include "insn-attr.h"
39 #include "flags.h"
40 #include "reload.h"
41 #include "function.h"
42 #include "expr.h"
43 #include "optabs.h"
44 #include "toplev.h"
45 #include "recog.h"
46 #include "ggc.h"
47 #include "except.h"
48 #include "c-pragma.h"
49 #include "integrate.h"
50 #include "tm_p.h"
51 #include "target.h"
52 #include "target-def.h"
53 #include "debug.h"
54 #include "langhooks.h"
55
56 /* Forward definitions of types. */
57 typedef struct minipool_node Mnode;
58 typedef struct minipool_fixup Mfix;
59
60 const struct attribute_spec arm_attribute_table[];
61
62 /* Forward function declarations. */
63 static arm_stack_offsets *arm_get_frame_offsets (void);
64 static void arm_add_gc_roots (void);
65 static int arm_gen_constant (enum rtx_code, enum machine_mode, rtx,
66 HOST_WIDE_INT, rtx, rtx, int, int);
67 static unsigned bit_count (unsigned long);
68 static int arm_address_register_rtx_p (rtx, int);
69 static int arm_legitimate_index_p (enum machine_mode, rtx, RTX_CODE, int);
70 static int thumb_base_register_rtx_p (rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
71 inline static int thumb_index_register_rtx_p (rtx, int);
72 static int thumb_far_jump_used_p (void);
73 static bool thumb_force_lr_save (void);
74 static int const_ok_for_op (HOST_WIDE_INT, enum rtx_code);
75 static rtx emit_sfm (int, int);
76 static int arm_size_return_regs (void);
77 #ifndef AOF_ASSEMBLER
78 static bool arm_assemble_integer (rtx, unsigned int, int);
79 #endif
80 static const char *fp_const_from_val (REAL_VALUE_TYPE *);
81 static arm_cc get_arm_condition_code (rtx);
82 static HOST_WIDE_INT int_log2 (HOST_WIDE_INT);
83 static rtx is_jump_table (rtx);
84 static const char *output_multi_immediate (rtx *, const char *, const char *,
85 int, HOST_WIDE_INT);
86 static const char *shift_op (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT *);
87 static struct machine_function *arm_init_machine_status (void);
88 static void thumb_exit (FILE *, int);
89 static rtx is_jump_table (rtx);
90 static HOST_WIDE_INT get_jump_table_size (rtx);
91 static Mnode *move_minipool_fix_forward_ref (Mnode *, Mnode *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
92 static Mnode *add_minipool_forward_ref (Mfix *);
93 static Mnode *move_minipool_fix_backward_ref (Mnode *, Mnode *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
94 static Mnode *add_minipool_backward_ref (Mfix *);
95 static void assign_minipool_offsets (Mfix *);
96 static void arm_print_value (FILE *, rtx);
97 static void dump_minipool (rtx);
98 static int arm_barrier_cost (rtx);
99 static Mfix *create_fix_barrier (Mfix *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
100 static void push_minipool_barrier (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
101 static void push_minipool_fix (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT, rtx *, enum machine_mode,
102 rtx);
103 static void arm_reorg (void);
104 static bool note_invalid_constants (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT, int);
105 static int current_file_function_operand (rtx);
106 static unsigned long arm_compute_save_reg0_reg12_mask (void);
107 static unsigned long arm_compute_save_reg_mask (void);
108 static unsigned long arm_isr_value (tree);
109 static unsigned long arm_compute_func_type (void);
110 static tree arm_handle_fndecl_attribute (tree *, tree, tree, int, bool *);
111 static tree arm_handle_isr_attribute (tree *, tree, tree, int, bool *);
112 #if TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
113 static tree arm_handle_notshared_attribute (tree *, tree, tree, int, bool *);
114 #endif
115 static void arm_output_function_epilogue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
116 static void arm_output_function_prologue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
117 static void thumb_output_function_prologue (FILE *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
118 static int arm_comp_type_attributes (tree, tree);
119 static void arm_set_default_type_attributes (tree);
120 static int arm_adjust_cost (rtx, rtx, rtx, int);
121 static int count_insns_for_constant (HOST_WIDE_INT, int);
122 static int arm_get_strip_length (int);
123 static bool arm_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree, tree);
124 static void arm_internal_label (FILE *, const char *, unsigned long);
125 static void arm_output_mi_thunk (FILE *, tree, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT,
126 tree);
127 static int arm_rtx_costs_1 (rtx, enum rtx_code, enum rtx_code);
128 static bool arm_size_rtx_costs (rtx, int, int, int *);
129 static bool arm_slowmul_rtx_costs (rtx, int, int, int *);
130 static bool arm_fastmul_rtx_costs (rtx, int, int, int *);
131 static bool arm_xscale_rtx_costs (rtx, int, int, int *);
132 static bool arm_9e_rtx_costs (rtx, int, int, int *);
133 static int arm_address_cost (rtx);
134 static bool arm_memory_load_p (rtx);
135 static bool arm_cirrus_insn_p (rtx);
136 static void cirrus_reorg (rtx);
137 static void arm_init_builtins (void);
138 static rtx arm_expand_builtin (tree, rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
139 static void arm_init_iwmmxt_builtins (void);
140 static rtx safe_vector_operand (rtx, enum machine_mode);
141 static rtx arm_expand_binop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx);
142 static rtx arm_expand_unop_builtin (enum insn_code, tree, rtx, int);
143 static rtx arm_expand_builtin (tree, rtx, rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
144 static void emit_constant_insn (rtx cond, rtx pattern);
145 static rtx emit_set_insn (rtx, rtx);
146 static int arm_arg_partial_bytes (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *, enum machine_mode,
147 tree, bool);
148
149 #ifdef OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF
150 static void arm_elf_asm_constructor (rtx, int);
151 #endif
152 #ifndef ARM_PE
153 static void arm_encode_section_info (tree, rtx, int);
154 #endif
155
156 static void arm_file_end (void);
157 static void arm_file_start (void);
158
159 #ifdef AOF_ASSEMBLER
160 static void aof_globalize_label (FILE *, const char *);
161 static void aof_dump_imports (FILE *);
162 static void aof_dump_pic_table (FILE *);
163 static void aof_file_start (void);
164 static void aof_file_end (void);
165 static void aof_asm_init_sections (void);
166 #endif
167 static void arm_setup_incoming_varargs (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *, enum machine_mode,
168 tree, int *, int);
169 static bool arm_pass_by_reference (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *,
170 enum machine_mode, tree, bool);
171 static bool arm_promote_prototypes (tree);
172 static bool arm_default_short_enums (void);
173 static bool arm_align_anon_bitfield (void);
174 static bool arm_return_in_msb (tree);
175 static bool arm_must_pass_in_stack (enum machine_mode, tree);
176 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
177 static void arm_unwind_emit (FILE *, rtx);
178 static bool arm_output_ttype (rtx);
179 #endif
180
181 static tree arm_cxx_guard_type (void);
182 static bool arm_cxx_guard_mask_bit (void);
183 static tree arm_get_cookie_size (tree);
184 static bool arm_cookie_has_size (void);
185 static bool arm_cxx_cdtor_returns_this (void);
186 static bool arm_cxx_key_method_may_be_inline (void);
187 static void arm_cxx_determine_class_data_visibility (tree);
188 static bool arm_cxx_class_data_always_comdat (void);
189 static bool arm_cxx_use_aeabi_atexit (void);
190 static void arm_init_libfuncs (void);
191 static bool arm_handle_option (size_t, const char *, int);
192 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT arm_shift_truncation_mask (enum machine_mode);
193 static bool arm_cannot_copy_insn_p (rtx);
194 static bool arm_tls_symbol_p (rtx x);
195
196
197 /* Initialize the GCC target structure. */
198 #if TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
199 #undef TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
200 #define TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES merge_dllimport_decl_attributes
201 #endif
202
203 #undef TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
204 #define TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE arm_attribute_table
205
206 #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
207 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START arm_file_start
208
209 #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
210 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_END arm_file_end
211
212 #ifdef AOF_ASSEMBLER
213 #undef TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
214 #define TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP "\tDCB\t"
215 #undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
216 #define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP "\tDCW\t"
217 #undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
218 #define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP "\tDCD\t"
219 #undef TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
220 #define TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL aof_globalize_label
221 #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
222 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_START aof_file_start
223 #undef TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
224 #define TARGET_ASM_FILE_END aof_file_end
225 #else
226 #undef TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
227 #define TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP NULL
228 #undef TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
229 #define TARGET_ASM_INTEGER arm_assemble_integer
230 #endif
231
232 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
233 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE arm_output_function_prologue
234
235 #undef TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
236 #define TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE arm_output_function_epilogue
237
238 #undef TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
239 #define TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS (TARGET_DEFAULT | MASK_SCHED_PROLOG)
240 #undef TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
241 #define TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION arm_handle_option
242
243 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
244 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES arm_comp_type_attributes
245
246 #undef TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
247 #define TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES arm_set_default_type_attributes
248
249 #undef TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
250 #define TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST arm_adjust_cost
251
252 #undef TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
253 #ifdef ARM_PE
254 #define TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO arm_pe_encode_section_info
255 #else
256 #define TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO arm_encode_section_info
257 #endif
258
259 #undef TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
260 #define TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING arm_strip_name_encoding
261
262 #undef TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
263 #define TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL arm_internal_label
264
265 #undef TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
266 #define TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL arm_function_ok_for_sibcall
267
268 #undef TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
269 #define TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK arm_output_mi_thunk
270 #undef TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
271 #define TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK default_can_output_mi_thunk_no_vcall
272
273 /* This will be overridden in arm_override_options. */
274 #undef TARGET_RTX_COSTS
275 #define TARGET_RTX_COSTS arm_slowmul_rtx_costs
276 #undef TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
277 #define TARGET_ADDRESS_COST arm_address_cost
278
279 #undef TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
280 #define TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK arm_shift_truncation_mask
281 #undef TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
282 #define TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P arm_vector_mode_supported_p
283
284 #undef TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
285 #define TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG arm_reorg
286
287 #undef TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
288 #define TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS arm_init_builtins
289 #undef TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
290 #define TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN arm_expand_builtin
291
292 #undef TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
293 #define TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS arm_init_libfuncs
294
295 #undef TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS
296 #define TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS hook_bool_tree_true
297 #undef TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN
298 #define TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN hook_bool_tree_true
299 #undef TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
300 #define TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES arm_promote_prototypes
301 #undef TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
302 #define TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE arm_pass_by_reference
303 #undef TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
304 #define TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES arm_arg_partial_bytes
305
306 #undef TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
307 #define TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS arm_setup_incoming_varargs
308
309 #undef TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
310 #define TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS arm_default_short_enums
311
312 #undef TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
313 #define TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD arm_align_anon_bitfield
314
315 #undef TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
316 #define TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD hook_bool_void_false
317
318 #undef TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
319 #define TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE arm_cxx_guard_type
320
321 #undef TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
322 #define TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT arm_cxx_guard_mask_bit
323
324 #undef TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
325 #define TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE arm_get_cookie_size
326
327 #undef TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
328 #define TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE arm_cookie_has_size
329
330 #undef TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
331 #define TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS arm_cxx_cdtor_returns_this
332
333 #undef TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
334 #define TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE arm_cxx_key_method_may_be_inline
335
336 #undef TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
337 #define TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT arm_cxx_use_aeabi_atexit
338
339 #undef TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
340 #define TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY \
341 arm_cxx_determine_class_data_visibility
342
343 #undef TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
344 #define TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT arm_cxx_class_data_always_comdat
345
346 #undef TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
347 #define TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB arm_return_in_msb
348
349 #undef TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
350 #define TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK arm_must_pass_in_stack
351
352 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
353 #undef TARGET_UNWIND_EMIT
354 #define TARGET_UNWIND_EMIT arm_unwind_emit
355
356 /* EABI unwinding tables use a different format for the typeinfo tables. */
357 #undef TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
358 #define TARGET_ASM_TTYPE arm_output_ttype
359
360 #undef TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
361 #define TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER true
362 #endif /* TARGET_UNWIND_INFO */
363
364 #undef TARGET_CANNOT_COPY_INSN_P
365 #define TARGET_CANNOT_COPY_INSN_P arm_cannot_copy_insn_p
366
367 #ifdef HAVE_AS_TLS
368 #undef TARGET_HAVE_TLS
369 #define TARGET_HAVE_TLS true
370 #endif
371
372 #undef TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
373 #define TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM arm_tls_referenced_p
374
375 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
376
377 /* Obstack for minipool constant handling. */
378 static struct obstack minipool_obstack;
379 static char * minipool_startobj;
380
381 /* The maximum number of insns skipped which
382 will be conditionalised if possible. */
383 static int max_insns_skipped = 5;
384
385 extern FILE * asm_out_file;
386
387 /* True if we are currently building a constant table. */
388 int making_const_table;
389
390 /* Define the information needed to generate branch insns. This is
391 stored from the compare operation. */
392 rtx arm_compare_op0, arm_compare_op1;
393
394 /* The processor for which instructions should be scheduled. */
395 enum processor_type arm_tune = arm_none;
396
397 /* The default processor used if not overriden by commandline. */
398 static enum processor_type arm_default_cpu = arm_none;
399
400 /* Which floating point model to use. */
401 enum arm_fp_model arm_fp_model;
402
403 /* Which floating point hardware is available. */
404 enum fputype arm_fpu_arch;
405
406 /* Which floating point hardware to schedule for. */
407 enum fputype arm_fpu_tune;
408
409 /* Whether to use floating point hardware. */
410 enum float_abi_type arm_float_abi;
411
412 /* Which ABI to use. */
413 enum arm_abi_type arm_abi;
414
415 /* Which thread pointer model to use. */
416 enum arm_tp_type target_thread_pointer = TP_AUTO;
417
418 /* Used to parse -mstructure_size_boundary command line option. */
419 int arm_structure_size_boundary = DEFAULT_STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY;
420
421 /* Used for Thumb call_via trampolines. */
422 rtx thumb_call_via_label[14];
423 static int thumb_call_reg_needed;
424
425 /* Bit values used to identify processor capabilities. */
426 #define FL_CO_PROC (1 << 0) /* Has external co-processor bus */
427 #define FL_ARCH3M (1 << 1) /* Extended multiply */
428 #define FL_MODE26 (1 << 2) /* 26-bit mode support */
429 #define FL_MODE32 (1 << 3) /* 32-bit mode support */
430 #define FL_ARCH4 (1 << 4) /* Architecture rel 4 */
431 #define FL_ARCH5 (1 << 5) /* Architecture rel 5 */
432 #define FL_THUMB (1 << 6) /* Thumb aware */
433 #define FL_LDSCHED (1 << 7) /* Load scheduling necessary */
434 #define FL_STRONG (1 << 8) /* StrongARM */
435 #define FL_ARCH5E (1 << 9) /* DSP extensions to v5 */
436 #define FL_XSCALE (1 << 10) /* XScale */
437 #define FL_CIRRUS (1 << 11) /* Cirrus/DSP. */
438 #define FL_ARCH6 (1 << 12) /* Architecture rel 6. Adds
439 media instructions. */
440 #define FL_VFPV2 (1 << 13) /* Vector Floating Point V2. */
441 #define FL_WBUF (1 << 14) /* Schedule for write buffer ops.
442 Note: ARM6 & 7 derivatives only. */
443 #define FL_ARCH6K (1 << 15) /* Architecture rel 6 K extensions. */
444
445 #define FL_IWMMXT (1 << 29) /* XScale v2 or "Intel Wireless MMX technology". */
446
447 #define FL_FOR_ARCH2 0
448 #define FL_FOR_ARCH3 FL_MODE32
449 #define FL_FOR_ARCH3M (FL_FOR_ARCH3 | FL_ARCH3M)
450 #define FL_FOR_ARCH4 (FL_FOR_ARCH3M | FL_ARCH4)
451 #define FL_FOR_ARCH4T (FL_FOR_ARCH4 | FL_THUMB)
452 #define FL_FOR_ARCH5 (FL_FOR_ARCH4 | FL_ARCH5)
453 #define FL_FOR_ARCH5T (FL_FOR_ARCH5 | FL_THUMB)
454 #define FL_FOR_ARCH5E (FL_FOR_ARCH5 | FL_ARCH5E)
455 #define FL_FOR_ARCH5TE (FL_FOR_ARCH5E | FL_THUMB)
456 #define FL_FOR_ARCH5TEJ FL_FOR_ARCH5TE
457 #define FL_FOR_ARCH6 (FL_FOR_ARCH5TE | FL_ARCH6)
458 #define FL_FOR_ARCH6J FL_FOR_ARCH6
459 #define FL_FOR_ARCH6K (FL_FOR_ARCH6 | FL_ARCH6K)
460 #define FL_FOR_ARCH6Z FL_FOR_ARCH6
461 #define FL_FOR_ARCH6ZK FL_FOR_ARCH6K
462
463 /* The bits in this mask specify which
464 instructions we are allowed to generate. */
465 static unsigned long insn_flags = 0;
466
467 /* The bits in this mask specify which instruction scheduling options should
468 be used. */
469 static unsigned long tune_flags = 0;
470
471 /* The following are used in the arm.md file as equivalents to bits
472 in the above two flag variables. */
473
474 /* Nonzero if this chip supports the ARM Architecture 3M extensions. */
475 int arm_arch3m = 0;
476
477 /* Nonzero if this chip supports the ARM Architecture 4 extensions. */
478 int arm_arch4 = 0;
479
480 /* Nonzero if this chip supports the ARM Architecture 4t extensions. */
481 int arm_arch4t = 0;
482
483 /* Nonzero if this chip supports the ARM Architecture 5 extensions. */
484 int arm_arch5 = 0;
485
486 /* Nonzero if this chip supports the ARM Architecture 5E extensions. */
487 int arm_arch5e = 0;
488
489 /* Nonzero if this chip supports the ARM Architecture 6 extensions. */
490 int arm_arch6 = 0;
491
492 /* Nonzero if this chip supports the ARM 6K extensions. */
493 int arm_arch6k = 0;
494
495 /* Nonzero if this chip can benefit from load scheduling. */
496 int arm_ld_sched = 0;
497
498 /* Nonzero if this chip is a StrongARM. */
499 int arm_tune_strongarm = 0;
500
501 /* Nonzero if this chip is a Cirrus variant. */
502 int arm_arch_cirrus = 0;
503
504 /* Nonzero if this chip supports Intel Wireless MMX technology. */
505 int arm_arch_iwmmxt = 0;
506
507 /* Nonzero if this chip is an XScale. */
508 int arm_arch_xscale = 0;
509
510 /* Nonzero if tuning for XScale */
511 int arm_tune_xscale = 0;
512
513 /* Nonzero if we want to tune for stores that access the write-buffer.
514 This typically means an ARM6 or ARM7 with MMU or MPU. */
515 int arm_tune_wbuf = 0;
516
517 /* Nonzero if generating Thumb instructions. */
518 int thumb_code = 0;
519
520 /* Nonzero if we should define __THUMB_INTERWORK__ in the
521 preprocessor.
522 XXX This is a bit of a hack, it's intended to help work around
523 problems in GLD which doesn't understand that armv5t code is
524 interworking clean. */
525 int arm_cpp_interwork = 0;
526
527 /* In case of a PRE_INC, POST_INC, PRE_DEC, POST_DEC memory reference, we
528 must report the mode of the memory reference from PRINT_OPERAND to
529 PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS. */
530 enum machine_mode output_memory_reference_mode;
531
532 /* The register number to be used for the PIC offset register. */
533 unsigned arm_pic_register = INVALID_REGNUM;
534
535 /* Set to 1 when a return insn is output, this means that the epilogue
536 is not needed. */
537 int return_used_this_function;
538
539 /* Set to 1 after arm_reorg has started. Reset to start at the start of
540 the next function. */
541 static int after_arm_reorg = 0;
542
543 /* The maximum number of insns to be used when loading a constant. */
544 static int arm_constant_limit = 3;
545
546 /* For an explanation of these variables, see final_prescan_insn below. */
547 int arm_ccfsm_state;
548 enum arm_cond_code arm_current_cc;
549 rtx arm_target_insn;
550 int arm_target_label;
551
552 /* The condition codes of the ARM, and the inverse function. */
553 static const char * const arm_condition_codes[] =
554 {
555 "eq", "ne", "cs", "cc", "mi", "pl", "vs", "vc",
556 "hi", "ls", "ge", "lt", "gt", "le", "al", "nv"
557 };
558
559 #define streq(string1, string2) (strcmp (string1, string2) == 0)
560
561 /* Initialization code. */
562
563 struct processors
564 {
565 const char *const name;
566 enum processor_type core;
567 const char *arch;
568 const unsigned long flags;
569 bool (* rtx_costs) (rtx, int, int, int *);
570 };
571
572 /* Not all of these give usefully different compilation alternatives,
573 but there is no simple way of generalizing them. */
574 static const struct processors all_cores[] =
575 {
576 /* ARM Cores */
577 #define ARM_CORE(NAME, IDENT, ARCH, FLAGS, COSTS) \
578 {NAME, arm_none, #ARCH, FLAGS | FL_FOR_ARCH##ARCH, arm_##COSTS##_rtx_costs},
579 #include "arm-cores.def"
580 #undef ARM_CORE
581 {NULL, arm_none, NULL, 0, NULL}
582 };
583
584 static const struct processors all_architectures[] =
585 {
586 /* ARM Architectures */
587 /* We don't specify rtx_costs here as it will be figured out
588 from the core. */
589
590 {"armv2", arm2, "2", FL_CO_PROC | FL_MODE26 | FL_FOR_ARCH2, NULL},
591 {"armv2a", arm2, "2", FL_CO_PROC | FL_MODE26 | FL_FOR_ARCH2, NULL},
592 {"armv3", arm6, "3", FL_CO_PROC | FL_MODE26 | FL_FOR_ARCH3, NULL},
593 {"armv3m", arm7m, "3M", FL_CO_PROC | FL_MODE26 | FL_FOR_ARCH3M, NULL},
594 {"armv4", arm7tdmi, "4", FL_CO_PROC | FL_MODE26 | FL_FOR_ARCH4, NULL},
595 /* Strictly, FL_MODE26 is a permitted option for v4t, but there are no
596 implementations that support it, so we will leave it out for now. */
597 {"armv4t", arm7tdmi, "4T", FL_CO_PROC | FL_FOR_ARCH4T, NULL},
598 {"armv5", arm10tdmi, "5", FL_CO_PROC | FL_FOR_ARCH5, NULL},
599 {"armv5t", arm10tdmi, "5T", FL_CO_PROC | FL_FOR_ARCH5T, NULL},
600 {"armv5e", arm1026ejs, "5E", FL_CO_PROC | FL_FOR_ARCH5E, NULL},
601 {"armv5te", arm1026ejs, "5TE", FL_CO_PROC | FL_FOR_ARCH5TE, NULL},
602 {"armv6", arm1136js, "6", FL_CO_PROC | FL_FOR_ARCH6, NULL},
603 {"armv6j", arm1136js, "6J", FL_CO_PROC | FL_FOR_ARCH6J, NULL},
604 {"armv6k", mpcore, "6K", FL_CO_PROC | FL_FOR_ARCH6K, NULL},
605 {"armv6z", arm1176jzs, "6Z", FL_CO_PROC | FL_FOR_ARCH6Z, NULL},
606 {"armv6zk", arm1176jzs, "6ZK", FL_CO_PROC | FL_FOR_ARCH6ZK, NULL},
607 /* Clang compatibility... define __ARM_ARCH_7A__, but codegen is still 6ZK. */
608 {"armv7a", arm1176jzs, "7A", FL_CO_PROC | FL_FOR_ARCH6ZK, NULL},
609 {"ep9312", ep9312, "4T", FL_LDSCHED | FL_CIRRUS | FL_FOR_ARCH4, NULL},
610 {"iwmmxt", iwmmxt, "5TE", FL_LDSCHED | FL_STRONG | FL_FOR_ARCH5TE | FL_XSCALE | FL_IWMMXT , NULL},
611 {NULL, arm_none, NULL, 0 , NULL}
612 };
613
614 struct arm_cpu_select
615 {
616 const char * string;
617 const char * name;
618 const struct processors * processors;
619 };
620
621 /* This is a magic structure. The 'string' field is magically filled in
622 with a pointer to the value specified by the user on the command line
623 assuming that the user has specified such a value. */
624
625 static struct arm_cpu_select arm_select[] =
626 {
627 /* string name processors */
628 { NULL, "-mcpu=", all_cores },
629 { NULL, "-march=", all_architectures },
630 { NULL, "-mtune=", all_cores }
631 };
632
633 /* Defines representing the indexes into the above table. */
634 #define ARM_OPT_SET_CPU 0
635 #define ARM_OPT_SET_ARCH 1
636 #define ARM_OPT_SET_TUNE 2
637
638 /* The name of the preprocessor macro to define for this architecture. */
639
640 char arm_arch_name[] = "__ARM_ARCH_0UNK__";
641
642 struct fpu_desc
643 {
644 const char * name;
645 enum fputype fpu;
646 };
647
648
649 /* Available values for -mfpu=. */
650
651 static const struct fpu_desc all_fpus[] =
652 {
653 {"fpa", FPUTYPE_FPA},
654 {"fpe2", FPUTYPE_FPA_EMU2},
655 {"fpe3", FPUTYPE_FPA_EMU2},
656 {"maverick", FPUTYPE_MAVERICK},
657 {"vfp", FPUTYPE_VFP}
658 };
659
660
661 /* Floating point models used by the different hardware.
662 See fputype in arm.h. */
663
664 static const enum fputype fp_model_for_fpu[] =
665 {
666 /* No FP hardware. */
667 ARM_FP_MODEL_UNKNOWN, /* FPUTYPE_NONE */
668 ARM_FP_MODEL_FPA, /* FPUTYPE_FPA */
669 ARM_FP_MODEL_FPA, /* FPUTYPE_FPA_EMU2 */
670 ARM_FP_MODEL_FPA, /* FPUTYPE_FPA_EMU3 */
671 ARM_FP_MODEL_MAVERICK, /* FPUTYPE_MAVERICK */
672 ARM_FP_MODEL_VFP /* FPUTYPE_VFP */
673 };
674
675
676 struct float_abi
677 {
678 const char * name;
679 enum float_abi_type abi_type;
680 };
681
682
683 /* Available values for -mfloat-abi=. */
684
685 static const struct float_abi all_float_abis[] =
686 {
687 {"soft", ARM_FLOAT_ABI_SOFT},
688 {"softfp", ARM_FLOAT_ABI_SOFTFP},
689 {"hard", ARM_FLOAT_ABI_HARD}
690 };
691
692
693 struct abi_name
694 {
695 const char *name;
696 enum arm_abi_type abi_type;
697 };
698
699
700 /* Available values for -mabi=. */
701
702 static const struct abi_name arm_all_abis[] =
703 {
704 {"apcs-gnu", ARM_ABI_APCS},
705 {"atpcs", ARM_ABI_ATPCS},
706 {"aapcs", ARM_ABI_AAPCS},
707 {"iwmmxt", ARM_ABI_IWMMXT},
708 {"aapcs-linux", ARM_ABI_AAPCS_LINUX}
709 };
710
711 /* Supported TLS relocations. */
712
713 enum tls_reloc {
714 TLS_GD32,
715 TLS_LDM32,
716 TLS_LDO32,
717 TLS_IE32,
718 TLS_LE32
719 };
720
721 /* Emit an insn that's a simple single-set. Both the operands must be known
722 to be valid. */
723 inline static rtx
emit_set_insn(rtx x,rtx y)724 emit_set_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
725 {
726 return emit_insn (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, x, y));
727 }
728
729 /* Return the number of bits set in VALUE. */
730 static unsigned
bit_count(unsigned long value)731 bit_count (unsigned long value)
732 {
733 unsigned long count = 0;
734
735 while (value)
736 {
737 count++;
738 value &= value - 1; /* Clear the least-significant set bit. */
739 }
740
741 return count;
742 }
743
744 /* Set up library functions unique to ARM. */
745
746 static void
arm_init_libfuncs(void)747 arm_init_libfuncs (void)
748 {
749 /* There are no special library functions unless we are using the
750 ARM BPABI. */
751 if (!TARGET_BPABI)
752 return;
753
754 /* The functions below are described in Section 4 of the "Run-Time
755 ABI for the ARM architecture", Version 1.0. */
756
757 /* Double-precision floating-point arithmetic. Table 2. */
758 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, DFmode, "__aeabi_dadd");
759 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DFmode, "__aeabi_ddiv");
760 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, DFmode, "__aeabi_dmul");
761 set_optab_libfunc (neg_optab, DFmode, "__aeabi_dneg");
762 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, DFmode, "__aeabi_dsub");
763
764 /* Double-precision comparisons. Table 3. */
765 set_optab_libfunc (eq_optab, DFmode, "__aeabi_dcmpeq");
766 set_optab_libfunc (ne_optab, DFmode, NULL);
767 set_optab_libfunc (lt_optab, DFmode, "__aeabi_dcmplt");
768 set_optab_libfunc (le_optab, DFmode, "__aeabi_dcmple");
769 set_optab_libfunc (ge_optab, DFmode, "__aeabi_dcmpge");
770 set_optab_libfunc (gt_optab, DFmode, "__aeabi_dcmpgt");
771 set_optab_libfunc (unord_optab, DFmode, "__aeabi_dcmpun");
772
773 /* Single-precision floating-point arithmetic. Table 4. */
774 set_optab_libfunc (add_optab, SFmode, "__aeabi_fadd");
775 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, SFmode, "__aeabi_fdiv");
776 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, SFmode, "__aeabi_fmul");
777 set_optab_libfunc (neg_optab, SFmode, "__aeabi_fneg");
778 set_optab_libfunc (sub_optab, SFmode, "__aeabi_fsub");
779
780 /* Single-precision comparisons. Table 5. */
781 set_optab_libfunc (eq_optab, SFmode, "__aeabi_fcmpeq");
782 set_optab_libfunc (ne_optab, SFmode, NULL);
783 set_optab_libfunc (lt_optab, SFmode, "__aeabi_fcmplt");
784 set_optab_libfunc (le_optab, SFmode, "__aeabi_fcmple");
785 set_optab_libfunc (ge_optab, SFmode, "__aeabi_fcmpge");
786 set_optab_libfunc (gt_optab, SFmode, "__aeabi_fcmpgt");
787 set_optab_libfunc (unord_optab, SFmode, "__aeabi_fcmpun");
788
789 /* Floating-point to integer conversions. Table 6. */
790 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, DFmode, "__aeabi_d2iz");
791 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, SImode, DFmode, "__aeabi_d2uiz");
792 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, DImode, DFmode, "__aeabi_d2lz");
793 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, DImode, DFmode, "__aeabi_d2ulz");
794 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, SImode, SFmode, "__aeabi_f2iz");
795 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, SImode, SFmode, "__aeabi_f2uiz");
796 set_conv_libfunc (sfix_optab, DImode, SFmode, "__aeabi_f2lz");
797 set_conv_libfunc (ufix_optab, DImode, SFmode, "__aeabi_f2ulz");
798
799 /* Conversions between floating types. Table 7. */
800 set_conv_libfunc (trunc_optab, SFmode, DFmode, "__aeabi_d2f");
801 set_conv_libfunc (sext_optab, DFmode, SFmode, "__aeabi_f2d");
802
803 /* Integer to floating-point conversions. Table 8. */
804 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, DFmode, SImode, "__aeabi_i2d");
805 set_conv_libfunc (ufloat_optab, DFmode, SImode, "__aeabi_ui2d");
806 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, DFmode, DImode, "__aeabi_l2d");
807 set_conv_libfunc (ufloat_optab, DFmode, DImode, "__aeabi_ul2d");
808 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, SFmode, SImode, "__aeabi_i2f");
809 set_conv_libfunc (ufloat_optab, SFmode, SImode, "__aeabi_ui2f");
810 set_conv_libfunc (sfloat_optab, SFmode, DImode, "__aeabi_l2f");
811 set_conv_libfunc (ufloat_optab, SFmode, DImode, "__aeabi_ul2f");
812
813 /* Long long. Table 9. */
814 set_optab_libfunc (smul_optab, DImode, "__aeabi_lmul");
815 set_optab_libfunc (sdivmod_optab, DImode, "__aeabi_ldivmod");
816 set_optab_libfunc (udivmod_optab, DImode, "__aeabi_uldivmod");
817 set_optab_libfunc (ashl_optab, DImode, "__aeabi_llsl");
818 set_optab_libfunc (lshr_optab, DImode, "__aeabi_llsr");
819 set_optab_libfunc (ashr_optab, DImode, "__aeabi_lasr");
820 set_optab_libfunc (cmp_optab, DImode, "__aeabi_lcmp");
821 set_optab_libfunc (ucmp_optab, DImode, "__aeabi_ulcmp");
822
823 /* Integer (32/32->32) division. \S 4.3.1. */
824 set_optab_libfunc (sdivmod_optab, SImode, "__aeabi_idivmod");
825 set_optab_libfunc (udivmod_optab, SImode, "__aeabi_uidivmod");
826
827 /* The divmod functions are designed so that they can be used for
828 plain division, even though they return both the quotient and the
829 remainder. The quotient is returned in the usual location (i.e.,
830 r0 for SImode, {r0, r1} for DImode), just as would be expected
831 for an ordinary division routine. Because the AAPCS calling
832 conventions specify that all of { r0, r1, r2, r3 } are
833 callee-saved registers, there is no need to tell the compiler
834 explicitly that those registers are clobbered by these
835 routines. */
836 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, DImode, "__aeabi_ldivmod");
837 set_optab_libfunc (udiv_optab, DImode, "__aeabi_uldivmod");
838
839 /* For SImode division the ABI provides div-without-mod routines,
840 which are faster. */
841 set_optab_libfunc (sdiv_optab, SImode, "__aeabi_idiv");
842 set_optab_libfunc (udiv_optab, SImode, "__aeabi_uidiv");
843
844 /* We don't have mod libcalls. Fortunately gcc knows how to use the
845 divmod libcalls instead. */
846 set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, DImode, NULL);
847 set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, DImode, NULL);
848 set_optab_libfunc (smod_optab, SImode, NULL);
849 set_optab_libfunc (umod_optab, SImode, NULL);
850 }
851
852 /* Implement TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION. */
853
854 static bool
arm_handle_option(size_t code,const char * arg,int value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)855 arm_handle_option (size_t code, const char *arg, int value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
856 {
857 switch (code)
858 {
859 case OPT_march_:
860 arm_select[1].string = arg;
861 return true;
862
863 case OPT_mcpu_:
864 arm_select[0].string = arg;
865 return true;
866
867 case OPT_mhard_float:
868 target_float_abi_name = "hard";
869 return true;
870
871 case OPT_msoft_float:
872 target_float_abi_name = "soft";
873 return true;
874
875 case OPT_mtune_:
876 arm_select[2].string = arg;
877 return true;
878
879 default:
880 return true;
881 }
882 }
883
884 /* Fix up any incompatible options that the user has specified.
885 This has now turned into a maze. */
886 void
arm_override_options(void)887 arm_override_options (void)
888 {
889 unsigned i;
890 enum processor_type target_arch_cpu = arm_none;
891
892 /* Set up the flags based on the cpu/architecture selected by the user. */
893 for (i = ARRAY_SIZE (arm_select); i--;)
894 {
895 struct arm_cpu_select * ptr = arm_select + i;
896
897 if (ptr->string != NULL && ptr->string[0] != '\0')
898 {
899 const struct processors * sel;
900
901 for (sel = ptr->processors; sel->name != NULL; sel++)
902 if (streq (ptr->string, sel->name))
903 {
904 /* Set the architecture define. */
905 if (i != ARM_OPT_SET_TUNE)
906 sprintf (arm_arch_name, "__ARM_ARCH_%s__", sel->arch);
907
908 /* Determine the processor core for which we should
909 tune code-generation. */
910 if (/* -mcpu= is a sensible default. */
911 i == ARM_OPT_SET_CPU
912 /* -mtune= overrides -mcpu= and -march=. */
913 || i == ARM_OPT_SET_TUNE)
914 arm_tune = (enum processor_type) (sel - ptr->processors);
915
916 /* Remember the CPU associated with this architecture.
917 If no other option is used to set the CPU type,
918 we'll use this to guess the most suitable tuning
919 options. */
920 if (i == ARM_OPT_SET_ARCH)
921 target_arch_cpu = sel->core;
922
923 if (i != ARM_OPT_SET_TUNE)
924 {
925 /* If we have been given an architecture and a processor
926 make sure that they are compatible. We only generate
927 a warning though, and we prefer the CPU over the
928 architecture. */
929 if (insn_flags != 0 && (insn_flags ^ sel->flags))
930 warning (0, "switch -mcpu=%s conflicts with -march= switch",
931 ptr->string);
932
933 insn_flags = sel->flags;
934 }
935
936 break;
937 }
938
939 if (sel->name == NULL)
940 error ("bad value (%s) for %s switch", ptr->string, ptr->name);
941 }
942 }
943
944 /* Guess the tuning options from the architecture if necessary. */
945 if (arm_tune == arm_none)
946 arm_tune = target_arch_cpu;
947
948 /* If the user did not specify a processor, choose one for them. */
949 if (insn_flags == 0)
950 {
951 const struct processors * sel;
952 unsigned int sought;
953 enum processor_type cpu;
954
955 cpu = TARGET_CPU_DEFAULT;
956 if (cpu == arm_none)
957 {
958 #ifdef SUBTARGET_CPU_DEFAULT
959 /* Use the subtarget default CPU if none was specified by
960 configure. */
961 cpu = SUBTARGET_CPU_DEFAULT;
962 #endif
963 /* Default to ARM6. */
964 if (cpu == arm_none)
965 cpu = arm6;
966 }
967 sel = &all_cores[cpu];
968
969 insn_flags = sel->flags;
970
971 /* Now check to see if the user has specified some command line
972 switch that require certain abilities from the cpu. */
973 sought = 0;
974
975 if (TARGET_INTERWORK || TARGET_THUMB)
976 {
977 sought |= (FL_THUMB | FL_MODE32);
978
979 /* There are no ARM processors that support both APCS-26 and
980 interworking. Therefore we force FL_MODE26 to be removed
981 from insn_flags here (if it was set), so that the search
982 below will always be able to find a compatible processor. */
983 insn_flags &= ~FL_MODE26;
984 }
985
986 if (sought != 0 && ((sought & insn_flags) != sought))
987 {
988 /* Try to locate a CPU type that supports all of the abilities
989 of the default CPU, plus the extra abilities requested by
990 the user. */
991 for (sel = all_cores; sel->name != NULL; sel++)
992 if ((sel->flags & sought) == (sought | insn_flags))
993 break;
994
995 if (sel->name == NULL)
996 {
997 unsigned current_bit_count = 0;
998 const struct processors * best_fit = NULL;
999
1000 /* Ideally we would like to issue an error message here
1001 saying that it was not possible to find a CPU compatible
1002 with the default CPU, but which also supports the command
1003 line options specified by the programmer, and so they
1004 ought to use the -mcpu=<name> command line option to
1005 override the default CPU type.
1006
1007 If we cannot find a cpu that has both the
1008 characteristics of the default cpu and the given
1009 command line options we scan the array again looking
1010 for a best match. */
1011 for (sel = all_cores; sel->name != NULL; sel++)
1012 if ((sel->flags & sought) == sought)
1013 {
1014 unsigned count;
1015
1016 count = bit_count (sel->flags & insn_flags);
1017
1018 if (count >= current_bit_count)
1019 {
1020 best_fit = sel;
1021 current_bit_count = count;
1022 }
1023 }
1024
1025 gcc_assert (best_fit);
1026 sel = best_fit;
1027 }
1028
1029 insn_flags = sel->flags;
1030 }
1031 sprintf (arm_arch_name, "__ARM_ARCH_%s__", sel->arch);
1032 arm_default_cpu = (enum processor_type) (sel - all_cores);
1033 if (arm_tune == arm_none)
1034 arm_tune = arm_default_cpu;
1035 }
1036
1037 /* The processor for which we should tune should now have been
1038 chosen. */
1039 gcc_assert (arm_tune != arm_none);
1040
1041 tune_flags = all_cores[(int)arm_tune].flags;
1042 if (optimize_size)
1043 targetm.rtx_costs = arm_size_rtx_costs;
1044 else
1045 targetm.rtx_costs = all_cores[(int)arm_tune].rtx_costs;
1046
1047 /* Make sure that the processor choice does not conflict with any of the
1048 other command line choices. */
1049 if (TARGET_INTERWORK && !(insn_flags & FL_THUMB))
1050 {
1051 warning (0, "target CPU does not support interworking" );
1052 target_flags &= ~MASK_INTERWORK;
1053 }
1054
1055 if (TARGET_THUMB && !(insn_flags & FL_THUMB))
1056 {
1057 warning (0, "target CPU does not support THUMB instructions");
1058 target_flags &= ~MASK_THUMB;
1059 }
1060
1061 if (TARGET_APCS_FRAME && TARGET_THUMB)
1062 {
1063 /* warning (0, "ignoring -mapcs-frame because -mthumb was used"); */
1064 target_flags &= ~MASK_APCS_FRAME;
1065 }
1066
1067 /* Callee super interworking implies thumb interworking. Adding
1068 this to the flags here simplifies the logic elsewhere. */
1069 if (TARGET_THUMB && TARGET_CALLEE_INTERWORKING)
1070 target_flags |= MASK_INTERWORK;
1071
1072 /* TARGET_BACKTRACE calls leaf_function_p, which causes a crash if done
1073 from here where no function is being compiled currently. */
1074 if ((TARGET_TPCS_FRAME || TARGET_TPCS_LEAF_FRAME) && TARGET_ARM)
1075 warning (0, "enabling backtrace support is only meaningful when compiling for the Thumb");
1076
1077 if (TARGET_ARM && TARGET_CALLEE_INTERWORKING)
1078 warning (0, "enabling callee interworking support is only meaningful when compiling for the Thumb");
1079
1080 if (TARGET_ARM && TARGET_CALLER_INTERWORKING)
1081 warning (0, "enabling caller interworking support is only meaningful when compiling for the Thumb");
1082
1083 if (TARGET_APCS_STACK && !TARGET_APCS_FRAME)
1084 {
1085 warning (0, "-mapcs-stack-check incompatible with -mno-apcs-frame");
1086 target_flags |= MASK_APCS_FRAME;
1087 }
1088
1089 if (TARGET_POKE_FUNCTION_NAME)
1090 target_flags |= MASK_APCS_FRAME;
1091
1092 if (TARGET_APCS_REENT && flag_pic)
1093 error ("-fpic and -mapcs-reent are incompatible");
1094
1095 if (TARGET_APCS_REENT)
1096 warning (0, "APCS reentrant code not supported. Ignored");
1097
1098 /* If this target is normally configured to use APCS frames, warn if they
1099 are turned off and debugging is turned on. */
1100 if (TARGET_ARM
1101 && write_symbols != NO_DEBUG
1102 && !TARGET_APCS_FRAME
1103 && (TARGET_DEFAULT & MASK_APCS_FRAME))
1104 warning (0, "-g with -mno-apcs-frame may not give sensible debugging");
1105
1106 /* If stack checking is disabled, we can use r10 as the PIC register,
1107 which keeps r9 available. */
1108 if (flag_pic && TARGET_SINGLE_PIC_BASE)
1109 arm_pic_register = TARGET_APCS_STACK ? 9 : 10;
1110
1111 if (TARGET_APCS_FLOAT)
1112 warning (0, "passing floating point arguments in fp regs not yet supported");
1113
1114 /* Initialize boolean versions of the flags, for use in the arm.md file. */
1115 arm_arch3m = (insn_flags & FL_ARCH3M) != 0;
1116 arm_arch4 = (insn_flags & FL_ARCH4) != 0;
1117 arm_arch4t = arm_arch4 & ((insn_flags & FL_THUMB) != 0);
1118 arm_arch5 = (insn_flags & FL_ARCH5) != 0;
1119 arm_arch5e = (insn_flags & FL_ARCH5E) != 0;
1120 arm_arch6 = (insn_flags & FL_ARCH6) != 0;
1121 arm_arch6k = (insn_flags & FL_ARCH6K) != 0;
1122 arm_arch_xscale = (insn_flags & FL_XSCALE) != 0;
1123 arm_arch_cirrus = (insn_flags & FL_CIRRUS) != 0;
1124
1125 arm_ld_sched = (tune_flags & FL_LDSCHED) != 0;
1126 arm_tune_strongarm = (tune_flags & FL_STRONG) != 0;
1127 thumb_code = (TARGET_ARM == 0);
1128 arm_tune_wbuf = (tune_flags & FL_WBUF) != 0;
1129 arm_tune_xscale = (tune_flags & FL_XSCALE) != 0;
1130 arm_arch_iwmmxt = (insn_flags & FL_IWMMXT) != 0;
1131
1132 /* V5 code we generate is completely interworking capable, so we turn off
1133 TARGET_INTERWORK here to avoid many tests later on. */
1134
1135 /* XXX However, we must pass the right pre-processor defines to CPP
1136 or GLD can get confused. This is a hack. */
1137 if (TARGET_INTERWORK)
1138 arm_cpp_interwork = 1;
1139
1140 if (arm_arch5)
1141 target_flags &= ~MASK_INTERWORK;
1142
1143 if (target_abi_name)
1144 {
1145 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (arm_all_abis); i++)
1146 {
1147 if (streq (arm_all_abis[i].name, target_abi_name))
1148 {
1149 arm_abi = arm_all_abis[i].abi_type;
1150 break;
1151 }
1152 }
1153 if (i == ARRAY_SIZE (arm_all_abis))
1154 error ("invalid ABI option: -mabi=%s", target_abi_name);
1155 }
1156 else
1157 arm_abi = ARM_DEFAULT_ABI;
1158
1159 if (TARGET_IWMMXT && !ARM_DOUBLEWORD_ALIGN)
1160 error ("iwmmxt requires an AAPCS compatible ABI for proper operation");
1161
1162 if (TARGET_IWMMXT_ABI && !TARGET_IWMMXT)
1163 error ("iwmmxt abi requires an iwmmxt capable cpu");
1164
1165 arm_fp_model = ARM_FP_MODEL_UNKNOWN;
1166 if (target_fpu_name == NULL && target_fpe_name != NULL)
1167 {
1168 if (streq (target_fpe_name, "2"))
1169 target_fpu_name = "fpe2";
1170 else if (streq (target_fpe_name, "3"))
1171 target_fpu_name = "fpe3";
1172 else
1173 error ("invalid floating point emulation option: -mfpe=%s",
1174 target_fpe_name);
1175 }
1176 if (target_fpu_name != NULL)
1177 {
1178 /* The user specified a FPU. */
1179 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (all_fpus); i++)
1180 {
1181 if (streq (all_fpus[i].name, target_fpu_name))
1182 {
1183 arm_fpu_arch = all_fpus[i].fpu;
1184 arm_fpu_tune = arm_fpu_arch;
1185 arm_fp_model = fp_model_for_fpu[arm_fpu_arch];
1186 break;
1187 }
1188 }
1189 if (arm_fp_model == ARM_FP_MODEL_UNKNOWN)
1190 error ("invalid floating point option: -mfpu=%s", target_fpu_name);
1191 }
1192 else
1193 {
1194 #ifdef FPUTYPE_DEFAULT
1195 /* Use the default if it is specified for this platform. */
1196 arm_fpu_arch = FPUTYPE_DEFAULT;
1197 arm_fpu_tune = FPUTYPE_DEFAULT;
1198 #else
1199 /* Pick one based on CPU type. */
1200 /* ??? Some targets assume FPA is the default.
1201 if ((insn_flags & FL_VFP) != 0)
1202 arm_fpu_arch = FPUTYPE_VFP;
1203 else
1204 */
1205 if (arm_arch_cirrus)
1206 arm_fpu_arch = FPUTYPE_MAVERICK;
1207 else
1208 arm_fpu_arch = FPUTYPE_FPA_EMU2;
1209 #endif
1210 if (tune_flags & FL_CO_PROC && arm_fpu_arch == FPUTYPE_FPA_EMU2)
1211 arm_fpu_tune = FPUTYPE_FPA;
1212 else
1213 arm_fpu_tune = arm_fpu_arch;
1214 arm_fp_model = fp_model_for_fpu[arm_fpu_arch];
1215 gcc_assert (arm_fp_model != ARM_FP_MODEL_UNKNOWN);
1216 }
1217
1218 if (target_float_abi_name != NULL)
1219 {
1220 /* The user specified a FP ABI. */
1221 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (all_float_abis); i++)
1222 {
1223 if (streq (all_float_abis[i].name, target_float_abi_name))
1224 {
1225 arm_float_abi = all_float_abis[i].abi_type;
1226 break;
1227 }
1228 }
1229 if (i == ARRAY_SIZE (all_float_abis))
1230 error ("invalid floating point abi: -mfloat-abi=%s",
1231 target_float_abi_name);
1232 }
1233 else
1234 arm_float_abi = TARGET_DEFAULT_FLOAT_ABI;
1235
1236 if (arm_float_abi == ARM_FLOAT_ABI_HARD && TARGET_VFP)
1237 sorry ("-mfloat-abi=hard and VFP");
1238
1239 /* FPA and iWMMXt are incompatible because the insn encodings overlap.
1240 VFP and iWMMXt can theoretically coexist, but it's unlikely such silicon
1241 will ever exist. GCC makes no attempt to support this combination. */
1242 if (TARGET_IWMMXT && !TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT)
1243 sorry ("iWMMXt and hardware floating point");
1244
1245 /* If soft-float is specified then don't use FPU. */
1246 if (TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT)
1247 arm_fpu_arch = FPUTYPE_NONE;
1248
1249 /* For arm2/3 there is no need to do any scheduling if there is only
1250 a floating point emulator, or we are doing software floating-point. */
1251 if ((TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT
1252 || arm_fpu_tune == FPUTYPE_FPA_EMU2
1253 || arm_fpu_tune == FPUTYPE_FPA_EMU3)
1254 && (tune_flags & FL_MODE32) == 0)
1255 flag_schedule_insns = flag_schedule_insns_after_reload = 0;
1256
1257 if (target_thread_switch)
1258 {
1259 if (strcmp (target_thread_switch, "soft") == 0)
1260 target_thread_pointer = TP_SOFT;
1261 else if (strcmp (target_thread_switch, "auto") == 0)
1262 target_thread_pointer = TP_AUTO;
1263 else if (strcmp (target_thread_switch, "cp15") == 0)
1264 target_thread_pointer = TP_CP15;
1265 else
1266 error ("invalid thread pointer option: -mtp=%s", target_thread_switch);
1267 }
1268
1269 /* Use the cp15 method if it is available. */
1270 if (target_thread_pointer == TP_AUTO)
1271 {
1272 if (arm_arch6k && !TARGET_THUMB)
1273 target_thread_pointer = TP_CP15;
1274 else
1275 target_thread_pointer = TP_SOFT;
1276 }
1277
1278 if (TARGET_HARD_TP && TARGET_THUMB)
1279 error ("can not use -mtp=cp15 with -mthumb");
1280
1281 /* Override the default structure alignment for AAPCS ABI. */
1282 if (TARGET_AAPCS_BASED)
1283 arm_structure_size_boundary = 8;
1284
1285 if (structure_size_string != NULL)
1286 {
1287 int size = strtol (structure_size_string, NULL, 0);
1288
1289 if (size == 8 || size == 32
1290 || (ARM_DOUBLEWORD_ALIGN && size == 64))
1291 arm_structure_size_boundary = size;
1292 else
1293 warning (0, "structure size boundary can only be set to %s",
1294 ARM_DOUBLEWORD_ALIGN ? "8, 32 or 64": "8 or 32");
1295 }
1296
1297 if (arm_pic_register_string != NULL)
1298 {
1299 int pic_register = decode_reg_name (arm_pic_register_string);
1300
1301 if (!flag_pic)
1302 warning (0, "-mpic-register= is useless without -fpic");
1303
1304 /* Prevent the user from choosing an obviously stupid PIC register. */
1305 else if (pic_register < 0 || call_used_regs[pic_register]
1306 || pic_register == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1307 || pic_register == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1308 || pic_register >= PC_REGNUM)
1309 error ("unable to use '%s' for PIC register", arm_pic_register_string);
1310 else
1311 arm_pic_register = pic_register;
1312 }
1313
1314 if (TARGET_THUMB && flag_schedule_insns)
1315 {
1316 /* Don't warn since it's on by default in -O2. */
1317 flag_schedule_insns = 0;
1318 }
1319
1320 if (optimize_size)
1321 {
1322 arm_constant_limit = 1;
1323
1324 /* If optimizing for size, bump the number of instructions that we
1325 are prepared to conditionally execute (even on a StrongARM). */
1326 max_insns_skipped = 6;
1327 }
1328 else
1329 {
1330 /* For processors with load scheduling, it never costs more than
1331 2 cycles to load a constant, and the load scheduler may well
1332 reduce that to 1. */
1333 if (arm_ld_sched)
1334 arm_constant_limit = 1;
1335
1336 /* On XScale the longer latency of a load makes it more difficult
1337 to achieve a good schedule, so it's faster to synthesize
1338 constants that can be done in two insns. */
1339 if (arm_tune_xscale)
1340 arm_constant_limit = 2;
1341
1342 /* StrongARM has early execution of branches, so a sequence
1343 that is worth skipping is shorter. */
1344 if (arm_tune_strongarm)
1345 max_insns_skipped = 3;
1346 }
1347
1348 /* Register global variables with the garbage collector. */
1349 arm_add_gc_roots ();
1350 }
1351
1352 static void
arm_add_gc_roots(void)1353 arm_add_gc_roots (void)
1354 {
1355 gcc_obstack_init(&minipool_obstack);
1356 minipool_startobj = (char *) obstack_alloc (&minipool_obstack, 0);
1357 }
1358
1359 /* A table of known ARM exception types.
1360 For use with the interrupt function attribute. */
1361
1362 typedef struct
1363 {
1364 const char *const arg;
1365 const unsigned long return_value;
1366 }
1367 isr_attribute_arg;
1368
1369 static const isr_attribute_arg isr_attribute_args [] =
1370 {
1371 { "IRQ", ARM_FT_ISR },
1372 { "irq", ARM_FT_ISR },
1373 { "FIQ", ARM_FT_FIQ },
1374 { "fiq", ARM_FT_FIQ },
1375 { "ABORT", ARM_FT_ISR },
1376 { "abort", ARM_FT_ISR },
1377 { "ABORT", ARM_FT_ISR },
1378 { "abort", ARM_FT_ISR },
1379 { "UNDEF", ARM_FT_EXCEPTION },
1380 { "undef", ARM_FT_EXCEPTION },
1381 { "SWI", ARM_FT_EXCEPTION },
1382 { "swi", ARM_FT_EXCEPTION },
1383 { NULL, ARM_FT_NORMAL }
1384 };
1385
1386 /* Returns the (interrupt) function type of the current
1387 function, or ARM_FT_UNKNOWN if the type cannot be determined. */
1388
1389 static unsigned long
arm_isr_value(tree argument)1390 arm_isr_value (tree argument)
1391 {
1392 const isr_attribute_arg * ptr;
1393 const char * arg;
1394
1395 /* No argument - default to IRQ. */
1396 if (argument == NULL_TREE)
1397 return ARM_FT_ISR;
1398
1399 /* Get the value of the argument. */
1400 if (TREE_VALUE (argument) == NULL_TREE
1401 || TREE_CODE (TREE_VALUE (argument)) != STRING_CST)
1402 return ARM_FT_UNKNOWN;
1403
1404 arg = TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (argument));
1405
1406 /* Check it against the list of known arguments. */
1407 for (ptr = isr_attribute_args; ptr->arg != NULL; ptr++)
1408 if (streq (arg, ptr->arg))
1409 return ptr->return_value;
1410
1411 /* An unrecognized interrupt type. */
1412 return ARM_FT_UNKNOWN;
1413 }
1414
1415 /* Computes the type of the current function. */
1416
1417 static unsigned long
arm_compute_func_type(void)1418 arm_compute_func_type (void)
1419 {
1420 unsigned long type = ARM_FT_UNKNOWN;
1421 tree a;
1422 tree attr;
1423
1424 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (current_function_decl) == FUNCTION_DECL);
1425
1426 /* Decide if the current function is volatile. Such functions
1427 never return, and many memory cycles can be saved by not storing
1428 register values that will never be needed again. This optimization
1429 was added to speed up context switching in a kernel application. */
1430 if (optimize > 0
1431 && (TREE_NOTHROW (current_function_decl)
1432 || !(flag_unwind_tables
1433 || (flag_exceptions && !USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)))
1434 && TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (current_function_decl))
1435 type |= ARM_FT_VOLATILE;
1436
1437 if (cfun->static_chain_decl != NULL)
1438 type |= ARM_FT_NESTED;
1439
1440 attr = DECL_ATTRIBUTES (current_function_decl);
1441
1442 a = lookup_attribute ("naked", attr);
1443 if (a != NULL_TREE)
1444 type |= ARM_FT_NAKED;
1445
1446 a = lookup_attribute ("isr", attr);
1447 if (a == NULL_TREE)
1448 a = lookup_attribute ("interrupt", attr);
1449
1450 if (a == NULL_TREE)
1451 type |= TARGET_INTERWORK ? ARM_FT_INTERWORKED : ARM_FT_NORMAL;
1452 else
1453 type |= arm_isr_value (TREE_VALUE (a));
1454
1455 return type;
1456 }
1457
1458 /* Returns the type of the current function. */
1459
1460 unsigned long
arm_current_func_type(void)1461 arm_current_func_type (void)
1462 {
1463 if (ARM_FUNC_TYPE (cfun->machine->func_type) == ARM_FT_UNKNOWN)
1464 cfun->machine->func_type = arm_compute_func_type ();
1465
1466 return cfun->machine->func_type;
1467 }
1468
1469 /* Return 1 if it is possible to return using a single instruction.
1470 If SIBLING is non-null, this is a test for a return before a sibling
1471 call. SIBLING is the call insn, so we can examine its register usage. */
1472
1473 int
use_return_insn(int iscond,rtx sibling)1474 use_return_insn (int iscond, rtx sibling)
1475 {
1476 int regno;
1477 unsigned int func_type;
1478 unsigned long saved_int_regs;
1479 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust;
1480 arm_stack_offsets *offsets;
1481
1482 /* Never use a return instruction before reload has run. */
1483 if (!reload_completed)
1484 return 0;
1485
1486 func_type = arm_current_func_type ();
1487
1488 /* Naked functions and volatile functions need special
1489 consideration. */
1490 if (func_type & (ARM_FT_VOLATILE | ARM_FT_NAKED))
1491 return 0;
1492
1493 /* So do interrupt functions that use the frame pointer. */
1494 if (IS_INTERRUPT (func_type) && frame_pointer_needed)
1495 return 0;
1496
1497 offsets = arm_get_frame_offsets ();
1498 stack_adjust = offsets->outgoing_args - offsets->saved_regs;
1499
1500 /* As do variadic functions. */
1501 if (current_function_pretend_args_size
1502 || cfun->machine->uses_anonymous_args
1503 /* Or if the function calls __builtin_eh_return () */
1504 || current_function_calls_eh_return
1505 /* Or if the function calls alloca */
1506 || current_function_calls_alloca
1507 /* Or if there is a stack adjustment. However, if the stack pointer
1508 is saved on the stack, we can use a pre-incrementing stack load. */
1509 || !(stack_adjust == 0 || (frame_pointer_needed && stack_adjust == 4)))
1510 return 0;
1511
1512 saved_int_regs = arm_compute_save_reg_mask ();
1513
1514 /* Unfortunately, the insn
1515
1516 ldmib sp, {..., sp, ...}
1517
1518 triggers a bug on most SA-110 based devices, such that the stack
1519 pointer won't be correctly restored if the instruction takes a
1520 page fault. We work around this problem by popping r3 along with
1521 the other registers, since that is never slower than executing
1522 another instruction.
1523
1524 We test for !arm_arch5 here, because code for any architecture
1525 less than this could potentially be run on one of the buggy
1526 chips. */
1527 if (stack_adjust == 4 && !arm_arch5)
1528 {
1529 /* Validate that r3 is a call-clobbered register (always true in
1530 the default abi) ... */
1531 if (!call_used_regs[3])
1532 return 0;
1533
1534 /* ... that it isn't being used for a return value ... */
1535 if (arm_size_return_regs () >= (4 * UNITS_PER_WORD))
1536 return 0;
1537
1538 /* ... or for a tail-call argument ... */
1539 if (sibling)
1540 {
1541 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (sibling) == CALL_INSN);
1542
1543 if (find_regno_fusage (sibling, USE, 3))
1544 return 0;
1545 }
1546
1547 /* ... and that there are no call-saved registers in r0-r2
1548 (always true in the default ABI). */
1549 if (saved_int_regs & 0x7)
1550 return 0;
1551 }
1552
1553 /* Can't be done if interworking with Thumb, and any registers have been
1554 stacked. */
1555 if (TARGET_INTERWORK && saved_int_regs != 0)
1556 return 0;
1557
1558 /* On StrongARM, conditional returns are expensive if they aren't
1559 taken and multiple registers have been stacked. */
1560 if (iscond && arm_tune_strongarm)
1561 {
1562 /* Conditional return when just the LR is stored is a simple
1563 conditional-load instruction, that's not expensive. */
1564 if (saved_int_regs != 0 && saved_int_regs != (1 << LR_REGNUM))
1565 return 0;
1566
1567 if (flag_pic
1568 && arm_pic_register != INVALID_REGNUM
1569 && regs_ever_live[PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM])
1570 return 0;
1571 }
1572
1573 /* If there are saved registers but the LR isn't saved, then we need
1574 two instructions for the return. */
1575 if (saved_int_regs && !(saved_int_regs & (1 << LR_REGNUM)))
1576 return 0;
1577
1578 /* Can't be done if any of the FPA regs are pushed,
1579 since this also requires an insn. */
1580 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && TARGET_FPA)
1581 for (regno = FIRST_FPA_REGNUM; regno <= LAST_FPA_REGNUM; regno++)
1582 if (regs_ever_live[regno] && !call_used_regs[regno])
1583 return 0;
1584
1585 /* Likewise VFP regs. */
1586 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && TARGET_VFP)
1587 for (regno = FIRST_VFP_REGNUM; regno <= LAST_VFP_REGNUM; regno++)
1588 if (regs_ever_live[regno] && !call_used_regs[regno])
1589 return 0;
1590
1591 if (TARGET_REALLY_IWMMXT)
1592 for (regno = FIRST_IWMMXT_REGNUM; regno <= LAST_IWMMXT_REGNUM; regno++)
1593 if (regs_ever_live[regno] && ! call_used_regs [regno])
1594 return 0;
1595
1596 return 1;
1597 }
1598
1599 /* Return TRUE if int I is a valid immediate ARM constant. */
1600
1601 int
const_ok_for_arm(HOST_WIDE_INT i)1602 const_ok_for_arm (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
1603 {
1604 int lowbit;
1605
1606 /* For machines with >32 bit HOST_WIDE_INT, the bits above bit 31 must
1607 be all zero, or all one. */
1608 if ((i & ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xffffffff) != 0
1609 && ((i & ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xffffffff)
1610 != ((~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0)
1611 & ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xffffffff)))
1612 return FALSE;
1613
1614 i &= (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xffffffff;
1615
1616 /* Fast return for 0 and small values. We must do this for zero, since
1617 the code below can't handle that one case. */
1618 if ((i & ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xff) == 0)
1619 return TRUE;
1620
1621 /* Get the number of trailing zeros, rounded down to the nearest even
1622 number. */
1623 lowbit = (ffs ((int) i) - 1) & ~1;
1624
1625 if ((i & ~(((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xff) << lowbit)) == 0)
1626 return TRUE;
1627 else if (lowbit <= 4
1628 && ((i & ~0xc000003f) == 0
1629 || (i & ~0xf000000f) == 0
1630 || (i & ~0xfc000003) == 0))
1631 return TRUE;
1632
1633 return FALSE;
1634 }
1635
1636 /* Return true if I is a valid constant for the operation CODE. */
1637 static int
const_ok_for_op(HOST_WIDE_INT i,enum rtx_code code)1638 const_ok_for_op (HOST_WIDE_INT i, enum rtx_code code)
1639 {
1640 if (const_ok_for_arm (i))
1641 return 1;
1642
1643 switch (code)
1644 {
1645 case PLUS:
1646 return const_ok_for_arm (ARM_SIGN_EXTEND (-i));
1647
1648 case MINUS: /* Should only occur with (MINUS I reg) => rsb */
1649 case XOR:
1650 case IOR:
1651 return 0;
1652
1653 case AND:
1654 return const_ok_for_arm (ARM_SIGN_EXTEND (~i));
1655
1656 default:
1657 gcc_unreachable ();
1658 }
1659 }
1660
1661 /* Emit a sequence of insns to handle a large constant.
1662 CODE is the code of the operation required, it can be any of SET, PLUS,
1663 IOR, AND, XOR, MINUS;
1664 MODE is the mode in which the operation is being performed;
1665 VAL is the integer to operate on;
1666 SOURCE is the other operand (a register, or a null-pointer for SET);
1667 SUBTARGETS means it is safe to create scratch registers if that will
1668 either produce a simpler sequence, or we will want to cse the values.
1669 Return value is the number of insns emitted. */
1670
1671 int
arm_split_constant(enum rtx_code code,enum machine_mode mode,rtx insn,HOST_WIDE_INT val,rtx target,rtx source,int subtargets)1672 arm_split_constant (enum rtx_code code, enum machine_mode mode, rtx insn,
1673 HOST_WIDE_INT val, rtx target, rtx source, int subtargets)
1674 {
1675 rtx cond;
1676
1677 if (insn && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == COND_EXEC)
1678 cond = COND_EXEC_TEST (PATTERN (insn));
1679 else
1680 cond = NULL_RTX;
1681
1682 if (subtargets || code == SET
1683 || (GET_CODE (target) == REG && GET_CODE (source) == REG
1684 && REGNO (target) != REGNO (source)))
1685 {
1686 /* After arm_reorg has been called, we can't fix up expensive
1687 constants by pushing them into memory so we must synthesize
1688 them in-line, regardless of the cost. This is only likely to
1689 be more costly on chips that have load delay slots and we are
1690 compiling without running the scheduler (so no splitting
1691 occurred before the final instruction emission).
1692
1693 Ref: gcc -O1 -mcpu=strongarm gcc.c-torture/compile/980506-2.c
1694 */
1695 if (!after_arm_reorg
1696 && !cond
1697 && (arm_gen_constant (code, mode, NULL_RTX, val, target, source,
1698 1, 0)
1699 > arm_constant_limit + (code != SET)))
1700 {
1701 if (code == SET)
1702 {
1703 /* Currently SET is the only monadic value for CODE, all
1704 the rest are diadic. */
1705 emit_set_insn (target, GEN_INT (val));
1706 return 1;
1707 }
1708 else
1709 {
1710 rtx temp = subtargets ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : target;
1711
1712 emit_set_insn (temp, GEN_INT (val));
1713 /* For MINUS, the value is subtracted from, since we never
1714 have subtraction of a constant. */
1715 if (code == MINUS)
1716 emit_set_insn (target, gen_rtx_MINUS (mode, temp, source));
1717 else
1718 emit_set_insn (target,
1719 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, mode, source, temp));
1720 return 2;
1721 }
1722 }
1723 }
1724
1725 return arm_gen_constant (code, mode, cond, val, target, source, subtargets,
1726 1);
1727 }
1728
1729 static int
count_insns_for_constant(HOST_WIDE_INT remainder,int i)1730 count_insns_for_constant (HOST_WIDE_INT remainder, int i)
1731 {
1732 HOST_WIDE_INT temp1;
1733 int num_insns = 0;
1734 do
1735 {
1736 int end;
1737
1738 if (i <= 0)
1739 i += 32;
1740 if (remainder & (3 << (i - 2)))
1741 {
1742 end = i - 8;
1743 if (end < 0)
1744 end += 32;
1745 temp1 = remainder & ((0x0ff << end)
1746 | ((i < end) ? (0xff >> (32 - end)) : 0));
1747 remainder &= ~temp1;
1748 num_insns++;
1749 i -= 6;
1750 }
1751 i -= 2;
1752 } while (remainder);
1753 return num_insns;
1754 }
1755
1756 /* Emit an instruction with the indicated PATTERN. If COND is
1757 non-NULL, conditionalize the execution of the instruction on COND
1758 being true. */
1759
1760 static void
emit_constant_insn(rtx cond,rtx pattern)1761 emit_constant_insn (rtx cond, rtx pattern)
1762 {
1763 if (cond)
1764 pattern = gen_rtx_COND_EXEC (VOIDmode, copy_rtx (cond), pattern);
1765 emit_insn (pattern);
1766 }
1767
1768 /* As above, but extra parameter GENERATE which, if clear, suppresses
1769 RTL generation. */
1770
1771 static int
arm_gen_constant(enum rtx_code code,enum machine_mode mode,rtx cond,HOST_WIDE_INT val,rtx target,rtx source,int subtargets,int generate)1772 arm_gen_constant (enum rtx_code code, enum machine_mode mode, rtx cond,
1773 HOST_WIDE_INT val, rtx target, rtx source, int subtargets,
1774 int generate)
1775 {
1776 int can_invert = 0;
1777 int can_negate = 0;
1778 int can_negate_initial = 0;
1779 int can_shift = 0;
1780 int i;
1781 int num_bits_set = 0;
1782 int set_sign_bit_copies = 0;
1783 int clear_sign_bit_copies = 0;
1784 int clear_zero_bit_copies = 0;
1785 int set_zero_bit_copies = 0;
1786 int insns = 0;
1787 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT temp1, temp2;
1788 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT remainder = val & 0xffffffff;
1789
1790 /* Find out which operations are safe for a given CODE. Also do a quick
1791 check for degenerate cases; these can occur when DImode operations
1792 are split. */
1793 switch (code)
1794 {
1795 case SET:
1796 can_invert = 1;
1797 can_shift = 1;
1798 can_negate = 1;
1799 break;
1800
1801 case PLUS:
1802 can_negate = 1;
1803 can_negate_initial = 1;
1804 break;
1805
1806 case IOR:
1807 if (remainder == 0xffffffff)
1808 {
1809 if (generate)
1810 emit_constant_insn (cond,
1811 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target,
1812 GEN_INT (ARM_SIGN_EXTEND (val))));
1813 return 1;
1814 }
1815 if (remainder == 0)
1816 {
1817 if (reload_completed && rtx_equal_p (target, source))
1818 return 0;
1819 if (generate)
1820 emit_constant_insn (cond,
1821 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, source));
1822 return 1;
1823 }
1824 break;
1825
1826 case AND:
1827 if (remainder == 0)
1828 {
1829 if (generate)
1830 emit_constant_insn (cond,
1831 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, const0_rtx));
1832 return 1;
1833 }
1834 if (remainder == 0xffffffff)
1835 {
1836 if (reload_completed && rtx_equal_p (target, source))
1837 return 0;
1838 if (generate)
1839 emit_constant_insn (cond,
1840 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, source));
1841 return 1;
1842 }
1843 can_invert = 1;
1844 break;
1845
1846 case XOR:
1847 if (remainder == 0)
1848 {
1849 if (reload_completed && rtx_equal_p (target, source))
1850 return 0;
1851 if (generate)
1852 emit_constant_insn (cond,
1853 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target, source));
1854 return 1;
1855 }
1856
1857 /* We don't know how to handle other cases yet. */
1858 gcc_assert (remainder == 0xffffffff);
1859
1860 if (generate)
1861 emit_constant_insn (cond,
1862 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target,
1863 gen_rtx_NOT (mode, source)));
1864 return 1;
1865
1866 case MINUS:
1867 /* We treat MINUS as (val - source), since (source - val) is always
1868 passed as (source + (-val)). */
1869 if (remainder == 0)
1870 {
1871 if (generate)
1872 emit_constant_insn (cond,
1873 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target,
1874 gen_rtx_NEG (mode, source)));
1875 return 1;
1876 }
1877 if (const_ok_for_arm (val))
1878 {
1879 if (generate)
1880 emit_constant_insn (cond,
1881 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target,
1882 gen_rtx_MINUS (mode, GEN_INT (val),
1883 source)));
1884 return 1;
1885 }
1886 can_negate = 1;
1887
1888 break;
1889
1890 default:
1891 gcc_unreachable ();
1892 }
1893
1894 /* If we can do it in one insn get out quickly. */
1895 if (const_ok_for_arm (val)
1896 || (can_negate_initial && const_ok_for_arm (-val))
1897 || (can_invert && const_ok_for_arm (~val)))
1898 {
1899 if (generate)
1900 emit_constant_insn (cond,
1901 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target,
1902 (source
1903 ? gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, mode, source,
1904 GEN_INT (val))
1905 : GEN_INT (val))));
1906 return 1;
1907 }
1908
1909 /* Calculate a few attributes that may be useful for specific
1910 optimizations. */
1911 for (i = 31; i >= 0; i--)
1912 {
1913 if ((remainder & (1 << i)) == 0)
1914 clear_sign_bit_copies++;
1915 else
1916 break;
1917 }
1918
1919 for (i = 31; i >= 0; i--)
1920 {
1921 if ((remainder & (1 << i)) != 0)
1922 set_sign_bit_copies++;
1923 else
1924 break;
1925 }
1926
1927 for (i = 0; i <= 31; i++)
1928 {
1929 if ((remainder & (1 << i)) == 0)
1930 clear_zero_bit_copies++;
1931 else
1932 break;
1933 }
1934
1935 for (i = 0; i <= 31; i++)
1936 {
1937 if ((remainder & (1 << i)) != 0)
1938 set_zero_bit_copies++;
1939 else
1940 break;
1941 }
1942
1943 switch (code)
1944 {
1945 case SET:
1946 /* See if we can do this by sign_extending a constant that is known
1947 to be negative. This is a good, way of doing it, since the shift
1948 may well merge into a subsequent insn. */
1949 if (set_sign_bit_copies > 1)
1950 {
1951 if (const_ok_for_arm
1952 (temp1 = ARM_SIGN_EXTEND (remainder
1953 << (set_sign_bit_copies - 1))))
1954 {
1955 if (generate)
1956 {
1957 rtx new_src = subtargets ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : target;
1958 emit_constant_insn (cond,
1959 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, new_src,
1960 GEN_INT (temp1)));
1961 emit_constant_insn (cond,
1962 gen_ashrsi3 (target, new_src,
1963 GEN_INT (set_sign_bit_copies - 1)));
1964 }
1965 return 2;
1966 }
1967 /* For an inverted constant, we will need to set the low bits,
1968 these will be shifted out of harm's way. */
1969 temp1 |= (1 << (set_sign_bit_copies - 1)) - 1;
1970 if (const_ok_for_arm (~temp1))
1971 {
1972 if (generate)
1973 {
1974 rtx new_src = subtargets ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : target;
1975 emit_constant_insn (cond,
1976 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, new_src,
1977 GEN_INT (temp1)));
1978 emit_constant_insn (cond,
1979 gen_ashrsi3 (target, new_src,
1980 GEN_INT (set_sign_bit_copies - 1)));
1981 }
1982 return 2;
1983 }
1984 }
1985
1986 /* See if we can calculate the value as the difference between two
1987 valid immediates. */
1988 if (clear_sign_bit_copies + clear_zero_bit_copies <= 16)
1989 {
1990 int topshift = clear_sign_bit_copies & ~1;
1991
1992 temp1 = ARM_SIGN_EXTEND ((remainder + (0x00800000 >> topshift))
1993 & (0xff000000 >> topshift));
1994
1995 /* If temp1 is zero, then that means the 9 most significant
1996 bits of remainder were 1 and we've caused it to overflow.
1997 When topshift is 0 we don't need to do anything since we
1998 can borrow from 'bit 32'. */
1999 if (temp1 == 0 && topshift != 0)
2000 temp1 = 0x80000000 >> (topshift - 1);
2001
2002 temp2 = ARM_SIGN_EXTEND (temp1 - remainder);
2003
2004 if (const_ok_for_arm (temp2))
2005 {
2006 if (generate)
2007 {
2008 rtx new_src = subtargets ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : target;
2009 emit_constant_insn (cond,
2010 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, new_src,
2011 GEN_INT (temp1)));
2012 emit_constant_insn (cond,
2013 gen_addsi3 (target, new_src,
2014 GEN_INT (-temp2)));
2015 }
2016
2017 return 2;
2018 }
2019 }
2020
2021 /* See if we can generate this by setting the bottom (or the top)
2022 16 bits, and then shifting these into the other half of the
2023 word. We only look for the simplest cases, to do more would cost
2024 too much. Be careful, however, not to generate this when the
2025 alternative would take fewer insns. */
2026 if (val & 0xffff0000)
2027 {
2028 temp1 = remainder & 0xffff0000;
2029 temp2 = remainder & 0x0000ffff;
2030
2031 /* Overlaps outside this range are best done using other methods. */
2032 for (i = 9; i < 24; i++)
2033 {
2034 if ((((temp2 | (temp2 << i)) & 0xffffffff) == remainder)
2035 && !const_ok_for_arm (temp2))
2036 {
2037 rtx new_src = (subtargets
2038 ? (generate ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : NULL_RTX)
2039 : target);
2040 insns = arm_gen_constant (code, mode, cond, temp2, new_src,
2041 source, subtargets, generate);
2042 source = new_src;
2043 if (generate)
2044 emit_constant_insn
2045 (cond,
2046 gen_rtx_SET
2047 (VOIDmode, target,
2048 gen_rtx_IOR (mode,
2049 gen_rtx_ASHIFT (mode, source,
2050 GEN_INT (i)),
2051 source)));
2052 return insns + 1;
2053 }
2054 }
2055
2056 /* Don't duplicate cases already considered. */
2057 for (i = 17; i < 24; i++)
2058 {
2059 if (((temp1 | (temp1 >> i)) == remainder)
2060 && !const_ok_for_arm (temp1))
2061 {
2062 rtx new_src = (subtargets
2063 ? (generate ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : NULL_RTX)
2064 : target);
2065 insns = arm_gen_constant (code, mode, cond, temp1, new_src,
2066 source, subtargets, generate);
2067 source = new_src;
2068 if (generate)
2069 emit_constant_insn
2070 (cond,
2071 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target,
2072 gen_rtx_IOR
2073 (mode,
2074 gen_rtx_LSHIFTRT (mode, source,
2075 GEN_INT (i)),
2076 source)));
2077 return insns + 1;
2078 }
2079 }
2080 }
2081 break;
2082
2083 case IOR:
2084 case XOR:
2085 /* If we have IOR or XOR, and the constant can be loaded in a
2086 single instruction, and we can find a temporary to put it in,
2087 then this can be done in two instructions instead of 3-4. */
2088 if (subtargets
2089 /* TARGET can't be NULL if SUBTARGETS is 0 */
2090 || (reload_completed && !reg_mentioned_p (target, source)))
2091 {
2092 if (const_ok_for_arm (ARM_SIGN_EXTEND (~val)))
2093 {
2094 if (generate)
2095 {
2096 rtx sub = subtargets ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : target;
2097
2098 emit_constant_insn (cond,
2099 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, sub,
2100 GEN_INT (val)));
2101 emit_constant_insn (cond,
2102 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target,
2103 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, mode,
2104 source, sub)));
2105 }
2106 return 2;
2107 }
2108 }
2109
2110 if (code == XOR)
2111 break;
2112
2113 if (set_sign_bit_copies > 8
2114 && (val & (-1 << (32 - set_sign_bit_copies))) == val)
2115 {
2116 if (generate)
2117 {
2118 rtx sub = subtargets ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : target;
2119 rtx shift = GEN_INT (set_sign_bit_copies);
2120
2121 emit_constant_insn
2122 (cond,
2123 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, sub,
2124 gen_rtx_NOT (mode,
2125 gen_rtx_ASHIFT (mode,
2126 source,
2127 shift))));
2128 emit_constant_insn
2129 (cond,
2130 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target,
2131 gen_rtx_NOT (mode,
2132 gen_rtx_LSHIFTRT (mode, sub,
2133 shift))));
2134 }
2135 return 2;
2136 }
2137
2138 if (set_zero_bit_copies > 8
2139 && (remainder & ((1 << set_zero_bit_copies) - 1)) == remainder)
2140 {
2141 if (generate)
2142 {
2143 rtx sub = subtargets ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : target;
2144 rtx shift = GEN_INT (set_zero_bit_copies);
2145
2146 emit_constant_insn
2147 (cond,
2148 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, sub,
2149 gen_rtx_NOT (mode,
2150 gen_rtx_LSHIFTRT (mode,
2151 source,
2152 shift))));
2153 emit_constant_insn
2154 (cond,
2155 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target,
2156 gen_rtx_NOT (mode,
2157 gen_rtx_ASHIFT (mode, sub,
2158 shift))));
2159 }
2160 return 2;
2161 }
2162
2163 if (const_ok_for_arm (temp1 = ARM_SIGN_EXTEND (~val)))
2164 {
2165 if (generate)
2166 {
2167 rtx sub = subtargets ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : target;
2168 emit_constant_insn (cond,
2169 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, sub,
2170 gen_rtx_NOT (mode, source)));
2171 source = sub;
2172 if (subtargets)
2173 sub = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2174 emit_constant_insn (cond,
2175 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, sub,
2176 gen_rtx_AND (mode, source,
2177 GEN_INT (temp1))));
2178 emit_constant_insn (cond,
2179 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, target,
2180 gen_rtx_NOT (mode, sub)));
2181 }
2182 return 3;
2183 }
2184 break;
2185
2186 case AND:
2187 /* See if two shifts will do 2 or more insn's worth of work. */
2188 if (clear_sign_bit_copies >= 16 && clear_sign_bit_copies < 24)
2189 {
2190 HOST_WIDE_INT shift_mask = ((0xffffffff
2191 << (32 - clear_sign_bit_copies))
2192 & 0xffffffff);
2193
2194 if ((remainder | shift_mask) != 0xffffffff)
2195 {
2196 if (generate)
2197 {
2198 rtx new_src = subtargets ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : target;
2199 insns = arm_gen_constant (AND, mode, cond,
2200 remainder | shift_mask,
2201 new_src, source, subtargets, 1);
2202 source = new_src;
2203 }
2204 else
2205 {
2206 rtx targ = subtargets ? NULL_RTX : target;
2207 insns = arm_gen_constant (AND, mode, cond,
2208 remainder | shift_mask,
2209 targ, source, subtargets, 0);
2210 }
2211 }
2212
2213 if (generate)
2214 {
2215 rtx new_src = subtargets ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : target;
2216 rtx shift = GEN_INT (clear_sign_bit_copies);
2217
2218 emit_insn (gen_ashlsi3 (new_src, source, shift));
2219 emit_insn (gen_lshrsi3 (target, new_src, shift));
2220 }
2221
2222 return insns + 2;
2223 }
2224
2225 if (clear_zero_bit_copies >= 16 && clear_zero_bit_copies < 24)
2226 {
2227 HOST_WIDE_INT shift_mask = (1 << clear_zero_bit_copies) - 1;
2228
2229 if ((remainder | shift_mask) != 0xffffffff)
2230 {
2231 if (generate)
2232 {
2233 rtx new_src = subtargets ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : target;
2234
2235 insns = arm_gen_constant (AND, mode, cond,
2236 remainder | shift_mask,
2237 new_src, source, subtargets, 1);
2238 source = new_src;
2239 }
2240 else
2241 {
2242 rtx targ = subtargets ? NULL_RTX : target;
2243
2244 insns = arm_gen_constant (AND, mode, cond,
2245 remainder | shift_mask,
2246 targ, source, subtargets, 0);
2247 }
2248 }
2249
2250 if (generate)
2251 {
2252 rtx new_src = subtargets ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : target;
2253 rtx shift = GEN_INT (clear_zero_bit_copies);
2254
2255 emit_insn (gen_lshrsi3 (new_src, source, shift));
2256 emit_insn (gen_ashlsi3 (target, new_src, shift));
2257 }
2258
2259 return insns + 2;
2260 }
2261
2262 break;
2263
2264 default:
2265 break;
2266 }
2267
2268 for (i = 0; i < 32; i++)
2269 if (remainder & (1 << i))
2270 num_bits_set++;
2271
2272 if (code == AND || (can_invert && num_bits_set > 16))
2273 remainder = (~remainder) & 0xffffffff;
2274 else if (code == PLUS && num_bits_set > 16)
2275 remainder = (-remainder) & 0xffffffff;
2276 else
2277 {
2278 can_invert = 0;
2279 can_negate = 0;
2280 }
2281
2282 /* Now try and find a way of doing the job in either two or three
2283 instructions.
2284 We start by looking for the largest block of zeros that are aligned on
2285 a 2-bit boundary, we then fill up the temps, wrapping around to the
2286 top of the word when we drop off the bottom.
2287 In the worst case this code should produce no more than four insns. */
2288 {
2289 int best_start = 0;
2290 int best_consecutive_zeros = 0;
2291
2292 for (i = 0; i < 32; i += 2)
2293 {
2294 int consecutive_zeros = 0;
2295
2296 if (!(remainder & (3 << i)))
2297 {
2298 while ((i < 32) && !(remainder & (3 << i)))
2299 {
2300 consecutive_zeros += 2;
2301 i += 2;
2302 }
2303 if (consecutive_zeros > best_consecutive_zeros)
2304 {
2305 best_consecutive_zeros = consecutive_zeros;
2306 best_start = i - consecutive_zeros;
2307 }
2308 i -= 2;
2309 }
2310 }
2311
2312 /* So long as it won't require any more insns to do so, it's
2313 desirable to emit a small constant (in bits 0...9) in the last
2314 insn. This way there is more chance that it can be combined with
2315 a later addressing insn to form a pre-indexed load or store
2316 operation. Consider:
2317
2318 *((volatile int *)0xe0000100) = 1;
2319 *((volatile int *)0xe0000110) = 2;
2320
2321 We want this to wind up as:
2322
2323 mov rA, #0xe0000000
2324 mov rB, #1
2325 str rB, [rA, #0x100]
2326 mov rB, #2
2327 str rB, [rA, #0x110]
2328
2329 rather than having to synthesize both large constants from scratch.
2330
2331 Therefore, we calculate how many insns would be required to emit
2332 the constant starting from `best_start', and also starting from
2333 zero (i.e. with bit 31 first to be output). If `best_start' doesn't
2334 yield a shorter sequence, we may as well use zero. */
2335 if (best_start != 0
2336 && ((((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1) << best_start) < remainder)
2337 && (count_insns_for_constant (remainder, 0) <=
2338 count_insns_for_constant (remainder, best_start)))
2339 best_start = 0;
2340
2341 /* Now start emitting the insns. */
2342 i = best_start;
2343 do
2344 {
2345 int end;
2346
2347 if (i <= 0)
2348 i += 32;
2349 if (remainder & (3 << (i - 2)))
2350 {
2351 end = i - 8;
2352 if (end < 0)
2353 end += 32;
2354 temp1 = remainder & ((0x0ff << end)
2355 | ((i < end) ? (0xff >> (32 - end)) : 0));
2356 remainder &= ~temp1;
2357
2358 if (generate)
2359 {
2360 rtx new_src, temp1_rtx;
2361
2362 if (code == SET || code == MINUS)
2363 {
2364 new_src = (subtargets ? gen_reg_rtx (mode) : target);
2365 if (can_invert && code != MINUS)
2366 temp1 = ~temp1;
2367 }
2368 else
2369 {
2370 if (remainder && subtargets)
2371 new_src = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
2372 else
2373 new_src = target;
2374 if (can_invert)
2375 temp1 = ~temp1;
2376 else if (can_negate)
2377 temp1 = -temp1;
2378 }
2379
2380 temp1 = trunc_int_for_mode (temp1, mode);
2381 temp1_rtx = GEN_INT (temp1);
2382
2383 if (code == SET)
2384 ;
2385 else if (code == MINUS)
2386 temp1_rtx = gen_rtx_MINUS (mode, temp1_rtx, source);
2387 else
2388 temp1_rtx = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, mode, source, temp1_rtx);
2389
2390 emit_constant_insn (cond,
2391 gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, new_src,
2392 temp1_rtx));
2393 source = new_src;
2394 }
2395
2396 if (code == SET)
2397 {
2398 can_invert = 0;
2399 code = PLUS;
2400 }
2401 else if (code == MINUS)
2402 code = PLUS;
2403
2404 insns++;
2405 i -= 6;
2406 }
2407 i -= 2;
2408 }
2409 while (remainder);
2410 }
2411
2412 return insns;
2413 }
2414
2415 /* Canonicalize a comparison so that we are more likely to recognize it.
2416 This can be done for a few constant compares, where we can make the
2417 immediate value easier to load. */
2418
2419 enum rtx_code
arm_canonicalize_comparison(enum rtx_code code,enum machine_mode mode,rtx * op1)2420 arm_canonicalize_comparison (enum rtx_code code, enum machine_mode mode,
2421 rtx * op1)
2422 {
2423 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i = INTVAL (*op1);
2424 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT maxval;
2425 maxval = (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1) << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE(mode) - 1)) - 1;
2426
2427 switch (code)
2428 {
2429 case EQ:
2430 case NE:
2431 return code;
2432
2433 case GT:
2434 case LE:
2435 if (i != maxval
2436 && (const_ok_for_arm (i + 1) || const_ok_for_arm (-(i + 1))))
2437 {
2438 *op1 = GEN_INT (i + 1);
2439 return code == GT ? GE : LT;
2440 }
2441 break;
2442
2443 case GE:
2444 case LT:
2445 if (i != ~maxval
2446 && (const_ok_for_arm (i - 1) || const_ok_for_arm (-(i - 1))))
2447 {
2448 *op1 = GEN_INT (i - 1);
2449 return code == GE ? GT : LE;
2450 }
2451 break;
2452
2453 case GTU:
2454 case LEU:
2455 if (i != ~((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0)
2456 && (const_ok_for_arm (i + 1) || const_ok_for_arm (-(i + 1))))
2457 {
2458 *op1 = GEN_INT (i + 1);
2459 return code == GTU ? GEU : LTU;
2460 }
2461 break;
2462
2463 case GEU:
2464 case LTU:
2465 if (i != 0
2466 && (const_ok_for_arm (i - 1) || const_ok_for_arm (-(i - 1))))
2467 {
2468 *op1 = GEN_INT (i - 1);
2469 return code == GEU ? GTU : LEU;
2470 }
2471 break;
2472
2473 default:
2474 gcc_unreachable ();
2475 }
2476
2477 return code;
2478 }
2479
2480
2481 /* Define how to find the value returned by a function. */
2482
2483 rtx
arm_function_value(tree type,tree func ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)2484 arm_function_value(tree type, tree func ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2485 {
2486 enum machine_mode mode;
2487 int unsignedp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
2488 rtx r ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
2489
2490 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
2491 /* Promote integer types. */
2492 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type))
2493 PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (mode, unsignedp, type);
2494
2495 /* Promotes small structs returned in a register to full-word size
2496 for big-endian AAPCS. */
2497 if (arm_return_in_msb (type))
2498 {
2499 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
2500 if (size % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0)
2501 {
2502 size += UNITS_PER_WORD - size % UNITS_PER_WORD;
2503 mode = mode_for_size (size * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 0);
2504 }
2505 }
2506
2507 return LIBCALL_VALUE(mode);
2508 }
2509
2510 /* Determine the amount of memory needed to store the possible return
2511 registers of an untyped call. */
2512 int
arm_apply_result_size(void)2513 arm_apply_result_size (void)
2514 {
2515 int size = 16;
2516
2517 if (TARGET_ARM)
2518 {
2519 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT_ABI)
2520 {
2521 if (TARGET_FPA)
2522 size += 12;
2523 if (TARGET_MAVERICK)
2524 size += 8;
2525 }
2526 if (TARGET_IWMMXT_ABI)
2527 size += 8;
2528 }
2529
2530 return size;
2531 }
2532
2533 /* Decide whether a type should be returned in memory (true)
2534 or in a register (false). This is called by the macro
2535 RETURN_IN_MEMORY. */
2536 int
arm_return_in_memory(tree type)2537 arm_return_in_memory (tree type)
2538 {
2539 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
2540
2541 if (!AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) &&
2542 (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE) &&
2543 !(TARGET_AAPCS_BASED && TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE))
2544 /* All simple types are returned in registers.
2545 For AAPCS, complex types are treated the same as aggregates. */
2546 return 0;
2547
2548 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
2549
2550 if (arm_abi != ARM_ABI_APCS)
2551 {
2552 /* ATPCS and later return aggregate types in memory only if they are
2553 larger than a word (or are variable size). */
2554 return (size < 0 || size > UNITS_PER_WORD);
2555 }
2556
2557 /* To maximize backwards compatibility with previous versions of gcc,
2558 return vectors up to 4 words in registers. */
2559 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
2560 return (size < 0 || size > (4 * UNITS_PER_WORD));
2561
2562 /* For the arm-wince targets we choose to be compatible with Microsoft's
2563 ARM and Thumb compilers, which always return aggregates in memory. */
2564 #ifndef ARM_WINCE
2565 /* All structures/unions bigger than one word are returned in memory.
2566 Also catch the case where int_size_in_bytes returns -1. In this case
2567 the aggregate is either huge or of variable size, and in either case
2568 we will want to return it via memory and not in a register. */
2569 if (size < 0 || size > UNITS_PER_WORD)
2570 return 1;
2571
2572 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
2573 {
2574 tree field;
2575
2576 /* For a struct the APCS says that we only return in a register
2577 if the type is 'integer like' and every addressable element
2578 has an offset of zero. For practical purposes this means
2579 that the structure can have at most one non bit-field element
2580 and that this element must be the first one in the structure. */
2581
2582 /* Find the first field, ignoring non FIELD_DECL things which will
2583 have been created by C++. */
2584 for (field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
2585 field && TREE_CODE (field) != FIELD_DECL;
2586 field = TREE_CHAIN (field))
2587 continue;
2588
2589 if (field == NULL)
2590 return 0; /* An empty structure. Allowed by an extension to ANSI C. */
2591
2592 /* Check that the first field is valid for returning in a register. */
2593
2594 /* ... Floats are not allowed */
2595 if (FLOAT_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (field)))
2596 return 1;
2597
2598 /* ... Aggregates that are not themselves valid for returning in
2599 a register are not allowed. */
2600 if (RETURN_IN_MEMORY (TREE_TYPE (field)))
2601 return 1;
2602
2603 /* Now check the remaining fields, if any. Only bitfields are allowed,
2604 since they are not addressable. */
2605 for (field = TREE_CHAIN (field);
2606 field;
2607 field = TREE_CHAIN (field))
2608 {
2609 if (TREE_CODE (field) != FIELD_DECL)
2610 continue;
2611
2612 if (!DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field))
2613 return 1;
2614 }
2615
2616 return 0;
2617 }
2618
2619 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
2620 {
2621 tree field;
2622
2623 /* Unions can be returned in registers if every element is
2624 integral, or can be returned in an integer register. */
2625 for (field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
2626 field;
2627 field = TREE_CHAIN (field))
2628 {
2629 if (TREE_CODE (field) != FIELD_DECL)
2630 continue;
2631
2632 if (FLOAT_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (field)))
2633 return 1;
2634
2635 if (RETURN_IN_MEMORY (TREE_TYPE (field)))
2636 return 1;
2637 }
2638
2639 return 0;
2640 }
2641 #endif /* not ARM_WINCE */
2642
2643 /* Return all other types in memory. */
2644 return 1;
2645 }
2646
2647 /* Indicate whether or not words of a double are in big-endian order. */
2648
2649 int
arm_float_words_big_endian(void)2650 arm_float_words_big_endian (void)
2651 {
2652 if (TARGET_MAVERICK)
2653 return 0;
2654
2655 /* For FPA, float words are always big-endian. For VFP, floats words
2656 follow the memory system mode. */
2657
2658 if (TARGET_FPA)
2659 {
2660 return 1;
2661 }
2662
2663 if (TARGET_VFP)
2664 return (TARGET_BIG_END ? 1 : 0);
2665
2666 return 1;
2667 }
2668
2669 /* Initialize a variable CUM of type CUMULATIVE_ARGS
2670 for a call to a function whose data type is FNTYPE.
2671 For a library call, FNTYPE is NULL. */
2672 void
arm_init_cumulative_args(CUMULATIVE_ARGS * pcum,tree fntype,rtx libname ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,tree fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)2673 arm_init_cumulative_args (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *pcum, tree fntype,
2674 rtx libname ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2675 tree fndecl ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2676 {
2677 /* On the ARM, the offset starts at 0. */
2678 pcum->nregs = 0;
2679 pcum->iwmmxt_nregs = 0;
2680 pcum->can_split = true;
2681
2682 pcum->call_cookie = CALL_NORMAL;
2683
2684 if (TARGET_LONG_CALLS)
2685 pcum->call_cookie = CALL_LONG;
2686
2687 /* Check for long call/short call attributes. The attributes
2688 override any command line option. */
2689 if (fntype)
2690 {
2691 if (lookup_attribute ("short_call", TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (fntype)))
2692 pcum->call_cookie = CALL_SHORT;
2693 else if (lookup_attribute ("long_call", TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (fntype)))
2694 pcum->call_cookie = CALL_LONG;
2695 }
2696
2697 /* Varargs vectors are treated the same as long long.
2698 named_count avoids having to change the way arm handles 'named' */
2699 pcum->named_count = 0;
2700 pcum->nargs = 0;
2701
2702 if (TARGET_REALLY_IWMMXT && fntype)
2703 {
2704 tree fn_arg;
2705
2706 for (fn_arg = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (fntype);
2707 fn_arg;
2708 fn_arg = TREE_CHAIN (fn_arg))
2709 pcum->named_count += 1;
2710
2711 if (! pcum->named_count)
2712 pcum->named_count = INT_MAX;
2713 }
2714 }
2715
2716
2717 /* Return true if mode/type need doubleword alignment. */
2718 bool
arm_needs_doubleword_align(enum machine_mode mode,tree type)2719 arm_needs_doubleword_align (enum machine_mode mode, tree type)
2720 {
2721 return (GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) > PARM_BOUNDARY
2722 || (type && TYPE_ALIGN (type) > PARM_BOUNDARY));
2723 }
2724
2725
2726 /* Determine where to put an argument to a function.
2727 Value is zero to push the argument on the stack,
2728 or a hard register in which to store the argument.
2729
2730 MODE is the argument's machine mode.
2731 TYPE is the data type of the argument (as a tree).
2732 This is null for libcalls where that information may
2733 not be available.
2734 CUM is a variable of type CUMULATIVE_ARGS which gives info about
2735 the preceding args and about the function being called.
2736 NAMED is nonzero if this argument is a named parameter
2737 (otherwise it is an extra parameter matching an ellipsis). */
2738
2739 rtx
arm_function_arg(CUMULATIVE_ARGS * pcum,enum machine_mode mode,tree type,int named)2740 arm_function_arg (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *pcum, enum machine_mode mode,
2741 tree type, int named)
2742 {
2743 int nregs;
2744
2745 /* Varargs vectors are treated the same as long long.
2746 named_count avoids having to change the way arm handles 'named' */
2747 if (TARGET_IWMMXT_ABI
2748 && arm_vector_mode_supported_p (mode)
2749 && pcum->named_count > pcum->nargs + 1)
2750 {
2751 if (pcum->iwmmxt_nregs <= 9)
2752 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, pcum->iwmmxt_nregs + FIRST_IWMMXT_REGNUM);
2753 else
2754 {
2755 pcum->can_split = false;
2756 return NULL_RTX;
2757 }
2758 }
2759
2760 /* Put doubleword aligned quantities in even register pairs. */
2761 if (pcum->nregs & 1
2762 && ARM_DOUBLEWORD_ALIGN
2763 && arm_needs_doubleword_align (mode, type))
2764 pcum->nregs++;
2765
2766 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2767 /* Compute operand 2 of the call insn. */
2768 return GEN_INT (pcum->call_cookie);
2769
2770 /* Only allow splitting an arg between regs and memory if all preceding
2771 args were allocated to regs. For args passed by reference we only count
2772 the reference pointer. */
2773 if (pcum->can_split)
2774 nregs = 1;
2775 else
2776 nregs = ARM_NUM_REGS2 (mode, type);
2777
2778 if (!named || pcum->nregs + nregs > NUM_ARG_REGS)
2779 return NULL_RTX;
2780
2781 return gen_rtx_REG (mode, pcum->nregs);
2782 }
2783
2784 static int
arm_arg_partial_bytes(CUMULATIVE_ARGS * pcum,enum machine_mode mode,tree type,bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)2785 arm_arg_partial_bytes (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *pcum, enum machine_mode mode,
2786 tree type, bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2787 {
2788 int nregs = pcum->nregs;
2789
2790 if (arm_vector_mode_supported_p (mode))
2791 return 0;
2792
2793 if (NUM_ARG_REGS > nregs
2794 && (NUM_ARG_REGS < nregs + ARM_NUM_REGS2 (mode, type))
2795 && pcum->can_split)
2796 return (NUM_ARG_REGS - nregs) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
2797
2798 return 0;
2799 }
2800
2801 /* Variable sized types are passed by reference. This is a GCC
2802 extension to the ARM ABI. */
2803
2804 static bool
arm_pass_by_reference(CUMULATIVE_ARGS * cum ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,tree type,bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)2805 arm_pass_by_reference (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2806 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2807 tree type, bool named ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2808 {
2809 return type && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) != INTEGER_CST;
2810 }
2811
2812 /* Encode the current state of the #pragma [no_]long_calls. */
2813 typedef enum
2814 {
2815 OFF, /* No #pragma [no_]long_calls is in effect. */
2816 LONG, /* #pragma long_calls is in effect. */
2817 SHORT /* #pragma no_long_calls is in effect. */
2818 } arm_pragma_enum;
2819
2820 static arm_pragma_enum arm_pragma_long_calls = OFF;
2821
2822 void
arm_pr_long_calls(struct cpp_reader * pfile ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)2823 arm_pr_long_calls (struct cpp_reader * pfile ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2824 {
2825 arm_pragma_long_calls = LONG;
2826 }
2827
2828 void
arm_pr_no_long_calls(struct cpp_reader * pfile ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)2829 arm_pr_no_long_calls (struct cpp_reader * pfile ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2830 {
2831 arm_pragma_long_calls = SHORT;
2832 }
2833
2834 void
arm_pr_long_calls_off(struct cpp_reader * pfile ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)2835 arm_pr_long_calls_off (struct cpp_reader * pfile ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2836 {
2837 arm_pragma_long_calls = OFF;
2838 }
2839
2840 /* Table of machine attributes. */
2841 const struct attribute_spec arm_attribute_table[] =
2842 {
2843 /* { name, min_len, max_len, decl_req, type_req, fn_type_req, handler } */
2844 /* Function calls made to this symbol must be done indirectly, because
2845 it may lie outside of the 26 bit addressing range of a normal function
2846 call. */
2847 { "long_call", 0, 0, false, true, true, NULL },
2848 /* Whereas these functions are always known to reside within the 26 bit
2849 addressing range. */
2850 { "short_call", 0, 0, false, true, true, NULL },
2851 /* Interrupt Service Routines have special prologue and epilogue requirements. */
2852 { "isr", 0, 1, false, false, false, arm_handle_isr_attribute },
2853 { "interrupt", 0, 1, false, false, false, arm_handle_isr_attribute },
2854 { "naked", 0, 0, true, false, false, arm_handle_fndecl_attribute },
2855 #ifdef ARM_PE
2856 /* ARM/PE has three new attributes:
2857 interfacearm - ?
2858 dllexport - for exporting a function/variable that will live in a dll
2859 dllimport - for importing a function/variable from a dll
2860
2861 Microsoft allows multiple declspecs in one __declspec, separating
2862 them with spaces. We do NOT support this. Instead, use __declspec
2863 multiple times.
2864 */
2865 { "dllimport", 0, 0, true, false, false, NULL },
2866 { "dllexport", 0, 0, true, false, false, NULL },
2867 { "interfacearm", 0, 0, true, false, false, arm_handle_fndecl_attribute },
2868 #elif TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
2869 { "dllimport", 0, 0, false, false, false, handle_dll_attribute },
2870 { "dllexport", 0, 0, false, false, false, handle_dll_attribute },
2871 { "notshared", 0, 0, false, true, false, arm_handle_notshared_attribute },
2872 #endif
2873 { NULL, 0, 0, false, false, false, NULL }
2874 };
2875
2876 /* Handle an attribute requiring a FUNCTION_DECL;
2877 arguments as in struct attribute_spec.handler. */
2878 static tree
arm_handle_fndecl_attribute(tree * node,tree name,tree args ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,int flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,bool * no_add_attrs)2879 arm_handle_fndecl_attribute (tree *node, tree name, tree args ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2880 int flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, bool *no_add_attrs)
2881 {
2882 if (TREE_CODE (*node) != FUNCTION_DECL)
2883 {
2884 warning (OPT_Wattributes, "%qs attribute only applies to functions",
2885 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
2886 *no_add_attrs = true;
2887 }
2888
2889 return NULL_TREE;
2890 }
2891
2892 /* Handle an "interrupt" or "isr" attribute;
2893 arguments as in struct attribute_spec.handler. */
2894 static tree
arm_handle_isr_attribute(tree * node,tree name,tree args,int flags,bool * no_add_attrs)2895 arm_handle_isr_attribute (tree *node, tree name, tree args, int flags,
2896 bool *no_add_attrs)
2897 {
2898 if (DECL_P (*node))
2899 {
2900 if (TREE_CODE (*node) != FUNCTION_DECL)
2901 {
2902 warning (OPT_Wattributes, "%qs attribute only applies to functions",
2903 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
2904 *no_add_attrs = true;
2905 }
2906 /* FIXME: the argument if any is checked for type attributes;
2907 should it be checked for decl ones? */
2908 }
2909 else
2910 {
2911 if (TREE_CODE (*node) == FUNCTION_TYPE
2912 || TREE_CODE (*node) == METHOD_TYPE)
2913 {
2914 if (arm_isr_value (args) == ARM_FT_UNKNOWN)
2915 {
2916 warning (OPT_Wattributes, "%qs attribute ignored",
2917 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
2918 *no_add_attrs = true;
2919 }
2920 }
2921 else if (TREE_CODE (*node) == POINTER_TYPE
2922 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (*node)) == FUNCTION_TYPE
2923 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (*node)) == METHOD_TYPE)
2924 && arm_isr_value (args) != ARM_FT_UNKNOWN)
2925 {
2926 *node = build_variant_type_copy (*node);
2927 TREE_TYPE (*node) = build_type_attribute_variant
2928 (TREE_TYPE (*node),
2929 tree_cons (name, args, TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (TREE_TYPE (*node))));
2930 *no_add_attrs = true;
2931 }
2932 else
2933 {
2934 /* Possibly pass this attribute on from the type to a decl. */
2935 if (flags & ((int) ATTR_FLAG_DECL_NEXT
2936 | (int) ATTR_FLAG_FUNCTION_NEXT
2937 | (int) ATTR_FLAG_ARRAY_NEXT))
2938 {
2939 *no_add_attrs = true;
2940 return tree_cons (name, args, NULL_TREE);
2941 }
2942 else
2943 {
2944 warning (OPT_Wattributes, "%qs attribute ignored",
2945 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
2946 }
2947 }
2948 }
2949
2950 return NULL_TREE;
2951 }
2952
2953 #if TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
2954 /* Handle the "notshared" attribute. This attribute is another way of
2955 requesting hidden visibility. ARM's compiler supports
2956 "__declspec(notshared)"; we support the same thing via an
2957 attribute. */
2958
2959 static tree
arm_handle_notshared_attribute(tree * node,tree name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,tree args ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,int flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,bool * no_add_attrs)2960 arm_handle_notshared_attribute (tree *node,
2961 tree name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2962 tree args ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2963 int flags ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2964 bool *no_add_attrs)
2965 {
2966 tree decl = TYPE_NAME (*node);
2967
2968 if (decl)
2969 {
2970 DECL_VISIBILITY (decl) = VISIBILITY_HIDDEN;
2971 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (decl) = 1;
2972 *no_add_attrs = false;
2973 }
2974 return NULL_TREE;
2975 }
2976 #endif
2977
2978 /* Return 0 if the attributes for two types are incompatible, 1 if they
2979 are compatible, and 2 if they are nearly compatible (which causes a
2980 warning to be generated). */
2981 static int
arm_comp_type_attributes(tree type1,tree type2)2982 arm_comp_type_attributes (tree type1, tree type2)
2983 {
2984 int l1, l2, s1, s2;
2985
2986 /* Check for mismatch of non-default calling convention. */
2987 if (TREE_CODE (type1) != FUNCTION_TYPE)
2988 return 1;
2989
2990 /* Check for mismatched call attributes. */
2991 l1 = lookup_attribute ("long_call", TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (type1)) != NULL;
2992 l2 = lookup_attribute ("long_call", TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (type2)) != NULL;
2993 s1 = lookup_attribute ("short_call", TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (type1)) != NULL;
2994 s2 = lookup_attribute ("short_call", TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (type2)) != NULL;
2995
2996 /* Only bother to check if an attribute is defined. */
2997 if (l1 | l2 | s1 | s2)
2998 {
2999 /* If one type has an attribute, the other must have the same attribute. */
3000 if ((l1 != l2) || (s1 != s2))
3001 return 0;
3002
3003 /* Disallow mixed attributes. */
3004 if ((l1 & s2) || (l2 & s1))
3005 return 0;
3006 }
3007
3008 /* Check for mismatched ISR attribute. */
3009 l1 = lookup_attribute ("isr", TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (type1)) != NULL;
3010 if (! l1)
3011 l1 = lookup_attribute ("interrupt", TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (type1)) != NULL;
3012 l2 = lookup_attribute ("isr", TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (type2)) != NULL;
3013 if (! l2)
3014 l1 = lookup_attribute ("interrupt", TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (type2)) != NULL;
3015 if (l1 != l2)
3016 return 0;
3017
3018 return 1;
3019 }
3020
3021 /* Encode long_call or short_call attribute by prefixing
3022 symbol name in DECL with a special character FLAG. */
3023 void
arm_encode_call_attribute(tree decl,int flag)3024 arm_encode_call_attribute (tree decl, int flag)
3025 {
3026 const char * str = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), 0);
3027 int len = strlen (str);
3028 char * newstr;
3029
3030 /* Do not allow weak functions to be treated as short call. */
3031 if (DECL_WEAK (decl) && flag == SHORT_CALL_FLAG_CHAR)
3032 return;
3033
3034 newstr = alloca (len + 2);
3035 newstr[0] = flag;
3036 strcpy (newstr + 1, str);
3037
3038 newstr = (char *) ggc_alloc_string (newstr, len + 1);
3039 XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), 0) = newstr;
3040 }
3041
3042 /* Assigns default attributes to newly defined type. This is used to
3043 set short_call/long_call attributes for function types of
3044 functions defined inside corresponding #pragma scopes. */
3045 static void
arm_set_default_type_attributes(tree type)3046 arm_set_default_type_attributes (tree type)
3047 {
3048 /* Add __attribute__ ((long_call)) to all functions, when
3049 inside #pragma long_calls or __attribute__ ((short_call)),
3050 when inside #pragma no_long_calls. */
3051 if (TREE_CODE (type) == FUNCTION_TYPE || TREE_CODE (type) == METHOD_TYPE)
3052 {
3053 tree type_attr_list, attr_name;
3054 type_attr_list = TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (type);
3055
3056 if (arm_pragma_long_calls == LONG)
3057 attr_name = get_identifier ("long_call");
3058 else if (arm_pragma_long_calls == SHORT)
3059 attr_name = get_identifier ("short_call");
3060 else
3061 return;
3062
3063 type_attr_list = tree_cons (attr_name, NULL_TREE, type_attr_list);
3064 TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (type) = type_attr_list;
3065 }
3066 }
3067
3068 /* Return 1 if the operand is a SYMBOL_REF for a function known to be
3069 defined within the current compilation unit. If this cannot be
3070 determined, then 0 is returned. */
3071 static int
current_file_function_operand(rtx sym_ref)3072 current_file_function_operand (rtx sym_ref)
3073 {
3074 /* This is a bit of a fib. A function will have a short call flag
3075 applied to its name if it has the short call attribute, or it has
3076 already been defined within the current compilation unit. */
3077 if (ENCODED_SHORT_CALL_ATTR_P (XSTR (sym_ref, 0)))
3078 return 1;
3079
3080 /* The current function is always defined within the current compilation
3081 unit. If it s a weak definition however, then this may not be the real
3082 definition of the function, and so we have to say no. */
3083 if (sym_ref == XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0)
3084 && !DECL_WEAK (current_function_decl))
3085 return 1;
3086
3087 /* We cannot make the determination - default to returning 0. */
3088 return 0;
3089 }
3090
3091 /* Return nonzero if a 32 bit "long_call" should be generated for
3092 this call. We generate a long_call if the function:
3093
3094 a. has an __attribute__((long call))
3095 or b. is within the scope of a #pragma long_calls
3096 or c. the -mlong-calls command line switch has been specified
3097 . and either:
3098 1. -ffunction-sections is in effect
3099 or 2. the current function has __attribute__ ((section))
3100 or 3. the target function has __attribute__ ((section))
3101
3102 However we do not generate a long call if the function:
3103
3104 d. has an __attribute__ ((short_call))
3105 or e. is inside the scope of a #pragma no_long_calls
3106 or f. is defined within the current compilation unit.
3107
3108 This function will be called by C fragments contained in the machine
3109 description file. SYM_REF and CALL_COOKIE correspond to the matched
3110 rtl operands. CALL_SYMBOL is used to distinguish between
3111 two different callers of the function. It is set to 1 in the
3112 "call_symbol" and "call_symbol_value" patterns and to 0 in the "call"
3113 and "call_value" patterns. This is because of the difference in the
3114 SYM_REFs passed by these patterns. */
3115 int
arm_is_longcall_p(rtx sym_ref,int call_cookie,int call_symbol)3116 arm_is_longcall_p (rtx sym_ref, int call_cookie, int call_symbol)
3117 {
3118 if (!call_symbol)
3119 {
3120 if (GET_CODE (sym_ref) != MEM)
3121 return 0;
3122
3123 sym_ref = XEXP (sym_ref, 0);
3124 }
3125
3126 if (GET_CODE (sym_ref) != SYMBOL_REF)
3127 return 0;
3128
3129 if (call_cookie & CALL_SHORT)
3130 return 0;
3131
3132 if (TARGET_LONG_CALLS)
3133 {
3134 if (flag_function_sections
3135 || DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
3136 /* c.3 is handled by the definition of the
3137 ARM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE macro. */
3138 return 1;
3139 }
3140
3141 if (current_file_function_operand (sym_ref))
3142 return 0;
3143
3144 return (call_cookie & CALL_LONG)
3145 || ENCODED_LONG_CALL_ATTR_P (XSTR (sym_ref, 0))
3146 || TARGET_LONG_CALLS;
3147 }
3148
3149 /* Return nonzero if it is ok to make a tail-call to DECL. */
3150 static bool
arm_function_ok_for_sibcall(tree decl,tree exp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3151 arm_function_ok_for_sibcall (tree decl, tree exp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3152 {
3153 int call_type = TARGET_LONG_CALLS ? CALL_LONG : CALL_NORMAL;
3154
3155 if (cfun->machine->sibcall_blocked)
3156 return false;
3157
3158 /* Never tailcall something for which we have no decl, or if we
3159 are in Thumb mode. */
3160 if (decl == NULL || TARGET_THUMB)
3161 return false;
3162
3163 /* Get the calling method. */
3164 if (lookup_attribute ("short_call", TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (TREE_TYPE (decl))))
3165 call_type = CALL_SHORT;
3166 else if (lookup_attribute ("long_call", TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (TREE_TYPE (decl))))
3167 call_type = CALL_LONG;
3168
3169 /* Cannot tail-call to long calls, since these are out of range of
3170 a branch instruction. However, if not compiling PIC, we know
3171 we can reach the symbol if it is in this compilation unit. */
3172 if (call_type == CALL_LONG && (flag_pic || !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl)))
3173 return false;
3174
3175 /* If we are interworking and the function is not declared static
3176 then we can't tail-call it unless we know that it exists in this
3177 compilation unit (since it might be a Thumb routine). */
3178 if (TARGET_INTERWORK && TREE_PUBLIC (decl) && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
3179 return false;
3180
3181 /* Never tailcall from an ISR routine - it needs a special exit sequence. */
3182 if (IS_INTERRUPT (arm_current_func_type ()))
3183 return false;
3184
3185 /* Everything else is ok. */
3186 return true;
3187 }
3188
3189
3190 /* Addressing mode support functions. */
3191
3192 /* Return nonzero if X is a legitimate immediate operand when compiling
3193 for PIC. We know that X satisfies CONSTANT_P and flag_pic is true. */
3194 int
legitimate_pic_operand_p(rtx x)3195 legitimate_pic_operand_p (rtx x)
3196 {
3197 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF
3198 || (GET_CODE (x) == CONST
3199 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
3200 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF))
3201 return 0;
3202
3203 return 1;
3204 }
3205
3206 rtx
legitimize_pic_address(rtx orig,enum machine_mode mode,rtx reg)3207 legitimize_pic_address (rtx orig, enum machine_mode mode, rtx reg)
3208 {
3209 if (GET_CODE (orig) == SYMBOL_REF
3210 || GET_CODE (orig) == LABEL_REF)
3211 {
3212 #ifndef AOF_ASSEMBLER
3213 rtx pic_ref, address;
3214 #endif
3215 rtx insn;
3216 int subregs = 0;
3217
3218 /* If this function doesn't have a pic register, create one now.
3219 A lot of the logic here is made obscure by the fact that this
3220 routine gets called as part of the rtx cost estimation
3221 process. We don't want those calls to affect any assumptions
3222 about the real function; and further, we can't call
3223 entry_of_function() until we start the real expansion
3224 process. */
3225 if (!current_function_uses_pic_offset_table)
3226 {
3227 gcc_assert (!no_new_pseudos);
3228 if (arm_pic_register != INVALID_REGNUM)
3229 {
3230 if (!cfun->machine->pic_reg)
3231 cfun->machine->pic_reg = gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, arm_pic_register);
3232
3233 /* Play games to avoid marking the function as needing pic
3234 if we are being called as part of the cost-estimation
3235 process. */
3236 if (!ir_type())
3237 current_function_uses_pic_offset_table = 1;
3238 }
3239 else
3240 {
3241 rtx seq;
3242
3243 if (!cfun->machine->pic_reg)
3244 cfun->machine->pic_reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3245
3246 /* Play games to avoid marking the function as needing pic
3247 if we are being called as part of the cost-estimation
3248 process. */
3249 if (!ir_type())
3250 {
3251 current_function_uses_pic_offset_table = 1;
3252 start_sequence ();
3253
3254 arm_load_pic_register (0UL);
3255
3256 seq = get_insns ();
3257 end_sequence ();
3258 emit_insn_after (seq, entry_of_function ());
3259 }
3260 }
3261 }
3262
3263 if (reg == 0)
3264 {
3265 gcc_assert (!no_new_pseudos);
3266 reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3267
3268 subregs = 1;
3269 }
3270
3271 #ifdef AOF_ASSEMBLER
3272 /* The AOF assembler can generate relocations for these directly, and
3273 understands that the PIC register has to be added into the offset. */
3274 insn = emit_insn (gen_pic_load_addr_based (reg, orig));
3275 #else
3276 if (subregs)
3277 address = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3278 else
3279 address = reg;
3280
3281 if (TARGET_ARM)
3282 emit_insn (gen_pic_load_addr_arm (address, orig));
3283 else
3284 emit_insn (gen_pic_load_addr_thumb (address, orig));
3285
3286 if ((GET_CODE (orig) == LABEL_REF
3287 || (GET_CODE (orig) == SYMBOL_REF &&
3288 SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (orig)))
3289 && NEED_GOT_RELOC)
3290 pic_ref = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, cfun->machine->pic_reg, address);
3291 else
3292 {
3293 pic_ref = gen_const_mem (Pmode,
3294 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, cfun->machine->pic_reg,
3295 address));
3296 }
3297
3298 insn = emit_move_insn (reg, pic_ref);
3299 #endif
3300 /* Put a REG_EQUAL note on this insn, so that it can be optimized
3301 by loop. */
3302 REG_NOTES (insn) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_EQUAL, orig,
3303 REG_NOTES (insn));
3304 return reg;
3305 }
3306 else if (GET_CODE (orig) == CONST)
3307 {
3308 rtx base, offset;
3309
3310 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (orig, 0)) == PLUS
3311 && XEXP (XEXP (orig, 0), 0) == cfun->machine->pic_reg)
3312 return orig;
3313
3314 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (orig, 0)) == UNSPEC
3315 && XINT (XEXP (orig, 0), 1) == UNSPEC_TLS)
3316 return orig;
3317
3318 if (reg == 0)
3319 {
3320 gcc_assert (!no_new_pseudos);
3321 reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3322 }
3323
3324 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (orig, 0)) == PLUS);
3325
3326 base = legitimize_pic_address (XEXP (XEXP (orig, 0), 0), Pmode, reg);
3327 offset = legitimize_pic_address (XEXP (XEXP (orig, 0), 1), Pmode,
3328 base == reg ? 0 : reg);
3329
3330 if (GET_CODE (offset) == CONST_INT)
3331 {
3332 /* The base register doesn't really matter, we only want to
3333 test the index for the appropriate mode. */
3334 if (!arm_legitimate_index_p (mode, offset, SET, 0))
3335 {
3336 gcc_assert (!no_new_pseudos);
3337 offset = force_reg (Pmode, offset);
3338 }
3339
3340 if (GET_CODE (offset) == CONST_INT)
3341 return plus_constant (base, INTVAL (offset));
3342 }
3343
3344 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > 4
3345 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
3346 || TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT))
3347 {
3348 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (reg, base, offset));
3349 return reg;
3350 }
3351
3352 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, base, offset);
3353 }
3354
3355 return orig;
3356 }
3357
3358
3359 /* Find a spare low register to use during the prolog of a function. */
3360
3361 static int
thumb_find_work_register(unsigned long pushed_regs_mask)3362 thumb_find_work_register (unsigned long pushed_regs_mask)
3363 {
3364 int reg;
3365
3366 /* Check the argument registers first as these are call-used. The
3367 register allocation order means that sometimes r3 might be used
3368 but earlier argument registers might not, so check them all. */
3369 for (reg = LAST_ARG_REGNUM; reg >= 0; reg --)
3370 if (!regs_ever_live[reg])
3371 return reg;
3372
3373 /* Before going on to check the call-saved registers we can try a couple
3374 more ways of deducing that r3 is available. The first is when we are
3375 pushing anonymous arguments onto the stack and we have less than 4
3376 registers worth of fixed arguments(*). In this case r3 will be part of
3377 the variable argument list and so we can be sure that it will be
3378 pushed right at the start of the function. Hence it will be available
3379 for the rest of the prologue.
3380 (*): ie current_function_pretend_args_size is greater than 0. */
3381 if (cfun->machine->uses_anonymous_args
3382 && current_function_pretend_args_size > 0)
3383 return LAST_ARG_REGNUM;
3384
3385 /* The other case is when we have fixed arguments but less than 4 registers
3386 worth. In this case r3 might be used in the body of the function, but
3387 it is not being used to convey an argument into the function. In theory
3388 we could just check current_function_args_size to see how many bytes are
3389 being passed in argument registers, but it seems that it is unreliable.
3390 Sometimes it will have the value 0 when in fact arguments are being
3391 passed. (See testcase execute/20021111-1.c for an example). So we also
3392 check the args_info.nregs field as well. The problem with this field is
3393 that it makes no allowances for arguments that are passed to the
3394 function but which are not used. Hence we could miss an opportunity
3395 when a function has an unused argument in r3. But it is better to be
3396 safe than to be sorry. */
3397 if (! cfun->machine->uses_anonymous_args
3398 && current_function_args_size >= 0
3399 && current_function_args_size <= (LAST_ARG_REGNUM * UNITS_PER_WORD)
3400 && cfun->args_info.nregs < 4)
3401 return LAST_ARG_REGNUM;
3402
3403 /* Otherwise look for a call-saved register that is going to be pushed. */
3404 for (reg = LAST_LO_REGNUM; reg > LAST_ARG_REGNUM; reg --)
3405 if (pushed_regs_mask & (1 << reg))
3406 return reg;
3407
3408 /* Something went wrong - thumb_compute_save_reg_mask()
3409 should have arranged for a suitable register to be pushed. */
3410 gcc_unreachable ();
3411 }
3412
3413 static GTY(()) int pic_labelno;
3414
3415 /* Generate code to load the PIC register. In thumb mode SCRATCH is a
3416 low register. */
3417
3418 void
arm_load_pic_register(unsigned long saved_regs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)3419 arm_load_pic_register (unsigned long saved_regs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3420 {
3421 #ifndef AOF_ASSEMBLER
3422 rtx l1, labelno, pic_tmp, pic_tmp2, pic_rtx;
3423 rtx global_offset_table;
3424
3425 if (current_function_uses_pic_offset_table == 0 || TARGET_SINGLE_PIC_BASE)
3426 return;
3427
3428 gcc_assert (flag_pic);
3429
3430 /* We use an UNSPEC rather than a LABEL_REF because this label never appears
3431 in the code stream. */
3432
3433 labelno = GEN_INT (pic_labelno++);
3434 l1 = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, labelno), UNSPEC_PIC_LABEL);
3435 l1 = gen_rtx_CONST (VOIDmode, l1);
3436
3437 global_offset_table = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_");
3438 /* On the ARM the PC register contains 'dot + 8' at the time of the
3439 addition, on the Thumb it is 'dot + 4'. */
3440 pic_tmp = plus_constant (l1, TARGET_ARM ? 8 : 4);
3441 if (GOT_PCREL)
3442 pic_tmp2 = gen_rtx_CONST (VOIDmode,
3443 gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, global_offset_table, pc_rtx));
3444 else
3445 pic_tmp2 = gen_rtx_CONST (VOIDmode, global_offset_table);
3446
3447 pic_rtx = gen_rtx_CONST (Pmode, gen_rtx_MINUS (Pmode, pic_tmp2, pic_tmp));
3448
3449 if (TARGET_ARM)
3450 {
3451 emit_insn (gen_pic_load_addr_arm (cfun->machine->pic_reg, pic_rtx));
3452 emit_insn (gen_pic_add_dot_plus_eight (cfun->machine->pic_reg,
3453 cfun->machine->pic_reg, labelno));
3454 }
3455 else
3456 {
3457 if (arm_pic_register != INVALID_REGNUM
3458 && REGNO (cfun->machine->pic_reg) > LAST_LO_REGNUM)
3459 {
3460 /* We will have pushed the pic register, so we should always be
3461 able to find a work register. */
3462 pic_tmp = gen_rtx_REG (SImode,
3463 thumb_find_work_register (saved_regs));
3464 emit_insn (gen_pic_load_addr_thumb (pic_tmp, pic_rtx));
3465 emit_insn (gen_movsi (pic_offset_table_rtx, pic_tmp));
3466 }
3467 else
3468 emit_insn (gen_pic_load_addr_thumb (cfun->machine->pic_reg, pic_rtx));
3469 emit_insn (gen_pic_add_dot_plus_four (cfun->machine->pic_reg,
3470 cfun->machine->pic_reg, labelno));
3471 }
3472
3473 /* Need to emit this whether or not we obey regdecls,
3474 since setjmp/longjmp can cause life info to screw up. */
3475 emit_insn (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, cfun->machine->pic_reg));
3476 #endif /* AOF_ASSEMBLER */
3477 }
3478
3479
3480 /* Return nonzero if X is valid as an ARM state addressing register. */
3481 static int
arm_address_register_rtx_p(rtx x,int strict_p)3482 arm_address_register_rtx_p (rtx x, int strict_p)
3483 {
3484 int regno;
3485
3486 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
3487 return 0;
3488
3489 regno = REGNO (x);
3490
3491 if (strict_p)
3492 return ARM_REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (regno);
3493
3494 return (regno <= LAST_ARM_REGNUM
3495 || regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3496 || regno == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3497 || regno == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM);
3498 }
3499
3500 /* Return TRUE if this rtx is the difference of a symbol and a label,
3501 and will reduce to a PC-relative relocation in the object file.
3502 Expressions like this can be left alone when generating PIC, rather
3503 than forced through the GOT. */
3504 static int
pcrel_constant_p(rtx x)3505 pcrel_constant_p (rtx x)
3506 {
3507 if (GET_CODE (x) == MINUS)
3508 return symbol_mentioned_p (XEXP (x, 0)) && label_mentioned_p (XEXP (x, 1));
3509
3510 return FALSE;
3511 }
3512
3513 /* Return nonzero if X is a valid ARM state address operand. */
3514 int
arm_legitimate_address_p(enum machine_mode mode,rtx x,RTX_CODE outer,int strict_p)3515 arm_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, RTX_CODE outer,
3516 int strict_p)
3517 {
3518 bool use_ldrd;
3519 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
3520
3521 if (arm_address_register_rtx_p (x, strict_p))
3522 return 1;
3523
3524 use_ldrd = (TARGET_LDRD
3525 && (mode == DImode
3526 || (mode == DFmode && (TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT || TARGET_VFP))));
3527
3528 if (code == POST_INC || code == PRE_DEC
3529 || ((code == PRE_INC || code == POST_DEC)
3530 && (use_ldrd || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= 4)))
3531 return arm_address_register_rtx_p (XEXP (x, 0), strict_p);
3532
3533 else if ((code == POST_MODIFY || code == PRE_MODIFY)
3534 && arm_address_register_rtx_p (XEXP (x, 0), strict_p)
3535 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == PLUS
3536 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0), XEXP (x, 0)))
3537 {
3538 rtx addend = XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1);
3539
3540 /* Don't allow ldrd post increment by register because it's hard
3541 to fixup invalid register choices. */
3542 if (use_ldrd
3543 && GET_CODE (x) == POST_MODIFY
3544 && GET_CODE (addend) == REG)
3545 return 0;
3546
3547 return ((use_ldrd || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= 4)
3548 && arm_legitimate_index_p (mode, addend, outer, strict_p));
3549 }
3550
3551 /* After reload constants split into minipools will have addresses
3552 from a LABEL_REF. */
3553 else if (reload_completed
3554 && (code == LABEL_REF
3555 || (code == CONST
3556 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
3557 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == LABEL_REF
3558 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)))
3559 return 1;
3560
3561 else if (mode == TImode)
3562 return 0;
3563
3564 else if (code == PLUS)
3565 {
3566 rtx xop0 = XEXP (x, 0);
3567 rtx xop1 = XEXP (x, 1);
3568
3569 return ((arm_address_register_rtx_p (xop0, strict_p)
3570 && arm_legitimate_index_p (mode, xop1, outer, strict_p))
3571 || (arm_address_register_rtx_p (xop1, strict_p)
3572 && arm_legitimate_index_p (mode, xop0, outer, strict_p)));
3573 }
3574
3575 #if 0
3576 /* Reload currently can't handle MINUS, so disable this for now */
3577 else if (GET_CODE (x) == MINUS)
3578 {
3579 rtx xop0 = XEXP (x, 0);
3580 rtx xop1 = XEXP (x, 1);
3581
3582 return (arm_address_register_rtx_p (xop0, strict_p)
3583 && arm_legitimate_index_p (mode, xop1, outer, strict_p));
3584 }
3585 #endif
3586
3587 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_FLOAT
3588 && code == SYMBOL_REF
3589 && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (x)
3590 && ! (flag_pic
3591 && symbol_mentioned_p (get_pool_constant (x))
3592 && ! pcrel_constant_p (get_pool_constant (x))))
3593 return 1;
3594
3595 return 0;
3596 }
3597
3598 /* Return nonzero if INDEX is valid for an address index operand in
3599 ARM state. */
3600 static int
arm_legitimate_index_p(enum machine_mode mode,rtx index,RTX_CODE outer,int strict_p)3601 arm_legitimate_index_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx index, RTX_CODE outer,
3602 int strict_p)
3603 {
3604 HOST_WIDE_INT range;
3605 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (index);
3606
3607 /* Standard coprocessor addressing modes. */
3608 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT
3609 && (TARGET_FPA || TARGET_MAVERICK)
3610 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
3611 || (TARGET_MAVERICK && mode == DImode)))
3612 return (code == CONST_INT && INTVAL (index) < 1024
3613 && INTVAL (index) > -1024
3614 && (INTVAL (index) & 3) == 0);
3615
3616 if (TARGET_REALLY_IWMMXT && VALID_IWMMXT_REG_MODE (mode))
3617 {
3618 /* For DImode assume values will usually live in core regs
3619 and only allow LDRD addressing modes. */
3620 if (!TARGET_LDRD || mode != DImode)
3621 return (code == CONST_INT
3622 && INTVAL (index) < 1024
3623 && INTVAL (index) > -1024
3624 && (INTVAL (index) & 3) == 0);
3625 }
3626
3627 if (arm_address_register_rtx_p (index, strict_p)
3628 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= 4))
3629 return 1;
3630
3631 if (mode == DImode || mode == DFmode)
3632 {
3633 if (code == CONST_INT)
3634 {
3635 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (index);
3636
3637 if (TARGET_LDRD)
3638 return val > -256 && val < 256;
3639 else
3640 return val > -4096 && val < 4092;
3641 }
3642
3643 return TARGET_LDRD && arm_address_register_rtx_p (index, strict_p);
3644 }
3645
3646 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= 4
3647 && ! (arm_arch4
3648 && (mode == HImode
3649 || (mode == QImode && outer == SIGN_EXTEND))))
3650 {
3651 if (code == MULT)
3652 {
3653 rtx xiop0 = XEXP (index, 0);
3654 rtx xiop1 = XEXP (index, 1);
3655
3656 return ((arm_address_register_rtx_p (xiop0, strict_p)
3657 && power_of_two_operand (xiop1, SImode))
3658 || (arm_address_register_rtx_p (xiop1, strict_p)
3659 && power_of_two_operand (xiop0, SImode)));
3660 }
3661 else if (code == LSHIFTRT || code == ASHIFTRT
3662 || code == ASHIFT || code == ROTATERT)
3663 {
3664 rtx op = XEXP (index, 1);
3665
3666 return (arm_address_register_rtx_p (XEXP (index, 0), strict_p)
3667 && GET_CODE (op) == CONST_INT
3668 && INTVAL (op) > 0
3669 && INTVAL (op) <= 31);
3670 }
3671 }
3672
3673 /* For ARM v4 we may be doing a sign-extend operation during the
3674 load. */
3675 if (arm_arch4)
3676 {
3677 if (mode == HImode || (outer == SIGN_EXTEND && mode == QImode))
3678 range = 256;
3679 else
3680 range = 4096;
3681 }
3682 else
3683 range = (mode == HImode) ? 4095 : 4096;
3684
3685 return (code == CONST_INT
3686 && INTVAL (index) < range
3687 && INTVAL (index) > -range);
3688 }
3689
3690 /* Return nonzero if X is valid as a Thumb state base register. */
3691 static int
thumb_base_register_rtx_p(rtx x,enum machine_mode mode,int strict_p)3692 thumb_base_register_rtx_p (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, int strict_p)
3693 {
3694 int regno;
3695
3696 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG)
3697 return 0;
3698
3699 regno = REGNO (x);
3700
3701 if (strict_p)
3702 return THUMB_REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (regno, mode);
3703
3704 return (regno <= LAST_LO_REGNUM
3705 || regno > LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
3706 || regno == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3707 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= 4
3708 && (regno == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3709 || regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
3710 || x == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
3711 || x == arg_pointer_rtx)));
3712 }
3713
3714 /* Return nonzero if x is a legitimate index register. This is the case
3715 for any base register that can access a QImode object. */
3716 inline static int
thumb_index_register_rtx_p(rtx x,int strict_p)3717 thumb_index_register_rtx_p (rtx x, int strict_p)
3718 {
3719 return thumb_base_register_rtx_p (x, QImode, strict_p);
3720 }
3721
3722 /* Return nonzero if x is a legitimate Thumb-state address.
3723
3724 The AP may be eliminated to either the SP or the FP, so we use the
3725 least common denominator, e.g. SImode, and offsets from 0 to 64.
3726
3727 ??? Verify whether the above is the right approach.
3728
3729 ??? Also, the FP may be eliminated to the SP, so perhaps that
3730 needs special handling also.
3731
3732 ??? Look at how the mips16 port solves this problem. It probably uses
3733 better ways to solve some of these problems.
3734
3735 Although it is not incorrect, we don't accept QImode and HImode
3736 addresses based on the frame pointer or arg pointer until the
3737 reload pass starts. This is so that eliminating such addresses
3738 into stack based ones won't produce impossible code. */
3739 int
thumb_legitimate_address_p(enum machine_mode mode,rtx x,int strict_p)3740 thumb_legitimate_address_p (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int strict_p)
3741 {
3742 /* ??? Not clear if this is right. Experiment. */
3743 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < 4
3744 && !(reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
3745 && (reg_mentioned_p (frame_pointer_rtx, x)
3746 || reg_mentioned_p (arg_pointer_rtx, x)
3747 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_incoming_args_rtx, x)
3748 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, x)
3749 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, x)
3750 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_vars_rtx, x)))
3751 return 0;
3752
3753 /* Accept any base register. SP only in SImode or larger. */
3754 else if (thumb_base_register_rtx_p (x, mode, strict_p))
3755 return 1;
3756
3757 /* This is PC relative data before arm_reorg runs. */
3758 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= 4 && CONSTANT_P (x)
3759 && GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF
3760 && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (x) && !flag_pic)
3761 return 1;
3762
3763 /* This is PC relative data after arm_reorg runs. */
3764 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= 4 && reload_completed
3765 && (GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF
3766 || (GET_CODE (x) == CONST
3767 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
3768 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == LABEL_REF
3769 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)))
3770 return 1;
3771
3772 /* Post-inc indexing only supported for SImode and larger. */
3773 else if (GET_CODE (x) == POST_INC && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= 4
3774 && thumb_index_register_rtx_p (XEXP (x, 0), strict_p))
3775 return 1;
3776
3777 else if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
3778 {
3779 /* REG+REG address can be any two index registers. */
3780 /* We disallow FRAME+REG addressing since we know that FRAME
3781 will be replaced with STACK, and SP relative addressing only
3782 permits SP+OFFSET. */
3783 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= 4
3784 && XEXP (x, 0) != frame_pointer_rtx
3785 && XEXP (x, 1) != frame_pointer_rtx
3786 && thumb_index_register_rtx_p (XEXP (x, 0), strict_p)
3787 && thumb_index_register_rtx_p (XEXP (x, 1), strict_p))
3788 return 1;
3789
3790 /* REG+const has 5-7 bit offset for non-SP registers. */
3791 else if ((thumb_index_register_rtx_p (XEXP (x, 0), strict_p)
3792 || XEXP (x, 0) == arg_pointer_rtx)
3793 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
3794 && thumb_legitimate_offset_p (mode, INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))))
3795 return 1;
3796
3797 /* REG+const has 10 bit offset for SP, but only SImode and
3798 larger is supported. */
3799 /* ??? Should probably check for DI/DFmode overflow here
3800 just like GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_OFFSET does. */
3801 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
3802 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3803 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= 4
3804 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
3805 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >= 0
3806 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= 1024
3807 && (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) & 3) == 0)
3808 return 1;
3809
3810 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
3811 && REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3812 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= 4
3813 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
3814 && (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) & 3) == 0)
3815 return 1;
3816 }
3817
3818 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_FLOAT
3819 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 4
3820 && GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF
3821 && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (x)
3822 && ! (flag_pic
3823 && symbol_mentioned_p (get_pool_constant (x))
3824 && ! pcrel_constant_p (get_pool_constant (x))))
3825 return 1;
3826
3827 return 0;
3828 }
3829
3830 /* Return nonzero if VAL can be used as an offset in a Thumb-state address
3831 instruction of mode MODE. */
3832 int
thumb_legitimate_offset_p(enum machine_mode mode,HOST_WIDE_INT val)3833 thumb_legitimate_offset_p (enum machine_mode mode, HOST_WIDE_INT val)
3834 {
3835 switch (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
3836 {
3837 case 1:
3838 return val >= 0 && val < 32;
3839
3840 case 2:
3841 return val >= 0 && val < 64 && (val & 1) == 0;
3842
3843 default:
3844 return (val >= 0
3845 && (val + GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)) <= 128
3846 && (val & 3) == 0);
3847 }
3848 }
3849
3850 /* Build the SYMBOL_REF for __tls_get_addr. */
3851
3852 static GTY(()) rtx tls_get_addr_libfunc;
3853
3854 static rtx
get_tls_get_addr(void)3855 get_tls_get_addr (void)
3856 {
3857 if (!tls_get_addr_libfunc)
3858 tls_get_addr_libfunc = init_one_libfunc ("__tls_get_addr");
3859 return tls_get_addr_libfunc;
3860 }
3861
3862 static rtx
arm_load_tp(rtx target)3863 arm_load_tp (rtx target)
3864 {
3865 if (!target)
3866 target = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
3867
3868 if (TARGET_HARD_TP)
3869 {
3870 /* Can return in any reg. */
3871 emit_insn (gen_load_tp_hard (target));
3872 }
3873 else
3874 {
3875 /* Always returned in r0. Immediately copy the result into a pseudo,
3876 otherwise other uses of r0 (e.g. setting up function arguments) may
3877 clobber the value. */
3878
3879 rtx tmp;
3880
3881 emit_insn (gen_load_tp_soft ());
3882
3883 tmp = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 0);
3884 emit_move_insn (target, tmp);
3885 }
3886 return target;
3887 }
3888
3889 static rtx
load_tls_operand(rtx x,rtx reg)3890 load_tls_operand (rtx x, rtx reg)
3891 {
3892 rtx tmp;
3893
3894 if (reg == NULL_RTX)
3895 reg = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
3896
3897 tmp = gen_rtx_CONST (SImode, x);
3898
3899 emit_move_insn (reg, tmp);
3900
3901 return reg;
3902 }
3903
3904 static rtx
arm_call_tls_get_addr(rtx x,rtx reg,rtx * valuep,int reloc)3905 arm_call_tls_get_addr (rtx x, rtx reg, rtx *valuep, int reloc)
3906 {
3907 rtx insns, label, labelno, sum;
3908
3909 start_sequence ();
3910
3911 labelno = GEN_INT (pic_labelno++);
3912 label = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, labelno), UNSPEC_PIC_LABEL);
3913 label = gen_rtx_CONST (VOIDmode, label);
3914
3915 sum = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode,
3916 gen_rtvec (4, x, GEN_INT (reloc), label,
3917 GEN_INT (TARGET_ARM ? 8 : 4)),
3918 UNSPEC_TLS);
3919 reg = load_tls_operand (sum, reg);
3920
3921 if (TARGET_ARM)
3922 emit_insn (gen_pic_add_dot_plus_eight (reg, reg, labelno));
3923 else
3924 emit_insn (gen_pic_add_dot_plus_four (reg, reg, labelno));
3925
3926 *valuep = emit_library_call_value (get_tls_get_addr (), NULL_RTX, LCT_PURE, /* LCT_CONST? */
3927 Pmode, 1, reg, Pmode);
3928
3929 insns = get_insns ();
3930 end_sequence ();
3931
3932 return insns;
3933 }
3934
3935 rtx
legitimize_tls_address(rtx x,rtx reg)3936 legitimize_tls_address (rtx x, rtx reg)
3937 {
3938 rtx dest, tp, label, labelno, sum, insns, ret, eqv, addend;
3939 unsigned int model = SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (x);
3940
3941 switch (model)
3942 {
3943 case TLS_MODEL_GLOBAL_DYNAMIC:
3944 insns = arm_call_tls_get_addr (x, reg, &ret, TLS_GD32);
3945 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3946 emit_libcall_block (insns, dest, ret, x);
3947 return dest;
3948
3949 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_DYNAMIC:
3950 insns = arm_call_tls_get_addr (x, reg, &ret, TLS_LDM32);
3951
3952 /* Attach a unique REG_EQUIV, to allow the RTL optimizers to
3953 share the LDM result with other LD model accesses. */
3954 eqv = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, const1_rtx),
3955 UNSPEC_TLS);
3956 dest = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
3957 emit_libcall_block (insns, dest, ret, eqv);
3958
3959 /* Load the addend. */
3960 addend = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (2, x, GEN_INT (TLS_LDO32)),
3961 UNSPEC_TLS);
3962 addend = force_reg (SImode, gen_rtx_CONST (SImode, addend));
3963 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, dest, addend);
3964
3965 case TLS_MODEL_INITIAL_EXEC:
3966 labelno = GEN_INT (pic_labelno++);
3967 label = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode, gen_rtvec (1, labelno), UNSPEC_PIC_LABEL);
3968 label = gen_rtx_CONST (VOIDmode, label);
3969 sum = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode,
3970 gen_rtvec (4, x, GEN_INT (TLS_IE32), label,
3971 GEN_INT (TARGET_ARM ? 8 : 4)),
3972 UNSPEC_TLS);
3973 reg = load_tls_operand (sum, reg);
3974
3975 if (TARGET_ARM)
3976 emit_insn (gen_tls_load_dot_plus_eight (reg, reg, labelno));
3977 else
3978 {
3979 emit_insn (gen_pic_add_dot_plus_four (reg, reg, labelno));
3980 emit_move_insn (reg, gen_const_mem (SImode, reg));
3981 }
3982
3983 tp = arm_load_tp (NULL_RTX);
3984
3985 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, reg);
3986
3987 case TLS_MODEL_LOCAL_EXEC:
3988 tp = arm_load_tp (NULL_RTX);
3989
3990 reg = gen_rtx_UNSPEC (Pmode,
3991 gen_rtvec (2, x, GEN_INT (TLS_LE32)),
3992 UNSPEC_TLS);
3993 reg = force_reg (SImode, gen_rtx_CONST (SImode, reg));
3994
3995 return gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, tp, reg);
3996
3997 default:
3998 abort ();
3999 }
4000 }
4001
4002 /* Try machine-dependent ways of modifying an illegitimate address
4003 to be legitimate. If we find one, return the new, valid address. */
4004 rtx
arm_legitimize_address(rtx x,rtx orig_x,enum machine_mode mode)4005 arm_legitimize_address (rtx x, rtx orig_x, enum machine_mode mode)
4006 {
4007 if (arm_tls_symbol_p (x))
4008 return legitimize_tls_address (x, NULL_RTX);
4009
4010 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS)
4011 {
4012 rtx xop0 = XEXP (x, 0);
4013 rtx xop1 = XEXP (x, 1);
4014
4015 if (CONSTANT_P (xop0) && !symbol_mentioned_p (xop0))
4016 xop0 = force_reg (SImode, xop0);
4017
4018 if (CONSTANT_P (xop1) && !symbol_mentioned_p (xop1))
4019 xop1 = force_reg (SImode, xop1);
4020
4021 if (ARM_BASE_REGISTER_RTX_P (xop0)
4022 && GET_CODE (xop1) == CONST_INT)
4023 {
4024 HOST_WIDE_INT n, low_n;
4025 rtx base_reg, val;
4026 n = INTVAL (xop1);
4027
4028 /* VFP addressing modes actually allow greater offsets, but for
4029 now we just stick with the lowest common denominator. */
4030 if (mode == DImode
4031 || ((TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT || TARGET_VFP) && mode == DFmode))
4032 {
4033 low_n = n & 0x0f;
4034 n &= ~0x0f;
4035 if (low_n > 4)
4036 {
4037 n += 16;
4038 low_n -= 16;
4039 }
4040 }
4041 else
4042 {
4043 low_n = ((mode) == TImode ? 0
4044 : n >= 0 ? (n & 0xfff) : -((-n) & 0xfff));
4045 n -= low_n;
4046 }
4047
4048 base_reg = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
4049 val = force_operand (plus_constant (xop0, n), NULL_RTX);
4050 emit_move_insn (base_reg, val);
4051 x = plus_constant (base_reg, low_n);
4052 }
4053 else if (xop0 != XEXP (x, 0) || xop1 != XEXP (x, 1))
4054 x = gen_rtx_PLUS (SImode, xop0, xop1);
4055 }
4056
4057 /* XXX We don't allow MINUS any more -- see comment in
4058 arm_legitimate_address_p (). */
4059 else if (GET_CODE (x) == MINUS)
4060 {
4061 rtx xop0 = XEXP (x, 0);
4062 rtx xop1 = XEXP (x, 1);
4063
4064 if (CONSTANT_P (xop0))
4065 xop0 = force_reg (SImode, xop0);
4066
4067 if (CONSTANT_P (xop1) && ! symbol_mentioned_p (xop1))
4068 xop1 = force_reg (SImode, xop1);
4069
4070 if (xop0 != XEXP (x, 0) || xop1 != XEXP (x, 1))
4071 x = gen_rtx_MINUS (SImode, xop0, xop1);
4072 }
4073
4074 /* Make sure to take full advantage of the pre-indexed addressing mode
4075 with absolute addresses which often allows for the base register to
4076 be factorized for multiple adjacent memory references, and it might
4077 even allows for the mini pool to be avoided entirely. */
4078 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && optimize > 0)
4079 {
4080 unsigned int bits;
4081 HOST_WIDE_INT mask, base, index;
4082 rtx base_reg;
4083
4084 /* ldr and ldrb can use a 12 bit index, ldrsb and the rest can only
4085 use a 8 bit index. So let's use a 12 bit index for SImode only and
4086 hope that arm_gen_constant will enable ldrb to use more bits. */
4087 bits = (mode == SImode) ? 12 : 8;
4088 mask = (1 << bits) - 1;
4089 base = INTVAL (x) & ~mask;
4090 index = INTVAL (x) & mask;
4091 if (bit_count (base & 0xffffffff) > (32 - bits)/2)
4092 {
4093 /* It'll most probably be more efficient to generate the base
4094 with more bits set and use a negative index instead. */
4095 base |= mask;
4096 index -= mask;
4097 }
4098 base_reg = force_reg (SImode, GEN_INT (base));
4099 x = plus_constant (base_reg, index);
4100 }
4101
4102 if (flag_pic)
4103 {
4104 /* We need to find and carefully transform any SYMBOL and LABEL
4105 references; so go back to the original address expression. */
4106 rtx new_x = legitimize_pic_address (orig_x, mode, NULL_RTX);
4107
4108 if (new_x != orig_x)
4109 x = new_x;
4110 }
4111
4112 return x;
4113 }
4114
4115
4116 /* Try machine-dependent ways of modifying an illegitimate Thumb address
4117 to be legitimate. If we find one, return the new, valid address. */
4118 rtx
thumb_legitimize_address(rtx x,rtx orig_x,enum machine_mode mode)4119 thumb_legitimize_address (rtx x, rtx orig_x, enum machine_mode mode)
4120 {
4121 if (arm_tls_symbol_p (x))
4122 return legitimize_tls_address (x, NULL_RTX);
4123
4124 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
4125 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
4126 && (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >= 32 * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
4127 || INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) < 0))
4128 {
4129 rtx xop0 = XEXP (x, 0);
4130 rtx xop1 = XEXP (x, 1);
4131 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = INTVAL (xop1);
4132
4133 /* Try and fold the offset into a biasing of the base register and
4134 then offsetting that. Don't do this when optimizing for space
4135 since it can cause too many CSEs. */
4136 if (optimize_size && offset >= 0
4137 && offset < 256 + 31 * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
4138 {
4139 HOST_WIDE_INT delta;
4140
4141 if (offset >= 256)
4142 delta = offset - (256 - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
4143 else if (offset < 32 * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + 8)
4144 delta = 31 * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
4145 else
4146 delta = offset & (~31 * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
4147
4148 xop0 = force_operand (plus_constant (xop0, offset - delta),
4149 NULL_RTX);
4150 x = plus_constant (xop0, delta);
4151 }
4152 else if (offset < 0 && offset > -256)
4153 /* Small negative offsets are best done with a subtract before the
4154 dereference, forcing these into a register normally takes two
4155 instructions. */
4156 x = force_operand (x, NULL_RTX);
4157 else
4158 {
4159 /* For the remaining cases, force the constant into a register. */
4160 xop1 = force_reg (SImode, xop1);
4161 x = gen_rtx_PLUS (SImode, xop0, xop1);
4162 }
4163 }
4164 else if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
4165 && s_register_operand (XEXP (x, 1), SImode)
4166 && !s_register_operand (XEXP (x, 0), SImode))
4167 {
4168 rtx xop0 = force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
4169
4170 x = gen_rtx_PLUS (SImode, xop0, XEXP (x, 1));
4171 }
4172
4173 if (flag_pic)
4174 {
4175 /* We need to find and carefully transform any SYMBOL and LABEL
4176 references; so go back to the original address expression. */
4177 rtx new_x = legitimize_pic_address (orig_x, mode, NULL_RTX);
4178
4179 if (new_x != orig_x)
4180 x = new_x;
4181 }
4182
4183 return x;
4184 }
4185
4186 rtx
thumb_legitimize_reload_address(rtx * x_p,enum machine_mode mode,int opnum,int type,int ind_levels ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)4187 thumb_legitimize_reload_address (rtx *x_p,
4188 enum machine_mode mode,
4189 int opnum, int type,
4190 int ind_levels ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4191 {
4192 rtx x = *x_p;
4193
4194 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
4195 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < 4
4196 && REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
4197 && XEXP (x, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
4198 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
4199 && !thumb_legitimate_offset_p (mode, INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))))
4200 {
4201 rtx orig_x = x;
4202
4203 x = copy_rtx (x);
4204 push_reload (orig_x, NULL_RTX, x_p, NULL, MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (mode),
4205 Pmode, VOIDmode, 0, 0, opnum, type);
4206 return x;
4207 }
4208
4209 /* If both registers are hi-regs, then it's better to reload the
4210 entire expression rather than each register individually. That
4211 only requires one reload register rather than two. */
4212 if (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
4213 && REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
4214 && REG_P (XEXP (x, 1))
4215 && !REG_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (XEXP (x, 0), mode)
4216 && !REG_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (XEXP (x, 1), mode))
4217 {
4218 rtx orig_x = x;
4219
4220 x = copy_rtx (x);
4221 push_reload (orig_x, NULL_RTX, x_p, NULL, MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (mode),
4222 Pmode, VOIDmode, 0, 0, opnum, type);
4223 return x;
4224 }
4225
4226 return NULL;
4227 }
4228
4229 /* Test for various thread-local symbols. */
4230
4231 /* Return TRUE if X is a thread-local symbol. */
4232
4233 static bool
arm_tls_symbol_p(rtx x)4234 arm_tls_symbol_p (rtx x)
4235 {
4236 if (! TARGET_HAVE_TLS)
4237 return false;
4238
4239 if (GET_CODE (x) != SYMBOL_REF)
4240 return false;
4241
4242 return SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (x) != 0;
4243 }
4244
4245 /* Helper for arm_tls_referenced_p. */
4246
4247 static int
arm_tls_operand_p_1(rtx * x,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)4248 arm_tls_operand_p_1 (rtx *x, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4249 {
4250 if (GET_CODE (*x) == SYMBOL_REF)
4251 return SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (*x) != 0;
4252
4253 /* Don't recurse into UNSPEC_TLS looking for TLS symbols; these are
4254 TLS offsets, not real symbol references. */
4255 if (GET_CODE (*x) == UNSPEC
4256 && XINT (*x, 1) == UNSPEC_TLS)
4257 return -1;
4258
4259 return 0;
4260 }
4261
4262 /* Return TRUE if X contains any TLS symbol references. */
4263
4264 bool
arm_tls_referenced_p(rtx x)4265 arm_tls_referenced_p (rtx x)
4266 {
4267 if (! TARGET_HAVE_TLS)
4268 return false;
4269
4270 return for_each_rtx (&x, arm_tls_operand_p_1, NULL);
4271 }
4272
4273 #define REG_OR_SUBREG_REG(X) \
4274 (GET_CODE (X) == REG \
4275 || (GET_CODE (X) == SUBREG && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (X)) == REG))
4276
4277 #define REG_OR_SUBREG_RTX(X) \
4278 (GET_CODE (X) == REG ? (X) : SUBREG_REG (X))
4279
4280 #ifndef COSTS_N_INSNS
4281 #define COSTS_N_INSNS(N) ((N) * 4 - 2)
4282 #endif
4283 static inline int
thumb_rtx_costs(rtx x,enum rtx_code code,enum rtx_code outer)4284 thumb_rtx_costs (rtx x, enum rtx_code code, enum rtx_code outer)
4285 {
4286 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
4287
4288 switch (code)
4289 {
4290 case ASHIFT:
4291 case ASHIFTRT:
4292 case LSHIFTRT:
4293 case ROTATERT:
4294 case PLUS:
4295 case MINUS:
4296 case COMPARE:
4297 case NEG:
4298 case NOT:
4299 return COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
4300
4301 case MULT:
4302 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
4303 {
4304 int cycles = 0;
4305 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i = INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
4306
4307 while (i)
4308 {
4309 i >>= 2;
4310 cycles++;
4311 }
4312 return COSTS_N_INSNS (2) + cycles;
4313 }
4314 return COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + 16;
4315
4316 case SET:
4317 return (COSTS_N_INSNS (1)
4318 + 4 * ((GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == MEM)
4319 + GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == MEM));
4320
4321 case CONST_INT:
4322 if (outer == SET)
4323 {
4324 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (x) < 256)
4325 return 0;
4326 if (thumb_shiftable_const (INTVAL (x)))
4327 return COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
4328 return COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
4329 }
4330 else if ((outer == PLUS || outer == COMPARE)
4331 && INTVAL (x) < 256 && INTVAL (x) > -256)
4332 return 0;
4333 else if (outer == AND
4334 && INTVAL (x) < 256 && INTVAL (x) >= -256)
4335 return COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
4336 else if (outer == ASHIFT || outer == ASHIFTRT
4337 || outer == LSHIFTRT)
4338 return 0;
4339 return COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
4340
4341 case CONST:
4342 case CONST_DOUBLE:
4343 case LABEL_REF:
4344 case SYMBOL_REF:
4345 return COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
4346
4347 case UDIV:
4348 case UMOD:
4349 case DIV:
4350 case MOD:
4351 return 100;
4352
4353 case TRUNCATE:
4354 return 99;
4355
4356 case AND:
4357 case XOR:
4358 case IOR:
4359 /* XXX guess. */
4360 return 8;
4361
4362 case MEM:
4363 /* XXX another guess. */
4364 /* Memory costs quite a lot for the first word, but subsequent words
4365 load at the equivalent of a single insn each. */
4366 return (10 + 4 * ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD)
4367 + ((GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (x))
4368 ? 4 : 0));
4369
4370 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
4371 /* XXX a guess. */
4372 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == PC || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 2)) == PC)
4373 return 14;
4374 return 2;
4375
4376 case ZERO_EXTEND:
4377 /* XXX still guessing. */
4378 switch (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
4379 {
4380 case QImode:
4381 return (1 + (mode == DImode ? 4 : 0)
4382 + (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MEM ? 10 : 0));
4383
4384 case HImode:
4385 return (4 + (mode == DImode ? 4 : 0)
4386 + (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MEM ? 10 : 0));
4387
4388 case SImode:
4389 return (1 + (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MEM ? 10 : 0));
4390
4391 default:
4392 return 99;
4393 }
4394
4395 default:
4396 return 99;
4397 }
4398 }
4399
4400
4401 /* Worker routine for arm_rtx_costs. */
4402 static inline int
arm_rtx_costs_1(rtx x,enum rtx_code code,enum rtx_code outer)4403 arm_rtx_costs_1 (rtx x, enum rtx_code code, enum rtx_code outer)
4404 {
4405 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
4406 enum rtx_code subcode;
4407 int extra_cost;
4408
4409 switch (code)
4410 {
4411 case MEM:
4412 /* Memory costs quite a lot for the first word, but subsequent words
4413 load at the equivalent of a single insn each. */
4414 return (10 + 4 * ((GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD)
4415 + (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF
4416 && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (x) ? 4 : 0));
4417
4418 case DIV:
4419 case MOD:
4420 case UDIV:
4421 case UMOD:
4422 return optimize_size ? COSTS_N_INSNS (2) : 100;
4423
4424 case ROTATE:
4425 if (mode == SImode && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == REG)
4426 return 4;
4427 /* Fall through */
4428 case ROTATERT:
4429 if (mode != SImode)
4430 return 8;
4431 /* Fall through */
4432 case ASHIFT: case LSHIFTRT: case ASHIFTRT:
4433 if (mode == DImode)
4434 return (8 + (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT ? 0 : 8)
4435 + ((GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
4436 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SUBREG
4437 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))) == REG))
4438 ? 0 : 8));
4439 return (1 + ((GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
4440 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SUBREG
4441 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))) == REG))
4442 ? 0 : 4)
4443 + ((GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == REG
4444 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == SUBREG
4445 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1))) == REG)
4446 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT))
4447 ? 0 : 4));
4448
4449 case MINUS:
4450 if (mode == DImode)
4451 return (4 + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1)) ? 0 : 8)
4452 + ((REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))
4453 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CONST_INT
4454 && const_ok_for_arm (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 0)))))
4455 ? 0 : 8));
4456
4457 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
4458 return (2 + ((REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1))
4459 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_DOUBLE
4460 && arm_const_double_rtx (XEXP (x, 1))))
4461 ? 0 : 8)
4462 + ((REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))
4463 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CONST_DOUBLE
4464 && arm_const_double_rtx (XEXP (x, 0))))
4465 ? 0 : 8));
4466
4467 if (((GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CONST_INT
4468 && const_ok_for_arm (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 0)))
4469 && REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1))))
4470 || (((subcode = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1))) == ASHIFT
4471 || subcode == ASHIFTRT || subcode == LSHIFTRT
4472 || subcode == ROTATE || subcode == ROTATERT
4473 || (subcode == MULT
4474 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1)) == CONST_INT
4475 && ((INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1)) &
4476 (INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1)) - 1)) == 0)))
4477 && REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0))
4478 && (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1))
4479 || GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1)) == CONST_INT)
4480 && REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))))
4481 return 1;
4482 /* Fall through */
4483
4484 case PLUS:
4485 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MULT)
4486 {
4487 extra_cost = rtx_cost (XEXP (x, 0), code);
4488 if (!REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1)))
4489 extra_cost += 4 * ARM_NUM_REGS (mode);
4490 return extra_cost;
4491 }
4492
4493 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
4494 return (2 + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)) ? 0 : 8)
4495 + ((REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1))
4496 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_DOUBLE
4497 && arm_const_double_rtx (XEXP (x, 1))))
4498 ? 0 : 8));
4499
4500 /* Fall through */
4501 case AND: case XOR: case IOR:
4502 extra_cost = 0;
4503
4504 /* Normally the frame registers will be spilt into reg+const during
4505 reload, so it is a bad idea to combine them with other instructions,
4506 since then they might not be moved outside of loops. As a compromise
4507 we allow integration with ops that have a constant as their second
4508 operand. */
4509 if ((REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))
4510 && ARM_FRAME_RTX (REG_OR_SUBREG_RTX (XEXP (x, 0)))
4511 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) != CONST_INT)
4512 || (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))
4513 && ARM_FRAME_RTX (REG_OR_SUBREG_RTX (XEXP (x, 0)))))
4514 extra_cost = 4;
4515
4516 if (mode == DImode)
4517 return (4 + extra_cost + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)) ? 0 : 8)
4518 + ((REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1))
4519 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
4520 && const_ok_for_op (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)), code)))
4521 ? 0 : 8));
4522
4523 if (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)))
4524 return (1 + (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT ? 0 : extra_cost)
4525 + ((REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1))
4526 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
4527 && const_ok_for_op (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)), code)))
4528 ? 0 : 4));
4529
4530 else if (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1)))
4531 return (1 + extra_cost
4532 + ((((subcode = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0))) == ASHIFT
4533 || subcode == LSHIFTRT || subcode == ASHIFTRT
4534 || subcode == ROTATE || subcode == ROTATERT
4535 || (subcode == MULT
4536 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
4537 && ((INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) &
4538 (INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) - 1)) == 0)))
4539 && (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)))
4540 && ((REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)))
4541 || GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT))
4542 ? 0 : 4));
4543
4544 return 8;
4545
4546 case MULT:
4547 /* This should have been handled by the CPU specific routines. */
4548 gcc_unreachable ();
4549
4550 case TRUNCATE:
4551 if (arm_arch3m && mode == SImode
4552 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == LSHIFTRT
4553 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == MULT
4554 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 0))
4555 == GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 1)))
4556 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 0)) == ZERO_EXTEND
4557 || GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 0)) == SIGN_EXTEND))
4558 return 8;
4559 return 99;
4560
4561 case NEG:
4562 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
4563 return 4 + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)) ? 0 : 6);
4564 /* Fall through */
4565 case NOT:
4566 if (mode == DImode)
4567 return 4 + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)) ? 0 : 4);
4568
4569 return 1 + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)) ? 0 : 4);
4570
4571 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
4572 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == PC || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 2)) == PC)
4573 return 14;
4574 return 2;
4575
4576 case COMPARE:
4577 return 1;
4578
4579 case ABS:
4580 return 4 + (mode == DImode ? 4 : 0);
4581
4582 case SIGN_EXTEND:
4583 if (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == QImode)
4584 return (4 + (mode == DImode ? 4 : 0)
4585 + (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MEM ? 10 : 0));
4586 /* Fall through */
4587 case ZERO_EXTEND:
4588 switch (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
4589 {
4590 case QImode:
4591 return (1 + (mode == DImode ? 4 : 0)
4592 + (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MEM ? 10 : 0));
4593
4594 case HImode:
4595 return (4 + (mode == DImode ? 4 : 0)
4596 + (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MEM ? 10 : 0));
4597
4598 case SImode:
4599 return (1 + (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MEM ? 10 : 0));
4600
4601 case V8QImode:
4602 case V4HImode:
4603 case V2SImode:
4604 case V4QImode:
4605 case V2HImode:
4606 return 1;
4607
4608 default:
4609 gcc_unreachable ();
4610 }
4611 gcc_unreachable ();
4612
4613 case CONST_INT:
4614 if (const_ok_for_arm (INTVAL (x)))
4615 return outer == SET ? 2 : -1;
4616 else if (outer == AND
4617 && const_ok_for_arm (~INTVAL (x)))
4618 return -1;
4619 else if ((outer == COMPARE
4620 || outer == PLUS || outer == MINUS)
4621 && const_ok_for_arm (-INTVAL (x)))
4622 return -1;
4623 else
4624 return 5;
4625
4626 case CONST:
4627 case LABEL_REF:
4628 case SYMBOL_REF:
4629 return 6;
4630
4631 case CONST_DOUBLE:
4632 if (arm_const_double_rtx (x))
4633 return outer == SET ? 2 : -1;
4634 else if ((outer == COMPARE || outer == PLUS)
4635 && neg_const_double_rtx_ok_for_fpa (x))
4636 return -1;
4637 return 7;
4638
4639 default:
4640 return 99;
4641 }
4642 }
4643
4644 /* RTX costs when optimizing for size. */
4645 static bool
arm_size_rtx_costs(rtx x,int code,int outer_code,int * total)4646 arm_size_rtx_costs (rtx x, int code, int outer_code, int *total)
4647 {
4648 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
4649
4650 if (TARGET_THUMB)
4651 {
4652 /* XXX TBD. For now, use the standard costs. */
4653 *total = thumb_rtx_costs (x, code, outer_code);
4654 return true;
4655 }
4656
4657 switch (code)
4658 {
4659 case MEM:
4660 /* A memory access costs 1 insn if the mode is small, or the address is
4661 a single register, otherwise it costs one insn per word. */
4662 if (REG_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
4663 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
4664 else
4665 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (ARM_NUM_REGS (mode));
4666 return true;
4667
4668 case DIV:
4669 case MOD:
4670 case UDIV:
4671 case UMOD:
4672 /* Needs a libcall, so it costs about this. */
4673 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
4674 return false;
4675
4676 case ROTATE:
4677 if (mode == SImode && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == REG)
4678 {
4679 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2) + rtx_cost (XEXP (x, 0), code);
4680 return true;
4681 }
4682 /* Fall through */
4683 case ROTATERT:
4684 case ASHIFT:
4685 case LSHIFTRT:
4686 case ASHIFTRT:
4687 if (mode == DImode && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
4688 {
4689 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3) + rtx_cost (XEXP (x, 0), code);
4690 return true;
4691 }
4692 else if (mode == SImode)
4693 {
4694 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1) + rtx_cost (XEXP (x, 0), code);
4695 /* Slightly disparage register shifts, but not by much. */
4696 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) != CONST_INT)
4697 *total += 1 + rtx_cost (XEXP (x, 1), code);
4698 return true;
4699 }
4700
4701 /* Needs a libcall. */
4702 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
4703 return false;
4704
4705 case MINUS:
4706 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
4707 {
4708 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
4709 return false;
4710 }
4711
4712 if (mode == SImode)
4713 {
4714 enum rtx_code subcode0 = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0));
4715 enum rtx_code subcode1 = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1));
4716
4717 if (subcode0 == ROTATE || subcode0 == ROTATERT || subcode0 == ASHIFT
4718 || subcode0 == LSHIFTRT || subcode0 == ASHIFTRT
4719 || subcode1 == ROTATE || subcode1 == ROTATERT
4720 || subcode1 == ASHIFT || subcode1 == LSHIFTRT
4721 || subcode1 == ASHIFTRT)
4722 {
4723 /* It's just the cost of the two operands. */
4724 *total = 0;
4725 return false;
4726 }
4727
4728 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
4729 return false;
4730 }
4731
4732 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (ARM_NUM_REGS (mode));
4733 return false;
4734
4735 case PLUS:
4736 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
4737 {
4738 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
4739 return false;
4740 }
4741
4742 /* Fall through */
4743 case AND: case XOR: case IOR:
4744 if (mode == SImode)
4745 {
4746 enum rtx_code subcode = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0));
4747
4748 if (subcode == ROTATE || subcode == ROTATERT || subcode == ASHIFT
4749 || subcode == LSHIFTRT || subcode == ASHIFTRT
4750 || (code == AND && subcode == NOT))
4751 {
4752 /* It's just the cost of the two operands. */
4753 *total = 0;
4754 return false;
4755 }
4756 }
4757
4758 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (ARM_NUM_REGS (mode));
4759 return false;
4760
4761 case MULT:
4762 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (ARM_NUM_REGS (mode));
4763 return false;
4764
4765 case NEG:
4766 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
4767 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
4768 /* Fall through */
4769 case NOT:
4770 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (ARM_NUM_REGS (mode));
4771
4772 return false;
4773
4774 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
4775 *total = 0;
4776 return false;
4777
4778 case COMPARE:
4779 if (cc_register (XEXP (x, 0), VOIDmode))
4780 * total = 0;
4781 else
4782 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
4783 return false;
4784
4785 case ABS:
4786 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
4787 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
4788 else
4789 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1 + ARM_NUM_REGS (mode));
4790 return false;
4791
4792 case SIGN_EXTEND:
4793 *total = 0;
4794 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0))) < 4)
4795 {
4796 if (!(arm_arch4 && MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0))))
4797 *total += COSTS_N_INSNS (arm_arch6 ? 1 : 2);
4798 }
4799 if (mode == DImode)
4800 *total += COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
4801 return false;
4802
4803 case ZERO_EXTEND:
4804 *total = 0;
4805 if (!(arm_arch4 && MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0))))
4806 {
4807 switch (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
4808 {
4809 case QImode:
4810 *total += COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
4811 break;
4812
4813 case HImode:
4814 *total += COSTS_N_INSNS (arm_arch6 ? 1 : 2);
4815
4816 case SImode:
4817 break;
4818
4819 default:
4820 *total += COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
4821 }
4822 }
4823
4824 if (mode == DImode)
4825 *total += COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
4826
4827 return false;
4828
4829 case CONST_INT:
4830 if (const_ok_for_arm (INTVAL (x)))
4831 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (outer_code == SET ? 1 : 0);
4832 else if (const_ok_for_arm (~INTVAL (x)))
4833 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (outer_code == AND ? 0 : 1);
4834 else if (const_ok_for_arm (-INTVAL (x)))
4835 {
4836 if (outer_code == COMPARE || outer_code == PLUS
4837 || outer_code == MINUS)
4838 *total = 0;
4839 else
4840 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (1);
4841 }
4842 else
4843 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
4844 return true;
4845
4846 case CONST:
4847 case LABEL_REF:
4848 case SYMBOL_REF:
4849 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (2);
4850 return true;
4851
4852 case CONST_DOUBLE:
4853 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (4);
4854 return true;
4855
4856 default:
4857 if (mode != VOIDmode)
4858 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (ARM_NUM_REGS (mode));
4859 else
4860 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (4); /* How knows? */
4861 return false;
4862 }
4863 }
4864
4865 /* RTX costs for cores with a slow MUL implementation. */
4866
4867 static bool
arm_slowmul_rtx_costs(rtx x,int code,int outer_code,int * total)4868 arm_slowmul_rtx_costs (rtx x, int code, int outer_code, int *total)
4869 {
4870 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
4871
4872 if (TARGET_THUMB)
4873 {
4874 *total = thumb_rtx_costs (x, code, outer_code);
4875 return true;
4876 }
4877
4878 switch (code)
4879 {
4880 case MULT:
4881 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
4882 || mode == DImode)
4883 {
4884 *total = 30;
4885 return true;
4886 }
4887
4888 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
4889 {
4890 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i = (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))
4891 & (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xffffffff);
4892 int cost, const_ok = const_ok_for_arm (i);
4893 int j, booth_unit_size;
4894
4895 /* Tune as appropriate. */
4896 cost = const_ok ? 4 : 8;
4897 booth_unit_size = 2;
4898 for (j = 0; i && j < 32; j += booth_unit_size)
4899 {
4900 i >>= booth_unit_size;
4901 cost += 2;
4902 }
4903
4904 *total = cost;
4905 return true;
4906 }
4907
4908 *total = 30 + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)) ? 0 : 4)
4909 + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1)) ? 0 : 4);
4910 return true;
4911
4912 default:
4913 *total = arm_rtx_costs_1 (x, code, outer_code);
4914 return true;
4915 }
4916 }
4917
4918
4919 /* RTX cost for cores with a fast multiply unit (M variants). */
4920
4921 static bool
arm_fastmul_rtx_costs(rtx x,int code,int outer_code,int * total)4922 arm_fastmul_rtx_costs (rtx x, int code, int outer_code, int *total)
4923 {
4924 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
4925
4926 if (TARGET_THUMB)
4927 {
4928 *total = thumb_rtx_costs (x, code, outer_code);
4929 return true;
4930 }
4931
4932 switch (code)
4933 {
4934 case MULT:
4935 /* There is no point basing this on the tuning, since it is always the
4936 fast variant if it exists at all. */
4937 if (mode == DImode
4938 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)))
4939 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ZERO_EXTEND
4940 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SIGN_EXTEND))
4941 {
4942 *total = 8;
4943 return true;
4944 }
4945
4946
4947 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
4948 || mode == DImode)
4949 {
4950 *total = 30;
4951 return true;
4952 }
4953
4954 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
4955 {
4956 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i = (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))
4957 & (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xffffffff);
4958 int cost, const_ok = const_ok_for_arm (i);
4959 int j, booth_unit_size;
4960
4961 /* Tune as appropriate. */
4962 cost = const_ok ? 4 : 8;
4963 booth_unit_size = 8;
4964 for (j = 0; i && j < 32; j += booth_unit_size)
4965 {
4966 i >>= booth_unit_size;
4967 cost += 2;
4968 }
4969
4970 *total = cost;
4971 return true;
4972 }
4973
4974 *total = 8 + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)) ? 0 : 4)
4975 + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1)) ? 0 : 4);
4976 return true;
4977
4978 default:
4979 *total = arm_rtx_costs_1 (x, code, outer_code);
4980 return true;
4981 }
4982 }
4983
4984
4985 /* RTX cost for XScale CPUs. */
4986
4987 static bool
arm_xscale_rtx_costs(rtx x,int code,int outer_code,int * total)4988 arm_xscale_rtx_costs (rtx x, int code, int outer_code, int *total)
4989 {
4990 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
4991
4992 if (TARGET_THUMB)
4993 {
4994 *total = thumb_rtx_costs (x, code, outer_code);
4995 return true;
4996 }
4997
4998 switch (code)
4999 {
5000 case MULT:
5001 /* There is no point basing this on the tuning, since it is always the
5002 fast variant if it exists at all. */
5003 if (mode == DImode
5004 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)))
5005 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ZERO_EXTEND
5006 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SIGN_EXTEND))
5007 {
5008 *total = 8;
5009 return true;
5010 }
5011
5012
5013 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
5014 || mode == DImode)
5015 {
5016 *total = 30;
5017 return true;
5018 }
5019
5020 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
5021 {
5022 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i = (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))
5023 & (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xffffffff);
5024 int cost, const_ok = const_ok_for_arm (i);
5025 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT masked_const;
5026
5027 /* The cost will be related to two insns.
5028 First a load of the constant (MOV or LDR), then a multiply. */
5029 cost = 2;
5030 if (! const_ok)
5031 cost += 1; /* LDR is probably more expensive because
5032 of longer result latency. */
5033 masked_const = i & 0xffff8000;
5034 if (masked_const != 0 && masked_const != 0xffff8000)
5035 {
5036 masked_const = i & 0xf8000000;
5037 if (masked_const == 0 || masked_const == 0xf8000000)
5038 cost += 1;
5039 else
5040 cost += 2;
5041 }
5042 *total = cost;
5043 return true;
5044 }
5045
5046 *total = 8 + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)) ? 0 : 4)
5047 + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1)) ? 0 : 4);
5048 return true;
5049
5050 case COMPARE:
5051 /* A COMPARE of a MULT is slow on XScale; the muls instruction
5052 will stall until the multiplication is complete. */
5053 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MULT)
5054 *total = 4 + rtx_cost (XEXP (x, 0), code);
5055 else
5056 *total = arm_rtx_costs_1 (x, code, outer_code);
5057 return true;
5058
5059 default:
5060 *total = arm_rtx_costs_1 (x, code, outer_code);
5061 return true;
5062 }
5063 }
5064
5065
5066 /* RTX costs for 9e (and later) cores. */
5067
5068 static bool
arm_9e_rtx_costs(rtx x,int code,int outer_code,int * total)5069 arm_9e_rtx_costs (rtx x, int code, int outer_code, int *total)
5070 {
5071 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
5072 int nonreg_cost;
5073 int cost;
5074
5075 if (TARGET_THUMB)
5076 {
5077 switch (code)
5078 {
5079 case MULT:
5080 *total = COSTS_N_INSNS (3);
5081 return true;
5082
5083 default:
5084 *total = thumb_rtx_costs (x, code, outer_code);
5085 return true;
5086 }
5087 }
5088
5089 switch (code)
5090 {
5091 case MULT:
5092 /* There is no point basing this on the tuning, since it is always the
5093 fast variant if it exists at all. */
5094 if (mode == DImode
5095 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)))
5096 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ZERO_EXTEND
5097 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SIGN_EXTEND))
5098 {
5099 *total = 3;
5100 return true;
5101 }
5102
5103
5104 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT)
5105 {
5106 *total = 30;
5107 return true;
5108 }
5109 if (mode == DImode)
5110 {
5111 cost = 7;
5112 nonreg_cost = 8;
5113 }
5114 else
5115 {
5116 cost = 2;
5117 nonreg_cost = 4;
5118 }
5119
5120
5121 *total = cost + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)) ? 0 : nonreg_cost)
5122 + (REG_OR_SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1)) ? 0 : nonreg_cost);
5123 return true;
5124
5125 default:
5126 *total = arm_rtx_costs_1 (x, code, outer_code);
5127 return true;
5128 }
5129 }
5130 /* All address computations that can be done are free, but rtx cost returns
5131 the same for practically all of them. So we weight the different types
5132 of address here in the order (most pref first):
5133 PRE/POST_INC/DEC, SHIFT or NON-INT sum, INT sum, REG, MEM or LABEL. */
5134 static inline int
arm_arm_address_cost(rtx x)5135 arm_arm_address_cost (rtx x)
5136 {
5137 enum rtx_code c = GET_CODE (x);
5138
5139 if (c == PRE_INC || c == PRE_DEC || c == POST_INC || c == POST_DEC)
5140 return 0;
5141 if (c == MEM || c == LABEL_REF || c == SYMBOL_REF)
5142 return 10;
5143
5144 if (c == PLUS || c == MINUS)
5145 {
5146 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CONST_INT)
5147 return 2;
5148
5149 if (ARITHMETIC_P (XEXP (x, 0)) || ARITHMETIC_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
5150 return 3;
5151
5152 return 4;
5153 }
5154
5155 return 6;
5156 }
5157
5158 static inline int
arm_thumb_address_cost(rtx x)5159 arm_thumb_address_cost (rtx x)
5160 {
5161 enum rtx_code c = GET_CODE (x);
5162
5163 if (c == REG)
5164 return 1;
5165 if (c == PLUS
5166 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
5167 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
5168 return 1;
5169
5170 return 2;
5171 }
5172
5173 static int
arm_address_cost(rtx x)5174 arm_address_cost (rtx x)
5175 {
5176 return TARGET_ARM ? arm_arm_address_cost (x) : arm_thumb_address_cost (x);
5177 }
5178
5179 static int
arm_adjust_cost(rtx insn,rtx link,rtx dep,int cost)5180 arm_adjust_cost (rtx insn, rtx link, rtx dep, int cost)
5181 {
5182 rtx i_pat, d_pat;
5183
5184 /* Some true dependencies can have a higher cost depending
5185 on precisely how certain input operands are used. */
5186 if (arm_tune_xscale
5187 && REG_NOTE_KIND (link) == 0
5188 && recog_memoized (insn) >= 0
5189 && recog_memoized (dep) >= 0)
5190 {
5191 int shift_opnum = get_attr_shift (insn);
5192 enum attr_type attr_type = get_attr_type (dep);
5193
5194 /* If nonzero, SHIFT_OPNUM contains the operand number of a shifted
5195 operand for INSN. If we have a shifted input operand and the
5196 instruction we depend on is another ALU instruction, then we may
5197 have to account for an additional stall. */
5198 if (shift_opnum != 0
5199 && (attr_type == TYPE_ALU_SHIFT || attr_type == TYPE_ALU_SHIFT_REG))
5200 {
5201 rtx shifted_operand;
5202 int opno;
5203
5204 /* Get the shifted operand. */
5205 extract_insn (insn);
5206 shifted_operand = recog_data.operand[shift_opnum];
5207
5208 /* Iterate over all the operands in DEP. If we write an operand
5209 that overlaps with SHIFTED_OPERAND, then we have increase the
5210 cost of this dependency. */
5211 extract_insn (dep);
5212 preprocess_constraints ();
5213 for (opno = 0; opno < recog_data.n_operands; opno++)
5214 {
5215 /* We can ignore strict inputs. */
5216 if (recog_data.operand_type[opno] == OP_IN)
5217 continue;
5218
5219 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (recog_data.operand[opno],
5220 shifted_operand))
5221 return 2;
5222 }
5223 }
5224 }
5225
5226 /* XXX This is not strictly true for the FPA. */
5227 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) == REG_DEP_ANTI
5228 || REG_NOTE_KIND (link) == REG_DEP_OUTPUT)
5229 return 0;
5230
5231 /* Call insns don't incur a stall, even if they follow a load. */
5232 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) == 0
5233 && GET_CODE (insn) == CALL_INSN)
5234 return 1;
5235
5236 if ((i_pat = single_set (insn)) != NULL
5237 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (i_pat)) == MEM
5238 && (d_pat = single_set (dep)) != NULL
5239 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (d_pat)) == MEM)
5240 {
5241 rtx src_mem = XEXP (SET_SRC (i_pat), 0);
5242 /* This is a load after a store, there is no conflict if the load reads
5243 from a cached area. Assume that loads from the stack, and from the
5244 constant pool are cached, and that others will miss. This is a
5245 hack. */
5246
5247 if ((GET_CODE (src_mem) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (src_mem))
5248 || reg_mentioned_p (stack_pointer_rtx, src_mem)
5249 || reg_mentioned_p (frame_pointer_rtx, src_mem)
5250 || reg_mentioned_p (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, src_mem))
5251 return 1;
5252 }
5253
5254 return cost;
5255 }
5256
5257 static int fp_consts_inited = 0;
5258
5259 /* Only zero is valid for VFP. Other values are also valid for FPA. */
5260 static const char * const strings_fp[8] =
5261 {
5262 "0", "1", "2", "3",
5263 "4", "5", "0.5", "10"
5264 };
5265
5266 static REAL_VALUE_TYPE values_fp[8];
5267
5268 static void
init_fp_table(void)5269 init_fp_table (void)
5270 {
5271 int i;
5272 REAL_VALUE_TYPE r;
5273
5274 if (TARGET_VFP)
5275 fp_consts_inited = 1;
5276 else
5277 fp_consts_inited = 8;
5278
5279 for (i = 0; i < fp_consts_inited; i++)
5280 {
5281 r = REAL_VALUE_ATOF (strings_fp[i], DFmode);
5282 values_fp[i] = r;
5283 }
5284 }
5285
5286 /* Return TRUE if rtx X is a valid immediate FP constant. */
5287 int
arm_const_double_rtx(rtx x)5288 arm_const_double_rtx (rtx x)
5289 {
5290 REAL_VALUE_TYPE r;
5291 int i;
5292
5293 if (!fp_consts_inited)
5294 init_fp_table ();
5295
5296 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, x);
5297 if (REAL_VALUE_MINUS_ZERO (r))
5298 return 0;
5299
5300 for (i = 0; i < fp_consts_inited; i++)
5301 if (REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (r, values_fp[i]))
5302 return 1;
5303
5304 return 0;
5305 }
5306
5307 /* Return TRUE if rtx X is a valid immediate FPA constant. */
5308 int
neg_const_double_rtx_ok_for_fpa(rtx x)5309 neg_const_double_rtx_ok_for_fpa (rtx x)
5310 {
5311 REAL_VALUE_TYPE r;
5312 int i;
5313
5314 if (!fp_consts_inited)
5315 init_fp_table ();
5316
5317 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, x);
5318 r = REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (r);
5319 if (REAL_VALUE_MINUS_ZERO (r))
5320 return 0;
5321
5322 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
5323 if (REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (r, values_fp[i]))
5324 return 1;
5325
5326 return 0;
5327 }
5328
5329 /* Predicates for `match_operand' and `match_operator'. */
5330
5331 /* Return nonzero if OP is a valid Cirrus memory address pattern. */
5332 int
cirrus_memory_offset(rtx op)5333 cirrus_memory_offset (rtx op)
5334 {
5335 /* Reject eliminable registers. */
5336 if (! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
5337 && ( reg_mentioned_p (frame_pointer_rtx, op)
5338 || reg_mentioned_p (arg_pointer_rtx, op)
5339 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_incoming_args_rtx, op)
5340 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, op)
5341 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, op)
5342 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_vars_rtx, op)))
5343 return 0;
5344
5345 if (GET_CODE (op) == MEM)
5346 {
5347 rtx ind;
5348
5349 ind = XEXP (op, 0);
5350
5351 /* Match: (mem (reg)). */
5352 if (GET_CODE (ind) == REG)
5353 return 1;
5354
5355 /* Match:
5356 (mem (plus (reg)
5357 (const))). */
5358 if (GET_CODE (ind) == PLUS
5359 && GET_CODE (XEXP (ind, 0)) == REG
5360 && REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (XEXP (ind, 0), VOIDmode)
5361 && GET_CODE (XEXP (ind, 1)) == CONST_INT)
5362 return 1;
5363 }
5364
5365 return 0;
5366 }
5367
5368 /* Return TRUE if OP is a valid coprocessor memory address pattern.
5369 WB if true if writeback address modes are allowed. */
5370
5371 int
arm_coproc_mem_operand(rtx op,bool wb)5372 arm_coproc_mem_operand (rtx op, bool wb)
5373 {
5374 rtx ind;
5375
5376 /* Reject eliminable registers. */
5377 if (! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
5378 && ( reg_mentioned_p (frame_pointer_rtx, op)
5379 || reg_mentioned_p (arg_pointer_rtx, op)
5380 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_incoming_args_rtx, op)
5381 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, op)
5382 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, op)
5383 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_vars_rtx, op)))
5384 return FALSE;
5385
5386 /* Constants are converted into offsets from labels. */
5387 if (GET_CODE (op) != MEM)
5388 return FALSE;
5389
5390 ind = XEXP (op, 0);
5391
5392 if (reload_completed
5393 && (GET_CODE (ind) == LABEL_REF
5394 || (GET_CODE (ind) == CONST
5395 && GET_CODE (XEXP (ind, 0)) == PLUS
5396 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (ind, 0), 0)) == LABEL_REF
5397 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (ind, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)))
5398 return TRUE;
5399
5400 /* Match: (mem (reg)). */
5401 if (GET_CODE (ind) == REG)
5402 return arm_address_register_rtx_p (ind, 0);
5403
5404 /* Autoincremment addressing modes. */
5405 if (wb
5406 && (GET_CODE (ind) == PRE_INC
5407 || GET_CODE (ind) == POST_INC
5408 || GET_CODE (ind) == PRE_DEC
5409 || GET_CODE (ind) == POST_DEC))
5410 return arm_address_register_rtx_p (XEXP (ind, 0), 0);
5411
5412 if (wb
5413 && (GET_CODE (ind) == POST_MODIFY || GET_CODE (ind) == PRE_MODIFY)
5414 && arm_address_register_rtx_p (XEXP (ind, 0), 0)
5415 && GET_CODE (XEXP (ind, 1)) == PLUS
5416 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (XEXP (ind, 1), 0), XEXP (ind, 0)))
5417 ind = XEXP (ind, 1);
5418
5419 /* Match:
5420 (plus (reg)
5421 (const)). */
5422 if (GET_CODE (ind) == PLUS
5423 && GET_CODE (XEXP (ind, 0)) == REG
5424 && REG_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (XEXP (ind, 0), VOIDmode)
5425 && GET_CODE (XEXP (ind, 1)) == CONST_INT
5426 && INTVAL (XEXP (ind, 1)) > -1024
5427 && INTVAL (XEXP (ind, 1)) < 1024
5428 && (INTVAL (XEXP (ind, 1)) & 3) == 0)
5429 return TRUE;
5430
5431 return FALSE;
5432 }
5433
5434 /* Return true if X is a register that will be eliminated later on. */
5435 int
arm_eliminable_register(rtx x)5436 arm_eliminable_register (rtx x)
5437 {
5438 return REG_P (x) && (REGNO (x) == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
5439 || REGNO (x) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
5440 || (REGNO (x) >= FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
5441 && REGNO (x) <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER));
5442 }
5443
5444 /* Return GENERAL_REGS if a scratch register required to reload x to/from
5445 coprocessor registers. Otherwise return NO_REGS. */
5446
5447 enum reg_class
coproc_secondary_reload_class(enum machine_mode mode,rtx x,bool wb)5448 coproc_secondary_reload_class (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, bool wb)
5449 {
5450 if (arm_coproc_mem_operand (x, wb) || s_register_operand (x, mode))
5451 return NO_REGS;
5452
5453 return GENERAL_REGS;
5454 }
5455
5456 /* Values which must be returned in the most-significant end of the return
5457 register. */
5458
5459 static bool
arm_return_in_msb(tree valtype)5460 arm_return_in_msb (tree valtype)
5461 {
5462 return (TARGET_AAPCS_BASED
5463 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
5464 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (valtype)
5465 || TREE_CODE (valtype) == COMPLEX_TYPE));
5466 }
5467
5468 /* Returns TRUE if INSN is an "LDR REG, ADDR" instruction.
5469 Use by the Cirrus Maverick code which has to workaround
5470 a hardware bug triggered by such instructions. */
5471 static bool
arm_memory_load_p(rtx insn)5472 arm_memory_load_p (rtx insn)
5473 {
5474 rtx body, lhs, rhs;;
5475
5476 if (insn == NULL_RTX || GET_CODE (insn) != INSN)
5477 return false;
5478
5479 body = PATTERN (insn);
5480
5481 if (GET_CODE (body) != SET)
5482 return false;
5483
5484 lhs = XEXP (body, 0);
5485 rhs = XEXP (body, 1);
5486
5487 lhs = REG_OR_SUBREG_RTX (lhs);
5488
5489 /* If the destination is not a general purpose
5490 register we do not have to worry. */
5491 if (GET_CODE (lhs) != REG
5492 || REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (lhs)) != GENERAL_REGS)
5493 return false;
5494
5495 /* As well as loads from memory we also have to react
5496 to loads of invalid constants which will be turned
5497 into loads from the minipool. */
5498 return (GET_CODE (rhs) == MEM
5499 || GET_CODE (rhs) == SYMBOL_REF
5500 || note_invalid_constants (insn, -1, false));
5501 }
5502
5503 /* Return TRUE if INSN is a Cirrus instruction. */
5504 static bool
arm_cirrus_insn_p(rtx insn)5505 arm_cirrus_insn_p (rtx insn)
5506 {
5507 enum attr_cirrus attr;
5508
5509 /* get_attr cannot accept USE or CLOBBER. */
5510 if (!insn
5511 || GET_CODE (insn) != INSN
5512 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == USE
5513 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == CLOBBER)
5514 return 0;
5515
5516 attr = get_attr_cirrus (insn);
5517
5518 return attr != CIRRUS_NOT;
5519 }
5520
5521 /* Cirrus reorg for invalid instruction combinations. */
5522 static void
cirrus_reorg(rtx first)5523 cirrus_reorg (rtx first)
5524 {
5525 enum attr_cirrus attr;
5526 rtx body = PATTERN (first);
5527 rtx t;
5528 int nops;
5529
5530 /* Any branch must be followed by 2 non Cirrus instructions. */
5531 if (GET_CODE (first) == JUMP_INSN && GET_CODE (body) != RETURN)
5532 {
5533 nops = 0;
5534 t = next_nonnote_insn (first);
5535
5536 if (arm_cirrus_insn_p (t))
5537 ++ nops;
5538
5539 if (arm_cirrus_insn_p (next_nonnote_insn (t)))
5540 ++ nops;
5541
5542 while (nops --)
5543 emit_insn_after (gen_nop (), first);
5544
5545 return;
5546 }
5547
5548 /* (float (blah)) is in parallel with a clobber. */
5549 if (GET_CODE (body) == PARALLEL && XVECLEN (body, 0) > 0)
5550 body = XVECEXP (body, 0, 0);
5551
5552 if (GET_CODE (body) == SET)
5553 {
5554 rtx lhs = XEXP (body, 0), rhs = XEXP (body, 1);
5555
5556 /* cfldrd, cfldr64, cfstrd, cfstr64 must
5557 be followed by a non Cirrus insn. */
5558 if (get_attr_cirrus (first) == CIRRUS_DOUBLE)
5559 {
5560 if (arm_cirrus_insn_p (next_nonnote_insn (first)))
5561 emit_insn_after (gen_nop (), first);
5562
5563 return;
5564 }
5565 else if (arm_memory_load_p (first))
5566 {
5567 unsigned int arm_regno;
5568
5569 /* Any ldr/cfmvdlr, ldr/cfmvdhr, ldr/cfmvsr, ldr/cfmv64lr,
5570 ldr/cfmv64hr combination where the Rd field is the same
5571 in both instructions must be split with a non Cirrus
5572 insn. Example:
5573
5574 ldr r0, blah
5575 nop
5576 cfmvsr mvf0, r0. */
5577
5578 /* Get Arm register number for ldr insn. */
5579 if (GET_CODE (lhs) == REG)
5580 arm_regno = REGNO (lhs);
5581 else
5582 {
5583 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (rhs) == REG);
5584 arm_regno = REGNO (rhs);
5585 }
5586
5587 /* Next insn. */
5588 first = next_nonnote_insn (first);
5589
5590 if (! arm_cirrus_insn_p (first))
5591 return;
5592
5593 body = PATTERN (first);
5594
5595 /* (float (blah)) is in parallel with a clobber. */
5596 if (GET_CODE (body) == PARALLEL && XVECLEN (body, 0))
5597 body = XVECEXP (body, 0, 0);
5598
5599 if (GET_CODE (body) == FLOAT)
5600 body = XEXP (body, 0);
5601
5602 if (get_attr_cirrus (first) == CIRRUS_MOVE
5603 && GET_CODE (XEXP (body, 1)) == REG
5604 && arm_regno == REGNO (XEXP (body, 1)))
5605 emit_insn_after (gen_nop (), first);
5606
5607 return;
5608 }
5609 }
5610
5611 /* get_attr cannot accept USE or CLOBBER. */
5612 if (!first
5613 || GET_CODE (first) != INSN
5614 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (first)) == USE
5615 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (first)) == CLOBBER)
5616 return;
5617
5618 attr = get_attr_cirrus (first);
5619
5620 /* Any coprocessor compare instruction (cfcmps, cfcmpd, ...)
5621 must be followed by a non-coprocessor instruction. */
5622 if (attr == CIRRUS_COMPARE)
5623 {
5624 nops = 0;
5625
5626 t = next_nonnote_insn (first);
5627
5628 if (arm_cirrus_insn_p (t))
5629 ++ nops;
5630
5631 if (arm_cirrus_insn_p (next_nonnote_insn (t)))
5632 ++ nops;
5633
5634 while (nops --)
5635 emit_insn_after (gen_nop (), first);
5636
5637 return;
5638 }
5639 }
5640
5641 /* Return TRUE if X references a SYMBOL_REF. */
5642 int
symbol_mentioned_p(rtx x)5643 symbol_mentioned_p (rtx x)
5644 {
5645 const char * fmt;
5646 int i;
5647
5648 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF)
5649 return 1;
5650
5651 /* UNSPEC_TLS entries for a symbol include the SYMBOL_REF, but they
5652 are constant offsets, not symbols. */
5653 if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_TLS)
5654 return 0;
5655
5656 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (x));
5657
5658 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (GET_CODE (x)) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
5659 {
5660 if (fmt[i] == 'E')
5661 {
5662 int j;
5663
5664 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
5665 if (symbol_mentioned_p (XVECEXP (x, i, j)))
5666 return 1;
5667 }
5668 else if (fmt[i] == 'e' && symbol_mentioned_p (XEXP (x, i)))
5669 return 1;
5670 }
5671
5672 return 0;
5673 }
5674
5675 /* Return TRUE if X references a LABEL_REF. */
5676 int
label_mentioned_p(rtx x)5677 label_mentioned_p (rtx x)
5678 {
5679 const char * fmt;
5680 int i;
5681
5682 if (GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF)
5683 return 1;
5684
5685 /* UNSPEC_TLS entries for a symbol include a LABEL_REF for the referencing
5686 instruction, but they are constant offsets, not symbols. */
5687 if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_TLS)
5688 return 0;
5689
5690 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (x));
5691 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (GET_CODE (x)) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
5692 {
5693 if (fmt[i] == 'E')
5694 {
5695 int j;
5696
5697 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
5698 if (label_mentioned_p (XVECEXP (x, i, j)))
5699 return 1;
5700 }
5701 else if (fmt[i] == 'e' && label_mentioned_p (XEXP (x, i)))
5702 return 1;
5703 }
5704
5705 return 0;
5706 }
5707
5708 int
tls_mentioned_p(rtx x)5709 tls_mentioned_p (rtx x)
5710 {
5711 switch (GET_CODE (x))
5712 {
5713 case CONST:
5714 return tls_mentioned_p (XEXP (x, 0));
5715
5716 case UNSPEC:
5717 if (XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_TLS)
5718 return 1;
5719
5720 default:
5721 return 0;
5722 }
5723 }
5724
5725 /* Must not copy a SET whose source operand is PC-relative. */
5726
5727 static bool
arm_cannot_copy_insn_p(rtx insn)5728 arm_cannot_copy_insn_p (rtx insn)
5729 {
5730 rtx pat = PATTERN (insn);
5731
5732 if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL
5733 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0)) == SET)
5734 {
5735 rtx rhs = SET_SRC (XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0));
5736
5737 if (GET_CODE (rhs) == UNSPEC
5738 && XINT (rhs, 1) == UNSPEC_PIC_BASE)
5739 return TRUE;
5740
5741 if (GET_CODE (rhs) == MEM
5742 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rhs, 0)) == UNSPEC
5743 && XINT (XEXP (rhs, 0), 1) == UNSPEC_PIC_BASE)
5744 return TRUE;
5745 }
5746
5747 return FALSE;
5748 }
5749
5750 enum rtx_code
minmax_code(rtx x)5751 minmax_code (rtx x)
5752 {
5753 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
5754
5755 switch (code)
5756 {
5757 case SMAX:
5758 return GE;
5759 case SMIN:
5760 return LE;
5761 case UMIN:
5762 return LEU;
5763 case UMAX:
5764 return GEU;
5765 default:
5766 gcc_unreachable ();
5767 }
5768 }
5769
5770 /* Return 1 if memory locations are adjacent. */
5771 int
adjacent_mem_locations(rtx a,rtx b)5772 adjacent_mem_locations (rtx a, rtx b)
5773 {
5774 /* We don't guarantee to preserve the order of these memory refs. */
5775 if (volatile_refs_p (a) || volatile_refs_p (b))
5776 return 0;
5777
5778 if ((GET_CODE (XEXP (a, 0)) == REG
5779 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (a, 0)) == PLUS
5780 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (a, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT))
5781 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (b, 0)) == REG
5782 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (b, 0)) == PLUS
5783 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (b, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT)))
5784 {
5785 HOST_WIDE_INT val0 = 0, val1 = 0;
5786 rtx reg0, reg1;
5787 int val_diff;
5788
5789 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (a, 0)) == PLUS)
5790 {
5791 reg0 = XEXP (XEXP (a, 0), 0);
5792 val0 = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (a, 0), 1));
5793 }
5794 else
5795 reg0 = XEXP (a, 0);
5796
5797 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (b, 0)) == PLUS)
5798 {
5799 reg1 = XEXP (XEXP (b, 0), 0);
5800 val1 = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (b, 0), 1));
5801 }
5802 else
5803 reg1 = XEXP (b, 0);
5804
5805 /* Don't accept any offset that will require multiple
5806 instructions to handle, since this would cause the
5807 arith_adjacentmem pattern to output an overlong sequence. */
5808 if (!const_ok_for_op (PLUS, val0) || !const_ok_for_op (PLUS, val1))
5809 return 0;
5810
5811 /* Don't allow an eliminable register: register elimination can make
5812 the offset too large. */
5813 if (arm_eliminable_register (reg0))
5814 return 0;
5815
5816 val_diff = val1 - val0;
5817
5818 if (arm_ld_sched)
5819 {
5820 /* If the target has load delay slots, then there's no benefit
5821 to using an ldm instruction unless the offset is zero and
5822 we are optimizing for size. */
5823 return (optimize_size && (REGNO (reg0) == REGNO (reg1))
5824 && (val0 == 0 || val1 == 0 || val0 == 4 || val1 == 4)
5825 && (val_diff == 4 || val_diff == -4));
5826 }
5827
5828 return ((REGNO (reg0) == REGNO (reg1))
5829 && (val_diff == 4 || val_diff == -4));
5830 }
5831
5832 return 0;
5833 }
5834
5835 int
load_multiple_sequence(rtx * operands,int nops,int * regs,int * base,HOST_WIDE_INT * load_offset)5836 load_multiple_sequence (rtx *operands, int nops, int *regs, int *base,
5837 HOST_WIDE_INT *load_offset)
5838 {
5839 int unsorted_regs[4];
5840 HOST_WIDE_INT unsorted_offsets[4];
5841 int order[4];
5842 int base_reg = -1;
5843 int i;
5844
5845 /* Can only handle 2, 3, or 4 insns at present,
5846 though could be easily extended if required. */
5847 gcc_assert (nops >= 2 && nops <= 4);
5848
5849 /* Loop over the operands and check that the memory references are
5850 suitable (i.e. immediate offsets from the same base register). At
5851 the same time, extract the target register, and the memory
5852 offsets. */
5853 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
5854 {
5855 rtx reg;
5856 rtx offset;
5857
5858 /* Convert a subreg of a mem into the mem itself. */
5859 if (GET_CODE (operands[nops + i]) == SUBREG)
5860 operands[nops + i] = alter_subreg (operands + (nops + i));
5861
5862 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (operands[nops + i]) == MEM);
5863
5864 /* Don't reorder volatile memory references; it doesn't seem worth
5865 looking for the case where the order is ok anyway. */
5866 if (MEM_VOLATILE_P (operands[nops + i]))
5867 return 0;
5868
5869 offset = const0_rtx;
5870
5871 if ((GET_CODE (reg = XEXP (operands[nops + i], 0)) == REG
5872 || (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG
5873 && GET_CODE (reg = SUBREG_REG (reg)) == REG))
5874 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (operands[nops + i], 0)) == PLUS
5875 && ((GET_CODE (reg = XEXP (XEXP (operands[nops + i], 0), 0))
5876 == REG)
5877 || (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG
5878 && GET_CODE (reg = SUBREG_REG (reg)) == REG))
5879 && (GET_CODE (offset = XEXP (XEXP (operands[nops + i], 0), 1))
5880 == CONST_INT)))
5881 {
5882 if (i == 0)
5883 {
5884 base_reg = REGNO (reg);
5885 unsorted_regs[0] = (GET_CODE (operands[i]) == REG
5886 ? REGNO (operands[i])
5887 : REGNO (SUBREG_REG (operands[i])));
5888 order[0] = 0;
5889 }
5890 else
5891 {
5892 if (base_reg != (int) REGNO (reg))
5893 /* Not addressed from the same base register. */
5894 return 0;
5895
5896 unsorted_regs[i] = (GET_CODE (operands[i]) == REG
5897 ? REGNO (operands[i])
5898 : REGNO (SUBREG_REG (operands[i])));
5899 if (unsorted_regs[i] < unsorted_regs[order[0]])
5900 order[0] = i;
5901 }
5902
5903 /* If it isn't an integer register, or if it overwrites the
5904 base register but isn't the last insn in the list, then
5905 we can't do this. */
5906 if (unsorted_regs[i] < 0 || unsorted_regs[i] > 14
5907 || (i != nops - 1 && unsorted_regs[i] == base_reg))
5908 return 0;
5909
5910 unsorted_offsets[i] = INTVAL (offset);
5911 }
5912 else
5913 /* Not a suitable memory address. */
5914 return 0;
5915 }
5916
5917 /* All the useful information has now been extracted from the
5918 operands into unsorted_regs and unsorted_offsets; additionally,
5919 order[0] has been set to the lowest numbered register in the
5920 list. Sort the registers into order, and check that the memory
5921 offsets are ascending and adjacent. */
5922
5923 for (i = 1; i < nops; i++)
5924 {
5925 int j;
5926
5927 order[i] = order[i - 1];
5928 for (j = 0; j < nops; j++)
5929 if (unsorted_regs[j] > unsorted_regs[order[i - 1]]
5930 && (order[i] == order[i - 1]
5931 || unsorted_regs[j] < unsorted_regs[order[i]]))
5932 order[i] = j;
5933
5934 /* Have we found a suitable register? if not, one must be used more
5935 than once. */
5936 if (order[i] == order[i - 1])
5937 return 0;
5938
5939 /* Is the memory address adjacent and ascending? */
5940 if (unsorted_offsets[order[i]] != unsorted_offsets[order[i - 1]] + 4)
5941 return 0;
5942 }
5943
5944 if (base)
5945 {
5946 *base = base_reg;
5947
5948 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
5949 regs[i] = unsorted_regs[order[i]];
5950
5951 *load_offset = unsorted_offsets[order[0]];
5952 }
5953
5954 if (unsorted_offsets[order[0]] == 0)
5955 return 1; /* ldmia */
5956
5957 if (unsorted_offsets[order[0]] == 4)
5958 return 2; /* ldmib */
5959
5960 if (unsorted_offsets[order[nops - 1]] == 0)
5961 return 3; /* ldmda */
5962
5963 if (unsorted_offsets[order[nops - 1]] == -4)
5964 return 4; /* ldmdb */
5965
5966 /* For ARM8,9 & StrongARM, 2 ldr instructions are faster than an ldm
5967 if the offset isn't small enough. The reason 2 ldrs are faster
5968 is because these ARMs are able to do more than one cache access
5969 in a single cycle. The ARM9 and StrongARM have Harvard caches,
5970 whilst the ARM8 has a double bandwidth cache. This means that
5971 these cores can do both an instruction fetch and a data fetch in
5972 a single cycle, so the trick of calculating the address into a
5973 scratch register (one of the result regs) and then doing a load
5974 multiple actually becomes slower (and no smaller in code size).
5975 That is the transformation
5976
5977 ldr rd1, [rbase + offset]
5978 ldr rd2, [rbase + offset + 4]
5979
5980 to
5981
5982 add rd1, rbase, offset
5983 ldmia rd1, {rd1, rd2}
5984
5985 produces worse code -- '3 cycles + any stalls on rd2' instead of
5986 '2 cycles + any stalls on rd2'. On ARMs with only one cache
5987 access per cycle, the first sequence could never complete in less
5988 than 6 cycles, whereas the ldm sequence would only take 5 and
5989 would make better use of sequential accesses if not hitting the
5990 cache.
5991
5992 We cheat here and test 'arm_ld_sched' which we currently know to
5993 only be true for the ARM8, ARM9 and StrongARM. If this ever
5994 changes, then the test below needs to be reworked. */
5995 if (nops == 2 && arm_ld_sched)
5996 return 0;
5997
5998 /* Can't do it without setting up the offset, only do this if it takes
5999 no more than one insn. */
6000 return (const_ok_for_arm (unsorted_offsets[order[0]])
6001 || const_ok_for_arm (-unsorted_offsets[order[0]])) ? 5 : 0;
6002 }
6003
6004 const char *
emit_ldm_seq(rtx * operands,int nops)6005 emit_ldm_seq (rtx *operands, int nops)
6006 {
6007 int regs[4];
6008 int base_reg;
6009 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
6010 char buf[100];
6011 int i;
6012
6013 switch (load_multiple_sequence (operands, nops, regs, &base_reg, &offset))
6014 {
6015 case 1:
6016 strcpy (buf, "ldm%?ia\t");
6017 break;
6018
6019 case 2:
6020 strcpy (buf, "ldm%?ib\t");
6021 break;
6022
6023 case 3:
6024 strcpy (buf, "ldm%?da\t");
6025 break;
6026
6027 case 4:
6028 strcpy (buf, "ldm%?db\t");
6029 break;
6030
6031 case 5:
6032 if (offset >= 0)
6033 sprintf (buf, "add%%?\t%s%s, %s%s, #%ld", REGISTER_PREFIX,
6034 reg_names[regs[0]], REGISTER_PREFIX, reg_names[base_reg],
6035 (long) offset);
6036 else
6037 sprintf (buf, "sub%%?\t%s%s, %s%s, #%ld", REGISTER_PREFIX,
6038 reg_names[regs[0]], REGISTER_PREFIX, reg_names[base_reg],
6039 (long) -offset);
6040 output_asm_insn (buf, operands);
6041 base_reg = regs[0];
6042 strcpy (buf, "ldm%?ia\t");
6043 break;
6044
6045 default:
6046 gcc_unreachable ();
6047 }
6048
6049 sprintf (buf + strlen (buf), "%s%s, {%s%s", REGISTER_PREFIX,
6050 reg_names[base_reg], REGISTER_PREFIX, reg_names[regs[0]]);
6051
6052 for (i = 1; i < nops; i++)
6053 sprintf (buf + strlen (buf), ", %s%s", REGISTER_PREFIX,
6054 reg_names[regs[i]]);
6055
6056 strcat (buf, "}\t%@ phole ldm");
6057
6058 output_asm_insn (buf, operands);
6059 return "";
6060 }
6061
6062 int
store_multiple_sequence(rtx * operands,int nops,int * regs,int * base,HOST_WIDE_INT * load_offset)6063 store_multiple_sequence (rtx *operands, int nops, int *regs, int *base,
6064 HOST_WIDE_INT * load_offset)
6065 {
6066 int unsorted_regs[4];
6067 HOST_WIDE_INT unsorted_offsets[4];
6068 int order[4];
6069 int base_reg = -1;
6070 int i;
6071
6072 /* Can only handle 2, 3, or 4 insns at present, though could be easily
6073 extended if required. */
6074 gcc_assert (nops >= 2 && nops <= 4);
6075
6076 /* Loop over the operands and check that the memory references are
6077 suitable (i.e. immediate offsets from the same base register). At
6078 the same time, extract the target register, and the memory
6079 offsets. */
6080 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
6081 {
6082 rtx reg;
6083 rtx offset;
6084
6085 /* Convert a subreg of a mem into the mem itself. */
6086 if (GET_CODE (operands[nops + i]) == SUBREG)
6087 operands[nops + i] = alter_subreg (operands + (nops + i));
6088
6089 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (operands[nops + i]) == MEM);
6090
6091 /* Don't reorder volatile memory references; it doesn't seem worth
6092 looking for the case where the order is ok anyway. */
6093 if (MEM_VOLATILE_P (operands[nops + i]))
6094 return 0;
6095
6096 offset = const0_rtx;
6097
6098 if ((GET_CODE (reg = XEXP (operands[nops + i], 0)) == REG
6099 || (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG
6100 && GET_CODE (reg = SUBREG_REG (reg)) == REG))
6101 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (operands[nops + i], 0)) == PLUS
6102 && ((GET_CODE (reg = XEXP (XEXP (operands[nops + i], 0), 0))
6103 == REG)
6104 || (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG
6105 && GET_CODE (reg = SUBREG_REG (reg)) == REG))
6106 && (GET_CODE (offset = XEXP (XEXP (operands[nops + i], 0), 1))
6107 == CONST_INT)))
6108 {
6109 if (i == 0)
6110 {
6111 base_reg = REGNO (reg);
6112 unsorted_regs[0] = (GET_CODE (operands[i]) == REG
6113 ? REGNO (operands[i])
6114 : REGNO (SUBREG_REG (operands[i])));
6115 order[0] = 0;
6116 }
6117 else
6118 {
6119 if (base_reg != (int) REGNO (reg))
6120 /* Not addressed from the same base register. */
6121 return 0;
6122
6123 unsorted_regs[i] = (GET_CODE (operands[i]) == REG
6124 ? REGNO (operands[i])
6125 : REGNO (SUBREG_REG (operands[i])));
6126 if (unsorted_regs[i] < unsorted_regs[order[0]])
6127 order[0] = i;
6128 }
6129
6130 /* If it isn't an integer register, then we can't do this. */
6131 if (unsorted_regs[i] < 0 || unsorted_regs[i] > 14)
6132 return 0;
6133
6134 unsorted_offsets[i] = INTVAL (offset);
6135 }
6136 else
6137 /* Not a suitable memory address. */
6138 return 0;
6139 }
6140
6141 /* All the useful information has now been extracted from the
6142 operands into unsorted_regs and unsorted_offsets; additionally,
6143 order[0] has been set to the lowest numbered register in the
6144 list. Sort the registers into order, and check that the memory
6145 offsets are ascending and adjacent. */
6146
6147 for (i = 1; i < nops; i++)
6148 {
6149 int j;
6150
6151 order[i] = order[i - 1];
6152 for (j = 0; j < nops; j++)
6153 if (unsorted_regs[j] > unsorted_regs[order[i - 1]]
6154 && (order[i] == order[i - 1]
6155 || unsorted_regs[j] < unsorted_regs[order[i]]))
6156 order[i] = j;
6157
6158 /* Have we found a suitable register? if not, one must be used more
6159 than once. */
6160 if (order[i] == order[i - 1])
6161 return 0;
6162
6163 /* Is the memory address adjacent and ascending? */
6164 if (unsorted_offsets[order[i]] != unsorted_offsets[order[i - 1]] + 4)
6165 return 0;
6166 }
6167
6168 if (base)
6169 {
6170 *base = base_reg;
6171
6172 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
6173 regs[i] = unsorted_regs[order[i]];
6174
6175 *load_offset = unsorted_offsets[order[0]];
6176 }
6177
6178 if (unsorted_offsets[order[0]] == 0)
6179 return 1; /* stmia */
6180
6181 if (unsorted_offsets[order[0]] == 4)
6182 return 2; /* stmib */
6183
6184 if (unsorted_offsets[order[nops - 1]] == 0)
6185 return 3; /* stmda */
6186
6187 if (unsorted_offsets[order[nops - 1]] == -4)
6188 return 4; /* stmdb */
6189
6190 return 0;
6191 }
6192
6193 const char *
emit_stm_seq(rtx * operands,int nops)6194 emit_stm_seq (rtx *operands, int nops)
6195 {
6196 int regs[4];
6197 int base_reg;
6198 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
6199 char buf[100];
6200 int i;
6201
6202 switch (store_multiple_sequence (operands, nops, regs, &base_reg, &offset))
6203 {
6204 case 1:
6205 strcpy (buf, "stm%?ia\t");
6206 break;
6207
6208 case 2:
6209 strcpy (buf, "stm%?ib\t");
6210 break;
6211
6212 case 3:
6213 strcpy (buf, "stm%?da\t");
6214 break;
6215
6216 case 4:
6217 strcpy (buf, "stm%?db\t");
6218 break;
6219
6220 default:
6221 gcc_unreachable ();
6222 }
6223
6224 sprintf (buf + strlen (buf), "%s%s, {%s%s", REGISTER_PREFIX,
6225 reg_names[base_reg], REGISTER_PREFIX, reg_names[regs[0]]);
6226
6227 for (i = 1; i < nops; i++)
6228 sprintf (buf + strlen (buf), ", %s%s", REGISTER_PREFIX,
6229 reg_names[regs[i]]);
6230
6231 strcat (buf, "}\t%@ phole stm");
6232
6233 output_asm_insn (buf, operands);
6234 return "";
6235 }
6236
6237 /* Routines for use in generating RTL. */
6238
6239 rtx
arm_gen_load_multiple(int base_regno,int count,rtx from,int up,int write_back,rtx basemem,HOST_WIDE_INT * offsetp)6240 arm_gen_load_multiple (int base_regno, int count, rtx from, int up,
6241 int write_back, rtx basemem, HOST_WIDE_INT *offsetp)
6242 {
6243 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = *offsetp;
6244 int i = 0, j;
6245 rtx result;
6246 int sign = up ? 1 : -1;
6247 rtx mem, addr;
6248
6249 /* XScale has load-store double instructions, but they have stricter
6250 alignment requirements than load-store multiple, so we cannot
6251 use them.
6252
6253 For XScale ldm requires 2 + NREGS cycles to complete and blocks
6254 the pipeline until completion.
6255
6256 NREGS CYCLES
6257 1 3
6258 2 4
6259 3 5
6260 4 6
6261
6262 An ldr instruction takes 1-3 cycles, but does not block the
6263 pipeline.
6264
6265 NREGS CYCLES
6266 1 1-3
6267 2 2-6
6268 3 3-9
6269 4 4-12
6270
6271 Best case ldr will always win. However, the more ldr instructions
6272 we issue, the less likely we are to be able to schedule them well.
6273 Using ldr instructions also increases code size.
6274
6275 As a compromise, we use ldr for counts of 1 or 2 regs, and ldm
6276 for counts of 3 or 4 regs. */
6277 if (arm_tune_xscale && count <= 2 && ! optimize_size)
6278 {
6279 rtx seq;
6280
6281 start_sequence ();
6282
6283 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
6284 {
6285 addr = plus_constant (from, i * 4 * sign);
6286 mem = adjust_automodify_address (basemem, SImode, addr, offset);
6287 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, base_regno + i), mem);
6288 offset += 4 * sign;
6289 }
6290
6291 if (write_back)
6292 {
6293 emit_move_insn (from, plus_constant (from, count * 4 * sign));
6294 *offsetp = offset;
6295 }
6296
6297 seq = get_insns ();
6298 end_sequence ();
6299
6300 return seq;
6301 }
6302
6303 result = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode,
6304 rtvec_alloc (count + (write_back ? 1 : 0)));
6305 if (write_back)
6306 {
6307 XVECEXP (result, 0, 0)
6308 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, from, plus_constant (from, count * 4 * sign));
6309 i = 1;
6310 count++;
6311 }
6312
6313 for (j = 0; i < count; i++, j++)
6314 {
6315 addr = plus_constant (from, j * 4 * sign);
6316 mem = adjust_automodify_address_nv (basemem, SImode, addr, offset);
6317 XVECEXP (result, 0, i)
6318 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (SImode, base_regno + j), mem);
6319 offset += 4 * sign;
6320 }
6321
6322 if (write_back)
6323 *offsetp = offset;
6324
6325 return result;
6326 }
6327
6328 rtx
arm_gen_store_multiple(int base_regno,int count,rtx to,int up,int write_back,rtx basemem,HOST_WIDE_INT * offsetp)6329 arm_gen_store_multiple (int base_regno, int count, rtx to, int up,
6330 int write_back, rtx basemem, HOST_WIDE_INT *offsetp)
6331 {
6332 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = *offsetp;
6333 int i = 0, j;
6334 rtx result;
6335 int sign = up ? 1 : -1;
6336 rtx mem, addr;
6337
6338 /* See arm_gen_load_multiple for discussion of
6339 the pros/cons of ldm/stm usage for XScale. */
6340 if (arm_tune_xscale && count <= 2 && ! optimize_size)
6341 {
6342 rtx seq;
6343
6344 start_sequence ();
6345
6346 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
6347 {
6348 addr = plus_constant (to, i * 4 * sign);
6349 mem = adjust_automodify_address (basemem, SImode, addr, offset);
6350 emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (SImode, base_regno + i));
6351 offset += 4 * sign;
6352 }
6353
6354 if (write_back)
6355 {
6356 emit_move_insn (to, plus_constant (to, count * 4 * sign));
6357 *offsetp = offset;
6358 }
6359
6360 seq = get_insns ();
6361 end_sequence ();
6362
6363 return seq;
6364 }
6365
6366 result = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode,
6367 rtvec_alloc (count + (write_back ? 1 : 0)));
6368 if (write_back)
6369 {
6370 XVECEXP (result, 0, 0)
6371 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, to,
6372 plus_constant (to, count * 4 * sign));
6373 i = 1;
6374 count++;
6375 }
6376
6377 for (j = 0; i < count; i++, j++)
6378 {
6379 addr = plus_constant (to, j * 4 * sign);
6380 mem = adjust_automodify_address_nv (basemem, SImode, addr, offset);
6381 XVECEXP (result, 0, i)
6382 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, mem, gen_rtx_REG (SImode, base_regno + j));
6383 offset += 4 * sign;
6384 }
6385
6386 if (write_back)
6387 *offsetp = offset;
6388
6389 return result;
6390 }
6391
6392 int
arm_gen_movmemqi(rtx * operands)6393 arm_gen_movmemqi (rtx *operands)
6394 {
6395 HOST_WIDE_INT in_words_to_go, out_words_to_go, last_bytes;
6396 HOST_WIDE_INT srcoffset, dstoffset;
6397 int i;
6398 rtx src, dst, srcbase, dstbase;
6399 rtx part_bytes_reg = NULL;
6400 rtx mem;
6401
6402 if (GET_CODE (operands[2]) != CONST_INT
6403 || GET_CODE (operands[3]) != CONST_INT
6404 || INTVAL (operands[2]) > 64
6405 || INTVAL (operands[3]) & 3)
6406 return 0;
6407
6408 dstbase = operands[0];
6409 srcbase = operands[1];
6410
6411 dst = copy_to_mode_reg (SImode, XEXP (dstbase, 0));
6412 src = copy_to_mode_reg (SImode, XEXP (srcbase, 0));
6413
6414 in_words_to_go = ARM_NUM_INTS (INTVAL (operands[2]));
6415 out_words_to_go = INTVAL (operands[2]) / 4;
6416 last_bytes = INTVAL (operands[2]) & 3;
6417 dstoffset = srcoffset = 0;
6418
6419 if (out_words_to_go != in_words_to_go && ((in_words_to_go - 1) & 3) != 0)
6420 part_bytes_reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, (in_words_to_go - 1) & 3);
6421
6422 for (i = 0; in_words_to_go >= 2; i+=4)
6423 {
6424 if (in_words_to_go > 4)
6425 emit_insn (arm_gen_load_multiple (0, 4, src, TRUE, TRUE,
6426 srcbase, &srcoffset));
6427 else
6428 emit_insn (arm_gen_load_multiple (0, in_words_to_go, src, TRUE,
6429 FALSE, srcbase, &srcoffset));
6430
6431 if (out_words_to_go)
6432 {
6433 if (out_words_to_go > 4)
6434 emit_insn (arm_gen_store_multiple (0, 4, dst, TRUE, TRUE,
6435 dstbase, &dstoffset));
6436 else if (out_words_to_go != 1)
6437 emit_insn (arm_gen_store_multiple (0, out_words_to_go,
6438 dst, TRUE,
6439 (last_bytes == 0
6440 ? FALSE : TRUE),
6441 dstbase, &dstoffset));
6442 else
6443 {
6444 mem = adjust_automodify_address (dstbase, SImode, dst, dstoffset);
6445 emit_move_insn (mem, gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 0));
6446 if (last_bytes != 0)
6447 {
6448 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (dst, dst, GEN_INT (4)));
6449 dstoffset += 4;
6450 }
6451 }
6452 }
6453
6454 in_words_to_go -= in_words_to_go < 4 ? in_words_to_go : 4;
6455 out_words_to_go -= out_words_to_go < 4 ? out_words_to_go : 4;
6456 }
6457
6458 /* OUT_WORDS_TO_GO will be zero here if there are byte stores to do. */
6459 if (out_words_to_go)
6460 {
6461 rtx sreg;
6462
6463 mem = adjust_automodify_address (srcbase, SImode, src, srcoffset);
6464 sreg = copy_to_reg (mem);
6465
6466 mem = adjust_automodify_address (dstbase, SImode, dst, dstoffset);
6467 emit_move_insn (mem, sreg);
6468 in_words_to_go--;
6469
6470 gcc_assert (!in_words_to_go); /* Sanity check */
6471 }
6472
6473 if (in_words_to_go)
6474 {
6475 gcc_assert (in_words_to_go > 0);
6476
6477 mem = adjust_automodify_address (srcbase, SImode, src, srcoffset);
6478 part_bytes_reg = copy_to_mode_reg (SImode, mem);
6479 }
6480
6481 gcc_assert (!last_bytes || part_bytes_reg);
6482
6483 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && last_bytes)
6484 {
6485 rtx tmp = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
6486
6487 /* The bytes we want are in the top end of the word. */
6488 emit_insn (gen_lshrsi3 (tmp, part_bytes_reg,
6489 GEN_INT (8 * (4 - last_bytes))));
6490 part_bytes_reg = tmp;
6491
6492 while (last_bytes)
6493 {
6494 mem = adjust_automodify_address (dstbase, QImode,
6495 plus_constant (dst, last_bytes - 1),
6496 dstoffset + last_bytes - 1);
6497 emit_move_insn (mem, gen_lowpart (QImode, part_bytes_reg));
6498
6499 if (--last_bytes)
6500 {
6501 tmp = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
6502 emit_insn (gen_lshrsi3 (tmp, part_bytes_reg, GEN_INT (8)));
6503 part_bytes_reg = tmp;
6504 }
6505 }
6506
6507 }
6508 else
6509 {
6510 if (last_bytes > 1)
6511 {
6512 mem = adjust_automodify_address (dstbase, HImode, dst, dstoffset);
6513 emit_move_insn (mem, gen_lowpart (HImode, part_bytes_reg));
6514 last_bytes -= 2;
6515 if (last_bytes)
6516 {
6517 rtx tmp = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
6518 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (dst, dst, const2_rtx));
6519 emit_insn (gen_lshrsi3 (tmp, part_bytes_reg, GEN_INT (16)));
6520 part_bytes_reg = tmp;
6521 dstoffset += 2;
6522 }
6523 }
6524
6525 if (last_bytes)
6526 {
6527 mem = adjust_automodify_address (dstbase, QImode, dst, dstoffset);
6528 emit_move_insn (mem, gen_lowpart (QImode, part_bytes_reg));
6529 }
6530 }
6531
6532 return 1;
6533 }
6534
6535 /* Select a dominance comparison mode if possible for a test of the general
6536 form (OP (COND_OR (X) (Y)) (const_int 0)). We support three forms.
6537 COND_OR == DOM_CC_X_AND_Y => (X && Y)
6538 COND_OR == DOM_CC_NX_OR_Y => ((! X) || Y)
6539 COND_OR == DOM_CC_X_OR_Y => (X || Y)
6540 In all cases OP will be either EQ or NE, but we don't need to know which
6541 here. If we are unable to support a dominance comparison we return
6542 CC mode. This will then fail to match for the RTL expressions that
6543 generate this call. */
6544 enum machine_mode
arm_select_dominance_cc_mode(rtx x,rtx y,HOST_WIDE_INT cond_or)6545 arm_select_dominance_cc_mode (rtx x, rtx y, HOST_WIDE_INT cond_or)
6546 {
6547 enum rtx_code cond1, cond2;
6548 int swapped = 0;
6549
6550 /* Currently we will probably get the wrong result if the individual
6551 comparisons are not simple. This also ensures that it is safe to
6552 reverse a comparison if necessary. */
6553 if ((arm_select_cc_mode (cond1 = GET_CODE (x), XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1))
6554 != CCmode)
6555 || (arm_select_cc_mode (cond2 = GET_CODE (y), XEXP (y, 0), XEXP (y, 1))
6556 != CCmode))
6557 return CCmode;
6558
6559 /* The if_then_else variant of this tests the second condition if the
6560 first passes, but is true if the first fails. Reverse the first
6561 condition to get a true "inclusive-or" expression. */
6562 if (cond_or == DOM_CC_NX_OR_Y)
6563 cond1 = reverse_condition (cond1);
6564
6565 /* If the comparisons are not equal, and one doesn't dominate the other,
6566 then we can't do this. */
6567 if (cond1 != cond2
6568 && !comparison_dominates_p (cond1, cond2)
6569 && (swapped = 1, !comparison_dominates_p (cond2, cond1)))
6570 return CCmode;
6571
6572 if (swapped)
6573 {
6574 enum rtx_code temp = cond1;
6575 cond1 = cond2;
6576 cond2 = temp;
6577 }
6578
6579 switch (cond1)
6580 {
6581 case EQ:
6582 if (cond_or == DOM_CC_X_AND_Y)
6583 return CC_DEQmode;
6584
6585 switch (cond2)
6586 {
6587 case EQ: return CC_DEQmode;
6588 case LE: return CC_DLEmode;
6589 case LEU: return CC_DLEUmode;
6590 case GE: return CC_DGEmode;
6591 case GEU: return CC_DGEUmode;
6592 default: gcc_unreachable ();
6593 }
6594
6595 case LT:
6596 if (cond_or == DOM_CC_X_AND_Y)
6597 return CC_DLTmode;
6598
6599 switch (cond2)
6600 {
6601 case LT:
6602 return CC_DLTmode;
6603 case LE:
6604 return CC_DLEmode;
6605 case NE:
6606 return CC_DNEmode;
6607 default:
6608 gcc_unreachable ();
6609 }
6610
6611 case GT:
6612 if (cond_or == DOM_CC_X_AND_Y)
6613 return CC_DGTmode;
6614
6615 switch (cond2)
6616 {
6617 case GT:
6618 return CC_DGTmode;
6619 case GE:
6620 return CC_DGEmode;
6621 case NE:
6622 return CC_DNEmode;
6623 default:
6624 gcc_unreachable ();
6625 }
6626
6627 case LTU:
6628 if (cond_or == DOM_CC_X_AND_Y)
6629 return CC_DLTUmode;
6630
6631 switch (cond2)
6632 {
6633 case LTU:
6634 return CC_DLTUmode;
6635 case LEU:
6636 return CC_DLEUmode;
6637 case NE:
6638 return CC_DNEmode;
6639 default:
6640 gcc_unreachable ();
6641 }
6642
6643 case GTU:
6644 if (cond_or == DOM_CC_X_AND_Y)
6645 return CC_DGTUmode;
6646
6647 switch (cond2)
6648 {
6649 case GTU:
6650 return CC_DGTUmode;
6651 case GEU:
6652 return CC_DGEUmode;
6653 case NE:
6654 return CC_DNEmode;
6655 default:
6656 gcc_unreachable ();
6657 }
6658
6659 /* The remaining cases only occur when both comparisons are the
6660 same. */
6661 case NE:
6662 gcc_assert (cond1 == cond2);
6663 return CC_DNEmode;
6664
6665 case LE:
6666 gcc_assert (cond1 == cond2);
6667 return CC_DLEmode;
6668
6669 case GE:
6670 gcc_assert (cond1 == cond2);
6671 return CC_DGEmode;
6672
6673 case LEU:
6674 gcc_assert (cond1 == cond2);
6675 return CC_DLEUmode;
6676
6677 case GEU:
6678 gcc_assert (cond1 == cond2);
6679 return CC_DGEUmode;
6680
6681 default:
6682 gcc_unreachable ();
6683 }
6684 }
6685
6686 enum machine_mode
arm_select_cc_mode(enum rtx_code op,rtx x,rtx y)6687 arm_select_cc_mode (enum rtx_code op, rtx x, rtx y)
6688 {
6689 /* All floating point compares return CCFP if it is an equality
6690 comparison, and CCFPE otherwise. */
6691 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) == MODE_FLOAT)
6692 {
6693 switch (op)
6694 {
6695 case EQ:
6696 case NE:
6697 case UNORDERED:
6698 case ORDERED:
6699 case UNLT:
6700 case UNLE:
6701 case UNGT:
6702 case UNGE:
6703 case UNEQ:
6704 case LTGT:
6705 return CCFPmode;
6706
6707 case LT:
6708 case LE:
6709 case GT:
6710 case GE:
6711 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && TARGET_MAVERICK)
6712 return CCFPmode;
6713 return CCFPEmode;
6714
6715 default:
6716 gcc_unreachable ();
6717 }
6718 }
6719
6720 /* A compare with a shifted operand. Because of canonicalization, the
6721 comparison will have to be swapped when we emit the assembler. */
6722 if (GET_MODE (y) == SImode && GET_CODE (y) == REG
6723 && (GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFTRT
6724 || GET_CODE (x) == LSHIFTRT || GET_CODE (x) == ROTATE
6725 || GET_CODE (x) == ROTATERT))
6726 return CC_SWPmode;
6727
6728 /* This operation is performed swapped, but since we only rely on the Z
6729 flag we don't need an additional mode. */
6730 if (GET_MODE (y) == SImode && REG_P (y)
6731 && GET_CODE (x) == NEG
6732 && (op == EQ || op == NE))
6733 return CC_Zmode;
6734
6735 /* This is a special case that is used by combine to allow a
6736 comparison of a shifted byte load to be split into a zero-extend
6737 followed by a comparison of the shifted integer (only valid for
6738 equalities and unsigned inequalities). */
6739 if (GET_MODE (x) == SImode
6740 && GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT
6741 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) == 24
6742 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SUBREG
6743 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))) == MEM
6744 && GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))) == QImode
6745 && (op == EQ || op == NE
6746 || op == GEU || op == GTU || op == LTU || op == LEU)
6747 && GET_CODE (y) == CONST_INT)
6748 return CC_Zmode;
6749
6750 /* A construct for a conditional compare, if the false arm contains
6751 0, then both conditions must be true, otherwise either condition
6752 must be true. Not all conditions are possible, so CCmode is
6753 returned if it can't be done. */
6754 if (GET_CODE (x) == IF_THEN_ELSE
6755 && (XEXP (x, 2) == const0_rtx
6756 || XEXP (x, 2) == const1_rtx)
6757 && COMPARISON_P (XEXP (x, 0))
6758 && COMPARISON_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
6759 return arm_select_dominance_cc_mode (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1),
6760 INTVAL (XEXP (x, 2)));
6761
6762 /* Alternate canonicalizations of the above. These are somewhat cleaner. */
6763 if (GET_CODE (x) == AND
6764 && COMPARISON_P (XEXP (x, 0))
6765 && COMPARISON_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
6766 return arm_select_dominance_cc_mode (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1),
6767 DOM_CC_X_AND_Y);
6768
6769 if (GET_CODE (x) == IOR
6770 && COMPARISON_P (XEXP (x, 0))
6771 && COMPARISON_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
6772 return arm_select_dominance_cc_mode (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1),
6773 DOM_CC_X_OR_Y);
6774
6775 /* An operation (on Thumb) where we want to test for a single bit.
6776 This is done by shifting that bit up into the top bit of a
6777 scratch register; we can then branch on the sign bit. */
6778 if (TARGET_THUMB
6779 && GET_MODE (x) == SImode
6780 && (op == EQ || op == NE)
6781 && GET_CODE (x) == ZERO_EXTRACT
6782 && XEXP (x, 1) == const1_rtx)
6783 return CC_Nmode;
6784
6785 /* An operation that sets the condition codes as a side-effect, the
6786 V flag is not set correctly, so we can only use comparisons where
6787 this doesn't matter. (For LT and GE we can use "mi" and "pl"
6788 instead.) */
6789 if (GET_MODE (x) == SImode
6790 && y == const0_rtx
6791 && (op == EQ || op == NE || op == LT || op == GE)
6792 && (GET_CODE (x) == PLUS || GET_CODE (x) == MINUS
6793 || GET_CODE (x) == AND || GET_CODE (x) == IOR
6794 || GET_CODE (x) == XOR || GET_CODE (x) == MULT
6795 || GET_CODE (x) == NOT || GET_CODE (x) == NEG
6796 || GET_CODE (x) == LSHIFTRT
6797 || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFTRT
6798 || GET_CODE (x) == ROTATERT
6799 || (TARGET_ARM && GET_CODE (x) == ZERO_EXTRACT)))
6800 return CC_NOOVmode;
6801
6802 if (GET_MODE (x) == QImode && (op == EQ || op == NE))
6803 return CC_Zmode;
6804
6805 if (GET_MODE (x) == SImode && (op == LTU || op == GEU)
6806 && GET_CODE (x) == PLUS
6807 && (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (x, 0), y) || rtx_equal_p (XEXP (x, 1), y)))
6808 return CC_Cmode;
6809
6810 return CCmode;
6811 }
6812
6813 /* X and Y are two things to compare using CODE. Emit the compare insn and
6814 return the rtx for register 0 in the proper mode. FP means this is a
6815 floating point compare: I don't think that it is needed on the arm. */
6816 rtx
arm_gen_compare_reg(enum rtx_code code,rtx x,rtx y)6817 arm_gen_compare_reg (enum rtx_code code, rtx x, rtx y)
6818 {
6819 enum machine_mode mode = SELECT_CC_MODE (code, x, y);
6820 rtx cc_reg = gen_rtx_REG (mode, CC_REGNUM);
6821
6822 emit_set_insn (cc_reg, gen_rtx_COMPARE (mode, x, y));
6823
6824 return cc_reg;
6825 }
6826
6827 /* Generate a sequence of insns that will generate the correct return
6828 address mask depending on the physical architecture that the program
6829 is running on. */
6830 rtx
arm_gen_return_addr_mask(void)6831 arm_gen_return_addr_mask (void)
6832 {
6833 rtx reg = gen_reg_rtx (Pmode);
6834
6835 emit_insn (gen_return_addr_mask (reg));
6836 return reg;
6837 }
6838
6839 void
arm_reload_in_hi(rtx * operands)6840 arm_reload_in_hi (rtx *operands)
6841 {
6842 rtx ref = operands[1];
6843 rtx base, scratch;
6844 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
6845
6846 if (GET_CODE (ref) == SUBREG)
6847 {
6848 offset = SUBREG_BYTE (ref);
6849 ref = SUBREG_REG (ref);
6850 }
6851
6852 if (GET_CODE (ref) == REG)
6853 {
6854 /* We have a pseudo which has been spilt onto the stack; there
6855 are two cases here: the first where there is a simple
6856 stack-slot replacement and a second where the stack-slot is
6857 out of range, or is used as a subreg. */
6858 if (reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (ref)])
6859 {
6860 ref = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (ref)];
6861 base = find_replacement (&XEXP (ref, 0));
6862 }
6863 else
6864 /* The slot is out of range, or was dressed up in a SUBREG. */
6865 base = reg_equiv_address[REGNO (ref)];
6866 }
6867 else
6868 base = find_replacement (&XEXP (ref, 0));
6869
6870 /* Handle the case where the address is too complex to be offset by 1. */
6871 if (GET_CODE (base) == MINUS
6872 || (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (base, 1)) != CONST_INT))
6873 {
6874 rtx base_plus = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[2]) + 1);
6875
6876 emit_set_insn (base_plus, base);
6877 base = base_plus;
6878 }
6879 else if (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS)
6880 {
6881 /* The addend must be CONST_INT, or we would have dealt with it above. */
6882 HOST_WIDE_INT hi, lo;
6883
6884 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1));
6885 base = XEXP (base, 0);
6886
6887 /* Rework the address into a legal sequence of insns. */
6888 /* Valid range for lo is -4095 -> 4095 */
6889 lo = (offset >= 0
6890 ? (offset & 0xfff)
6891 : -((-offset) & 0xfff));
6892
6893 /* Corner case, if lo is the max offset then we would be out of range
6894 once we have added the additional 1 below, so bump the msb into the
6895 pre-loading insn(s). */
6896 if (lo == 4095)
6897 lo &= 0x7ff;
6898
6899 hi = ((((offset - lo) & (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xffffffff)
6900 ^ (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0x80000000)
6901 - (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0x80000000);
6902
6903 gcc_assert (hi + lo == offset);
6904
6905 if (hi != 0)
6906 {
6907 rtx base_plus = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[2]) + 1);
6908
6909 /* Get the base address; addsi3 knows how to handle constants
6910 that require more than one insn. */
6911 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (base_plus, base, GEN_INT (hi)));
6912 base = base_plus;
6913 offset = lo;
6914 }
6915 }
6916
6917 /* Operands[2] may overlap operands[0] (though it won't overlap
6918 operands[1]), that's why we asked for a DImode reg -- so we can
6919 use the bit that does not overlap. */
6920 if (REGNO (operands[2]) == REGNO (operands[0]))
6921 scratch = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[2]) + 1);
6922 else
6923 scratch = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[2]));
6924
6925 emit_insn (gen_zero_extendqisi2 (scratch,
6926 gen_rtx_MEM (QImode,
6927 plus_constant (base,
6928 offset))));
6929 emit_insn (gen_zero_extendqisi2 (gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, operands[0], 0),
6930 gen_rtx_MEM (QImode,
6931 plus_constant (base,
6932 offset + 1))));
6933 if (!BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
6934 emit_set_insn (gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, operands[0], 0),
6935 gen_rtx_IOR (SImode,
6936 gen_rtx_ASHIFT
6937 (SImode,
6938 gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, operands[0], 0),
6939 GEN_INT (8)),
6940 scratch));
6941 else
6942 emit_set_insn (gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, operands[0], 0),
6943 gen_rtx_IOR (SImode,
6944 gen_rtx_ASHIFT (SImode, scratch,
6945 GEN_INT (8)),
6946 gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, operands[0], 0)));
6947 }
6948
6949 /* Handle storing a half-word to memory during reload by synthesizing as two
6950 byte stores. Take care not to clobber the input values until after we
6951 have moved them somewhere safe. This code assumes that if the DImode
6952 scratch in operands[2] overlaps either the input value or output address
6953 in some way, then that value must die in this insn (we absolutely need
6954 two scratch registers for some corner cases). */
6955 void
arm_reload_out_hi(rtx * operands)6956 arm_reload_out_hi (rtx *operands)
6957 {
6958 rtx ref = operands[0];
6959 rtx outval = operands[1];
6960 rtx base, scratch;
6961 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
6962
6963 if (GET_CODE (ref) == SUBREG)
6964 {
6965 offset = SUBREG_BYTE (ref);
6966 ref = SUBREG_REG (ref);
6967 }
6968
6969 if (GET_CODE (ref) == REG)
6970 {
6971 /* We have a pseudo which has been spilt onto the stack; there
6972 are two cases here: the first where there is a simple
6973 stack-slot replacement and a second where the stack-slot is
6974 out of range, or is used as a subreg. */
6975 if (reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (ref)])
6976 {
6977 ref = reg_equiv_mem[REGNO (ref)];
6978 base = find_replacement (&XEXP (ref, 0));
6979 }
6980 else
6981 /* The slot is out of range, or was dressed up in a SUBREG. */
6982 base = reg_equiv_address[REGNO (ref)];
6983 }
6984 else
6985 base = find_replacement (&XEXP (ref, 0));
6986
6987 scratch = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[2]));
6988
6989 /* Handle the case where the address is too complex to be offset by 1. */
6990 if (GET_CODE (base) == MINUS
6991 || (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS && GET_CODE (XEXP (base, 1)) != CONST_INT))
6992 {
6993 rtx base_plus = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[2]) + 1);
6994
6995 /* Be careful not to destroy OUTVAL. */
6996 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (base_plus, outval))
6997 {
6998 /* Updating base_plus might destroy outval, see if we can
6999 swap the scratch and base_plus. */
7000 if (!reg_overlap_mentioned_p (scratch, outval))
7001 {
7002 rtx tmp = scratch;
7003 scratch = base_plus;
7004 base_plus = tmp;
7005 }
7006 else
7007 {
7008 rtx scratch_hi = gen_rtx_REG (HImode, REGNO (operands[2]));
7009
7010 /* Be conservative and copy OUTVAL into the scratch now,
7011 this should only be necessary if outval is a subreg
7012 of something larger than a word. */
7013 /* XXX Might this clobber base? I can't see how it can,
7014 since scratch is known to overlap with OUTVAL, and
7015 must be wider than a word. */
7016 emit_insn (gen_movhi (scratch_hi, outval));
7017 outval = scratch_hi;
7018 }
7019 }
7020
7021 emit_set_insn (base_plus, base);
7022 base = base_plus;
7023 }
7024 else if (GET_CODE (base) == PLUS)
7025 {
7026 /* The addend must be CONST_INT, or we would have dealt with it above. */
7027 HOST_WIDE_INT hi, lo;
7028
7029 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (base, 1));
7030 base = XEXP (base, 0);
7031
7032 /* Rework the address into a legal sequence of insns. */
7033 /* Valid range for lo is -4095 -> 4095 */
7034 lo = (offset >= 0
7035 ? (offset & 0xfff)
7036 : -((-offset) & 0xfff));
7037
7038 /* Corner case, if lo is the max offset then we would be out of range
7039 once we have added the additional 1 below, so bump the msb into the
7040 pre-loading insn(s). */
7041 if (lo == 4095)
7042 lo &= 0x7ff;
7043
7044 hi = ((((offset - lo) & (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xffffffff)
7045 ^ (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0x80000000)
7046 - (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0x80000000);
7047
7048 gcc_assert (hi + lo == offset);
7049
7050 if (hi != 0)
7051 {
7052 rtx base_plus = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, REGNO (operands[2]) + 1);
7053
7054 /* Be careful not to destroy OUTVAL. */
7055 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (base_plus, outval))
7056 {
7057 /* Updating base_plus might destroy outval, see if we
7058 can swap the scratch and base_plus. */
7059 if (!reg_overlap_mentioned_p (scratch, outval))
7060 {
7061 rtx tmp = scratch;
7062 scratch = base_plus;
7063 base_plus = tmp;
7064 }
7065 else
7066 {
7067 rtx scratch_hi = gen_rtx_REG (HImode, REGNO (operands[2]));
7068
7069 /* Be conservative and copy outval into scratch now,
7070 this should only be necessary if outval is a
7071 subreg of something larger than a word. */
7072 /* XXX Might this clobber base? I can't see how it
7073 can, since scratch is known to overlap with
7074 outval. */
7075 emit_insn (gen_movhi (scratch_hi, outval));
7076 outval = scratch_hi;
7077 }
7078 }
7079
7080 /* Get the base address; addsi3 knows how to handle constants
7081 that require more than one insn. */
7082 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (base_plus, base, GEN_INT (hi)));
7083 base = base_plus;
7084 offset = lo;
7085 }
7086 }
7087
7088 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
7089 {
7090 emit_insn (gen_movqi (gen_rtx_MEM (QImode,
7091 plus_constant (base, offset + 1)),
7092 gen_lowpart (QImode, outval)));
7093 emit_insn (gen_lshrsi3 (scratch,
7094 gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, outval, 0),
7095 GEN_INT (8)));
7096 emit_insn (gen_movqi (gen_rtx_MEM (QImode, plus_constant (base, offset)),
7097 gen_lowpart (QImode, scratch)));
7098 }
7099 else
7100 {
7101 emit_insn (gen_movqi (gen_rtx_MEM (QImode, plus_constant (base, offset)),
7102 gen_lowpart (QImode, outval)));
7103 emit_insn (gen_lshrsi3 (scratch,
7104 gen_rtx_SUBREG (SImode, outval, 0),
7105 GEN_INT (8)));
7106 emit_insn (gen_movqi (gen_rtx_MEM (QImode,
7107 plus_constant (base, offset + 1)),
7108 gen_lowpart (QImode, scratch)));
7109 }
7110 }
7111
7112 /* Return true if a type must be passed in memory. For AAPCS, small aggregates
7113 (padded to the size of a word) should be passed in a register. */
7114
7115 static bool
arm_must_pass_in_stack(enum machine_mode mode,tree type)7116 arm_must_pass_in_stack (enum machine_mode mode, tree type)
7117 {
7118 if (TARGET_AAPCS_BASED)
7119 return must_pass_in_stack_var_size (mode, type);
7120 else
7121 return must_pass_in_stack_var_size_or_pad (mode, type);
7122 }
7123
7124
7125 /* For use by FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (MODE, TYPE).
7126 Return true if an argument passed on the stack should be padded upwards,
7127 i.e. if the least-significant byte has useful data.
7128 For legacy APCS ABIs we use the default. For AAPCS based ABIs small
7129 aggregate types are placed in the lowest memory address. */
7130
7131 bool
arm_pad_arg_upward(enum machine_mode mode,tree type)7132 arm_pad_arg_upward (enum machine_mode mode, tree type)
7133 {
7134 if (!TARGET_AAPCS_BASED)
7135 return DEFAULT_FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING(mode, type) == upward;
7136
7137 if (type && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type))
7138 return false;
7139
7140 return true;
7141 }
7142
7143
7144 /* Similarly, for use by BLOCK_REG_PADDING (MODE, TYPE, FIRST).
7145 For non-AAPCS, return !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN if the least significant
7146 byte of the register has useful data, and return the opposite if the
7147 most significant byte does.
7148 For AAPCS, small aggregates and small complex types are always padded
7149 upwards. */
7150
7151 bool
arm_pad_reg_upward(enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,tree type,int first ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)7152 arm_pad_reg_upward (enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7153 tree type, int first ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7154 {
7155 if (TARGET_AAPCS_BASED
7156 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
7157 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
7158 && int_size_in_bytes (type) <= 4)
7159 return true;
7160
7161 /* Otherwise, use default padding. */
7162 return !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN;
7163 }
7164
7165
7166 /* Print a symbolic form of X to the debug file, F. */
7167 static void
arm_print_value(FILE * f,rtx x)7168 arm_print_value (FILE *f, rtx x)
7169 {
7170 switch (GET_CODE (x))
7171 {
7172 case CONST_INT:
7173 fprintf (f, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX, INTVAL (x));
7174 return;
7175
7176 case CONST_DOUBLE:
7177 fprintf (f, "<0x%lx,0x%lx>", (long)XWINT (x, 2), (long)XWINT (x, 3));
7178 return;
7179
7180 case CONST_VECTOR:
7181 {
7182 int i;
7183
7184 fprintf (f, "<");
7185 for (i = 0; i < CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (x); i++)
7186 {
7187 fprintf (f, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX, INTVAL (CONST_VECTOR_ELT (x, i)));
7188 if (i < (CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (x) - 1))
7189 fputc (',', f);
7190 }
7191 fprintf (f, ">");
7192 }
7193 return;
7194
7195 case CONST_STRING:
7196 fprintf (f, "\"%s\"", XSTR (x, 0));
7197 return;
7198
7199 case SYMBOL_REF:
7200 fprintf (f, "`%s'", XSTR (x, 0));
7201 return;
7202
7203 case LABEL_REF:
7204 fprintf (f, "L%d", INSN_UID (XEXP (x, 0)));
7205 return;
7206
7207 case CONST:
7208 arm_print_value (f, XEXP (x, 0));
7209 return;
7210
7211 case PLUS:
7212 arm_print_value (f, XEXP (x, 0));
7213 fprintf (f, "+");
7214 arm_print_value (f, XEXP (x, 1));
7215 return;
7216
7217 case PC:
7218 fprintf (f, "pc");
7219 return;
7220
7221 default:
7222 fprintf (f, "????");
7223 return;
7224 }
7225 }
7226
7227 /* Routines for manipulation of the constant pool. */
7228
7229 /* Arm instructions cannot load a large constant directly into a
7230 register; they have to come from a pc relative load. The constant
7231 must therefore be placed in the addressable range of the pc
7232 relative load. Depending on the precise pc relative load
7233 instruction the range is somewhere between 256 bytes and 4k. This
7234 means that we often have to dump a constant inside a function, and
7235 generate code to branch around it.
7236
7237 It is important to minimize this, since the branches will slow
7238 things down and make the code larger.
7239
7240 Normally we can hide the table after an existing unconditional
7241 branch so that there is no interruption of the flow, but in the
7242 worst case the code looks like this:
7243
7244 ldr rn, L1
7245 ...
7246 b L2
7247 align
7248 L1: .long value
7249 L2:
7250 ...
7251
7252 ldr rn, L3
7253 ...
7254 b L4
7255 align
7256 L3: .long value
7257 L4:
7258 ...
7259
7260 We fix this by performing a scan after scheduling, which notices
7261 which instructions need to have their operands fetched from the
7262 constant table and builds the table.
7263
7264 The algorithm starts by building a table of all the constants that
7265 need fixing up and all the natural barriers in the function (places
7266 where a constant table can be dropped without breaking the flow).
7267 For each fixup we note how far the pc-relative replacement will be
7268 able to reach and the offset of the instruction into the function.
7269
7270 Having built the table we then group the fixes together to form
7271 tables that are as large as possible (subject to addressing
7272 constraints) and emit each table of constants after the last
7273 barrier that is within range of all the instructions in the group.
7274 If a group does not contain a barrier, then we forcibly create one
7275 by inserting a jump instruction into the flow. Once the table has
7276 been inserted, the insns are then modified to reference the
7277 relevant entry in the pool.
7278
7279 Possible enhancements to the algorithm (not implemented) are:
7280
7281 1) For some processors and object formats, there may be benefit in
7282 aligning the pools to the start of cache lines; this alignment
7283 would need to be taken into account when calculating addressability
7284 of a pool. */
7285
7286 /* These typedefs are located at the start of this file, so that
7287 they can be used in the prototypes there. This comment is to
7288 remind readers of that fact so that the following structures
7289 can be understood more easily.
7290
7291 typedef struct minipool_node Mnode;
7292 typedef struct minipool_fixup Mfix; */
7293
7294 struct minipool_node
7295 {
7296 /* Doubly linked chain of entries. */
7297 Mnode * next;
7298 Mnode * prev;
7299 /* The maximum offset into the code that this entry can be placed. While
7300 pushing fixes for forward references, all entries are sorted in order
7301 of increasing max_address. */
7302 HOST_WIDE_INT max_address;
7303 /* Similarly for an entry inserted for a backwards ref. */
7304 HOST_WIDE_INT min_address;
7305 /* The number of fixes referencing this entry. This can become zero
7306 if we "unpush" an entry. In this case we ignore the entry when we
7307 come to emit the code. */
7308 int refcount;
7309 /* The offset from the start of the minipool. */
7310 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
7311 /* The value in table. */
7312 rtx value;
7313 /* The mode of value. */
7314 enum machine_mode mode;
7315 /* The size of the value. With iWMMXt enabled
7316 sizes > 4 also imply an alignment of 8-bytes. */
7317 int fix_size;
7318 };
7319
7320 struct minipool_fixup
7321 {
7322 Mfix * next;
7323 rtx insn;
7324 HOST_WIDE_INT address;
7325 rtx * loc;
7326 enum machine_mode mode;
7327 int fix_size;
7328 rtx value;
7329 Mnode * minipool;
7330 HOST_WIDE_INT forwards;
7331 HOST_WIDE_INT backwards;
7332 };
7333
7334 /* Fixes less than a word need padding out to a word boundary. */
7335 #define MINIPOOL_FIX_SIZE(mode) \
7336 (GET_MODE_SIZE ((mode)) >= 4 ? GET_MODE_SIZE ((mode)) : 4)
7337
7338 static Mnode * minipool_vector_head;
7339 static Mnode * minipool_vector_tail;
7340 static rtx minipool_vector_label;
7341 static int minipool_pad;
7342
7343 /* The linked list of all minipool fixes required for this function. */
7344 Mfix * minipool_fix_head;
7345 Mfix * minipool_fix_tail;
7346 /* The fix entry for the current minipool, once it has been placed. */
7347 Mfix * minipool_barrier;
7348
7349 /* Determines if INSN is the start of a jump table. Returns the end
7350 of the TABLE or NULL_RTX. */
7351 static rtx
is_jump_table(rtx insn)7352 is_jump_table (rtx insn)
7353 {
7354 rtx table;
7355
7356 if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
7357 && JUMP_LABEL (insn) != NULL
7358 && ((table = next_real_insn (JUMP_LABEL (insn)))
7359 == next_real_insn (insn))
7360 && table != NULL
7361 && GET_CODE (table) == JUMP_INSN
7362 && (GET_CODE (PATTERN (table)) == ADDR_VEC
7363 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (table)) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC))
7364 return table;
7365
7366 return NULL_RTX;
7367 }
7368
7369 #ifndef JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7370 #define JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION 0
7371 #endif
7372
7373 static HOST_WIDE_INT
get_jump_table_size(rtx insn)7374 get_jump_table_size (rtx insn)
7375 {
7376 /* ADDR_VECs only take room if read-only data does into the text
7377 section. */
7378 if (JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION || readonly_data_section == text_section)
7379 {
7380 rtx body = PATTERN (insn);
7381 int elt = GET_CODE (body) == ADDR_DIFF_VEC ? 1 : 0;
7382
7383 return GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (body)) * XVECLEN (body, elt);
7384 }
7385
7386 return 0;
7387 }
7388
7389 /* Move a minipool fix MP from its current location to before MAX_MP.
7390 If MAX_MP is NULL, then MP doesn't need moving, but the addressing
7391 constraints may need updating. */
7392 static Mnode *
move_minipool_fix_forward_ref(Mnode * mp,Mnode * max_mp,HOST_WIDE_INT max_address)7393 move_minipool_fix_forward_ref (Mnode *mp, Mnode *max_mp,
7394 HOST_WIDE_INT max_address)
7395 {
7396 /* The code below assumes these are different. */
7397 gcc_assert (mp != max_mp);
7398
7399 if (max_mp == NULL)
7400 {
7401 if (max_address < mp->max_address)
7402 mp->max_address = max_address;
7403 }
7404 else
7405 {
7406 if (max_address > max_mp->max_address - mp->fix_size)
7407 mp->max_address = max_mp->max_address - mp->fix_size;
7408 else
7409 mp->max_address = max_address;
7410
7411 /* Unlink MP from its current position. Since max_mp is non-null,
7412 mp->prev must be non-null. */
7413 mp->prev->next = mp->next;
7414 if (mp->next != NULL)
7415 mp->next->prev = mp->prev;
7416 else
7417 minipool_vector_tail = mp->prev;
7418
7419 /* Re-insert it before MAX_MP. */
7420 mp->next = max_mp;
7421 mp->prev = max_mp->prev;
7422 max_mp->prev = mp;
7423
7424 if (mp->prev != NULL)
7425 mp->prev->next = mp;
7426 else
7427 minipool_vector_head = mp;
7428 }
7429
7430 /* Save the new entry. */
7431 max_mp = mp;
7432
7433 /* Scan over the preceding entries and adjust their addresses as
7434 required. */
7435 while (mp->prev != NULL
7436 && mp->prev->max_address > mp->max_address - mp->prev->fix_size)
7437 {
7438 mp->prev->max_address = mp->max_address - mp->prev->fix_size;
7439 mp = mp->prev;
7440 }
7441
7442 return max_mp;
7443 }
7444
7445 /* Add a constant to the minipool for a forward reference. Returns the
7446 node added or NULL if the constant will not fit in this pool. */
7447 static Mnode *
add_minipool_forward_ref(Mfix * fix)7448 add_minipool_forward_ref (Mfix *fix)
7449 {
7450 /* If set, max_mp is the first pool_entry that has a lower
7451 constraint than the one we are trying to add. */
7452 Mnode * max_mp = NULL;
7453 HOST_WIDE_INT max_address = fix->address + fix->forwards - minipool_pad;
7454 Mnode * mp;
7455
7456 /* If the minipool starts before the end of FIX->INSN then this FIX
7457 can not be placed into the current pool. Furthermore, adding the
7458 new constant pool entry may cause the pool to start FIX_SIZE bytes
7459 earlier. */
7460 if (minipool_vector_head &&
7461 (fix->address + get_attr_length (fix->insn)
7462 >= minipool_vector_head->max_address - fix->fix_size))
7463 return NULL;
7464
7465 /* Scan the pool to see if a constant with the same value has
7466 already been added. While we are doing this, also note the
7467 location where we must insert the constant if it doesn't already
7468 exist. */
7469 for (mp = minipool_vector_head; mp != NULL; mp = mp->next)
7470 {
7471 if (GET_CODE (fix->value) == GET_CODE (mp->value)
7472 && fix->mode == mp->mode
7473 && (GET_CODE (fix->value) != CODE_LABEL
7474 || (CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (fix->value)
7475 == CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (mp->value)))
7476 && rtx_equal_p (fix->value, mp->value))
7477 {
7478 /* More than one fix references this entry. */
7479 mp->refcount++;
7480 return move_minipool_fix_forward_ref (mp, max_mp, max_address);
7481 }
7482
7483 /* Note the insertion point if necessary. */
7484 if (max_mp == NULL
7485 && mp->max_address > max_address)
7486 max_mp = mp;
7487
7488 /* If we are inserting an 8-bytes aligned quantity and
7489 we have not already found an insertion point, then
7490 make sure that all such 8-byte aligned quantities are
7491 placed at the start of the pool. */
7492 if (ARM_DOUBLEWORD_ALIGN
7493 && max_mp == NULL
7494 && fix->fix_size == 8
7495 && mp->fix_size != 8)
7496 {
7497 max_mp = mp;
7498 max_address = mp->max_address;
7499 }
7500 }
7501
7502 /* The value is not currently in the minipool, so we need to create
7503 a new entry for it. If MAX_MP is NULL, the entry will be put on
7504 the end of the list since the placement is less constrained than
7505 any existing entry. Otherwise, we insert the new fix before
7506 MAX_MP and, if necessary, adjust the constraints on the other
7507 entries. */
7508 mp = XNEW (Mnode);
7509 mp->fix_size = fix->fix_size;
7510 mp->mode = fix->mode;
7511 mp->value = fix->value;
7512 mp->refcount = 1;
7513 /* Not yet required for a backwards ref. */
7514 mp->min_address = -65536;
7515
7516 if (max_mp == NULL)
7517 {
7518 mp->max_address = max_address;
7519 mp->next = NULL;
7520 mp->prev = minipool_vector_tail;
7521
7522 if (mp->prev == NULL)
7523 {
7524 minipool_vector_head = mp;
7525 minipool_vector_label = gen_label_rtx ();
7526 }
7527 else
7528 mp->prev->next = mp;
7529
7530 minipool_vector_tail = mp;
7531 }
7532 else
7533 {
7534 if (max_address > max_mp->max_address - mp->fix_size)
7535 mp->max_address = max_mp->max_address - mp->fix_size;
7536 else
7537 mp->max_address = max_address;
7538
7539 mp->next = max_mp;
7540 mp->prev = max_mp->prev;
7541 max_mp->prev = mp;
7542 if (mp->prev != NULL)
7543 mp->prev->next = mp;
7544 else
7545 minipool_vector_head = mp;
7546 }
7547
7548 /* Save the new entry. */
7549 max_mp = mp;
7550
7551 /* Scan over the preceding entries and adjust their addresses as
7552 required. */
7553 while (mp->prev != NULL
7554 && mp->prev->max_address > mp->max_address - mp->prev->fix_size)
7555 {
7556 mp->prev->max_address = mp->max_address - mp->prev->fix_size;
7557 mp = mp->prev;
7558 }
7559
7560 return max_mp;
7561 }
7562
7563 static Mnode *
move_minipool_fix_backward_ref(Mnode * mp,Mnode * min_mp,HOST_WIDE_INT min_address)7564 move_minipool_fix_backward_ref (Mnode *mp, Mnode *min_mp,
7565 HOST_WIDE_INT min_address)
7566 {
7567 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
7568
7569 /* The code below assumes these are different. */
7570 gcc_assert (mp != min_mp);
7571
7572 if (min_mp == NULL)
7573 {
7574 if (min_address > mp->min_address)
7575 mp->min_address = min_address;
7576 }
7577 else
7578 {
7579 /* We will adjust this below if it is too loose. */
7580 mp->min_address = min_address;
7581
7582 /* Unlink MP from its current position. Since min_mp is non-null,
7583 mp->next must be non-null. */
7584 mp->next->prev = mp->prev;
7585 if (mp->prev != NULL)
7586 mp->prev->next = mp->next;
7587 else
7588 minipool_vector_head = mp->next;
7589
7590 /* Reinsert it after MIN_MP. */
7591 mp->prev = min_mp;
7592 mp->next = min_mp->next;
7593 min_mp->next = mp;
7594 if (mp->next != NULL)
7595 mp->next->prev = mp;
7596 else
7597 minipool_vector_tail = mp;
7598 }
7599
7600 min_mp = mp;
7601
7602 offset = 0;
7603 for (mp = minipool_vector_head; mp != NULL; mp = mp->next)
7604 {
7605 mp->offset = offset;
7606 if (mp->refcount > 0)
7607 offset += mp->fix_size;
7608
7609 if (mp->next && mp->next->min_address < mp->min_address + mp->fix_size)
7610 mp->next->min_address = mp->min_address + mp->fix_size;
7611 }
7612
7613 return min_mp;
7614 }
7615
7616 /* Add a constant to the minipool for a backward reference. Returns the
7617 node added or NULL if the constant will not fit in this pool.
7618
7619 Note that the code for insertion for a backwards reference can be
7620 somewhat confusing because the calculated offsets for each fix do
7621 not take into account the size of the pool (which is still under
7622 construction. */
7623 static Mnode *
add_minipool_backward_ref(Mfix * fix)7624 add_minipool_backward_ref (Mfix *fix)
7625 {
7626 /* If set, min_mp is the last pool_entry that has a lower constraint
7627 than the one we are trying to add. */
7628 Mnode *min_mp = NULL;
7629 /* This can be negative, since it is only a constraint. */
7630 HOST_WIDE_INT min_address = fix->address - fix->backwards;
7631 Mnode *mp;
7632
7633 /* If we can't reach the current pool from this insn, or if we can't
7634 insert this entry at the end of the pool without pushing other
7635 fixes out of range, then we don't try. This ensures that we
7636 can't fail later on. */
7637 if (min_address >= minipool_barrier->address
7638 || (minipool_vector_tail->min_address + fix->fix_size
7639 >= minipool_barrier->address))
7640 return NULL;
7641
7642 /* Scan the pool to see if a constant with the same value has
7643 already been added. While we are doing this, also note the
7644 location where we must insert the constant if it doesn't already
7645 exist. */
7646 for (mp = minipool_vector_tail; mp != NULL; mp = mp->prev)
7647 {
7648 if (GET_CODE (fix->value) == GET_CODE (mp->value)
7649 && fix->mode == mp->mode
7650 && (GET_CODE (fix->value) != CODE_LABEL
7651 || (CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (fix->value)
7652 == CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (mp->value)))
7653 && rtx_equal_p (fix->value, mp->value)
7654 /* Check that there is enough slack to move this entry to the
7655 end of the table (this is conservative). */
7656 && (mp->max_address
7657 > (minipool_barrier->address
7658 + minipool_vector_tail->offset
7659 + minipool_vector_tail->fix_size)))
7660 {
7661 mp->refcount++;
7662 return move_minipool_fix_backward_ref (mp, min_mp, min_address);
7663 }
7664
7665 if (min_mp != NULL)
7666 mp->min_address += fix->fix_size;
7667 else
7668 {
7669 /* Note the insertion point if necessary. */
7670 if (mp->min_address < min_address)
7671 {
7672 /* For now, we do not allow the insertion of 8-byte alignment
7673 requiring nodes anywhere but at the start of the pool. */
7674 if (ARM_DOUBLEWORD_ALIGN
7675 && fix->fix_size == 8 && mp->fix_size != 8)
7676 return NULL;
7677 else
7678 min_mp = mp;
7679 }
7680 else if (mp->max_address
7681 < minipool_barrier->address + mp->offset + fix->fix_size)
7682 {
7683 /* Inserting before this entry would push the fix beyond
7684 its maximum address (which can happen if we have
7685 re-located a forwards fix); force the new fix to come
7686 after it. */
7687 min_mp = mp;
7688 min_address = mp->min_address + fix->fix_size;
7689 }
7690 /* If we are inserting an 8-bytes aligned quantity and
7691 we have not already found an insertion point, then
7692 make sure that all such 8-byte aligned quantities are
7693 placed at the start of the pool. */
7694 else if (ARM_DOUBLEWORD_ALIGN
7695 && min_mp == NULL
7696 && fix->fix_size == 8
7697 && mp->fix_size < 8)
7698 {
7699 min_mp = mp;
7700 min_address = mp->min_address + fix->fix_size;
7701 }
7702 }
7703 }
7704
7705 /* We need to create a new entry. */
7706 mp = XNEW (Mnode);
7707 mp->fix_size = fix->fix_size;
7708 mp->mode = fix->mode;
7709 mp->value = fix->value;
7710 mp->refcount = 1;
7711 mp->max_address = minipool_barrier->address + 65536;
7712
7713 mp->min_address = min_address;
7714
7715 if (min_mp == NULL)
7716 {
7717 mp->prev = NULL;
7718 mp->next = minipool_vector_head;
7719
7720 if (mp->next == NULL)
7721 {
7722 minipool_vector_tail = mp;
7723 minipool_vector_label = gen_label_rtx ();
7724 }
7725 else
7726 mp->next->prev = mp;
7727
7728 minipool_vector_head = mp;
7729 }
7730 else
7731 {
7732 mp->next = min_mp->next;
7733 mp->prev = min_mp;
7734 min_mp->next = mp;
7735
7736 if (mp->next != NULL)
7737 mp->next->prev = mp;
7738 else
7739 minipool_vector_tail = mp;
7740 }
7741
7742 /* Save the new entry. */
7743 min_mp = mp;
7744
7745 if (mp->prev)
7746 mp = mp->prev;
7747 else
7748 mp->offset = 0;
7749
7750 /* Scan over the following entries and adjust their offsets. */
7751 while (mp->next != NULL)
7752 {
7753 if (mp->next->min_address < mp->min_address + mp->fix_size)
7754 mp->next->min_address = mp->min_address + mp->fix_size;
7755
7756 if (mp->refcount)
7757 mp->next->offset = mp->offset + mp->fix_size;
7758 else
7759 mp->next->offset = mp->offset;
7760
7761 mp = mp->next;
7762 }
7763
7764 return min_mp;
7765 }
7766
7767 static void
assign_minipool_offsets(Mfix * barrier)7768 assign_minipool_offsets (Mfix *barrier)
7769 {
7770 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
7771 Mnode *mp;
7772
7773 minipool_barrier = barrier;
7774
7775 for (mp = minipool_vector_head; mp != NULL; mp = mp->next)
7776 {
7777 mp->offset = offset;
7778
7779 if (mp->refcount > 0)
7780 offset += mp->fix_size;
7781 }
7782 }
7783
7784 /* Output the literal table */
7785 static void
dump_minipool(rtx scan)7786 dump_minipool (rtx scan)
7787 {
7788 Mnode * mp;
7789 Mnode * nmp;
7790 int align64 = 0;
7791
7792 if (ARM_DOUBLEWORD_ALIGN)
7793 for (mp = minipool_vector_head; mp != NULL; mp = mp->next)
7794 if (mp->refcount > 0 && mp->fix_size == 8)
7795 {
7796 align64 = 1;
7797 break;
7798 }
7799
7800 if (dump_file)
7801 fprintf (dump_file,
7802 ";; Emitting minipool after insn %u; address %ld; align %d (bytes)\n",
7803 INSN_UID (scan), (unsigned long) minipool_barrier->address, align64 ? 8 : 4);
7804
7805 scan = emit_label_after (gen_label_rtx (), scan);
7806 scan = emit_insn_after (align64 ? gen_align_8 () : gen_align_4 (), scan);
7807 scan = emit_label_after (minipool_vector_label, scan);
7808
7809 for (mp = minipool_vector_head; mp != NULL; mp = nmp)
7810 {
7811 if (mp->refcount > 0)
7812 {
7813 if (dump_file)
7814 {
7815 fprintf (dump_file,
7816 ";; Offset %u, min %ld, max %ld ",
7817 (unsigned) mp->offset, (unsigned long) mp->min_address,
7818 (unsigned long) mp->max_address);
7819 arm_print_value (dump_file, mp->value);
7820 fputc ('\n', dump_file);
7821 }
7822
7823 switch (mp->fix_size)
7824 {
7825 #ifdef HAVE_consttable_1
7826 case 1:
7827 scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_1 (mp->value), scan);
7828 break;
7829
7830 #endif
7831 #ifdef HAVE_consttable_2
7832 case 2:
7833 scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_2 (mp->value), scan);
7834 break;
7835
7836 #endif
7837 #ifdef HAVE_consttable_4
7838 case 4:
7839 scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_4 (mp->value), scan);
7840 break;
7841
7842 #endif
7843 #ifdef HAVE_consttable_8
7844 case 8:
7845 scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_8 (mp->value), scan);
7846 break;
7847
7848 #endif
7849 default:
7850 gcc_unreachable ();
7851 }
7852 }
7853
7854 nmp = mp->next;
7855 free (mp);
7856 }
7857
7858 minipool_vector_head = minipool_vector_tail = NULL;
7859 scan = emit_insn_after (gen_consttable_end (), scan);
7860 scan = emit_barrier_after (scan);
7861 }
7862
7863 /* Return the cost of forcibly inserting a barrier after INSN. */
7864 static int
arm_barrier_cost(rtx insn)7865 arm_barrier_cost (rtx insn)
7866 {
7867 /* Basing the location of the pool on the loop depth is preferable,
7868 but at the moment, the basic block information seems to be
7869 corrupt by this stage of the compilation. */
7870 int base_cost = 50;
7871 rtx next = next_nonnote_insn (insn);
7872
7873 if (next != NULL && GET_CODE (next) == CODE_LABEL)
7874 base_cost -= 20;
7875
7876 switch (GET_CODE (insn))
7877 {
7878 case CODE_LABEL:
7879 /* It will always be better to place the table before the label, rather
7880 than after it. */
7881 return 50;
7882
7883 case INSN:
7884 case CALL_INSN:
7885 return base_cost;
7886
7887 case JUMP_INSN:
7888 return base_cost - 10;
7889
7890 default:
7891 return base_cost + 10;
7892 }
7893 }
7894
7895 /* Find the best place in the insn stream in the range
7896 (FIX->address,MAX_ADDRESS) to forcibly insert a minipool barrier.
7897 Create the barrier by inserting a jump and add a new fix entry for
7898 it. */
7899 static Mfix *
create_fix_barrier(Mfix * fix,HOST_WIDE_INT max_address)7900 create_fix_barrier (Mfix *fix, HOST_WIDE_INT max_address)
7901 {
7902 HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0;
7903 rtx barrier;
7904 rtx from = fix->insn;
7905 /* The instruction after which we will insert the jump. */
7906 rtx selected = NULL;
7907 int selected_cost;
7908 /* The address at which the jump instruction will be placed. */
7909 HOST_WIDE_INT selected_address;
7910 Mfix * new_fix;
7911 HOST_WIDE_INT max_count = max_address - fix->address;
7912 rtx label = gen_label_rtx ();
7913
7914 selected_cost = arm_barrier_cost (from);
7915 selected_address = fix->address;
7916
7917 while (from && count < max_count)
7918 {
7919 rtx tmp;
7920 int new_cost;
7921
7922 /* This code shouldn't have been called if there was a natural barrier
7923 within range. */
7924 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (from) != BARRIER);
7925
7926 /* Count the length of this insn. */
7927 count += get_attr_length (from);
7928
7929 /* If there is a jump table, add its length. */
7930 tmp = is_jump_table (from);
7931 if (tmp != NULL)
7932 {
7933 count += get_jump_table_size (tmp);
7934
7935 /* Jump tables aren't in a basic block, so base the cost on
7936 the dispatch insn. If we select this location, we will
7937 still put the pool after the table. */
7938 new_cost = arm_barrier_cost (from);
7939
7940 if (count < max_count
7941 && (!selected || new_cost <= selected_cost))
7942 {
7943 selected = tmp;
7944 selected_cost = new_cost;
7945 selected_address = fix->address + count;
7946 }
7947
7948 /* Continue after the dispatch table. */
7949 from = NEXT_INSN (tmp);
7950 continue;
7951 }
7952
7953 new_cost = arm_barrier_cost (from);
7954
7955 if (count < max_count
7956 && (!selected || new_cost <= selected_cost))
7957 {
7958 selected = from;
7959 selected_cost = new_cost;
7960 selected_address = fix->address + count;
7961 }
7962
7963 from = NEXT_INSN (from);
7964 }
7965
7966 /* Make sure that we found a place to insert the jump. */
7967 gcc_assert (selected);
7968
7969 /* Create a new JUMP_INSN that branches around a barrier. */
7970 from = emit_jump_insn_after (gen_jump (label), selected);
7971 JUMP_LABEL (from) = label;
7972 barrier = emit_barrier_after (from);
7973 emit_label_after (label, barrier);
7974
7975 /* Create a minipool barrier entry for the new barrier. */
7976 new_fix = (Mfix *) obstack_alloc (&minipool_obstack, sizeof (* new_fix));
7977 new_fix->insn = barrier;
7978 new_fix->address = selected_address;
7979 new_fix->next = fix->next;
7980 fix->next = new_fix;
7981
7982 return new_fix;
7983 }
7984
7985 /* Record that there is a natural barrier in the insn stream at
7986 ADDRESS. */
7987 static void
push_minipool_barrier(rtx insn,HOST_WIDE_INT address)7988 push_minipool_barrier (rtx insn, HOST_WIDE_INT address)
7989 {
7990 Mfix * fix = (Mfix *) obstack_alloc (&minipool_obstack, sizeof (* fix));
7991
7992 fix->insn = insn;
7993 fix->address = address;
7994
7995 fix->next = NULL;
7996 if (minipool_fix_head != NULL)
7997 minipool_fix_tail->next = fix;
7998 else
7999 minipool_fix_head = fix;
8000
8001 minipool_fix_tail = fix;
8002 }
8003
8004 /* Record INSN, which will need fixing up to load a value from the
8005 minipool. ADDRESS is the offset of the insn since the start of the
8006 function; LOC is a pointer to the part of the insn which requires
8007 fixing; VALUE is the constant that must be loaded, which is of type
8008 MODE. */
8009 static void
push_minipool_fix(rtx insn,HOST_WIDE_INT address,rtx * loc,enum machine_mode mode,rtx value)8010 push_minipool_fix (rtx insn, HOST_WIDE_INT address, rtx *loc,
8011 enum machine_mode mode, rtx value)
8012 {
8013 Mfix * fix = (Mfix *) obstack_alloc (&minipool_obstack, sizeof (* fix));
8014
8015 #ifdef AOF_ASSEMBLER
8016 /* PIC symbol references need to be converted into offsets into the
8017 based area. */
8018 /* XXX This shouldn't be done here. */
8019 if (flag_pic && GET_CODE (value) == SYMBOL_REF)
8020 value = aof_pic_entry (value);
8021 #endif /* AOF_ASSEMBLER */
8022
8023 fix->insn = insn;
8024 fix->address = address;
8025 fix->loc = loc;
8026 fix->mode = mode;
8027 fix->fix_size = MINIPOOL_FIX_SIZE (mode);
8028 fix->value = value;
8029 fix->forwards = get_attr_pool_range (insn);
8030 fix->backwards = get_attr_neg_pool_range (insn);
8031 fix->minipool = NULL;
8032
8033 /* If an insn doesn't have a range defined for it, then it isn't
8034 expecting to be reworked by this code. Better to stop now than
8035 to generate duff assembly code. */
8036 gcc_assert (fix->forwards || fix->backwards);
8037
8038 /* If an entry requires 8-byte alignment then assume all constant pools
8039 require 4 bytes of padding. Trying to do this later on a per-pool
8040 basis is awkward because existing pool entries have to be modified. */
8041 if (ARM_DOUBLEWORD_ALIGN && fix->fix_size == 8)
8042 minipool_pad = 4;
8043
8044 if (dump_file)
8045 {
8046 fprintf (dump_file,
8047 ";; %smode fixup for i%d; addr %lu, range (%ld,%ld): ",
8048 GET_MODE_NAME (mode),
8049 INSN_UID (insn), (unsigned long) address,
8050 -1 * (long)fix->backwards, (long)fix->forwards);
8051 arm_print_value (dump_file, fix->value);
8052 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
8053 }
8054
8055 /* Add it to the chain of fixes. */
8056 fix->next = NULL;
8057
8058 if (minipool_fix_head != NULL)
8059 minipool_fix_tail->next = fix;
8060 else
8061 minipool_fix_head = fix;
8062
8063 minipool_fix_tail = fix;
8064 }
8065
8066 /* Return the cost of synthesizing a 64-bit constant VAL inline.
8067 Returns the number of insns needed, or 99 if we don't know how to
8068 do it. */
8069 int
arm_const_double_inline_cost(rtx val)8070 arm_const_double_inline_cost (rtx val)
8071 {
8072 rtx lowpart, highpart;
8073 enum machine_mode mode;
8074
8075 mode = GET_MODE (val);
8076
8077 if (mode == VOIDmode)
8078 mode = DImode;
8079
8080 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 8);
8081
8082 lowpart = gen_lowpart (SImode, val);
8083 highpart = gen_highpart_mode (SImode, mode, val);
8084
8085 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (lowpart) == CONST_INT);
8086 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (highpart) == CONST_INT);
8087
8088 return (arm_gen_constant (SET, SImode, NULL_RTX, INTVAL (lowpart),
8089 NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, 0, 0)
8090 + arm_gen_constant (SET, SImode, NULL_RTX, INTVAL (highpart),
8091 NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, 0, 0));
8092 }
8093
8094 /* Return true if it is worthwhile to split a 64-bit constant into two
8095 32-bit operations. This is the case if optimizing for size, or
8096 if we have load delay slots, or if one 32-bit part can be done with
8097 a single data operation. */
8098 bool
arm_const_double_by_parts(rtx val)8099 arm_const_double_by_parts (rtx val)
8100 {
8101 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (val);
8102 rtx part;
8103
8104 if (optimize_size || arm_ld_sched)
8105 return true;
8106
8107 if (mode == VOIDmode)
8108 mode = DImode;
8109
8110 part = gen_highpart_mode (SImode, mode, val);
8111
8112 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (part) == CONST_INT);
8113
8114 if (const_ok_for_arm (INTVAL (part))
8115 || const_ok_for_arm (~INTVAL (part)))
8116 return true;
8117
8118 part = gen_lowpart (SImode, val);
8119
8120 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (part) == CONST_INT);
8121
8122 if (const_ok_for_arm (INTVAL (part))
8123 || const_ok_for_arm (~INTVAL (part)))
8124 return true;
8125
8126 return false;
8127 }
8128
8129 /* Scan INSN and note any of its operands that need fixing.
8130 If DO_PUSHES is false we do not actually push any of the fixups
8131 needed. The function returns TRUE if any fixups were needed/pushed.
8132 This is used by arm_memory_load_p() which needs to know about loads
8133 of constants that will be converted into minipool loads. */
8134 static bool
note_invalid_constants(rtx insn,HOST_WIDE_INT address,int do_pushes)8135 note_invalid_constants (rtx insn, HOST_WIDE_INT address, int do_pushes)
8136 {
8137 bool result = false;
8138 int opno;
8139
8140 extract_insn (insn);
8141
8142 if (!constrain_operands (1))
8143 fatal_insn_not_found (insn);
8144
8145 if (recog_data.n_alternatives == 0)
8146 return false;
8147
8148 /* Fill in recog_op_alt with information about the constraints of
8149 this insn. */
8150 preprocess_constraints ();
8151
8152 for (opno = 0; opno < recog_data.n_operands; opno++)
8153 {
8154 /* Things we need to fix can only occur in inputs. */
8155 if (recog_data.operand_type[opno] != OP_IN)
8156 continue;
8157
8158 /* If this alternative is a memory reference, then any mention
8159 of constants in this alternative is really to fool reload
8160 into allowing us to accept one there. We need to fix them up
8161 now so that we output the right code. */
8162 if (recog_op_alt[opno][which_alternative].memory_ok)
8163 {
8164 rtx op = recog_data.operand[opno];
8165
8166 if (CONSTANT_P (op))
8167 {
8168 if (do_pushes)
8169 push_minipool_fix (insn, address, recog_data.operand_loc[opno],
8170 recog_data.operand_mode[opno], op);
8171 result = true;
8172 }
8173 else if (GET_CODE (op) == MEM
8174 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF
8175 && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (op, 0)))
8176 {
8177 if (do_pushes)
8178 {
8179 rtx cop = avoid_constant_pool_reference (op);
8180
8181 /* Casting the address of something to a mode narrower
8182 than a word can cause avoid_constant_pool_reference()
8183 to return the pool reference itself. That's no good to
8184 us here. Lets just hope that we can use the
8185 constant pool value directly. */
8186 if (op == cop)
8187 cop = get_pool_constant (XEXP (op, 0));
8188
8189 push_minipool_fix (insn, address,
8190 recog_data.operand_loc[opno],
8191 recog_data.operand_mode[opno], cop);
8192 }
8193
8194 result = true;
8195 }
8196 }
8197 }
8198
8199 return result;
8200 }
8201
8202 /* Gcc puts the pool in the wrong place for ARM, since we can only
8203 load addresses a limited distance around the pc. We do some
8204 special munging to move the constant pool values to the correct
8205 point in the code. */
8206 static void
arm_reorg(void)8207 arm_reorg (void)
8208 {
8209 rtx insn;
8210 HOST_WIDE_INT address = 0;
8211 Mfix * fix;
8212
8213 minipool_fix_head = minipool_fix_tail = NULL;
8214
8215 /* The first insn must always be a note, or the code below won't
8216 scan it properly. */
8217 insn = get_insns ();
8218 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE);
8219 minipool_pad = 0;
8220
8221 /* Scan all the insns and record the operands that will need fixing. */
8222 for (insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn); insn; insn = next_nonnote_insn (insn))
8223 {
8224 if (TARGET_CIRRUS_FIX_INVALID_INSNS
8225 && (arm_cirrus_insn_p (insn)
8226 || GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
8227 || arm_memory_load_p (insn)))
8228 cirrus_reorg (insn);
8229
8230 if (GET_CODE (insn) == BARRIER)
8231 push_minipool_barrier (insn, address);
8232 else if (INSN_P (insn))
8233 {
8234 rtx table;
8235
8236 note_invalid_constants (insn, address, true);
8237 address += get_attr_length (insn);
8238
8239 /* If the insn is a vector jump, add the size of the table
8240 and skip the table. */
8241 if ((table = is_jump_table (insn)) != NULL)
8242 {
8243 address += get_jump_table_size (table);
8244 insn = table;
8245 }
8246 }
8247 }
8248
8249 fix = minipool_fix_head;
8250
8251 /* Now scan the fixups and perform the required changes. */
8252 while (fix)
8253 {
8254 Mfix * ftmp;
8255 Mfix * fdel;
8256 Mfix * last_added_fix;
8257 Mfix * last_barrier = NULL;
8258 Mfix * this_fix;
8259
8260 /* Skip any further barriers before the next fix. */
8261 while (fix && GET_CODE (fix->insn) == BARRIER)
8262 fix = fix->next;
8263
8264 /* No more fixes. */
8265 if (fix == NULL)
8266 break;
8267
8268 last_added_fix = NULL;
8269
8270 for (ftmp = fix; ftmp; ftmp = ftmp->next)
8271 {
8272 if (GET_CODE (ftmp->insn) == BARRIER)
8273 {
8274 if (ftmp->address >= minipool_vector_head->max_address)
8275 break;
8276
8277 last_barrier = ftmp;
8278 }
8279 else if ((ftmp->minipool = add_minipool_forward_ref (ftmp)) == NULL)
8280 break;
8281
8282 last_added_fix = ftmp; /* Keep track of the last fix added. */
8283 }
8284
8285 /* If we found a barrier, drop back to that; any fixes that we
8286 could have reached but come after the barrier will now go in
8287 the next mini-pool. */
8288 if (last_barrier != NULL)
8289 {
8290 /* Reduce the refcount for those fixes that won't go into this
8291 pool after all. */
8292 for (fdel = last_barrier->next;
8293 fdel && fdel != ftmp;
8294 fdel = fdel->next)
8295 {
8296 fdel->minipool->refcount--;
8297 fdel->minipool = NULL;
8298 }
8299
8300 ftmp = last_barrier;
8301 }
8302 else
8303 {
8304 /* ftmp is first fix that we can't fit into this pool and
8305 there no natural barriers that we could use. Insert a
8306 new barrier in the code somewhere between the previous
8307 fix and this one, and arrange to jump around it. */
8308 HOST_WIDE_INT max_address;
8309
8310 /* The last item on the list of fixes must be a barrier, so
8311 we can never run off the end of the list of fixes without
8312 last_barrier being set. */
8313 gcc_assert (ftmp);
8314
8315 max_address = minipool_vector_head->max_address;
8316 /* Check that there isn't another fix that is in range that
8317 we couldn't fit into this pool because the pool was
8318 already too large: we need to put the pool before such an
8319 instruction. The pool itself may come just after the
8320 fix because create_fix_barrier also allows space for a
8321 jump instruction. */
8322 if (ftmp->address < max_address)
8323 max_address = ftmp->address + 1;
8324
8325 last_barrier = create_fix_barrier (last_added_fix, max_address);
8326 }
8327
8328 assign_minipool_offsets (last_barrier);
8329
8330 while (ftmp)
8331 {
8332 if (GET_CODE (ftmp->insn) != BARRIER
8333 && ((ftmp->minipool = add_minipool_backward_ref (ftmp))
8334 == NULL))
8335 break;
8336
8337 ftmp = ftmp->next;
8338 }
8339
8340 /* Scan over the fixes we have identified for this pool, fixing them
8341 up and adding the constants to the pool itself. */
8342 for (this_fix = fix; this_fix && ftmp != this_fix;
8343 this_fix = this_fix->next)
8344 if (GET_CODE (this_fix->insn) != BARRIER)
8345 {
8346 rtx addr
8347 = plus_constant (gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (VOIDmode,
8348 minipool_vector_label),
8349 this_fix->minipool->offset);
8350 *this_fix->loc = gen_rtx_MEM (this_fix->mode, addr);
8351 }
8352
8353 dump_minipool (last_barrier->insn);
8354 fix = ftmp;
8355 }
8356
8357 /* From now on we must synthesize any constants that we can't handle
8358 directly. This can happen if the RTL gets split during final
8359 instruction generation. */
8360 after_arm_reorg = 1;
8361
8362 /* Free the minipool memory. */
8363 obstack_free (&minipool_obstack, minipool_startobj);
8364 }
8365
8366 /* Routines to output assembly language. */
8367
8368 /* If the rtx is the correct value then return the string of the number.
8369 In this way we can ensure that valid double constants are generated even
8370 when cross compiling. */
8371 const char *
fp_immediate_constant(rtx x)8372 fp_immediate_constant (rtx x)
8373 {
8374 REAL_VALUE_TYPE r;
8375 int i;
8376
8377 if (!fp_consts_inited)
8378 init_fp_table ();
8379
8380 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, x);
8381 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
8382 if (REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (r, values_fp[i]))
8383 return strings_fp[i];
8384
8385 gcc_unreachable ();
8386 }
8387
8388 /* As for fp_immediate_constant, but value is passed directly, not in rtx. */
8389 static const char *
fp_const_from_val(REAL_VALUE_TYPE * r)8390 fp_const_from_val (REAL_VALUE_TYPE *r)
8391 {
8392 int i;
8393
8394 if (!fp_consts_inited)
8395 init_fp_table ();
8396
8397 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
8398 if (REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (*r, values_fp[i]))
8399 return strings_fp[i];
8400
8401 gcc_unreachable ();
8402 }
8403
8404 /* Output the operands of a LDM/STM instruction to STREAM.
8405 MASK is the ARM register set mask of which only bits 0-15 are important.
8406 REG is the base register, either the frame pointer or the stack pointer,
8407 INSTR is the possibly suffixed load or store instruction. */
8408
8409 static void
print_multi_reg(FILE * stream,const char * instr,unsigned reg,unsigned long mask)8410 print_multi_reg (FILE *stream, const char *instr, unsigned reg,
8411 unsigned long mask)
8412 {
8413 unsigned i;
8414 bool not_first = FALSE;
8415
8416 fputc ('\t', stream);
8417 asm_fprintf (stream, instr, reg);
8418 fputs (", {", stream);
8419
8420 for (i = 0; i <= LAST_ARM_REGNUM; i++)
8421 if (mask & (1 << i))
8422 {
8423 if (not_first)
8424 fprintf (stream, ", ");
8425
8426 asm_fprintf (stream, "%r", i);
8427 not_first = TRUE;
8428 }
8429
8430 fprintf (stream, "}\n");
8431 }
8432
8433
8434 /* Output a FLDMX instruction to STREAM.
8435 BASE if the register containing the address.
8436 REG and COUNT specify the register range.
8437 Extra registers may be added to avoid hardware bugs. */
8438
8439 static void
arm_output_fldmx(FILE * stream,unsigned int base,int reg,int count)8440 arm_output_fldmx (FILE * stream, unsigned int base, int reg, int count)
8441 {
8442 int i;
8443
8444 /* Workaround ARM10 VFPr1 bug. */
8445 if (count == 2 && !arm_arch6)
8446 {
8447 if (reg == 15)
8448 reg--;
8449 count++;
8450 }
8451
8452 fputc ('\t', stream);
8453 asm_fprintf (stream, "fldmfdx\t%r!, {", base);
8454
8455 for (i = reg; i < reg + count; i++)
8456 {
8457 if (i > reg)
8458 fputs (", ", stream);
8459 asm_fprintf (stream, "d%d", i);
8460 }
8461 fputs ("}\n", stream);
8462
8463 }
8464
8465
8466 /* Output the assembly for a store multiple. */
8467
8468 const char *
vfp_output_fstmx(rtx * operands)8469 vfp_output_fstmx (rtx * operands)
8470 {
8471 char pattern[100];
8472 int p;
8473 int base;
8474 int i;
8475
8476 strcpy (pattern, "fstmfdx\t%m0!, {%P1");
8477 p = strlen (pattern);
8478
8479 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == REG);
8480
8481 base = (REGNO (operands[1]) - FIRST_VFP_REGNUM) / 2;
8482 for (i = 1; i < XVECLEN (operands[2], 0); i++)
8483 {
8484 p += sprintf (&pattern[p], ", d%d", base + i);
8485 }
8486 strcpy (&pattern[p], "}");
8487
8488 output_asm_insn (pattern, operands);
8489 return "";
8490 }
8491
8492
8493 /* Emit RTL to save block of VFP register pairs to the stack. Returns the
8494 number of bytes pushed. */
8495
8496 static int
vfp_emit_fstmx(int base_reg,int count)8497 vfp_emit_fstmx (int base_reg, int count)
8498 {
8499 rtx par;
8500 rtx dwarf;
8501 rtx tmp, reg;
8502 int i;
8503
8504 /* Workaround ARM10 VFPr1 bug. Data corruption can occur when exactly two
8505 register pairs are stored by a store multiple insn. We avoid this
8506 by pushing an extra pair. */
8507 if (count == 2 && !arm_arch6)
8508 {
8509 if (base_reg == LAST_VFP_REGNUM - 3)
8510 base_reg -= 2;
8511 count++;
8512 }
8513
8514 /* ??? The frame layout is implementation defined. We describe
8515 standard format 1 (equivalent to a FSTMD insn and unused pad word).
8516 We really need some way of representing the whole block so that the
8517 unwinder can figure it out at runtime. */
8518 par = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, rtvec_alloc (count));
8519 dwarf = gen_rtx_SEQUENCE (VOIDmode, rtvec_alloc (count + 1));
8520
8521 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, base_reg);
8522 base_reg += 2;
8523
8524 XVECEXP (par, 0, 0)
8525 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
8526 gen_frame_mem (BLKmode,
8527 gen_rtx_PRE_DEC (BLKmode,
8528 stack_pointer_rtx)),
8529 gen_rtx_UNSPEC (BLKmode,
8530 gen_rtvec (1, reg),
8531 UNSPEC_PUSH_MULT));
8532
8533 tmp = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
8534 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, -(count * 8 + 4)));
8535 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (tmp) = 1;
8536 XVECEXP (dwarf, 0, 0) = tmp;
8537
8538 tmp = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
8539 gen_frame_mem (DFmode, stack_pointer_rtx),
8540 reg);
8541 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (tmp) = 1;
8542 XVECEXP (dwarf, 0, 1) = tmp;
8543
8544 for (i = 1; i < count; i++)
8545 {
8546 reg = gen_rtx_REG (DFmode, base_reg);
8547 base_reg += 2;
8548 XVECEXP (par, 0, i) = gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg);
8549
8550 tmp = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
8551 gen_frame_mem (DFmode,
8552 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx,
8553 i * 8)),
8554 reg);
8555 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (tmp) = 1;
8556 XVECEXP (dwarf, 0, i + 1) = tmp;
8557 }
8558
8559 par = emit_insn (par);
8560 REG_NOTES (par) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, dwarf,
8561 REG_NOTES (par));
8562 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (par) = 1;
8563
8564 return count * 8 + 4;
8565 }
8566
8567
8568 /* Output a 'call' insn. */
8569 const char *
output_call(rtx * operands)8570 output_call (rtx *operands)
8571 {
8572 gcc_assert (!arm_arch5); /* Patterns should call blx <reg> directly. */
8573
8574 /* Handle calls to lr using ip (which may be clobbered in subr anyway). */
8575 if (REGNO (operands[0]) == LR_REGNUM)
8576 {
8577 operands[0] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, IP_REGNUM);
8578 output_asm_insn ("mov%?\t%0, %|lr", operands);
8579 }
8580
8581 output_asm_insn ("mov%?\t%|lr, %|pc", operands);
8582
8583 if (TARGET_INTERWORK || arm_arch4t)
8584 output_asm_insn ("bx%?\t%0", operands);
8585 else
8586 output_asm_insn ("mov%?\t%|pc, %0", operands);
8587
8588 return "";
8589 }
8590
8591 /* Output a 'call' insn that is a reference in memory. */
8592 const char *
output_call_mem(rtx * operands)8593 output_call_mem (rtx *operands)
8594 {
8595 if (TARGET_INTERWORK && !arm_arch5)
8596 {
8597 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%|ip, %0", operands);
8598 output_asm_insn ("mov%?\t%|lr, %|pc", operands);
8599 output_asm_insn ("bx%?\t%|ip", operands);
8600 }
8601 else if (regno_use_in (LR_REGNUM, operands[0]))
8602 {
8603 /* LR is used in the memory address. We load the address in the
8604 first instruction. It's safe to use IP as the target of the
8605 load since the call will kill it anyway. */
8606 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%|ip, %0", operands);
8607 if (arm_arch5)
8608 output_asm_insn ("blx%?\t%|ip", operands);
8609 else
8610 {
8611 output_asm_insn ("mov%?\t%|lr, %|pc", operands);
8612 if (arm_arch4t)
8613 output_asm_insn ("bx%?\t%|ip", operands);
8614 else
8615 output_asm_insn ("mov%?\t%|pc, %|ip", operands);
8616 }
8617 }
8618 else
8619 {
8620 output_asm_insn ("mov%?\t%|lr, %|pc", operands);
8621 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%|pc, %0", operands);
8622 }
8623
8624 return "";
8625 }
8626
8627
8628 /* Output a move from arm registers to an fpa registers.
8629 OPERANDS[0] is an fpa register.
8630 OPERANDS[1] is the first registers of an arm register pair. */
8631 const char *
output_mov_long_double_fpa_from_arm(rtx * operands)8632 output_mov_long_double_fpa_from_arm (rtx *operands)
8633 {
8634 int arm_reg0 = REGNO (operands[1]);
8635 rtx ops[3];
8636
8637 gcc_assert (arm_reg0 != IP_REGNUM);
8638
8639 ops[0] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, arm_reg0);
8640 ops[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 1 + arm_reg0);
8641 ops[2] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 2 + arm_reg0);
8642
8643 output_asm_insn ("stm%?fd\t%|sp!, {%0, %1, %2}", ops);
8644 output_asm_insn ("ldf%?e\t%0, [%|sp], #12", operands);
8645
8646 return "";
8647 }
8648
8649 /* Output a move from an fpa register to arm registers.
8650 OPERANDS[0] is the first registers of an arm register pair.
8651 OPERANDS[1] is an fpa register. */
8652 const char *
output_mov_long_double_arm_from_fpa(rtx * operands)8653 output_mov_long_double_arm_from_fpa (rtx *operands)
8654 {
8655 int arm_reg0 = REGNO (operands[0]);
8656 rtx ops[3];
8657
8658 gcc_assert (arm_reg0 != IP_REGNUM);
8659
8660 ops[0] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, arm_reg0);
8661 ops[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 1 + arm_reg0);
8662 ops[2] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 2 + arm_reg0);
8663
8664 output_asm_insn ("stf%?e\t%1, [%|sp, #-12]!", operands);
8665 output_asm_insn ("ldm%?fd\t%|sp!, {%0, %1, %2}", ops);
8666 return "";
8667 }
8668
8669 /* Output a move from arm registers to arm registers of a long double
8670 OPERANDS[0] is the destination.
8671 OPERANDS[1] is the source. */
8672 const char *
output_mov_long_double_arm_from_arm(rtx * operands)8673 output_mov_long_double_arm_from_arm (rtx *operands)
8674 {
8675 /* We have to be careful here because the two might overlap. */
8676 int dest_start = REGNO (operands[0]);
8677 int src_start = REGNO (operands[1]);
8678 rtx ops[2];
8679 int i;
8680
8681 if (dest_start < src_start)
8682 {
8683 for (i = 0; i < 3; i++)
8684 {
8685 ops[0] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, dest_start + i);
8686 ops[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, src_start + i);
8687 output_asm_insn ("mov%?\t%0, %1", ops);
8688 }
8689 }
8690 else
8691 {
8692 for (i = 2; i >= 0; i--)
8693 {
8694 ops[0] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, dest_start + i);
8695 ops[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, src_start + i);
8696 output_asm_insn ("mov%?\t%0, %1", ops);
8697 }
8698 }
8699
8700 return "";
8701 }
8702
8703
8704 /* Output a move from arm registers to an fpa registers.
8705 OPERANDS[0] is an fpa register.
8706 OPERANDS[1] is the first registers of an arm register pair. */
8707 const char *
output_mov_double_fpa_from_arm(rtx * operands)8708 output_mov_double_fpa_from_arm (rtx *operands)
8709 {
8710 int arm_reg0 = REGNO (operands[1]);
8711 rtx ops[2];
8712
8713 gcc_assert (arm_reg0 != IP_REGNUM);
8714
8715 ops[0] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, arm_reg0);
8716 ops[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 1 + arm_reg0);
8717 output_asm_insn ("stm%?fd\t%|sp!, {%0, %1}", ops);
8718 output_asm_insn ("ldf%?d\t%0, [%|sp], #8", operands);
8719 return "";
8720 }
8721
8722 /* Output a move from an fpa register to arm registers.
8723 OPERANDS[0] is the first registers of an arm register pair.
8724 OPERANDS[1] is an fpa register. */
8725 const char *
output_mov_double_arm_from_fpa(rtx * operands)8726 output_mov_double_arm_from_fpa (rtx *operands)
8727 {
8728 int arm_reg0 = REGNO (operands[0]);
8729 rtx ops[2];
8730
8731 gcc_assert (arm_reg0 != IP_REGNUM);
8732
8733 ops[0] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, arm_reg0);
8734 ops[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 1 + arm_reg0);
8735 output_asm_insn ("stf%?d\t%1, [%|sp, #-8]!", operands);
8736 output_asm_insn ("ldm%?fd\t%|sp!, {%0, %1}", ops);
8737 return "";
8738 }
8739
8740 /* Output a move between double words.
8741 It must be REG<-REG, REG<-CONST_DOUBLE, REG<-CONST_INT, REG<-MEM
8742 or MEM<-REG and all MEMs must be offsettable addresses. */
8743 const char *
output_move_double(rtx * operands)8744 output_move_double (rtx *operands)
8745 {
8746 enum rtx_code code0 = GET_CODE (operands[0]);
8747 enum rtx_code code1 = GET_CODE (operands[1]);
8748 rtx otherops[3];
8749
8750 if (code0 == REG)
8751 {
8752 int reg0 = REGNO (operands[0]);
8753
8754 otherops[0] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 1 + reg0);
8755
8756 gcc_assert (code1 == MEM); /* Constraints should ensure this. */
8757
8758 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (operands[1], 0)))
8759 {
8760 case REG:
8761 output_asm_insn ("ldm%?ia\t%m1, %M0", operands);
8762 break;
8763
8764 case PRE_INC:
8765 gcc_assert (TARGET_LDRD);
8766 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?d\t%0, [%m1, #8]!", operands);
8767 break;
8768
8769 case PRE_DEC:
8770 output_asm_insn ("ldm%?db\t%m1!, %M0", operands);
8771 break;
8772
8773 case POST_INC:
8774 output_asm_insn ("ldm%?ia\t%m1!, %M0", operands);
8775 break;
8776
8777 case POST_DEC:
8778 gcc_assert (TARGET_LDRD);
8779 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?d\t%0, [%m1], #-8", operands);
8780 break;
8781
8782 case PRE_MODIFY:
8783 case POST_MODIFY:
8784 otherops[0] = operands[0];
8785 otherops[1] = XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (operands[1], 0), 1), 0);
8786 otherops[2] = XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (operands[1], 0), 1), 1);
8787
8788 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (operands[1], 0)) == PRE_MODIFY)
8789 {
8790 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (otherops[0], otherops[2]))
8791 {
8792 /* Registers overlap so split out the increment. */
8793 output_asm_insn ("add%?\t%1, %1, %2", otherops);
8794 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?d\t%0, [%1] @split", otherops);
8795 }
8796 else
8797 {
8798 /* IWMMXT allows offsets larger than ldrd can handle,
8799 fix these up with a pair of ldr. */
8800 if (GET_CODE (otherops[2]) == CONST_INT
8801 && (INTVAL(otherops[2]) <= -256
8802 || INTVAL(otherops[2]) >= 256))
8803 {
8804 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, [%1, %2]!", otherops);
8805 otherops[0] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 1 + reg0);
8806 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, [%1, #4]", otherops);
8807 }
8808 else
8809 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?d\t%0, [%1, %2]!", otherops);
8810 }
8811 }
8812 else
8813 {
8814 /* IWMMXT allows offsets larger than ldrd can handle,
8815 fix these up with a pair of ldr. */
8816 if (GET_CODE (otherops[2]) == CONST_INT
8817 && (INTVAL(otherops[2]) <= -256
8818 || INTVAL(otherops[2]) >= 256))
8819 {
8820 otherops[0] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 1 + reg0);
8821 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, [%1, #4]", otherops);
8822 otherops[0] = operands[0];
8823 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, [%1], %2", otherops);
8824 }
8825 else
8826 /* We only allow constant increments, so this is safe. */
8827 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?d\t%0, [%1], %2", otherops);
8828 }
8829 break;
8830
8831 case LABEL_REF:
8832 case CONST:
8833 output_asm_insn ("adr%?\t%0, %1", operands);
8834 output_asm_insn ("ldm%?ia\t%0, %M0", operands);
8835 break;
8836
8837 default:
8838 if (arm_add_operand (XEXP (XEXP (operands[1], 0), 1),
8839 GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (operands[1], 0), 1))))
8840 {
8841 otherops[0] = operands[0];
8842 otherops[1] = XEXP (XEXP (operands[1], 0), 0);
8843 otherops[2] = XEXP (XEXP (operands[1], 0), 1);
8844
8845 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (operands[1], 0)) == PLUS)
8846 {
8847 if (GET_CODE (otherops[2]) == CONST_INT)
8848 {
8849 switch ((int) INTVAL (otherops[2]))
8850 {
8851 case -8:
8852 output_asm_insn ("ldm%?db\t%1, %M0", otherops);
8853 return "";
8854 case -4:
8855 output_asm_insn ("ldm%?da\t%1, %M0", otherops);
8856 return "";
8857 case 4:
8858 output_asm_insn ("ldm%?ib\t%1, %M0", otherops);
8859 return "";
8860 }
8861 }
8862 if (TARGET_LDRD
8863 && (GET_CODE (otherops[2]) == REG
8864 || (GET_CODE (otherops[2]) == CONST_INT
8865 && INTVAL (otherops[2]) > -256
8866 && INTVAL (otherops[2]) < 256)))
8867 {
8868 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (otherops[0],
8869 otherops[2]))
8870 {
8871 /* Swap base and index registers over to
8872 avoid a conflict. */
8873 otherops[1] = XEXP (XEXP (operands[1], 0), 1);
8874 otherops[2] = XEXP (XEXP (operands[1], 0), 0);
8875 }
8876 /* If both registers conflict, it will usually
8877 have been fixed by a splitter. */
8878 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (otherops[0], otherops[2]))
8879 {
8880 output_asm_insn ("add%?\t%1, %1, %2", otherops);
8881 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?d\t%0, [%1]",
8882 otherops);
8883 }
8884 else
8885 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?d\t%0, [%1, %2]", otherops);
8886 return "";
8887 }
8888
8889 if (GET_CODE (otherops[2]) == CONST_INT)
8890 {
8891 if (!(const_ok_for_arm (INTVAL (otherops[2]))))
8892 output_asm_insn ("sub%?\t%0, %1, #%n2", otherops);
8893 else
8894 output_asm_insn ("add%?\t%0, %1, %2", otherops);
8895 }
8896 else
8897 output_asm_insn ("add%?\t%0, %1, %2", otherops);
8898 }
8899 else
8900 output_asm_insn ("sub%?\t%0, %1, %2", otherops);
8901
8902 return "ldm%?ia\t%0, %M0";
8903 }
8904 else
8905 {
8906 otherops[1] = adjust_address (operands[1], SImode, 4);
8907 /* Take care of overlapping base/data reg. */
8908 if (reg_mentioned_p (operands[0], operands[1]))
8909 {
8910 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, %1", otherops);
8911 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, %1", operands);
8912 }
8913 else
8914 {
8915 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, %1", operands);
8916 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, %1", otherops);
8917 }
8918 }
8919 }
8920 }
8921 else
8922 {
8923 /* Constraints should ensure this. */
8924 gcc_assert (code0 == MEM && code1 == REG);
8925 gcc_assert (REGNO (operands[1]) != IP_REGNUM);
8926
8927 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (operands[0], 0)))
8928 {
8929 case REG:
8930 output_asm_insn ("stm%?ia\t%m0, %M1", operands);
8931 break;
8932
8933 case PRE_INC:
8934 gcc_assert (TARGET_LDRD);
8935 output_asm_insn ("str%?d\t%1, [%m0, #8]!", operands);
8936 break;
8937
8938 case PRE_DEC:
8939 output_asm_insn ("stm%?db\t%m0!, %M1", operands);
8940 break;
8941
8942 case POST_INC:
8943 output_asm_insn ("stm%?ia\t%m0!, %M1", operands);
8944 break;
8945
8946 case POST_DEC:
8947 gcc_assert (TARGET_LDRD);
8948 output_asm_insn ("str%?d\t%1, [%m0], #-8", operands);
8949 break;
8950
8951 case PRE_MODIFY:
8952 case POST_MODIFY:
8953 otherops[0] = operands[1];
8954 otherops[1] = XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (operands[0], 0), 1), 0);
8955 otherops[2] = XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (operands[0], 0), 1), 1);
8956
8957 /* IWMMXT allows offsets larger than ldrd can handle,
8958 fix these up with a pair of ldr. */
8959 if (GET_CODE (otherops[2]) == CONST_INT
8960 && (INTVAL(otherops[2]) <= -256
8961 || INTVAL(otherops[2]) >= 256))
8962 {
8963 rtx reg1;
8964 reg1 = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 1 + REGNO (operands[1]));
8965 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (operands[0], 0)) == PRE_MODIFY)
8966 {
8967 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, [%1, %2]!", otherops);
8968 otherops[0] = reg1;
8969 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, [%1, #4]", otherops);
8970 }
8971 else
8972 {
8973 otherops[0] = reg1;
8974 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, [%1, #4]", otherops);
8975 otherops[0] = operands[1];
8976 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, [%1], %2", otherops);
8977 }
8978 }
8979 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (operands[0], 0)) == PRE_MODIFY)
8980 output_asm_insn ("str%?d\t%0, [%1, %2]!", otherops);
8981 else
8982 output_asm_insn ("str%?d\t%0, [%1], %2", otherops);
8983 break;
8984
8985 case PLUS:
8986 otherops[2] = XEXP (XEXP (operands[0], 0), 1);
8987 if (GET_CODE (otherops[2]) == CONST_INT)
8988 {
8989 switch ((int) INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (operands[0], 0), 1)))
8990 {
8991 case -8:
8992 output_asm_insn ("stm%?db\t%m0, %M1", operands);
8993 return "";
8994
8995 case -4:
8996 output_asm_insn ("stm%?da\t%m0, %M1", operands);
8997 return "";
8998
8999 case 4:
9000 output_asm_insn ("stm%?ib\t%m0, %M1", operands);
9001 return "";
9002 }
9003 }
9004 if (TARGET_LDRD
9005 && (GET_CODE (otherops[2]) == REG
9006 || (GET_CODE (otherops[2]) == CONST_INT
9007 && INTVAL (otherops[2]) > -256
9008 && INTVAL (otherops[2]) < 256)))
9009 {
9010 otherops[0] = operands[1];
9011 otherops[1] = XEXP (XEXP (operands[0], 0), 0);
9012 output_asm_insn ("str%?d\t%0, [%1, %2]", otherops);
9013 return "";
9014 }
9015 /* Fall through */
9016
9017 default:
9018 otherops[0] = adjust_address (operands[0], SImode, 4);
9019 otherops[1] = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 1 + REGNO (operands[1]));
9020 output_asm_insn ("str%?\t%1, %0", operands);
9021 output_asm_insn ("str%?\t%1, %0", otherops);
9022 }
9023 }
9024
9025 return "";
9026 }
9027
9028 /* Output an ADD r, s, #n where n may be too big for one instruction.
9029 If adding zero to one register, output nothing. */
9030 const char *
output_add_immediate(rtx * operands)9031 output_add_immediate (rtx *operands)
9032 {
9033 HOST_WIDE_INT n = INTVAL (operands[2]);
9034
9035 if (n != 0 || REGNO (operands[0]) != REGNO (operands[1]))
9036 {
9037 if (n < 0)
9038 output_multi_immediate (operands,
9039 "sub%?\t%0, %1, %2", "sub%?\t%0, %0, %2", 2,
9040 -n);
9041 else
9042 output_multi_immediate (operands,
9043 "add%?\t%0, %1, %2", "add%?\t%0, %0, %2", 2,
9044 n);
9045 }
9046
9047 return "";
9048 }
9049
9050 /* Output a multiple immediate operation.
9051 OPERANDS is the vector of operands referred to in the output patterns.
9052 INSTR1 is the output pattern to use for the first constant.
9053 INSTR2 is the output pattern to use for subsequent constants.
9054 IMMED_OP is the index of the constant slot in OPERANDS.
9055 N is the constant value. */
9056 static const char *
output_multi_immediate(rtx * operands,const char * instr1,const char * instr2,int immed_op,HOST_WIDE_INT n)9057 output_multi_immediate (rtx *operands, const char *instr1, const char *instr2,
9058 int immed_op, HOST_WIDE_INT n)
9059 {
9060 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > 32
9061 n &= 0xffffffff;
9062 #endif
9063
9064 if (n == 0)
9065 {
9066 /* Quick and easy output. */
9067 operands[immed_op] = const0_rtx;
9068 output_asm_insn (instr1, operands);
9069 }
9070 else
9071 {
9072 int i;
9073 const char * instr = instr1;
9074
9075 /* Note that n is never zero here (which would give no output). */
9076 for (i = 0; i < 32; i += 2)
9077 {
9078 if (n & (3 << i))
9079 {
9080 operands[immed_op] = GEN_INT (n & (255 << i));
9081 output_asm_insn (instr, operands);
9082 instr = instr2;
9083 i += 6;
9084 }
9085 }
9086 }
9087
9088 return "";
9089 }
9090
9091 /* Return the appropriate ARM instruction for the operation code.
9092 The returned result should not be overwritten. OP is the rtx of the
9093 operation. SHIFT_FIRST_ARG is TRUE if the first argument of the operator
9094 was shifted. */
9095 const char *
arithmetic_instr(rtx op,int shift_first_arg)9096 arithmetic_instr (rtx op, int shift_first_arg)
9097 {
9098 switch (GET_CODE (op))
9099 {
9100 case PLUS:
9101 return "add";
9102
9103 case MINUS:
9104 return shift_first_arg ? "rsb" : "sub";
9105
9106 case IOR:
9107 return "orr";
9108
9109 case XOR:
9110 return "eor";
9111
9112 case AND:
9113 return "and";
9114
9115 default:
9116 gcc_unreachable ();
9117 }
9118 }
9119
9120 /* Ensure valid constant shifts and return the appropriate shift mnemonic
9121 for the operation code. The returned result should not be overwritten.
9122 OP is the rtx code of the shift.
9123 On exit, *AMOUNTP will be -1 if the shift is by a register, or a constant
9124 shift. */
9125 static const char *
shift_op(rtx op,HOST_WIDE_INT * amountp)9126 shift_op (rtx op, HOST_WIDE_INT *amountp)
9127 {
9128 const char * mnem;
9129 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (op);
9130
9131 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (op, 1)))
9132 {
9133 case REG:
9134 case SUBREG:
9135 *amountp = -1;
9136 break;
9137
9138 case CONST_INT:
9139 *amountp = INTVAL (XEXP (op, 1));
9140 break;
9141
9142 default:
9143 gcc_unreachable ();
9144 }
9145
9146 switch (code)
9147 {
9148 case ASHIFT:
9149 mnem = "asl";
9150 break;
9151
9152 case ASHIFTRT:
9153 mnem = "asr";
9154 break;
9155
9156 case LSHIFTRT:
9157 mnem = "lsr";
9158 break;
9159
9160 case ROTATE:
9161 gcc_assert (*amountp != -1);
9162 *amountp = 32 - *amountp;
9163
9164 /* Fall through. */
9165
9166 case ROTATERT:
9167 mnem = "ror";
9168 break;
9169
9170 case MULT:
9171 /* We never have to worry about the amount being other than a
9172 power of 2, since this case can never be reloaded from a reg. */
9173 gcc_assert (*amountp != -1);
9174 *amountp = int_log2 (*amountp);
9175 return "asl";
9176
9177 default:
9178 gcc_unreachable ();
9179 }
9180
9181 if (*amountp != -1)
9182 {
9183 /* This is not 100% correct, but follows from the desire to merge
9184 multiplication by a power of 2 with the recognizer for a
9185 shift. >=32 is not a valid shift for "asl", so we must try and
9186 output a shift that produces the correct arithmetical result.
9187 Using lsr #32 is identical except for the fact that the carry bit
9188 is not set correctly if we set the flags; but we never use the
9189 carry bit from such an operation, so we can ignore that. */
9190 if (code == ROTATERT)
9191 /* Rotate is just modulo 32. */
9192 *amountp &= 31;
9193 else if (*amountp != (*amountp & 31))
9194 {
9195 if (code == ASHIFT)
9196 mnem = "lsr";
9197 *amountp = 32;
9198 }
9199
9200 /* Shifts of 0 are no-ops. */
9201 if (*amountp == 0)
9202 return NULL;
9203 }
9204
9205 return mnem;
9206 }
9207
9208 /* Obtain the shift from the POWER of two. */
9209
9210 static HOST_WIDE_INT
int_log2(HOST_WIDE_INT power)9211 int_log2 (HOST_WIDE_INT power)
9212 {
9213 HOST_WIDE_INT shift = 0;
9214
9215 while ((((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << shift) & power) == 0)
9216 {
9217 gcc_assert (shift <= 31);
9218 shift++;
9219 }
9220
9221 return shift;
9222 }
9223
9224 /* Output a .ascii pseudo-op, keeping track of lengths. This is
9225 because /bin/as is horribly restrictive. The judgement about
9226 whether or not each character is 'printable' (and can be output as
9227 is) or not (and must be printed with an octal escape) must be made
9228 with reference to the *host* character set -- the situation is
9229 similar to that discussed in the comments above pp_c_char in
9230 c-pretty-print.c. */
9231
9232 #define MAX_ASCII_LEN 51
9233
9234 void
output_ascii_pseudo_op(FILE * stream,const unsigned char * p,int len)9235 output_ascii_pseudo_op (FILE *stream, const unsigned char *p, int len)
9236 {
9237 int i;
9238 int len_so_far = 0;
9239
9240 fputs ("\t.ascii\t\"", stream);
9241
9242 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
9243 {
9244 int c = p[i];
9245
9246 if (len_so_far >= MAX_ASCII_LEN)
9247 {
9248 fputs ("\"\n\t.ascii\t\"", stream);
9249 len_so_far = 0;
9250 }
9251
9252 if (ISPRINT (c))
9253 {
9254 if (c == '\\' || c == '\"')
9255 {
9256 putc ('\\', stream);
9257 len_so_far++;
9258 }
9259 putc (c, stream);
9260 len_so_far++;
9261 }
9262 else
9263 {
9264 fprintf (stream, "\\%03o", c);
9265 len_so_far += 4;
9266 }
9267 }
9268
9269 fputs ("\"\n", stream);
9270 }
9271
9272 /* Compute the register save mask for registers 0 through 12
9273 inclusive. This code is used by arm_compute_save_reg_mask. */
9274
9275 static unsigned long
arm_compute_save_reg0_reg12_mask(void)9276 arm_compute_save_reg0_reg12_mask (void)
9277 {
9278 unsigned long func_type = arm_current_func_type ();
9279 unsigned long save_reg_mask = 0;
9280 unsigned int reg;
9281
9282 if (IS_INTERRUPT (func_type))
9283 {
9284 unsigned int max_reg;
9285 /* Interrupt functions must not corrupt any registers,
9286 even call clobbered ones. If this is a leaf function
9287 we can just examine the registers used by the RTL, but
9288 otherwise we have to assume that whatever function is
9289 called might clobber anything, and so we have to save
9290 all the call-clobbered registers as well. */
9291 if (ARM_FUNC_TYPE (func_type) == ARM_FT_FIQ)
9292 /* FIQ handlers have registers r8 - r12 banked, so
9293 we only need to check r0 - r7, Normal ISRs only
9294 bank r14 and r15, so we must check up to r12.
9295 r13 is the stack pointer which is always preserved,
9296 so we do not need to consider it here. */
9297 max_reg = 7;
9298 else
9299 max_reg = 12;
9300
9301 for (reg = 0; reg <= max_reg; reg++)
9302 if (regs_ever_live[reg]
9303 || (! current_function_is_leaf && call_used_regs [reg]))
9304 save_reg_mask |= (1 << reg);
9305
9306 /* Also save the pic base register if necessary. */
9307 if (flag_pic
9308 && !TARGET_SINGLE_PIC_BASE
9309 && arm_pic_register != INVALID_REGNUM
9310 && current_function_uses_pic_offset_table)
9311 save_reg_mask |= 1 << PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM;
9312 }
9313 else
9314 {
9315 /* In the normal case we only need to save those registers
9316 which are call saved and which are used by this function. */
9317 for (reg = 0; reg <= 10; reg++)
9318 if (regs_ever_live[reg] && ! call_used_regs [reg])
9319 save_reg_mask |= (1 << reg);
9320
9321 /* Handle the frame pointer as a special case. */
9322 if (! TARGET_APCS_FRAME
9323 && ! frame_pointer_needed
9324 && regs_ever_live[HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM]
9325 && ! call_used_regs[HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM])
9326 save_reg_mask |= 1 << HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
9327
9328 /* If we aren't loading the PIC register,
9329 don't stack it even though it may be live. */
9330 if (flag_pic
9331 && !TARGET_SINGLE_PIC_BASE
9332 && arm_pic_register != INVALID_REGNUM
9333 && (regs_ever_live[PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM]
9334 || current_function_uses_pic_offset_table))
9335 save_reg_mask |= 1 << PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM;
9336 }
9337
9338 /* Save registers so the exception handler can modify them. */
9339 if (current_function_calls_eh_return)
9340 {
9341 unsigned int i;
9342
9343 for (i = 0; ; i++)
9344 {
9345 reg = EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (i);
9346 if (reg == INVALID_REGNUM)
9347 break;
9348 save_reg_mask |= 1 << reg;
9349 }
9350 }
9351
9352 return save_reg_mask;
9353 }
9354
9355 /* Compute a bit mask of which registers need to be
9356 saved on the stack for the current function. */
9357
9358 static unsigned long
arm_compute_save_reg_mask(void)9359 arm_compute_save_reg_mask (void)
9360 {
9361 unsigned int save_reg_mask = 0;
9362 unsigned long func_type = arm_current_func_type ();
9363
9364 if (IS_NAKED (func_type))
9365 /* This should never really happen. */
9366 return 0;
9367
9368 /* If we are creating a stack frame, then we must save the frame pointer,
9369 IP (which will hold the old stack pointer), LR and the PC. */
9370 if (frame_pointer_needed)
9371 save_reg_mask |=
9372 (1 << ARM_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
9373 | (1 << IP_REGNUM)
9374 | (1 << LR_REGNUM)
9375 | (1 << PC_REGNUM);
9376
9377 /* Volatile functions do not return, so there
9378 is no need to save any other registers. */
9379 if (IS_VOLATILE (func_type))
9380 return save_reg_mask;
9381
9382 save_reg_mask |= arm_compute_save_reg0_reg12_mask ();
9383
9384 /* Decide if we need to save the link register.
9385 Interrupt routines have their own banked link register,
9386 so they never need to save it.
9387 Otherwise if we do not use the link register we do not need to save
9388 it. If we are pushing other registers onto the stack however, we
9389 can save an instruction in the epilogue by pushing the link register
9390 now and then popping it back into the PC. This incurs extra memory
9391 accesses though, so we only do it when optimizing for size, and only
9392 if we know that we will not need a fancy return sequence. */
9393 if (regs_ever_live [LR_REGNUM]
9394 || (save_reg_mask
9395 && optimize_size
9396 && ARM_FUNC_TYPE (func_type) == ARM_FT_NORMAL
9397 && !current_function_calls_eh_return))
9398 save_reg_mask |= 1 << LR_REGNUM;
9399
9400 if (cfun->machine->lr_save_eliminated)
9401 save_reg_mask &= ~ (1 << LR_REGNUM);
9402
9403 if (TARGET_REALLY_IWMMXT
9404 && ((bit_count (save_reg_mask)
9405 + ARM_NUM_INTS (current_function_pretend_args_size)) % 2) != 0)
9406 {
9407 unsigned int reg;
9408
9409 /* The total number of registers that are going to be pushed
9410 onto the stack is odd. We need to ensure that the stack
9411 is 64-bit aligned before we start to save iWMMXt registers,
9412 and also before we start to create locals. (A local variable
9413 might be a double or long long which we will load/store using
9414 an iWMMXt instruction). Therefore we need to push another
9415 ARM register, so that the stack will be 64-bit aligned. We
9416 try to avoid using the arg registers (r0 -r3) as they might be
9417 used to pass values in a tail call. */
9418 for (reg = 4; reg <= 12; reg++)
9419 if ((save_reg_mask & (1 << reg)) == 0)
9420 break;
9421
9422 if (reg <= 12)
9423 save_reg_mask |= (1 << reg);
9424 else
9425 {
9426 cfun->machine->sibcall_blocked = 1;
9427 save_reg_mask |= (1 << 3);
9428 }
9429 }
9430
9431 return save_reg_mask;
9432 }
9433
9434
9435 /* Compute a bit mask of which registers need to be
9436 saved on the stack for the current function. */
9437 static unsigned long
thumb_compute_save_reg_mask(void)9438 thumb_compute_save_reg_mask (void)
9439 {
9440 unsigned long mask;
9441 unsigned reg;
9442
9443 mask = 0;
9444 for (reg = 0; reg < 12; reg ++)
9445 if (regs_ever_live[reg] && !call_used_regs[reg])
9446 mask |= 1 << reg;
9447
9448 if (flag_pic
9449 && !TARGET_SINGLE_PIC_BASE
9450 && arm_pic_register != INVALID_REGNUM
9451 && current_function_uses_pic_offset_table)
9452 mask |= 1 << PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM;
9453
9454 /* See if we might need r11 for calls to _interwork_r11_call_via_rN(). */
9455 if (!frame_pointer_needed && CALLER_INTERWORKING_SLOT_SIZE > 0)
9456 mask |= 1 << ARM_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
9457
9458 /* LR will also be pushed if any lo regs are pushed. */
9459 if (mask & 0xff || thumb_force_lr_save ())
9460 mask |= (1 << LR_REGNUM);
9461
9462 /* Make sure we have a low work register if we need one.
9463 We will need one if we are going to push a high register,
9464 but we are not currently intending to push a low register. */
9465 if ((mask & 0xff) == 0
9466 && ((mask & 0x0f00) || TARGET_BACKTRACE))
9467 {
9468 /* Use thumb_find_work_register to choose which register
9469 we will use. If the register is live then we will
9470 have to push it. Use LAST_LO_REGNUM as our fallback
9471 choice for the register to select. */
9472 reg = thumb_find_work_register (1 << LAST_LO_REGNUM);
9473
9474 if (! call_used_regs[reg])
9475 mask |= 1 << reg;
9476 }
9477
9478 return mask;
9479 }
9480
9481
9482 /* Return the number of bytes required to save VFP registers. */
9483 static int
arm_get_vfp_saved_size(void)9484 arm_get_vfp_saved_size (void)
9485 {
9486 unsigned int regno;
9487 int count;
9488 int saved;
9489
9490 saved = 0;
9491 /* Space for saved VFP registers. */
9492 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && TARGET_VFP)
9493 {
9494 count = 0;
9495 for (regno = FIRST_VFP_REGNUM;
9496 regno < LAST_VFP_REGNUM;
9497 regno += 2)
9498 {
9499 if ((!regs_ever_live[regno] || call_used_regs[regno])
9500 && (!regs_ever_live[regno + 1] || call_used_regs[regno + 1]))
9501 {
9502 if (count > 0)
9503 {
9504 /* Workaround ARM10 VFPr1 bug. */
9505 if (count == 2 && !arm_arch6)
9506 count++;
9507 saved += count * 8 + 4;
9508 }
9509 count = 0;
9510 }
9511 else
9512 count++;
9513 }
9514 if (count > 0)
9515 {
9516 if (count == 2 && !arm_arch6)
9517 count++;
9518 saved += count * 8 + 4;
9519 }
9520 }
9521 return saved;
9522 }
9523
9524
9525 /* Generate a function exit sequence. If REALLY_RETURN is false, then do
9526 everything bar the final return instruction. */
9527 const char *
output_return_instruction(rtx operand,int really_return,int reverse)9528 output_return_instruction (rtx operand, int really_return, int reverse)
9529 {
9530 char conditional[10];
9531 char instr[100];
9532 unsigned reg;
9533 unsigned long live_regs_mask;
9534 unsigned long func_type;
9535 arm_stack_offsets *offsets;
9536
9537 func_type = arm_current_func_type ();
9538
9539 if (IS_NAKED (func_type))
9540 return "";
9541
9542 if (IS_VOLATILE (func_type) && TARGET_ABORT_NORETURN)
9543 {
9544 /* If this function was declared non-returning, and we have
9545 found a tail call, then we have to trust that the called
9546 function won't return. */
9547 if (really_return)
9548 {
9549 rtx ops[2];
9550
9551 /* Otherwise, trap an attempted return by aborting. */
9552 ops[0] = operand;
9553 ops[1] = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, NEED_PLT_RELOC ? "abort(PLT)"
9554 : "abort");
9555 assemble_external_libcall (ops[1]);
9556 output_asm_insn (reverse ? "bl%D0\t%a1" : "bl%d0\t%a1", ops);
9557 }
9558
9559 return "";
9560 }
9561
9562 gcc_assert (!current_function_calls_alloca || really_return);
9563
9564 sprintf (conditional, "%%?%%%c0", reverse ? 'D' : 'd');
9565
9566 return_used_this_function = 1;
9567
9568 live_regs_mask = arm_compute_save_reg_mask ();
9569
9570 if (live_regs_mask)
9571 {
9572 const char * return_reg;
9573
9574 /* If we do not have any special requirements for function exit
9575 (e.g. interworking, or ISR) then we can load the return address
9576 directly into the PC. Otherwise we must load it into LR. */
9577 if (really_return
9578 && ! TARGET_INTERWORK)
9579 return_reg = reg_names[PC_REGNUM];
9580 else
9581 return_reg = reg_names[LR_REGNUM];
9582
9583 if ((live_regs_mask & (1 << IP_REGNUM)) == (1 << IP_REGNUM))
9584 {
9585 /* There are three possible reasons for the IP register
9586 being saved. 1) a stack frame was created, in which case
9587 IP contains the old stack pointer, or 2) an ISR routine
9588 corrupted it, or 3) it was saved to align the stack on
9589 iWMMXt. In case 1, restore IP into SP, otherwise just
9590 restore IP. */
9591 if (frame_pointer_needed)
9592 {
9593 live_regs_mask &= ~ (1 << IP_REGNUM);
9594 live_regs_mask |= (1 << SP_REGNUM);
9595 }
9596 else
9597 gcc_assert (IS_INTERRUPT (func_type) || TARGET_REALLY_IWMMXT);
9598 }
9599
9600 /* On some ARM architectures it is faster to use LDR rather than
9601 LDM to load a single register. On other architectures, the
9602 cost is the same. In 26 bit mode, or for exception handlers,
9603 we have to use LDM to load the PC so that the CPSR is also
9604 restored. */
9605 for (reg = 0; reg <= LAST_ARM_REGNUM; reg++)
9606 if (live_regs_mask == (1U << reg))
9607 break;
9608
9609 if (reg <= LAST_ARM_REGNUM
9610 && (reg != LR_REGNUM
9611 || ! really_return
9612 || ! IS_INTERRUPT (func_type)))
9613 {
9614 sprintf (instr, "ldr%s\t%%|%s, [%%|sp], #4", conditional,
9615 (reg == LR_REGNUM) ? return_reg : reg_names[reg]);
9616 }
9617 else
9618 {
9619 char *p;
9620 int first = 1;
9621
9622 /* Generate the load multiple instruction to restore the
9623 registers. Note we can get here, even if
9624 frame_pointer_needed is true, but only if sp already
9625 points to the base of the saved core registers. */
9626 if (live_regs_mask & (1 << SP_REGNUM))
9627 {
9628 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust;
9629
9630 offsets = arm_get_frame_offsets ();
9631 stack_adjust = offsets->outgoing_args - offsets->saved_regs;
9632 gcc_assert (stack_adjust == 0 || stack_adjust == 4);
9633
9634 if (stack_adjust && arm_arch5)
9635 sprintf (instr, "ldm%sib\t%%|sp, {", conditional);
9636 else
9637 {
9638 /* If we can't use ldmib (SA110 bug),
9639 then try to pop r3 instead. */
9640 if (stack_adjust)
9641 live_regs_mask |= 1 << 3;
9642 sprintf (instr, "ldm%sfd\t%%|sp, {", conditional);
9643 }
9644 }
9645 else
9646 sprintf (instr, "ldm%sfd\t%%|sp!, {", conditional);
9647
9648 p = instr + strlen (instr);
9649
9650 for (reg = 0; reg <= SP_REGNUM; reg++)
9651 if (live_regs_mask & (1 << reg))
9652 {
9653 int l = strlen (reg_names[reg]);
9654
9655 if (first)
9656 first = 0;
9657 else
9658 {
9659 memcpy (p, ", ", 2);
9660 p += 2;
9661 }
9662
9663 memcpy (p, "%|", 2);
9664 memcpy (p + 2, reg_names[reg], l);
9665 p += l + 2;
9666 }
9667
9668 if (live_regs_mask & (1 << LR_REGNUM))
9669 {
9670 sprintf (p, "%s%%|%s}", first ? "" : ", ", return_reg);
9671 /* If returning from an interrupt, restore the CPSR. */
9672 if (IS_INTERRUPT (func_type))
9673 strcat (p, "^");
9674 }
9675 else
9676 strcpy (p, "}");
9677 }
9678
9679 output_asm_insn (instr, & operand);
9680
9681 /* See if we need to generate an extra instruction to
9682 perform the actual function return. */
9683 if (really_return
9684 && func_type != ARM_FT_INTERWORKED
9685 && (live_regs_mask & (1 << LR_REGNUM)) != 0)
9686 {
9687 /* The return has already been handled
9688 by loading the LR into the PC. */
9689 really_return = 0;
9690 }
9691 }
9692
9693 if (really_return)
9694 {
9695 switch ((int) ARM_FUNC_TYPE (func_type))
9696 {
9697 case ARM_FT_ISR:
9698 case ARM_FT_FIQ:
9699 sprintf (instr, "sub%ss\t%%|pc, %%|lr, #4", conditional);
9700 break;
9701
9702 case ARM_FT_INTERWORKED:
9703 sprintf (instr, "bx%s\t%%|lr", conditional);
9704 break;
9705
9706 case ARM_FT_EXCEPTION:
9707 sprintf (instr, "mov%ss\t%%|pc, %%|lr", conditional);
9708 break;
9709
9710 default:
9711 /* Use bx if it's available. */
9712 if (arm_arch5 || arm_arch4t)
9713 sprintf (instr, "bx%s\t%%|lr", conditional);
9714 else
9715 sprintf (instr, "mov%s\t%%|pc, %%|lr", conditional);
9716 break;
9717 }
9718
9719 output_asm_insn (instr, & operand);
9720 }
9721
9722 return "";
9723 }
9724
9725 /* Write the function name into the code section, directly preceding
9726 the function prologue.
9727
9728 Code will be output similar to this:
9729 t0
9730 .ascii "arm_poke_function_name", 0
9731 .align
9732 t1
9733 .word 0xff000000 + (t1 - t0)
9734 arm_poke_function_name
9735 mov ip, sp
9736 stmfd sp!, {fp, ip, lr, pc}
9737 sub fp, ip, #4
9738
9739 When performing a stack backtrace, code can inspect the value
9740 of 'pc' stored at 'fp' + 0. If the trace function then looks
9741 at location pc - 12 and the top 8 bits are set, then we know
9742 that there is a function name embedded immediately preceding this
9743 location and has length ((pc[-3]) & 0xff000000).
9744
9745 We assume that pc is declared as a pointer to an unsigned long.
9746
9747 It is of no benefit to output the function name if we are assembling
9748 a leaf function. These function types will not contain a stack
9749 backtrace structure, therefore it is not possible to determine the
9750 function name. */
9751 void
arm_poke_function_name(FILE * stream,const char * name)9752 arm_poke_function_name (FILE *stream, const char *name)
9753 {
9754 unsigned long alignlength;
9755 unsigned long length;
9756 rtx x;
9757
9758 length = strlen (name) + 1;
9759 alignlength = ROUND_UP_WORD (length);
9760
9761 ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (stream, name, length);
9762 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (stream, 2);
9763 x = GEN_INT ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0xff000000 + alignlength);
9764 assemble_aligned_integer (UNITS_PER_WORD, x);
9765 }
9766
9767 /* Place some comments into the assembler stream
9768 describing the current function. */
9769 static void
arm_output_function_prologue(FILE * f,HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size)9770 arm_output_function_prologue (FILE *f, HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size)
9771 {
9772 unsigned long func_type;
9773
9774 if (!TARGET_ARM)
9775 {
9776 thumb_output_function_prologue (f, frame_size);
9777 return;
9778 }
9779
9780 /* Sanity check. */
9781 gcc_assert (!arm_ccfsm_state && !arm_target_insn);
9782
9783 func_type = arm_current_func_type ();
9784
9785 switch ((int) ARM_FUNC_TYPE (func_type))
9786 {
9787 default:
9788 case ARM_FT_NORMAL:
9789 break;
9790 case ARM_FT_INTERWORKED:
9791 asm_fprintf (f, "\t%@ Function supports interworking.\n");
9792 break;
9793 case ARM_FT_ISR:
9794 asm_fprintf (f, "\t%@ Interrupt Service Routine.\n");
9795 break;
9796 case ARM_FT_FIQ:
9797 asm_fprintf (f, "\t%@ Fast Interrupt Service Routine.\n");
9798 break;
9799 case ARM_FT_EXCEPTION:
9800 asm_fprintf (f, "\t%@ ARM Exception Handler.\n");
9801 break;
9802 }
9803
9804 if (IS_NAKED (func_type))
9805 asm_fprintf (f, "\t%@ Naked Function: prologue and epilogue provided by programmer.\n");
9806
9807 if (IS_VOLATILE (func_type))
9808 asm_fprintf (f, "\t%@ Volatile: function does not return.\n");
9809
9810 if (IS_NESTED (func_type))
9811 asm_fprintf (f, "\t%@ Nested: function declared inside another function.\n");
9812
9813 asm_fprintf (f, "\t%@ args = %d, pretend = %d, frame = %wd\n",
9814 current_function_args_size,
9815 current_function_pretend_args_size, frame_size);
9816
9817 asm_fprintf (f, "\t%@ frame_needed = %d, uses_anonymous_args = %d\n",
9818 frame_pointer_needed,
9819 cfun->machine->uses_anonymous_args);
9820
9821 if (cfun->machine->lr_save_eliminated)
9822 asm_fprintf (f, "\t%@ link register save eliminated.\n");
9823
9824 if (current_function_calls_eh_return)
9825 asm_fprintf (f, "\t@ Calls __builtin_eh_return.\n");
9826
9827 #ifdef AOF_ASSEMBLER
9828 if (flag_pic)
9829 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", IP_REGNUM, PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM);
9830 #endif
9831
9832 return_used_this_function = 0;
9833 }
9834
9835 const char *
arm_output_epilogue(rtx sibling)9836 arm_output_epilogue (rtx sibling)
9837 {
9838 int reg;
9839 unsigned long saved_regs_mask;
9840 unsigned long func_type;
9841 /* Floats_offset is the offset from the "virtual" frame. In an APCS
9842 frame that is $fp + 4 for a non-variadic function. */
9843 int floats_offset = 0;
9844 rtx operands[3];
9845 FILE * f = asm_out_file;
9846 unsigned int lrm_count = 0;
9847 int really_return = (sibling == NULL);
9848 int start_reg;
9849 arm_stack_offsets *offsets;
9850
9851 /* If we have already generated the return instruction
9852 then it is futile to generate anything else. */
9853 if (use_return_insn (FALSE, sibling) && return_used_this_function)
9854 return "";
9855
9856 func_type = arm_current_func_type ();
9857
9858 if (IS_NAKED (func_type))
9859 /* Naked functions don't have epilogues. */
9860 return "";
9861
9862 if (IS_VOLATILE (func_type) && TARGET_ABORT_NORETURN)
9863 {
9864 rtx op;
9865
9866 /* A volatile function should never return. Call abort. */
9867 op = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, NEED_PLT_RELOC ? "abort(PLT)" : "abort");
9868 assemble_external_libcall (op);
9869 output_asm_insn ("bl\t%a0", &op);
9870
9871 return "";
9872 }
9873
9874 /* If we are throwing an exception, then we really must be doing a
9875 return, so we can't tail-call. */
9876 gcc_assert (!current_function_calls_eh_return || really_return);
9877
9878 offsets = arm_get_frame_offsets ();
9879 saved_regs_mask = arm_compute_save_reg_mask ();
9880
9881 if (TARGET_IWMMXT)
9882 lrm_count = bit_count (saved_regs_mask);
9883
9884 floats_offset = offsets->saved_args;
9885 /* Compute how far away the floats will be. */
9886 for (reg = 0; reg <= LAST_ARM_REGNUM; reg++)
9887 if (saved_regs_mask & (1 << reg))
9888 floats_offset += 4;
9889
9890 if (frame_pointer_needed)
9891 {
9892 /* This variable is for the Virtual Frame Pointer, not VFP regs. */
9893 int vfp_offset = offsets->frame;
9894
9895 if (arm_fpu_arch == FPUTYPE_FPA_EMU2)
9896 {
9897 for (reg = LAST_FPA_REGNUM; reg >= FIRST_FPA_REGNUM; reg--)
9898 if (regs_ever_live[reg] && !call_used_regs[reg])
9899 {
9900 floats_offset += 12;
9901 asm_fprintf (f, "\tldfe\t%r, [%r, #-%d]\n",
9902 reg, FP_REGNUM, floats_offset - vfp_offset);
9903 }
9904 }
9905 else
9906 {
9907 start_reg = LAST_FPA_REGNUM;
9908
9909 for (reg = LAST_FPA_REGNUM; reg >= FIRST_FPA_REGNUM; reg--)
9910 {
9911 if (regs_ever_live[reg] && !call_used_regs[reg])
9912 {
9913 floats_offset += 12;
9914
9915 /* We can't unstack more than four registers at once. */
9916 if (start_reg - reg == 3)
9917 {
9918 asm_fprintf (f, "\tlfm\t%r, 4, [%r, #-%d]\n",
9919 reg, FP_REGNUM, floats_offset - vfp_offset);
9920 start_reg = reg - 1;
9921 }
9922 }
9923 else
9924 {
9925 if (reg != start_reg)
9926 asm_fprintf (f, "\tlfm\t%r, %d, [%r, #-%d]\n",
9927 reg + 1, start_reg - reg,
9928 FP_REGNUM, floats_offset - vfp_offset);
9929 start_reg = reg - 1;
9930 }
9931 }
9932
9933 /* Just in case the last register checked also needs unstacking. */
9934 if (reg != start_reg)
9935 asm_fprintf (f, "\tlfm\t%r, %d, [%r, #-%d]\n",
9936 reg + 1, start_reg - reg,
9937 FP_REGNUM, floats_offset - vfp_offset);
9938 }
9939
9940 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && TARGET_VFP)
9941 {
9942 int saved_size;
9943
9944 /* The fldmx insn does not have base+offset addressing modes,
9945 so we use IP to hold the address. */
9946 saved_size = arm_get_vfp_saved_size ();
9947
9948 if (saved_size > 0)
9949 {
9950 floats_offset += saved_size;
9951 asm_fprintf (f, "\tsub\t%r, %r, #%d\n", IP_REGNUM,
9952 FP_REGNUM, floats_offset - vfp_offset);
9953 }
9954 start_reg = FIRST_VFP_REGNUM;
9955 for (reg = FIRST_VFP_REGNUM; reg < LAST_VFP_REGNUM; reg += 2)
9956 {
9957 if ((!regs_ever_live[reg] || call_used_regs[reg])
9958 && (!regs_ever_live[reg + 1] || call_used_regs[reg + 1]))
9959 {
9960 if (start_reg != reg)
9961 arm_output_fldmx (f, IP_REGNUM,
9962 (start_reg - FIRST_VFP_REGNUM) / 2,
9963 (reg - start_reg) / 2);
9964 start_reg = reg + 2;
9965 }
9966 }
9967 if (start_reg != reg)
9968 arm_output_fldmx (f, IP_REGNUM,
9969 (start_reg - FIRST_VFP_REGNUM) / 2,
9970 (reg - start_reg) / 2);
9971 }
9972
9973 if (TARGET_IWMMXT)
9974 {
9975 /* The frame pointer is guaranteed to be non-double-word aligned.
9976 This is because it is set to (old_stack_pointer - 4) and the
9977 old_stack_pointer was double word aligned. Thus the offset to
9978 the iWMMXt registers to be loaded must also be non-double-word
9979 sized, so that the resultant address *is* double-word aligned.
9980 We can ignore floats_offset since that was already included in
9981 the live_regs_mask. */
9982 lrm_count += (lrm_count % 2 ? 2 : 1);
9983
9984 for (reg = LAST_IWMMXT_REGNUM; reg >= FIRST_IWMMXT_REGNUM; reg--)
9985 if (regs_ever_live[reg] && !call_used_regs[reg])
9986 {
9987 asm_fprintf (f, "\twldrd\t%r, [%r, #-%d]\n",
9988 reg, FP_REGNUM, lrm_count * 4);
9989 lrm_count += 2;
9990 }
9991 }
9992
9993 /* saved_regs_mask should contain the IP, which at the time of stack
9994 frame generation actually contains the old stack pointer. So a
9995 quick way to unwind the stack is just pop the IP register directly
9996 into the stack pointer. */
9997 gcc_assert (saved_regs_mask & (1 << IP_REGNUM));
9998 saved_regs_mask &= ~ (1 << IP_REGNUM);
9999 saved_regs_mask |= (1 << SP_REGNUM);
10000
10001 /* There are two registers left in saved_regs_mask - LR and PC. We
10002 only need to restore the LR register (the return address), but to
10003 save time we can load it directly into the PC, unless we need a
10004 special function exit sequence, or we are not really returning. */
10005 if (really_return
10006 && ARM_FUNC_TYPE (func_type) == ARM_FT_NORMAL
10007 && !current_function_calls_eh_return)
10008 /* Delete the LR from the register mask, so that the LR on
10009 the stack is loaded into the PC in the register mask. */
10010 saved_regs_mask &= ~ (1 << LR_REGNUM);
10011 else
10012 saved_regs_mask &= ~ (1 << PC_REGNUM);
10013
10014 /* We must use SP as the base register, because SP is one of the
10015 registers being restored. If an interrupt or page fault
10016 happens in the ldm instruction, the SP might or might not
10017 have been restored. That would be bad, as then SP will no
10018 longer indicate the safe area of stack, and we can get stack
10019 corruption. Using SP as the base register means that it will
10020 be reset correctly to the original value, should an interrupt
10021 occur. If the stack pointer already points at the right
10022 place, then omit the subtraction. */
10023 if (offsets->outgoing_args != (1 + (int) bit_count (saved_regs_mask))
10024 || current_function_calls_alloca)
10025 asm_fprintf (f, "\tsub\t%r, %r, #%d\n", SP_REGNUM, FP_REGNUM,
10026 4 * bit_count (saved_regs_mask));
10027 print_multi_reg (f, "ldmfd\t%r", SP_REGNUM, saved_regs_mask);
10028
10029 if (IS_INTERRUPT (func_type))
10030 /* Interrupt handlers will have pushed the
10031 IP onto the stack, so restore it now. */
10032 print_multi_reg (f, "ldmfd\t%r!", SP_REGNUM, 1 << IP_REGNUM);
10033 }
10034 else
10035 {
10036 /* Restore stack pointer if necessary. */
10037 if (offsets->outgoing_args != offsets->saved_regs)
10038 {
10039 operands[0] = operands[1] = stack_pointer_rtx;
10040 operands[2] = GEN_INT (offsets->outgoing_args - offsets->saved_regs);
10041 output_add_immediate (operands);
10042 }
10043
10044 if (arm_fpu_arch == FPUTYPE_FPA_EMU2)
10045 {
10046 for (reg = FIRST_FPA_REGNUM; reg <= LAST_FPA_REGNUM; reg++)
10047 if (regs_ever_live[reg] && !call_used_regs[reg])
10048 asm_fprintf (f, "\tldfe\t%r, [%r], #12\n",
10049 reg, SP_REGNUM);
10050 }
10051 else
10052 {
10053 start_reg = FIRST_FPA_REGNUM;
10054
10055 for (reg = FIRST_FPA_REGNUM; reg <= LAST_FPA_REGNUM; reg++)
10056 {
10057 if (regs_ever_live[reg] && !call_used_regs[reg])
10058 {
10059 if (reg - start_reg == 3)
10060 {
10061 asm_fprintf (f, "\tlfmfd\t%r, 4, [%r]!\n",
10062 start_reg, SP_REGNUM);
10063 start_reg = reg + 1;
10064 }
10065 }
10066 else
10067 {
10068 if (reg != start_reg)
10069 asm_fprintf (f, "\tlfmfd\t%r, %d, [%r]!\n",
10070 start_reg, reg - start_reg,
10071 SP_REGNUM);
10072
10073 start_reg = reg + 1;
10074 }
10075 }
10076
10077 /* Just in case the last register checked also needs unstacking. */
10078 if (reg != start_reg)
10079 asm_fprintf (f, "\tlfmfd\t%r, %d, [%r]!\n",
10080 start_reg, reg - start_reg, SP_REGNUM);
10081 }
10082
10083 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && TARGET_VFP)
10084 {
10085 start_reg = FIRST_VFP_REGNUM;
10086 for (reg = FIRST_VFP_REGNUM; reg < LAST_VFP_REGNUM; reg += 2)
10087 {
10088 if ((!regs_ever_live[reg] || call_used_regs[reg])
10089 && (!regs_ever_live[reg + 1] || call_used_regs[reg + 1]))
10090 {
10091 if (start_reg != reg)
10092 arm_output_fldmx (f, SP_REGNUM,
10093 (start_reg - FIRST_VFP_REGNUM) / 2,
10094 (reg - start_reg) / 2);
10095 start_reg = reg + 2;
10096 }
10097 }
10098 if (start_reg != reg)
10099 arm_output_fldmx (f, SP_REGNUM,
10100 (start_reg - FIRST_VFP_REGNUM) / 2,
10101 (reg - start_reg) / 2);
10102 }
10103 if (TARGET_IWMMXT)
10104 for (reg = FIRST_IWMMXT_REGNUM; reg <= LAST_IWMMXT_REGNUM; reg++)
10105 if (regs_ever_live[reg] && !call_used_regs[reg])
10106 asm_fprintf (f, "\twldrd\t%r, [%r], #8\n", reg, SP_REGNUM);
10107
10108 /* If we can, restore the LR into the PC. */
10109 if (ARM_FUNC_TYPE (func_type) == ARM_FT_NORMAL
10110 && really_return
10111 && current_function_pretend_args_size == 0
10112 && saved_regs_mask & (1 << LR_REGNUM)
10113 && !current_function_calls_eh_return)
10114 {
10115 saved_regs_mask &= ~ (1 << LR_REGNUM);
10116 saved_regs_mask |= (1 << PC_REGNUM);
10117 }
10118
10119 /* Load the registers off the stack. If we only have one register
10120 to load use the LDR instruction - it is faster. */
10121 if (saved_regs_mask == (1 << LR_REGNUM))
10122 {
10123 asm_fprintf (f, "\tldr\t%r, [%r], #4\n", LR_REGNUM, SP_REGNUM);
10124 }
10125 else if (saved_regs_mask)
10126 {
10127 if (saved_regs_mask & (1 << SP_REGNUM))
10128 /* Note - write back to the stack register is not enabled
10129 (i.e. "ldmfd sp!..."). We know that the stack pointer is
10130 in the list of registers and if we add writeback the
10131 instruction becomes UNPREDICTABLE. */
10132 print_multi_reg (f, "ldmfd\t%r", SP_REGNUM, saved_regs_mask);
10133 else
10134 print_multi_reg (f, "ldmfd\t%r!", SP_REGNUM, saved_regs_mask);
10135 }
10136
10137 if (current_function_pretend_args_size)
10138 {
10139 /* Unwind the pre-pushed regs. */
10140 operands[0] = operands[1] = stack_pointer_rtx;
10141 operands[2] = GEN_INT (current_function_pretend_args_size);
10142 output_add_immediate (operands);
10143 }
10144 }
10145
10146 /* We may have already restored PC directly from the stack. */
10147 if (!really_return || saved_regs_mask & (1 << PC_REGNUM))
10148 return "";
10149
10150 /* Stack adjustment for exception handler. */
10151 if (current_function_calls_eh_return)
10152 asm_fprintf (f, "\tadd\t%r, %r, %r\n", SP_REGNUM, SP_REGNUM,
10153 ARM_EH_STACKADJ_REGNUM);
10154
10155 /* Generate the return instruction. */
10156 switch ((int) ARM_FUNC_TYPE (func_type))
10157 {
10158 case ARM_FT_ISR:
10159 case ARM_FT_FIQ:
10160 asm_fprintf (f, "\tsubs\t%r, %r, #4\n", PC_REGNUM, LR_REGNUM);
10161 break;
10162
10163 case ARM_FT_EXCEPTION:
10164 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmovs\t%r, %r\n", PC_REGNUM, LR_REGNUM);
10165 break;
10166
10167 case ARM_FT_INTERWORKED:
10168 asm_fprintf (f, "\tbx\t%r\n", LR_REGNUM);
10169 break;
10170
10171 default:
10172 if (arm_arch5 || arm_arch4t)
10173 asm_fprintf (f, "\tbx\t%r\n", LR_REGNUM);
10174 else
10175 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", PC_REGNUM, LR_REGNUM);
10176 break;
10177 }
10178
10179 return "";
10180 }
10181
10182 static void
arm_output_function_epilogue(FILE * file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)10183 arm_output_function_epilogue (FILE *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10184 HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10185 {
10186 arm_stack_offsets *offsets;
10187
10188 if (TARGET_THUMB)
10189 {
10190 int regno;
10191
10192 /* Emit any call-via-reg trampolines that are needed for v4t support
10193 of call_reg and call_value_reg type insns. */
10194 for (regno = 0; regno < LR_REGNUM; regno++)
10195 {
10196 rtx label = cfun->machine->call_via[regno];
10197
10198 if (label != NULL)
10199 {
10200 switch_to_section (function_section (current_function_decl));
10201 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, "L",
10202 CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (label));
10203 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tbx\t%r\n", regno);
10204 }
10205 }
10206
10207 /* ??? Probably not safe to set this here, since it assumes that a
10208 function will be emitted as assembly immediately after we generate
10209 RTL for it. This does not happen for inline functions. */
10210 return_used_this_function = 0;
10211 }
10212 else
10213 {
10214 /* We need to take into account any stack-frame rounding. */
10215 offsets = arm_get_frame_offsets ();
10216
10217 gcc_assert (!use_return_insn (FALSE, NULL)
10218 || !return_used_this_function
10219 || offsets->saved_regs == offsets->outgoing_args
10220 || frame_pointer_needed);
10221
10222 /* Reset the ARM-specific per-function variables. */
10223 after_arm_reorg = 0;
10224 }
10225 }
10226
10227 /* Generate and emit an insn that we will recognize as a push_multi.
10228 Unfortunately, since this insn does not reflect very well the actual
10229 semantics of the operation, we need to annotate the insn for the benefit
10230 of DWARF2 frame unwind information. */
10231 static rtx
emit_multi_reg_push(unsigned long mask)10232 emit_multi_reg_push (unsigned long mask)
10233 {
10234 int num_regs = 0;
10235 int num_dwarf_regs;
10236 int i, j;
10237 rtx par;
10238 rtx dwarf;
10239 int dwarf_par_index;
10240 rtx tmp, reg;
10241
10242 for (i = 0; i <= LAST_ARM_REGNUM; i++)
10243 if (mask & (1 << i))
10244 num_regs++;
10245
10246 gcc_assert (num_regs && num_regs <= 16);
10247
10248 /* We don't record the PC in the dwarf frame information. */
10249 num_dwarf_regs = num_regs;
10250 if (mask & (1 << PC_REGNUM))
10251 num_dwarf_regs--;
10252
10253 /* For the body of the insn we are going to generate an UNSPEC in
10254 parallel with several USEs. This allows the insn to be recognized
10255 by the push_multi pattern in the arm.md file. The insn looks
10256 something like this:
10257
10258 (parallel [
10259 (set (mem:BLK (pre_dec:BLK (reg:SI sp)))
10260 (unspec:BLK [(reg:SI r4)] UNSPEC_PUSH_MULT))
10261 (use (reg:SI 11 fp))
10262 (use (reg:SI 12 ip))
10263 (use (reg:SI 14 lr))
10264 (use (reg:SI 15 pc))
10265 ])
10266
10267 For the frame note however, we try to be more explicit and actually
10268 show each register being stored into the stack frame, plus a (single)
10269 decrement of the stack pointer. We do it this way in order to be
10270 friendly to the stack unwinding code, which only wants to see a single
10271 stack decrement per instruction. The RTL we generate for the note looks
10272 something like this:
10273
10274 (sequence [
10275 (set (reg:SI sp) (plus:SI (reg:SI sp) (const_int -20)))
10276 (set (mem:SI (reg:SI sp)) (reg:SI r4))
10277 (set (mem:SI (plus:SI (reg:SI sp) (const_int 4))) (reg:SI fp))
10278 (set (mem:SI (plus:SI (reg:SI sp) (const_int 8))) (reg:SI ip))
10279 (set (mem:SI (plus:SI (reg:SI sp) (const_int 12))) (reg:SI lr))
10280 ])
10281
10282 This sequence is used both by the code to support stack unwinding for
10283 exceptions handlers and the code to generate dwarf2 frame debugging. */
10284
10285 par = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, rtvec_alloc (num_regs));
10286 dwarf = gen_rtx_SEQUENCE (VOIDmode, rtvec_alloc (num_dwarf_regs + 1));
10287 dwarf_par_index = 1;
10288
10289 for (i = 0; i <= LAST_ARM_REGNUM; i++)
10290 {
10291 if (mask & (1 << i))
10292 {
10293 reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, i);
10294
10295 XVECEXP (par, 0, 0)
10296 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
10297 gen_frame_mem (BLKmode,
10298 gen_rtx_PRE_DEC (BLKmode,
10299 stack_pointer_rtx)),
10300 gen_rtx_UNSPEC (BLKmode,
10301 gen_rtvec (1, reg),
10302 UNSPEC_PUSH_MULT));
10303
10304 if (i != PC_REGNUM)
10305 {
10306 tmp = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
10307 gen_frame_mem (SImode, stack_pointer_rtx),
10308 reg);
10309 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (tmp) = 1;
10310 XVECEXP (dwarf, 0, dwarf_par_index) = tmp;
10311 dwarf_par_index++;
10312 }
10313
10314 break;
10315 }
10316 }
10317
10318 for (j = 1, i++; j < num_regs; i++)
10319 {
10320 if (mask & (1 << i))
10321 {
10322 reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, i);
10323
10324 XVECEXP (par, 0, j) = gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg);
10325
10326 if (i != PC_REGNUM)
10327 {
10328 tmp
10329 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
10330 gen_frame_mem (SImode,
10331 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx,
10332 4 * j)),
10333 reg);
10334 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (tmp) = 1;
10335 XVECEXP (dwarf, 0, dwarf_par_index++) = tmp;
10336 }
10337
10338 j++;
10339 }
10340 }
10341
10342 par = emit_insn (par);
10343
10344 tmp = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
10345 stack_pointer_rtx,
10346 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, -4 * num_regs));
10347 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (tmp) = 1;
10348 XVECEXP (dwarf, 0, 0) = tmp;
10349
10350 REG_NOTES (par) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, dwarf,
10351 REG_NOTES (par));
10352 return par;
10353 }
10354
10355 /* Calculate the size of the return value that is passed in registers. */
10356 static int
arm_size_return_regs(void)10357 arm_size_return_regs (void)
10358 {
10359 enum machine_mode mode;
10360
10361 if (current_function_return_rtx != 0)
10362 mode = GET_MODE (current_function_return_rtx);
10363 else
10364 mode = DECL_MODE (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl));
10365
10366 return GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
10367 }
10368
10369 static rtx
emit_sfm(int base_reg,int count)10370 emit_sfm (int base_reg, int count)
10371 {
10372 rtx par;
10373 rtx dwarf;
10374 rtx tmp, reg;
10375 int i;
10376
10377 par = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, rtvec_alloc (count));
10378 dwarf = gen_rtx_SEQUENCE (VOIDmode, rtvec_alloc (count + 1));
10379
10380 reg = gen_rtx_REG (XFmode, base_reg++);
10381
10382 XVECEXP (par, 0, 0)
10383 = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
10384 gen_frame_mem (BLKmode,
10385 gen_rtx_PRE_DEC (BLKmode,
10386 stack_pointer_rtx)),
10387 gen_rtx_UNSPEC (BLKmode,
10388 gen_rtvec (1, reg),
10389 UNSPEC_PUSH_MULT));
10390 tmp = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
10391 gen_frame_mem (XFmode, stack_pointer_rtx), reg);
10392 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (tmp) = 1;
10393 XVECEXP (dwarf, 0, 1) = tmp;
10394
10395 for (i = 1; i < count; i++)
10396 {
10397 reg = gen_rtx_REG (XFmode, base_reg++);
10398 XVECEXP (par, 0, i) = gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg);
10399
10400 tmp = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
10401 gen_frame_mem (XFmode,
10402 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx,
10403 i * 12)),
10404 reg);
10405 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (tmp) = 1;
10406 XVECEXP (dwarf, 0, i + 1) = tmp;
10407 }
10408
10409 tmp = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode,
10410 stack_pointer_rtx,
10411 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, -12 * count));
10412
10413 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (tmp) = 1;
10414 XVECEXP (dwarf, 0, 0) = tmp;
10415
10416 par = emit_insn (par);
10417 REG_NOTES (par) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, dwarf,
10418 REG_NOTES (par));
10419 return par;
10420 }
10421
10422
10423 /* Return true if the current function needs to save/restore LR. */
10424
10425 static bool
thumb_force_lr_save(void)10426 thumb_force_lr_save (void)
10427 {
10428 return !cfun->machine->lr_save_eliminated
10429 && (!leaf_function_p ()
10430 || thumb_far_jump_used_p ()
10431 || regs_ever_live [LR_REGNUM]);
10432 }
10433
10434
10435 /* Compute the distance from register FROM to register TO.
10436 These can be the arg pointer (26), the soft frame pointer (25),
10437 the stack pointer (13) or the hard frame pointer (11).
10438 In thumb mode r7 is used as the soft frame pointer, if needed.
10439 Typical stack layout looks like this:
10440
10441 old stack pointer -> | |
10442 ----
10443 | | \
10444 | | saved arguments for
10445 | | vararg functions
10446 | | /
10447 --
10448 hard FP & arg pointer -> | | \
10449 | | stack
10450 | | frame
10451 | | /
10452 --
10453 | | \
10454 | | call saved
10455 | | registers
10456 soft frame pointer -> | | /
10457 --
10458 | | \
10459 | | local
10460 | | variables
10461 locals base pointer -> | | /
10462 --
10463 | | \
10464 | | outgoing
10465 | | arguments
10466 current stack pointer -> | | /
10467 --
10468
10469 For a given function some or all of these stack components
10470 may not be needed, giving rise to the possibility of
10471 eliminating some of the registers.
10472
10473 The values returned by this function must reflect the behavior
10474 of arm_expand_prologue() and arm_compute_save_reg_mask().
10475
10476 The sign of the number returned reflects the direction of stack
10477 growth, so the values are positive for all eliminations except
10478 from the soft frame pointer to the hard frame pointer.
10479
10480 SFP may point just inside the local variables block to ensure correct
10481 alignment. */
10482
10483
10484 /* Calculate stack offsets. These are used to calculate register elimination
10485 offsets and in prologue/epilogue code. */
10486
10487 static arm_stack_offsets *
arm_get_frame_offsets(void)10488 arm_get_frame_offsets (void)
10489 {
10490 struct arm_stack_offsets *offsets;
10491 unsigned long func_type;
10492 int leaf;
10493 int saved;
10494 HOST_WIDE_INT frame_size;
10495
10496 offsets = &cfun->machine->stack_offsets;
10497
10498 /* We need to know if we are a leaf function. Unfortunately, it
10499 is possible to be called after start_sequence has been called,
10500 which causes get_insns to return the insns for the sequence,
10501 not the function, which will cause leaf_function_p to return
10502 the incorrect result.
10503
10504 to know about leaf functions once reload has completed, and the
10505 frame size cannot be changed after that time, so we can safely
10506 use the cached value. */
10507
10508 if (reload_completed)
10509 return offsets;
10510
10511 /* Initially this is the size of the local variables. It will translated
10512 into an offset once we have determined the size of preceding data. */
10513 frame_size = ROUND_UP_WORD (get_frame_size ());
10514
10515 leaf = leaf_function_p ();
10516
10517 /* Space for variadic functions. */
10518 offsets->saved_args = current_function_pretend_args_size;
10519
10520 offsets->frame = offsets->saved_args + (frame_pointer_needed ? 4 : 0);
10521
10522 if (TARGET_ARM)
10523 {
10524 unsigned int regno;
10525
10526 saved = bit_count (arm_compute_save_reg_mask ()) * 4;
10527
10528 /* We know that SP will be doubleword aligned on entry, and we must
10529 preserve that condition at any subroutine call. We also require the
10530 soft frame pointer to be doubleword aligned. */
10531
10532 if (TARGET_REALLY_IWMMXT)
10533 {
10534 /* Check for the call-saved iWMMXt registers. */
10535 for (regno = FIRST_IWMMXT_REGNUM;
10536 regno <= LAST_IWMMXT_REGNUM;
10537 regno++)
10538 if (regs_ever_live [regno] && ! call_used_regs [regno])
10539 saved += 8;
10540 }
10541
10542 func_type = arm_current_func_type ();
10543 if (! IS_VOLATILE (func_type))
10544 {
10545 /* Space for saved FPA registers. */
10546 for (regno = FIRST_FPA_REGNUM; regno <= LAST_FPA_REGNUM; regno++)
10547 if (regs_ever_live[regno] && ! call_used_regs[regno])
10548 saved += 12;
10549
10550 /* Space for saved VFP registers. */
10551 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && TARGET_VFP)
10552 saved += arm_get_vfp_saved_size ();
10553 }
10554 }
10555 else /* TARGET_THUMB */
10556 {
10557 saved = bit_count (thumb_compute_save_reg_mask ()) * 4;
10558 if (TARGET_BACKTRACE)
10559 saved += 16;
10560 }
10561
10562 /* Saved registers include the stack frame. */
10563 offsets->saved_regs = offsets->saved_args + saved;
10564 offsets->soft_frame = offsets->saved_regs + CALLER_INTERWORKING_SLOT_SIZE;
10565 /* A leaf function does not need any stack alignment if it has nothing
10566 on the stack. */
10567 if (leaf && frame_size == 0)
10568 {
10569 offsets->outgoing_args = offsets->soft_frame;
10570 offsets->locals_base = offsets->soft_frame;
10571 return offsets;
10572 }
10573
10574 /* Ensure SFP has the correct alignment. */
10575 if (ARM_DOUBLEWORD_ALIGN
10576 && (offsets->soft_frame & 7))
10577 offsets->soft_frame += 4;
10578
10579 offsets->locals_base = offsets->soft_frame + frame_size;
10580 offsets->outgoing_args = (offsets->locals_base
10581 + current_function_outgoing_args_size);
10582
10583 if (ARM_DOUBLEWORD_ALIGN)
10584 {
10585 /* Ensure SP remains doubleword aligned. */
10586 if (offsets->outgoing_args & 7)
10587 offsets->outgoing_args += 4;
10588 gcc_assert (!(offsets->outgoing_args & 7));
10589 }
10590
10591 return offsets;
10592 }
10593
10594
10595 /* Calculate the relative offsets for the different stack pointers. Positive
10596 offsets are in the direction of stack growth. */
10597
10598 HOST_WIDE_INT
arm_compute_initial_elimination_offset(unsigned int from,unsigned int to)10599 arm_compute_initial_elimination_offset (unsigned int from, unsigned int to)
10600 {
10601 arm_stack_offsets *offsets;
10602
10603 offsets = arm_get_frame_offsets ();
10604
10605 /* OK, now we have enough information to compute the distances.
10606 There must be an entry in these switch tables for each pair
10607 of registers in ELIMINABLE_REGS, even if some of the entries
10608 seem to be redundant or useless. */
10609 switch (from)
10610 {
10611 case ARG_POINTER_REGNUM:
10612 switch (to)
10613 {
10614 case THUMB_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
10615 return 0;
10616
10617 case FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
10618 /* This is the reverse of the soft frame pointer
10619 to hard frame pointer elimination below. */
10620 return offsets->soft_frame - offsets->saved_args;
10621
10622 case ARM_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
10623 /* If there is no stack frame then the hard
10624 frame pointer and the arg pointer coincide. */
10625 if (offsets->frame == offsets->saved_regs)
10626 return 0;
10627 /* FIXME: Not sure about this. Maybe we should always return 0 ? */
10628 return (frame_pointer_needed
10629 && cfun->static_chain_decl != NULL
10630 && ! cfun->machine->uses_anonymous_args) ? 4 : 0;
10631
10632 case STACK_POINTER_REGNUM:
10633 /* If nothing has been pushed on the stack at all
10634 then this will return -4. This *is* correct! */
10635 return offsets->outgoing_args - (offsets->saved_args + 4);
10636
10637 default:
10638 gcc_unreachable ();
10639 }
10640 gcc_unreachable ();
10641
10642 case FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
10643 switch (to)
10644 {
10645 case THUMB_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
10646 return 0;
10647
10648 case ARM_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
10649 /* The hard frame pointer points to the top entry in the
10650 stack frame. The soft frame pointer to the bottom entry
10651 in the stack frame. If there is no stack frame at all,
10652 then they are identical. */
10653
10654 return offsets->frame - offsets->soft_frame;
10655
10656 case STACK_POINTER_REGNUM:
10657 return offsets->outgoing_args - offsets->soft_frame;
10658
10659 default:
10660 gcc_unreachable ();
10661 }
10662 gcc_unreachable ();
10663
10664 default:
10665 /* You cannot eliminate from the stack pointer.
10666 In theory you could eliminate from the hard frame
10667 pointer to the stack pointer, but this will never
10668 happen, since if a stack frame is not needed the
10669 hard frame pointer will never be used. */
10670 gcc_unreachable ();
10671 }
10672 }
10673
10674
10675 /* Generate the prologue instructions for entry into an ARM function. */
10676 void
arm_expand_prologue(void)10677 arm_expand_prologue (void)
10678 {
10679 int reg;
10680 rtx amount;
10681 rtx insn;
10682 rtx ip_rtx;
10683 unsigned long live_regs_mask;
10684 unsigned long func_type;
10685 int fp_offset = 0;
10686 int saved_pretend_args = 0;
10687 int saved_regs = 0;
10688 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT args_to_push;
10689 arm_stack_offsets *offsets;
10690
10691 func_type = arm_current_func_type ();
10692
10693 /* Naked functions don't have prologues. */
10694 if (IS_NAKED (func_type))
10695 return;
10696
10697 /* Make a copy of c_f_p_a_s as we may need to modify it locally. */
10698 args_to_push = current_function_pretend_args_size;
10699
10700 /* Compute which register we will have to save onto the stack. */
10701 live_regs_mask = arm_compute_save_reg_mask ();
10702
10703 ip_rtx = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, IP_REGNUM);
10704
10705 if (frame_pointer_needed)
10706 {
10707 if (IS_INTERRUPT (func_type))
10708 {
10709 /* Interrupt functions must not corrupt any registers.
10710 Creating a frame pointer however, corrupts the IP
10711 register, so we must push it first. */
10712 insn = emit_multi_reg_push (1 << IP_REGNUM);
10713
10714 /* Do not set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on this insn.
10715 The dwarf stack unwinding code only wants to see one
10716 stack decrement per function, and this is not it. If
10717 this instruction is labeled as being part of the frame
10718 creation sequence then dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr will
10719 die when it encounters the assignment of IP to FP
10720 later on, since the use of SP here establishes SP as
10721 the CFA register and not IP.
10722
10723 Anyway this instruction is not really part of the stack
10724 frame creation although it is part of the prologue. */
10725 }
10726 else if (IS_NESTED (func_type))
10727 {
10728 /* The Static chain register is the same as the IP register
10729 used as a scratch register during stack frame creation.
10730 To get around this need to find somewhere to store IP
10731 whilst the frame is being created. We try the following
10732 places in order:
10733
10734 1. The last argument register.
10735 2. A slot on the stack above the frame. (This only
10736 works if the function is not a varargs function).
10737 3. Register r3, after pushing the argument registers
10738 onto the stack.
10739
10740 Note - we only need to tell the dwarf2 backend about the SP
10741 adjustment in the second variant; the static chain register
10742 doesn't need to be unwound, as it doesn't contain a value
10743 inherited from the caller. */
10744
10745 if (regs_ever_live[3] == 0)
10746 insn = emit_set_insn (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 3), ip_rtx);
10747 else if (args_to_push == 0)
10748 {
10749 rtx dwarf;
10750
10751 insn = gen_rtx_PRE_DEC (SImode, stack_pointer_rtx);
10752 insn = emit_set_insn (gen_frame_mem (SImode, insn), ip_rtx);
10753 fp_offset = 4;
10754
10755 /* Just tell the dwarf backend that we adjusted SP. */
10756 dwarf = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
10757 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx,
10758 -fp_offset));
10759 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
10760 REG_NOTES (insn) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR,
10761 dwarf, REG_NOTES (insn));
10762 }
10763 else
10764 {
10765 /* Store the args on the stack. */
10766 if (cfun->machine->uses_anonymous_args)
10767 insn = emit_multi_reg_push
10768 ((0xf0 >> (args_to_push / 4)) & 0xf);
10769 else
10770 insn = emit_insn
10771 (gen_addsi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx,
10772 GEN_INT (- args_to_push)));
10773
10774 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
10775
10776 saved_pretend_args = 1;
10777 fp_offset = args_to_push;
10778 args_to_push = 0;
10779
10780 /* Now reuse r3 to preserve IP. */
10781 emit_set_insn (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 3), ip_rtx);
10782 }
10783 }
10784
10785 insn = emit_set_insn (ip_rtx,
10786 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, fp_offset));
10787 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
10788 }
10789
10790 if (args_to_push)
10791 {
10792 /* Push the argument registers, or reserve space for them. */
10793 if (cfun->machine->uses_anonymous_args)
10794 insn = emit_multi_reg_push
10795 ((0xf0 >> (args_to_push / 4)) & 0xf);
10796 else
10797 insn = emit_insn
10798 (gen_addsi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx,
10799 GEN_INT (- args_to_push)));
10800 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
10801 }
10802
10803 /* If this is an interrupt service routine, and the link register
10804 is going to be pushed, and we are not creating a stack frame,
10805 (which would involve an extra push of IP and a pop in the epilogue)
10806 subtracting four from LR now will mean that the function return
10807 can be done with a single instruction. */
10808 if ((func_type == ARM_FT_ISR || func_type == ARM_FT_FIQ)
10809 && (live_regs_mask & (1 << LR_REGNUM)) != 0
10810 && ! frame_pointer_needed)
10811 {
10812 rtx lr = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, LR_REGNUM);
10813
10814 emit_set_insn (lr, plus_constant (lr, -4));
10815 }
10816
10817 if (live_regs_mask)
10818 {
10819 insn = emit_multi_reg_push (live_regs_mask);
10820 saved_regs += bit_count (live_regs_mask) * 4;
10821 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
10822 }
10823
10824 if (TARGET_IWMMXT)
10825 for (reg = LAST_IWMMXT_REGNUM; reg >= FIRST_IWMMXT_REGNUM; reg--)
10826 if (regs_ever_live[reg] && ! call_used_regs [reg])
10827 {
10828 insn = gen_rtx_PRE_DEC (V2SImode, stack_pointer_rtx);
10829 insn = gen_frame_mem (V2SImode, insn);
10830 insn = emit_set_insn (insn, gen_rtx_REG (V2SImode, reg));
10831 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
10832 saved_regs += 8;
10833 }
10834
10835 if (! IS_VOLATILE (func_type))
10836 {
10837 int start_reg;
10838
10839 /* Save any floating point call-saved registers used by this
10840 function. */
10841 if (arm_fpu_arch == FPUTYPE_FPA_EMU2)
10842 {
10843 for (reg = LAST_FPA_REGNUM; reg >= FIRST_FPA_REGNUM; reg--)
10844 if (regs_ever_live[reg] && !call_used_regs[reg])
10845 {
10846 insn = gen_rtx_PRE_DEC (XFmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
10847 insn = gen_frame_mem (XFmode, insn);
10848 insn = emit_set_insn (insn, gen_rtx_REG (XFmode, reg));
10849 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
10850 saved_regs += 12;
10851 }
10852 }
10853 else
10854 {
10855 start_reg = LAST_FPA_REGNUM;
10856
10857 for (reg = LAST_FPA_REGNUM; reg >= FIRST_FPA_REGNUM; reg--)
10858 {
10859 if (regs_ever_live[reg] && !call_used_regs[reg])
10860 {
10861 if (start_reg - reg == 3)
10862 {
10863 insn = emit_sfm (reg, 4);
10864 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
10865 saved_regs += 48;
10866 start_reg = reg - 1;
10867 }
10868 }
10869 else
10870 {
10871 if (start_reg != reg)
10872 {
10873 insn = emit_sfm (reg + 1, start_reg - reg);
10874 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
10875 saved_regs += (start_reg - reg) * 12;
10876 }
10877 start_reg = reg - 1;
10878 }
10879 }
10880
10881 if (start_reg != reg)
10882 {
10883 insn = emit_sfm (reg + 1, start_reg - reg);
10884 saved_regs += (start_reg - reg) * 12;
10885 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
10886 }
10887 }
10888 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && TARGET_VFP)
10889 {
10890 start_reg = FIRST_VFP_REGNUM;
10891
10892 for (reg = FIRST_VFP_REGNUM; reg < LAST_VFP_REGNUM; reg += 2)
10893 {
10894 if ((!regs_ever_live[reg] || call_used_regs[reg])
10895 && (!regs_ever_live[reg + 1] || call_used_regs[reg + 1]))
10896 {
10897 if (start_reg != reg)
10898 saved_regs += vfp_emit_fstmx (start_reg,
10899 (reg - start_reg) / 2);
10900 start_reg = reg + 2;
10901 }
10902 }
10903 if (start_reg != reg)
10904 saved_regs += vfp_emit_fstmx (start_reg,
10905 (reg - start_reg) / 2);
10906 }
10907 }
10908
10909 if (frame_pointer_needed)
10910 {
10911 /* Create the new frame pointer. */
10912 insn = GEN_INT (-(4 + args_to_push + fp_offset));
10913 insn = emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, ip_rtx, insn));
10914 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
10915
10916 if (IS_NESTED (func_type))
10917 {
10918 /* Recover the static chain register. */
10919 if (regs_ever_live [3] == 0
10920 || saved_pretend_args)
10921 insn = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, 3);
10922 else /* if (current_function_pretend_args_size == 0) */
10923 {
10924 insn = plus_constant (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, 4);
10925 insn = gen_frame_mem (SImode, insn);
10926 }
10927
10928 emit_set_insn (ip_rtx, insn);
10929 /* Add a USE to stop propagate_one_insn() from barfing. */
10930 emit_insn (gen_prologue_use (ip_rtx));
10931 }
10932 }
10933
10934 offsets = arm_get_frame_offsets ();
10935 if (offsets->outgoing_args != offsets->saved_args + saved_regs)
10936 {
10937 /* This add can produce multiple insns for a large constant, so we
10938 need to get tricky. */
10939 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
10940
10941 amount = GEN_INT (offsets->saved_args + saved_regs
10942 - offsets->outgoing_args);
10943
10944 insn = emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx,
10945 amount));
10946 do
10947 {
10948 last = last ? NEXT_INSN (last) : get_insns ();
10949 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (last) = 1;
10950 }
10951 while (last != insn);
10952
10953 /* If the frame pointer is needed, emit a special barrier that
10954 will prevent the scheduler from moving stores to the frame
10955 before the stack adjustment. */
10956 if (frame_pointer_needed)
10957 insn = emit_insn (gen_stack_tie (stack_pointer_rtx,
10958 hard_frame_pointer_rtx));
10959 }
10960
10961
10962 if (flag_pic && arm_pic_register != INVALID_REGNUM)
10963 arm_load_pic_register (0UL);
10964
10965 /* If we are profiling, make sure no instructions are scheduled before
10966 the call to mcount. Similarly if the user has requested no
10967 scheduling in the prolog. Similarly if we want non-call exceptions
10968 using the EABI unwinder, to prevent faulting instructions from being
10969 swapped with a stack adjustment. */
10970 if (current_function_profile || !TARGET_SCHED_PROLOG
10971 || (ARM_EABI_UNWIND_TABLES && flag_non_call_exceptions))
10972 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
10973
10974 /* If the link register is being kept alive, with the return address in it,
10975 then make sure that it does not get reused by the ce2 pass. */
10976 if ((live_regs_mask & (1 << LR_REGNUM)) == 0)
10977 {
10978 emit_insn (gen_prologue_use (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, LR_REGNUM)));
10979 cfun->machine->lr_save_eliminated = 1;
10980 }
10981 }
10982
10983 /* If CODE is 'd', then the X is a condition operand and the instruction
10984 should only be executed if the condition is true.
10985 if CODE is 'D', then the X is a condition operand and the instruction
10986 should only be executed if the condition is false: however, if the mode
10987 of the comparison is CCFPEmode, then always execute the instruction -- we
10988 do this because in these circumstances !GE does not necessarily imply LT;
10989 in these cases the instruction pattern will take care to make sure that
10990 an instruction containing %d will follow, thereby undoing the effects of
10991 doing this instruction unconditionally.
10992 If CODE is 'N' then X is a floating point operand that must be negated
10993 before output.
10994 If CODE is 'B' then output a bitwise inverted value of X (a const int).
10995 If X is a REG and CODE is `M', output a ldm/stm style multi-reg. */
10996 void
arm_print_operand(FILE * stream,rtx x,int code)10997 arm_print_operand (FILE *stream, rtx x, int code)
10998 {
10999 switch (code)
11000 {
11001 case '@':
11002 fputs (ASM_COMMENT_START, stream);
11003 return;
11004
11005 case '_':
11006 fputs (user_label_prefix, stream);
11007 return;
11008
11009 case '|':
11010 fputs (REGISTER_PREFIX, stream);
11011 return;
11012
11013 case '?':
11014 if (arm_ccfsm_state == 3 || arm_ccfsm_state == 4)
11015 {
11016 if (TARGET_THUMB)
11017 {
11018 output_operand_lossage ("predicated Thumb instruction");
11019 break;
11020 }
11021 if (current_insn_predicate != NULL)
11022 {
11023 output_operand_lossage
11024 ("predicated instruction in conditional sequence");
11025 break;
11026 }
11027
11028 fputs (arm_condition_codes[arm_current_cc], stream);
11029 }
11030 else if (current_insn_predicate)
11031 {
11032 enum arm_cond_code code;
11033
11034 if (TARGET_THUMB)
11035 {
11036 output_operand_lossage ("predicated Thumb instruction");
11037 break;
11038 }
11039
11040 code = get_arm_condition_code (current_insn_predicate);
11041 fputs (arm_condition_codes[code], stream);
11042 }
11043 return;
11044
11045 case 'N':
11046 {
11047 REAL_VALUE_TYPE r;
11048 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, x);
11049 r = REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (r);
11050 fprintf (stream, "%s", fp_const_from_val (&r));
11051 }
11052 return;
11053
11054 case 'B':
11055 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
11056 {
11057 HOST_WIDE_INT val;
11058 val = ARM_SIGN_EXTEND (~INTVAL (x));
11059 fprintf (stream, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, val);
11060 }
11061 else
11062 {
11063 putc ('~', stream);
11064 output_addr_const (stream, x);
11065 }
11066 return;
11067
11068 case 'i':
11069 fprintf (stream, "%s", arithmetic_instr (x, 1));
11070 return;
11071
11072 /* Truncate Cirrus shift counts. */
11073 case 's':
11074 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
11075 {
11076 fprintf (stream, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, INTVAL (x) & 0x3f);
11077 return;
11078 }
11079 arm_print_operand (stream, x, 0);
11080 return;
11081
11082 case 'I':
11083 fprintf (stream, "%s", arithmetic_instr (x, 0));
11084 return;
11085
11086 case 'S':
11087 {
11088 HOST_WIDE_INT val;
11089 const char *shift;
11090
11091 if (!shift_operator (x, SImode))
11092 {
11093 output_operand_lossage ("invalid shift operand");
11094 break;
11095 }
11096
11097 shift = shift_op (x, &val);
11098
11099 if (shift)
11100 {
11101 fprintf (stream, ", %s ", shift);
11102 if (val == -1)
11103 arm_print_operand (stream, XEXP (x, 1), 0);
11104 else
11105 fprintf (stream, "#" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, val);
11106 }
11107 }
11108 return;
11109
11110 /* An explanation of the 'Q', 'R' and 'H' register operands:
11111
11112 In a pair of registers containing a DI or DF value the 'Q'
11113 operand returns the register number of the register containing
11114 the least significant part of the value. The 'R' operand returns
11115 the register number of the register containing the most
11116 significant part of the value.
11117
11118 The 'H' operand returns the higher of the two register numbers.
11119 On a run where WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN is true the 'H' operand is the
11120 same as the 'Q' operand, since the most significant part of the
11121 value is held in the lower number register. The reverse is true
11122 on systems where WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN is false.
11123
11124 The purpose of these operands is to distinguish between cases
11125 where the endian-ness of the values is important (for example
11126 when they are added together), and cases where the endian-ness
11127 is irrelevant, but the order of register operations is important.
11128 For example when loading a value from memory into a register
11129 pair, the endian-ness does not matter. Provided that the value
11130 from the lower memory address is put into the lower numbered
11131 register, and the value from the higher address is put into the
11132 higher numbered register, the load will work regardless of whether
11133 the value being loaded is big-wordian or little-wordian. The
11134 order of the two register loads can matter however, if the address
11135 of the memory location is actually held in one of the registers
11136 being overwritten by the load. */
11137 case 'Q':
11138 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG || REGNO (x) > LAST_ARM_REGNUM)
11139 {
11140 output_operand_lossage ("invalid operand for code '%c'", code);
11141 return;
11142 }
11143
11144 asm_fprintf (stream, "%r", REGNO (x) + (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? 1 : 0));
11145 return;
11146
11147 case 'R':
11148 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG || REGNO (x) > LAST_ARM_REGNUM)
11149 {
11150 output_operand_lossage ("invalid operand for code '%c'", code);
11151 return;
11152 }
11153
11154 asm_fprintf (stream, "%r", REGNO (x) + (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? 0 : 1));
11155 return;
11156
11157 case 'H':
11158 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG || REGNO (x) > LAST_ARM_REGNUM)
11159 {
11160 output_operand_lossage ("invalid operand for code '%c'", code);
11161 return;
11162 }
11163
11164 asm_fprintf (stream, "%r", REGNO (x) + 1);
11165 return;
11166
11167 case 'm':
11168 asm_fprintf (stream, "%r",
11169 GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == REG
11170 ? REGNO (XEXP (x, 0)) : REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)));
11171 return;
11172
11173 case 'M':
11174 asm_fprintf (stream, "{%r-%r}",
11175 REGNO (x),
11176 REGNO (x) + ARM_NUM_REGS (GET_MODE (x)) - 1);
11177 return;
11178
11179 case 'd':
11180 /* CONST_TRUE_RTX means always -- that's the default. */
11181 if (x == const_true_rtx)
11182 return;
11183
11184 if (!COMPARISON_P (x))
11185 {
11186 output_operand_lossage ("invalid operand for code '%c'", code);
11187 return;
11188 }
11189
11190 fputs (arm_condition_codes[get_arm_condition_code (x)],
11191 stream);
11192 return;
11193
11194 case 'D':
11195 /* CONST_TRUE_RTX means not always -- i.e. never. We shouldn't ever
11196 want to do that. */
11197 if (x == const_true_rtx)
11198 {
11199 output_operand_lossage ("instruction never exectued");
11200 return;
11201 }
11202 if (!COMPARISON_P (x))
11203 {
11204 output_operand_lossage ("invalid operand for code '%c'", code);
11205 return;
11206 }
11207
11208 fputs (arm_condition_codes[ARM_INVERSE_CONDITION_CODE
11209 (get_arm_condition_code (x))],
11210 stream);
11211 return;
11212
11213 /* Cirrus registers can be accessed in a variety of ways:
11214 single floating point (f)
11215 double floating point (d)
11216 32bit integer (fx)
11217 64bit integer (dx). */
11218 case 'W': /* Cirrus register in F mode. */
11219 case 'X': /* Cirrus register in D mode. */
11220 case 'Y': /* Cirrus register in FX mode. */
11221 case 'Z': /* Cirrus register in DX mode. */
11222 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == REG
11223 && REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (x)) == CIRRUS_REGS);
11224
11225 fprintf (stream, "mv%s%s",
11226 code == 'W' ? "f"
11227 : code == 'X' ? "d"
11228 : code == 'Y' ? "fx" : "dx", reg_names[REGNO (x)] + 2);
11229
11230 return;
11231
11232 /* Print cirrus register in the mode specified by the register's mode. */
11233 case 'V':
11234 {
11235 int mode = GET_MODE (x);
11236
11237 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG || REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (x)) != CIRRUS_REGS)
11238 {
11239 output_operand_lossage ("invalid operand for code '%c'", code);
11240 return;
11241 }
11242
11243 fprintf (stream, "mv%s%s",
11244 mode == DFmode ? "d"
11245 : mode == SImode ? "fx"
11246 : mode == DImode ? "dx"
11247 : "f", reg_names[REGNO (x)] + 2);
11248
11249 return;
11250 }
11251
11252 case 'U':
11253 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG
11254 || REGNO (x) < FIRST_IWMMXT_GR_REGNUM
11255 || REGNO (x) > LAST_IWMMXT_GR_REGNUM)
11256 /* Bad value for wCG register number. */
11257 {
11258 output_operand_lossage ("invalid operand for code '%c'", code);
11259 return;
11260 }
11261
11262 else
11263 fprintf (stream, "%d", REGNO (x) - FIRST_IWMMXT_GR_REGNUM);
11264 return;
11265
11266 /* Print an iWMMXt control register name. */
11267 case 'w':
11268 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT
11269 || INTVAL (x) < 0
11270 || INTVAL (x) >= 16)
11271 /* Bad value for wC register number. */
11272 {
11273 output_operand_lossage ("invalid operand for code '%c'", code);
11274 return;
11275 }
11276
11277 else
11278 {
11279 static const char * wc_reg_names [16] =
11280 {
11281 "wCID", "wCon", "wCSSF", "wCASF",
11282 "wC4", "wC5", "wC6", "wC7",
11283 "wCGR0", "wCGR1", "wCGR2", "wCGR3",
11284 "wC12", "wC13", "wC14", "wC15"
11285 };
11286
11287 fprintf (stream, wc_reg_names [INTVAL (x)]);
11288 }
11289 return;
11290
11291 /* Print a VFP double precision register name. */
11292 case 'P':
11293 {
11294 int mode = GET_MODE (x);
11295 int num;
11296
11297 if (mode != DImode && mode != DFmode)
11298 {
11299 output_operand_lossage ("invalid operand for code '%c'", code);
11300 return;
11301 }
11302
11303 if (GET_CODE (x) != REG
11304 || !IS_VFP_REGNUM (REGNO (x)))
11305 {
11306 output_operand_lossage ("invalid operand for code '%c'", code);
11307 return;
11308 }
11309
11310 num = REGNO(x) - FIRST_VFP_REGNUM;
11311 if (num & 1)
11312 {
11313 output_operand_lossage ("invalid operand for code '%c'", code);
11314 return;
11315 }
11316
11317 fprintf (stream, "d%d", num >> 1);
11318 }
11319 return;
11320
11321 default:
11322 if (x == 0)
11323 {
11324 output_operand_lossage ("missing operand");
11325 return;
11326 }
11327
11328 switch (GET_CODE (x))
11329 {
11330 case REG:
11331 asm_fprintf (stream, "%r", REGNO (x));
11332 break;
11333
11334 case MEM:
11335 output_memory_reference_mode = GET_MODE (x);
11336 output_address (XEXP (x, 0));
11337 break;
11338
11339 case CONST_DOUBLE:
11340 fprintf (stream, "#%s", fp_immediate_constant (x));
11341 break;
11342
11343 default:
11344 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) != NEG);
11345 fputc ('#', stream);
11346 output_addr_const (stream, x);
11347 break;
11348 }
11349 }
11350 }
11351
11352 #ifndef AOF_ASSEMBLER
11353 /* Target hook for assembling integer objects. The ARM version needs to
11354 handle word-sized values specially. */
11355 static bool
arm_assemble_integer(rtx x,unsigned int size,int aligned_p)11356 arm_assemble_integer (rtx x, unsigned int size, int aligned_p)
11357 {
11358 if (size == UNITS_PER_WORD && aligned_p)
11359 {
11360 fputs ("\t.word\t", asm_out_file);
11361 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, x);
11362
11363 /* Mark symbols as position independent. We only do this in the
11364 .text segment, not in the .data segment. */
11365 if (NEED_GOT_RELOC && flag_pic && making_const_table &&
11366 (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF || GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF))
11367 {
11368 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF
11369 && (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (x)
11370 || SYMBOL_REF_LOCAL_P (x)))
11371 fputs ("(GOTOFF)", asm_out_file);
11372 else if (GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF)
11373 fputs ("(GOTOFF)", asm_out_file);
11374 else
11375 fputs ("(GOT)", asm_out_file);
11376 }
11377 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
11378 return true;
11379 }
11380
11381 if (arm_vector_mode_supported_p (GET_MODE (x)))
11382 {
11383 int i, units;
11384
11385 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_VECTOR);
11386
11387 units = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (x);
11388
11389 switch (GET_MODE (x))
11390 {
11391 case V2SImode: size = 4; break;
11392 case V4HImode: size = 2; break;
11393 case V8QImode: size = 1; break;
11394 default:
11395 gcc_unreachable ();
11396 }
11397
11398 for (i = 0; i < units; i++)
11399 {
11400 rtx elt;
11401
11402 elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (x, i);
11403 assemble_integer
11404 (elt, size, i == 0 ? BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT : size * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1);
11405 }
11406
11407 return true;
11408 }
11409
11410 return default_assemble_integer (x, size, aligned_p);
11411 }
11412
11413
11414 /* Add a function to the list of static constructors. */
11415
11416 static void
arm_elf_asm_constructor(rtx symbol,int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)11417 arm_elf_asm_constructor (rtx symbol, int priority ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11418 {
11419 if (!TARGET_AAPCS_BASED)
11420 {
11421 default_named_section_asm_out_constructor (symbol, priority);
11422 return;
11423 }
11424
11425 /* Put these in the .init_array section, using a special relocation. */
11426 switch_to_section (ctors_section);
11427 assemble_align (POINTER_SIZE);
11428 fputs ("\t.word\t", asm_out_file);
11429 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, symbol);
11430 fputs ("(target1)\n", asm_out_file);
11431 }
11432 #endif
11433
11434 /* A finite state machine takes care of noticing whether or not instructions
11435 can be conditionally executed, and thus decrease execution time and code
11436 size by deleting branch instructions. The fsm is controlled by
11437 final_prescan_insn, and controls the actions of ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE. */
11438
11439 /* The state of the fsm controlling condition codes are:
11440 0: normal, do nothing special
11441 1: make ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE not output this instruction
11442 2: make ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE not output this instruction
11443 3: make instructions conditional
11444 4: make instructions conditional
11445
11446 State transitions (state->state by whom under condition):
11447 0 -> 1 final_prescan_insn if the `target' is a label
11448 0 -> 2 final_prescan_insn if the `target' is an unconditional branch
11449 1 -> 3 ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE after not having output the conditional branch
11450 2 -> 4 ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE after not having output the conditional branch
11451 3 -> 0 (*targetm.asm_out.internal_label) if the `target' label is reached
11452 (the target label has CODE_LABEL_NUMBER equal to arm_target_label).
11453 4 -> 0 final_prescan_insn if the `target' unconditional branch is reached
11454 (the target insn is arm_target_insn).
11455
11456 If the jump clobbers the conditions then we use states 2 and 4.
11457
11458 A similar thing can be done with conditional return insns.
11459
11460 XXX In case the `target' is an unconditional branch, this conditionalising
11461 of the instructions always reduces code size, but not always execution
11462 time. But then, I want to reduce the code size to somewhere near what
11463 /bin/cc produces. */
11464
11465 /* Returns the index of the ARM condition code string in
11466 `arm_condition_codes'. COMPARISON should be an rtx like
11467 `(eq (...) (...))'. */
11468 static enum arm_cond_code
get_arm_condition_code(rtx comparison)11469 get_arm_condition_code (rtx comparison)
11470 {
11471 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (comparison, 0));
11472 int code;
11473 enum rtx_code comp_code = GET_CODE (comparison);
11474
11475 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_CC)
11476 mode = SELECT_CC_MODE (comp_code, XEXP (comparison, 0),
11477 XEXP (comparison, 1));
11478
11479 switch (mode)
11480 {
11481 case CC_DNEmode: code = ARM_NE; goto dominance;
11482 case CC_DEQmode: code = ARM_EQ; goto dominance;
11483 case CC_DGEmode: code = ARM_GE; goto dominance;
11484 case CC_DGTmode: code = ARM_GT; goto dominance;
11485 case CC_DLEmode: code = ARM_LE; goto dominance;
11486 case CC_DLTmode: code = ARM_LT; goto dominance;
11487 case CC_DGEUmode: code = ARM_CS; goto dominance;
11488 case CC_DGTUmode: code = ARM_HI; goto dominance;
11489 case CC_DLEUmode: code = ARM_LS; goto dominance;
11490 case CC_DLTUmode: code = ARM_CC;
11491
11492 dominance:
11493 gcc_assert (comp_code == EQ || comp_code == NE);
11494
11495 if (comp_code == EQ)
11496 return ARM_INVERSE_CONDITION_CODE (code);
11497 return code;
11498
11499 case CC_NOOVmode:
11500 switch (comp_code)
11501 {
11502 case NE: return ARM_NE;
11503 case EQ: return ARM_EQ;
11504 case GE: return ARM_PL;
11505 case LT: return ARM_MI;
11506 default: gcc_unreachable ();
11507 }
11508
11509 case CC_Zmode:
11510 switch (comp_code)
11511 {
11512 case NE: return ARM_NE;
11513 case EQ: return ARM_EQ;
11514 default: gcc_unreachable ();
11515 }
11516
11517 case CC_Nmode:
11518 switch (comp_code)
11519 {
11520 case NE: return ARM_MI;
11521 case EQ: return ARM_PL;
11522 default: gcc_unreachable ();
11523 }
11524
11525 case CCFPEmode:
11526 case CCFPmode:
11527 /* These encodings assume that AC=1 in the FPA system control
11528 byte. This allows us to handle all cases except UNEQ and
11529 LTGT. */
11530 switch (comp_code)
11531 {
11532 case GE: return ARM_GE;
11533 case GT: return ARM_GT;
11534 case LE: return ARM_LS;
11535 case LT: return ARM_MI;
11536 case NE: return ARM_NE;
11537 case EQ: return ARM_EQ;
11538 case ORDERED: return ARM_VC;
11539 case UNORDERED: return ARM_VS;
11540 case UNLT: return ARM_LT;
11541 case UNLE: return ARM_LE;
11542 case UNGT: return ARM_HI;
11543 case UNGE: return ARM_PL;
11544 /* UNEQ and LTGT do not have a representation. */
11545 case UNEQ: /* Fall through. */
11546 case LTGT: /* Fall through. */
11547 default: gcc_unreachable ();
11548 }
11549
11550 case CC_SWPmode:
11551 switch (comp_code)
11552 {
11553 case NE: return ARM_NE;
11554 case EQ: return ARM_EQ;
11555 case GE: return ARM_LE;
11556 case GT: return ARM_LT;
11557 case LE: return ARM_GE;
11558 case LT: return ARM_GT;
11559 case GEU: return ARM_LS;
11560 case GTU: return ARM_CC;
11561 case LEU: return ARM_CS;
11562 case LTU: return ARM_HI;
11563 default: gcc_unreachable ();
11564 }
11565
11566 case CC_Cmode:
11567 switch (comp_code)
11568 {
11569 case LTU: return ARM_CS;
11570 case GEU: return ARM_CC;
11571 default: gcc_unreachable ();
11572 }
11573
11574 case CCmode:
11575 switch (comp_code)
11576 {
11577 case NE: return ARM_NE;
11578 case EQ: return ARM_EQ;
11579 case GE: return ARM_GE;
11580 case GT: return ARM_GT;
11581 case LE: return ARM_LE;
11582 case LT: return ARM_LT;
11583 case GEU: return ARM_CS;
11584 case GTU: return ARM_HI;
11585 case LEU: return ARM_LS;
11586 case LTU: return ARM_CC;
11587 default: gcc_unreachable ();
11588 }
11589
11590 default: gcc_unreachable ();
11591 }
11592 }
11593
11594 void
arm_final_prescan_insn(rtx insn)11595 arm_final_prescan_insn (rtx insn)
11596 {
11597 /* BODY will hold the body of INSN. */
11598 rtx body = PATTERN (insn);
11599
11600 /* This will be 1 if trying to repeat the trick, and things need to be
11601 reversed if it appears to fail. */
11602 int reverse = 0;
11603
11604 /* JUMP_CLOBBERS will be one implies that the conditions if a branch is
11605 taken are clobbered, even if the rtl suggests otherwise. It also
11606 means that we have to grub around within the jump expression to find
11607 out what the conditions are when the jump isn't taken. */
11608 int jump_clobbers = 0;
11609
11610 /* If we start with a return insn, we only succeed if we find another one. */
11611 int seeking_return = 0;
11612
11613 /* START_INSN will hold the insn from where we start looking. This is the
11614 first insn after the following code_label if REVERSE is true. */
11615 rtx start_insn = insn;
11616
11617 /* If in state 4, check if the target branch is reached, in order to
11618 change back to state 0. */
11619 if (arm_ccfsm_state == 4)
11620 {
11621 if (insn == arm_target_insn)
11622 {
11623 arm_target_insn = NULL;
11624 arm_ccfsm_state = 0;
11625 }
11626 return;
11627 }
11628
11629 /* If in state 3, it is possible to repeat the trick, if this insn is an
11630 unconditional branch to a label, and immediately following this branch
11631 is the previous target label which is only used once, and the label this
11632 branch jumps to is not too far off. */
11633 if (arm_ccfsm_state == 3)
11634 {
11635 if (simplejump_p (insn))
11636 {
11637 start_insn = next_nonnote_insn (start_insn);
11638 if (GET_CODE (start_insn) == BARRIER)
11639 {
11640 /* XXX Isn't this always a barrier? */
11641 start_insn = next_nonnote_insn (start_insn);
11642 }
11643 if (GET_CODE (start_insn) == CODE_LABEL
11644 && CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (start_insn) == arm_target_label
11645 && LABEL_NUSES (start_insn) == 1)
11646 reverse = TRUE;
11647 else
11648 return;
11649 }
11650 else if (GET_CODE (body) == RETURN)
11651 {
11652 start_insn = next_nonnote_insn (start_insn);
11653 if (GET_CODE (start_insn) == BARRIER)
11654 start_insn = next_nonnote_insn (start_insn);
11655 if (GET_CODE (start_insn) == CODE_LABEL
11656 && CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (start_insn) == arm_target_label
11657 && LABEL_NUSES (start_insn) == 1)
11658 {
11659 reverse = TRUE;
11660 seeking_return = 1;
11661 }
11662 else
11663 return;
11664 }
11665 else
11666 return;
11667 }
11668
11669 gcc_assert (!arm_ccfsm_state || reverse);
11670 if (GET_CODE (insn) != JUMP_INSN)
11671 return;
11672
11673 /* This jump might be paralleled with a clobber of the condition codes
11674 the jump should always come first */
11675 if (GET_CODE (body) == PARALLEL && XVECLEN (body, 0) > 0)
11676 body = XVECEXP (body, 0, 0);
11677
11678 if (reverse
11679 || (GET_CODE (body) == SET && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (body)) == PC
11680 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (body)) == IF_THEN_ELSE))
11681 {
11682 int insns_skipped;
11683 int fail = FALSE, succeed = FALSE;
11684 /* Flag which part of the IF_THEN_ELSE is the LABEL_REF. */
11685 int then_not_else = TRUE;
11686 rtx this_insn = start_insn, label = 0;
11687
11688 /* If the jump cannot be done with one instruction, we cannot
11689 conditionally execute the instruction in the inverse case. */
11690 if (get_attr_conds (insn) == CONDS_JUMP_CLOB)
11691 {
11692 jump_clobbers = 1;
11693 return;
11694 }
11695
11696 /* Register the insn jumped to. */
11697 if (reverse)
11698 {
11699 if (!seeking_return)
11700 label = XEXP (SET_SRC (body), 0);
11701 }
11702 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (body), 1)) == LABEL_REF)
11703 label = XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (body), 1), 0);
11704 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (body), 2)) == LABEL_REF)
11705 {
11706 label = XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (body), 2), 0);
11707 then_not_else = FALSE;
11708 }
11709 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (body), 1)) == RETURN)
11710 seeking_return = 1;
11711 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (body), 2)) == RETURN)
11712 {
11713 seeking_return = 1;
11714 then_not_else = FALSE;
11715 }
11716 else
11717 gcc_unreachable ();
11718
11719 /* See how many insns this branch skips, and what kind of insns. If all
11720 insns are okay, and the label or unconditional branch to the same
11721 label is not too far away, succeed. */
11722 for (insns_skipped = 0;
11723 !fail && !succeed && insns_skipped++ < max_insns_skipped;)
11724 {
11725 rtx scanbody;
11726
11727 this_insn = next_nonnote_insn (this_insn);
11728 if (!this_insn)
11729 break;
11730
11731 switch (GET_CODE (this_insn))
11732 {
11733 case CODE_LABEL:
11734 /* Succeed if it is the target label, otherwise fail since
11735 control falls in from somewhere else. */
11736 if (this_insn == label)
11737 {
11738 if (jump_clobbers)
11739 {
11740 arm_ccfsm_state = 2;
11741 this_insn = next_nonnote_insn (this_insn);
11742 }
11743 else
11744 arm_ccfsm_state = 1;
11745 succeed = TRUE;
11746 }
11747 else
11748 fail = TRUE;
11749 break;
11750
11751 case BARRIER:
11752 /* Succeed if the following insn is the target label.
11753 Otherwise fail.
11754 If return insns are used then the last insn in a function
11755 will be a barrier. */
11756 this_insn = next_nonnote_insn (this_insn);
11757 if (this_insn && this_insn == label)
11758 {
11759 if (jump_clobbers)
11760 {
11761 arm_ccfsm_state = 2;
11762 this_insn = next_nonnote_insn (this_insn);
11763 }
11764 else
11765 arm_ccfsm_state = 1;
11766 succeed = TRUE;
11767 }
11768 else
11769 fail = TRUE;
11770 break;
11771
11772 case CALL_INSN:
11773 /* The AAPCS says that conditional calls should not be
11774 used since they make interworking inefficient (the
11775 linker can't transform BL<cond> into BLX). That's
11776 only a problem if the machine has BLX. */
11777 if (arm_arch5)
11778 {
11779 fail = TRUE;
11780 break;
11781 }
11782
11783 /* Succeed if the following insn is the target label, or
11784 if the following two insns are a barrier and the
11785 target label. */
11786 this_insn = next_nonnote_insn (this_insn);
11787 if (this_insn && GET_CODE (this_insn) == BARRIER)
11788 this_insn = next_nonnote_insn (this_insn);
11789
11790 if (this_insn && this_insn == label
11791 && insns_skipped < max_insns_skipped)
11792 {
11793 if (jump_clobbers)
11794 {
11795 arm_ccfsm_state = 2;
11796 this_insn = next_nonnote_insn (this_insn);
11797 }
11798 else
11799 arm_ccfsm_state = 1;
11800 succeed = TRUE;
11801 }
11802 else
11803 fail = TRUE;
11804 break;
11805
11806 case JUMP_INSN:
11807 /* If this is an unconditional branch to the same label, succeed.
11808 If it is to another label, do nothing. If it is conditional,
11809 fail. */
11810 /* XXX Probably, the tests for SET and the PC are
11811 unnecessary. */
11812
11813 scanbody = PATTERN (this_insn);
11814 if (GET_CODE (scanbody) == SET
11815 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (scanbody)) == PC)
11816 {
11817 if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (scanbody)) == LABEL_REF
11818 && XEXP (SET_SRC (scanbody), 0) == label && !reverse)
11819 {
11820 arm_ccfsm_state = 2;
11821 succeed = TRUE;
11822 }
11823 else if (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (scanbody)) == IF_THEN_ELSE)
11824 fail = TRUE;
11825 }
11826 /* Fail if a conditional return is undesirable (e.g. on a
11827 StrongARM), but still allow this if optimizing for size. */
11828 else if (GET_CODE (scanbody) == RETURN
11829 && !use_return_insn (TRUE, NULL)
11830 && !optimize_size)
11831 fail = TRUE;
11832 else if (GET_CODE (scanbody) == RETURN
11833 && seeking_return)
11834 {
11835 arm_ccfsm_state = 2;
11836 succeed = TRUE;
11837 }
11838 else if (GET_CODE (scanbody) == PARALLEL)
11839 {
11840 switch (get_attr_conds (this_insn))
11841 {
11842 case CONDS_NOCOND:
11843 break;
11844 default:
11845 fail = TRUE;
11846 break;
11847 }
11848 }
11849 else
11850 fail = TRUE; /* Unrecognized jump (e.g. epilogue). */
11851
11852 break;
11853
11854 case INSN:
11855 /* Instructions using or affecting the condition codes make it
11856 fail. */
11857 scanbody = PATTERN (this_insn);
11858 if (!(GET_CODE (scanbody) == SET
11859 || GET_CODE (scanbody) == PARALLEL)
11860 || get_attr_conds (this_insn) != CONDS_NOCOND)
11861 fail = TRUE;
11862
11863 /* A conditional cirrus instruction must be followed by
11864 a non Cirrus instruction. However, since we
11865 conditionalize instructions in this function and by
11866 the time we get here we can't add instructions
11867 (nops), because shorten_branches() has already been
11868 called, we will disable conditionalizing Cirrus
11869 instructions to be safe. */
11870 if (GET_CODE (scanbody) != USE
11871 && GET_CODE (scanbody) != CLOBBER
11872 && get_attr_cirrus (this_insn) != CIRRUS_NOT)
11873 fail = TRUE;
11874 break;
11875
11876 default:
11877 break;
11878 }
11879 }
11880 if (succeed)
11881 {
11882 if ((!seeking_return) && (arm_ccfsm_state == 1 || reverse))
11883 arm_target_label = CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (label);
11884 else
11885 {
11886 gcc_assert (seeking_return || arm_ccfsm_state == 2);
11887
11888 while (this_insn && GET_CODE (PATTERN (this_insn)) == USE)
11889 {
11890 this_insn = next_nonnote_insn (this_insn);
11891 gcc_assert (!this_insn
11892 || (GET_CODE (this_insn) != BARRIER
11893 && GET_CODE (this_insn) != CODE_LABEL));
11894 }
11895 if (!this_insn)
11896 {
11897 /* Oh, dear! we ran off the end.. give up. */
11898 recog (PATTERN (insn), insn, NULL);
11899 arm_ccfsm_state = 0;
11900 arm_target_insn = NULL;
11901 return;
11902 }
11903 arm_target_insn = this_insn;
11904 }
11905 if (jump_clobbers)
11906 {
11907 gcc_assert (!reverse);
11908 arm_current_cc =
11909 get_arm_condition_code (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (body),
11910 0), 0), 1));
11911 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (SET_SRC (body), 0), 0)) == AND)
11912 arm_current_cc = ARM_INVERSE_CONDITION_CODE (arm_current_cc);
11913 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (body), 0)) == NE)
11914 arm_current_cc = ARM_INVERSE_CONDITION_CODE (arm_current_cc);
11915 }
11916 else
11917 {
11918 /* If REVERSE is true, ARM_CURRENT_CC needs to be inverted from
11919 what it was. */
11920 if (!reverse)
11921 arm_current_cc = get_arm_condition_code (XEXP (SET_SRC (body),
11922 0));
11923 }
11924
11925 if (reverse || then_not_else)
11926 arm_current_cc = ARM_INVERSE_CONDITION_CODE (arm_current_cc);
11927 }
11928
11929 /* Restore recog_data (getting the attributes of other insns can
11930 destroy this array, but final.c assumes that it remains intact
11931 across this call; since the insn has been recognized already we
11932 call recog direct). */
11933 recog (PATTERN (insn), insn, NULL);
11934 }
11935 }
11936
11937 /* Returns true if REGNO is a valid register
11938 for holding a quantity of type MODE. */
11939 int
arm_hard_regno_mode_ok(unsigned int regno,enum machine_mode mode)11940 arm_hard_regno_mode_ok (unsigned int regno, enum machine_mode mode)
11941 {
11942 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_CC)
11943 return (regno == CC_REGNUM
11944 || (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && TARGET_VFP
11945 && regno == VFPCC_REGNUM));
11946
11947 if (TARGET_THUMB)
11948 /* For the Thumb we only allow values bigger than SImode in
11949 registers 0 - 6, so that there is always a second low
11950 register available to hold the upper part of the value.
11951 We probably we ought to ensure that the register is the
11952 start of an even numbered register pair. */
11953 return (ARM_NUM_REGS (mode) < 2) || (regno < LAST_LO_REGNUM);
11954
11955 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && TARGET_MAVERICK
11956 && IS_CIRRUS_REGNUM (regno))
11957 /* We have outlawed SI values in Cirrus registers because they
11958 reside in the lower 32 bits, but SF values reside in the
11959 upper 32 bits. This causes gcc all sorts of grief. We can't
11960 even split the registers into pairs because Cirrus SI values
11961 get sign extended to 64bits-- aldyh. */
11962 return (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT) || (mode == DImode);
11963
11964 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && TARGET_VFP
11965 && IS_VFP_REGNUM (regno))
11966 {
11967 if (mode == SFmode || mode == SImode)
11968 return TRUE;
11969
11970 /* DFmode values are only valid in even register pairs. */
11971 if (mode == DFmode)
11972 return ((regno - FIRST_VFP_REGNUM) & 1) == 0;
11973 return FALSE;
11974 }
11975
11976 if (TARGET_REALLY_IWMMXT)
11977 {
11978 if (IS_IWMMXT_GR_REGNUM (regno))
11979 return mode == SImode;
11980
11981 if (IS_IWMMXT_REGNUM (regno))
11982 return VALID_IWMMXT_REG_MODE (mode);
11983 }
11984
11985 /* We allow any value to be stored in the general registers.
11986 Restrict doubleword quantities to even register pairs so that we can
11987 use ldrd. */
11988 if (regno <= LAST_ARM_REGNUM)
11989 return !(TARGET_LDRD && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > 4 && (regno & 1) != 0);
11990
11991 if (regno == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
11992 || regno == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
11993 /* We only allow integers in the fake hard registers. */
11994 return GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT;
11995
11996 /* The only registers left are the FPA registers
11997 which we only allow to hold FP values. */
11998 return (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT && TARGET_FPA
11999 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_FLOAT
12000 && regno >= FIRST_FPA_REGNUM
12001 && regno <= LAST_FPA_REGNUM);
12002 }
12003
12004 int
arm_regno_class(int regno)12005 arm_regno_class (int regno)
12006 {
12007 if (TARGET_THUMB)
12008 {
12009 if (regno == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
12010 return STACK_REG;
12011 if (regno == CC_REGNUM)
12012 return CC_REG;
12013 if (regno < 8)
12014 return LO_REGS;
12015 return HI_REGS;
12016 }
12017
12018 if ( regno <= LAST_ARM_REGNUM
12019 || regno == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
12020 || regno == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)
12021 return GENERAL_REGS;
12022
12023 if (regno == CC_REGNUM || regno == VFPCC_REGNUM)
12024 return NO_REGS;
12025
12026 if (IS_CIRRUS_REGNUM (regno))
12027 return CIRRUS_REGS;
12028
12029 if (IS_VFP_REGNUM (regno))
12030 return VFP_REGS;
12031
12032 if (IS_IWMMXT_REGNUM (regno))
12033 return IWMMXT_REGS;
12034
12035 if (IS_IWMMXT_GR_REGNUM (regno))
12036 return IWMMXT_GR_REGS;
12037
12038 return FPA_REGS;
12039 }
12040
12041 /* Handle a special case when computing the offset
12042 of an argument from the frame pointer. */
12043 int
arm_debugger_arg_offset(int value,rtx addr)12044 arm_debugger_arg_offset (int value, rtx addr)
12045 {
12046 rtx insn;
12047
12048 /* We are only interested if dbxout_parms() failed to compute the offset. */
12049 if (value != 0)
12050 return 0;
12051
12052 /* We can only cope with the case where the address is held in a register. */
12053 if (GET_CODE (addr) != REG)
12054 return 0;
12055
12056 /* If we are using the frame pointer to point at the argument, then
12057 an offset of 0 is correct. */
12058 if (REGNO (addr) == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
12059 return 0;
12060
12061 /* If we are using the stack pointer to point at the
12062 argument, then an offset of 0 is correct. */
12063 if ((TARGET_THUMB || !frame_pointer_needed)
12064 && REGNO (addr) == SP_REGNUM)
12065 return 0;
12066
12067 /* Oh dear. The argument is pointed to by a register rather
12068 than being held in a register, or being stored at a known
12069 offset from the frame pointer. Since GDB only understands
12070 those two kinds of argument we must translate the address
12071 held in the register into an offset from the frame pointer.
12072 We do this by searching through the insns for the function
12073 looking to see where this register gets its value. If the
12074 register is initialized from the frame pointer plus an offset
12075 then we are in luck and we can continue, otherwise we give up.
12076
12077 This code is exercised by producing debugging information
12078 for a function with arguments like this:
12079
12080 double func (double a, double b, int c, double d) {return d;}
12081
12082 Without this code the stab for parameter 'd' will be set to
12083 an offset of 0 from the frame pointer, rather than 8. */
12084
12085 /* The if() statement says:
12086
12087 If the insn is a normal instruction
12088 and if the insn is setting the value in a register
12089 and if the register being set is the register holding the address of the argument
12090 and if the address is computing by an addition
12091 that involves adding to a register
12092 which is the frame pointer
12093 a constant integer
12094
12095 then... */
12096
12097 for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
12098 {
12099 if ( GET_CODE (insn) == INSN
12100 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET
12101 && REGNO (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0)) == REGNO (addr)
12102 && GET_CODE (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 1)) == PLUS
12103 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 1), 0)) == REG
12104 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 1), 0)) == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
12105 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 1), 1)) == CONST_INT
12106 )
12107 {
12108 value = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (PATTERN (insn), 1), 1));
12109
12110 break;
12111 }
12112 }
12113
12114 if (value == 0)
12115 {
12116 debug_rtx (addr);
12117 warning (0, "unable to compute real location of stacked parameter");
12118 value = 8; /* XXX magic hack */
12119 }
12120
12121 return value;
12122 }
12123
12124 #define def_mbuiltin(MASK, NAME, TYPE, CODE) \
12125 do \
12126 { \
12127 if ((MASK) & insn_flags) \
12128 lang_hooks.builtin_function ((NAME), (TYPE), (CODE), \
12129 BUILT_IN_MD, NULL, NULL_TREE); \
12130 } \
12131 while (0)
12132
12133 struct builtin_description
12134 {
12135 const unsigned int mask;
12136 const enum insn_code icode;
12137 const char * const name;
12138 const enum arm_builtins code;
12139 const enum rtx_code comparison;
12140 const unsigned int flag;
12141 };
12142
12143 static const struct builtin_description bdesc_2arg[] =
12144 {
12145 #define IWMMXT_BUILTIN(code, string, builtin) \
12146 { FL_IWMMXT, CODE_FOR_##code, "__builtin_arm_" string, \
12147 ARM_BUILTIN_##builtin, 0, 0 },
12148
12149 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (addv8qi3, "waddb", WADDB)
12150 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (addv4hi3, "waddh", WADDH)
12151 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (addv2si3, "waddw", WADDW)
12152 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (subv8qi3, "wsubb", WSUBB)
12153 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (subv4hi3, "wsubh", WSUBH)
12154 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (subv2si3, "wsubw", WSUBW)
12155 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (ssaddv8qi3, "waddbss", WADDSSB)
12156 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (ssaddv4hi3, "waddhss", WADDSSH)
12157 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (ssaddv2si3, "waddwss", WADDSSW)
12158 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (sssubv8qi3, "wsubbss", WSUBSSB)
12159 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (sssubv4hi3, "wsubhss", WSUBSSH)
12160 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (sssubv2si3, "wsubwss", WSUBSSW)
12161 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (usaddv8qi3, "waddbus", WADDUSB)
12162 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (usaddv4hi3, "waddhus", WADDUSH)
12163 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (usaddv2si3, "waddwus", WADDUSW)
12164 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (ussubv8qi3, "wsubbus", WSUBUSB)
12165 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (ussubv4hi3, "wsubhus", WSUBUSH)
12166 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (ussubv2si3, "wsubwus", WSUBUSW)
12167 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (mulv4hi3, "wmulul", WMULUL)
12168 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (smulv4hi3_highpart, "wmulsm", WMULSM)
12169 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (umulv4hi3_highpart, "wmulum", WMULUM)
12170 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (eqv8qi3, "wcmpeqb", WCMPEQB)
12171 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (eqv4hi3, "wcmpeqh", WCMPEQH)
12172 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (eqv2si3, "wcmpeqw", WCMPEQW)
12173 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (gtuv8qi3, "wcmpgtub", WCMPGTUB)
12174 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (gtuv4hi3, "wcmpgtuh", WCMPGTUH)
12175 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (gtuv2si3, "wcmpgtuw", WCMPGTUW)
12176 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (gtv8qi3, "wcmpgtsb", WCMPGTSB)
12177 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (gtv4hi3, "wcmpgtsh", WCMPGTSH)
12178 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (gtv2si3, "wcmpgtsw", WCMPGTSW)
12179 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (umaxv8qi3, "wmaxub", WMAXUB)
12180 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (smaxv8qi3, "wmaxsb", WMAXSB)
12181 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (umaxv4hi3, "wmaxuh", WMAXUH)
12182 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (smaxv4hi3, "wmaxsh", WMAXSH)
12183 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (umaxv2si3, "wmaxuw", WMAXUW)
12184 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (smaxv2si3, "wmaxsw", WMAXSW)
12185 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (uminv8qi3, "wminub", WMINUB)
12186 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (sminv8qi3, "wminsb", WMINSB)
12187 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (uminv4hi3, "wminuh", WMINUH)
12188 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (sminv4hi3, "wminsh", WMINSH)
12189 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (uminv2si3, "wminuw", WMINUW)
12190 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (sminv2si3, "wminsw", WMINSW)
12191 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_anddi3, "wand", WAND)
12192 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_nanddi3, "wandn", WANDN)
12193 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_iordi3, "wor", WOR)
12194 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_xordi3, "wxor", WXOR)
12195 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_uavgv8qi3, "wavg2b", WAVG2B)
12196 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_uavgv4hi3, "wavg2h", WAVG2H)
12197 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_uavgrndv8qi3, "wavg2br", WAVG2BR)
12198 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_uavgrndv4hi3, "wavg2hr", WAVG2HR)
12199 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckilb, "wunpckilb", WUNPCKILB)
12200 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckilh, "wunpckilh", WUNPCKILH)
12201 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckilw, "wunpckilw", WUNPCKILW)
12202 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckihb, "wunpckihb", WUNPCKIHB)
12203 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckihh, "wunpckihh", WUNPCKIHH)
12204 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckihw, "wunpckihw", WUNPCKIHW)
12205 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wmadds, "wmadds", WMADDS)
12206 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wmaddu, "wmaddu", WMADDU)
12207
12208 #define IWMMXT_BUILTIN2(code, builtin) \
12209 { FL_IWMMXT, CODE_FOR_##code, NULL, ARM_BUILTIN_##builtin, 0, 0 },
12210
12211 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (iwmmxt_wpackhss, WPACKHSS)
12212 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (iwmmxt_wpackwss, WPACKWSS)
12213 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (iwmmxt_wpackdss, WPACKDSS)
12214 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (iwmmxt_wpackhus, WPACKHUS)
12215 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (iwmmxt_wpackwus, WPACKWUS)
12216 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (iwmmxt_wpackdus, WPACKDUS)
12217 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (ashlv4hi3_di, WSLLH)
12218 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (ashlv4hi3, WSLLHI)
12219 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (ashlv2si3_di, WSLLW)
12220 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (ashlv2si3, WSLLWI)
12221 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (ashldi3_di, WSLLD)
12222 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (ashldi3_iwmmxt, WSLLDI)
12223 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (lshrv4hi3_di, WSRLH)
12224 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (lshrv4hi3, WSRLHI)
12225 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (lshrv2si3_di, WSRLW)
12226 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (lshrv2si3, WSRLWI)
12227 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (lshrdi3_di, WSRLD)
12228 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (lshrdi3_iwmmxt, WSRLDI)
12229 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (ashrv4hi3_di, WSRAH)
12230 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (ashrv4hi3, WSRAHI)
12231 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (ashrv2si3_di, WSRAW)
12232 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (ashrv2si3, WSRAWI)
12233 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (ashrdi3_di, WSRAD)
12234 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (ashrdi3_iwmmxt, WSRADI)
12235 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (rorv4hi3_di, WRORH)
12236 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (rorv4hi3, WRORHI)
12237 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (rorv2si3_di, WRORW)
12238 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (rorv2si3, WRORWI)
12239 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (rordi3_di, WRORD)
12240 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (rordi3, WRORDI)
12241 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (iwmmxt_wmacuz, WMACUZ)
12242 IWMMXT_BUILTIN2 (iwmmxt_wmacsz, WMACSZ)
12243 };
12244
12245 static const struct builtin_description bdesc_1arg[] =
12246 {
12247 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_tmovmskb, "tmovmskb", TMOVMSKB)
12248 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_tmovmskh, "tmovmskh", TMOVMSKH)
12249 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_tmovmskw, "tmovmskw", TMOVMSKW)
12250 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_waccb, "waccb", WACCB)
12251 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wacch, "wacch", WACCH)
12252 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_waccw, "waccw", WACCW)
12253 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckehub, "wunpckehub", WUNPCKEHUB)
12254 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckehuh, "wunpckehuh", WUNPCKEHUH)
12255 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckehuw, "wunpckehuw", WUNPCKEHUW)
12256 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckehsb, "wunpckehsb", WUNPCKEHSB)
12257 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckehsh, "wunpckehsh", WUNPCKEHSH)
12258 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckehsw, "wunpckehsw", WUNPCKEHSW)
12259 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckelub, "wunpckelub", WUNPCKELUB)
12260 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckeluh, "wunpckeluh", WUNPCKELUH)
12261 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckeluw, "wunpckeluw", WUNPCKELUW)
12262 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckelsb, "wunpckelsb", WUNPCKELSB)
12263 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckelsh, "wunpckelsh", WUNPCKELSH)
12264 IWMMXT_BUILTIN (iwmmxt_wunpckelsw, "wunpckelsw", WUNPCKELSW)
12265 };
12266
12267 /* Set up all the iWMMXt builtins. This is
12268 not called if TARGET_IWMMXT is zero. */
12269
12270 static void
arm_init_iwmmxt_builtins(void)12271 arm_init_iwmmxt_builtins (void)
12272 {
12273 const struct builtin_description * d;
12274 size_t i;
12275 tree endlink = void_list_node;
12276
12277 tree V2SI_type_node = build_vector_type_for_mode (intSI_type_node, V2SImode);
12278 tree V4HI_type_node = build_vector_type_for_mode (intHI_type_node, V4HImode);
12279 tree V8QI_type_node = build_vector_type_for_mode (intQI_type_node, V8QImode);
12280
12281 tree int_ftype_int
12282 = build_function_type (integer_type_node,
12283 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_type_node, endlink));
12284 tree v8qi_ftype_v8qi_v8qi_int
12285 = build_function_type (V8QI_type_node,
12286 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V8QI_type_node,
12287 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V8QI_type_node,
12288 tree_cons (NULL_TREE,
12289 integer_type_node,
12290 endlink))));
12291 tree v4hi_ftype_v4hi_int
12292 = build_function_type (V4HI_type_node,
12293 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12294 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_type_node,
12295 endlink)));
12296 tree v2si_ftype_v2si_int
12297 = build_function_type (V2SI_type_node,
12298 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V2SI_type_node,
12299 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_type_node,
12300 endlink)));
12301 tree v2si_ftype_di_di
12302 = build_function_type (V2SI_type_node,
12303 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, long_long_integer_type_node,
12304 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, long_long_integer_type_node,
12305 endlink)));
12306 tree di_ftype_di_int
12307 = build_function_type (long_long_integer_type_node,
12308 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, long_long_integer_type_node,
12309 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_type_node,
12310 endlink)));
12311 tree di_ftype_di_int_int
12312 = build_function_type (long_long_integer_type_node,
12313 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, long_long_integer_type_node,
12314 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_type_node,
12315 tree_cons (NULL_TREE,
12316 integer_type_node,
12317 endlink))));
12318 tree int_ftype_v8qi
12319 = build_function_type (integer_type_node,
12320 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V8QI_type_node,
12321 endlink));
12322 tree int_ftype_v4hi
12323 = build_function_type (integer_type_node,
12324 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12325 endlink));
12326 tree int_ftype_v2si
12327 = build_function_type (integer_type_node,
12328 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V2SI_type_node,
12329 endlink));
12330 tree int_ftype_v8qi_int
12331 = build_function_type (integer_type_node,
12332 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V8QI_type_node,
12333 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_type_node,
12334 endlink)));
12335 tree int_ftype_v4hi_int
12336 = build_function_type (integer_type_node,
12337 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12338 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_type_node,
12339 endlink)));
12340 tree int_ftype_v2si_int
12341 = build_function_type (integer_type_node,
12342 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V2SI_type_node,
12343 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_type_node,
12344 endlink)));
12345 tree v8qi_ftype_v8qi_int_int
12346 = build_function_type (V8QI_type_node,
12347 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V8QI_type_node,
12348 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_type_node,
12349 tree_cons (NULL_TREE,
12350 integer_type_node,
12351 endlink))));
12352 tree v4hi_ftype_v4hi_int_int
12353 = build_function_type (V4HI_type_node,
12354 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12355 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_type_node,
12356 tree_cons (NULL_TREE,
12357 integer_type_node,
12358 endlink))));
12359 tree v2si_ftype_v2si_int_int
12360 = build_function_type (V2SI_type_node,
12361 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V2SI_type_node,
12362 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_type_node,
12363 tree_cons (NULL_TREE,
12364 integer_type_node,
12365 endlink))));
12366 /* Miscellaneous. */
12367 tree v8qi_ftype_v4hi_v4hi
12368 = build_function_type (V8QI_type_node,
12369 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12370 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12371 endlink)));
12372 tree v4hi_ftype_v2si_v2si
12373 = build_function_type (V4HI_type_node,
12374 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V2SI_type_node,
12375 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V2SI_type_node,
12376 endlink)));
12377 tree v2si_ftype_v4hi_v4hi
12378 = build_function_type (V2SI_type_node,
12379 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12380 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12381 endlink)));
12382 tree v2si_ftype_v8qi_v8qi
12383 = build_function_type (V2SI_type_node,
12384 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V8QI_type_node,
12385 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V8QI_type_node,
12386 endlink)));
12387 tree v4hi_ftype_v4hi_di
12388 = build_function_type (V4HI_type_node,
12389 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12390 tree_cons (NULL_TREE,
12391 long_long_integer_type_node,
12392 endlink)));
12393 tree v2si_ftype_v2si_di
12394 = build_function_type (V2SI_type_node,
12395 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V2SI_type_node,
12396 tree_cons (NULL_TREE,
12397 long_long_integer_type_node,
12398 endlink)));
12399 tree void_ftype_int_int
12400 = build_function_type (void_type_node,
12401 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_type_node,
12402 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_type_node,
12403 endlink)));
12404 tree di_ftype_void
12405 = build_function_type (long_long_unsigned_type_node, endlink);
12406 tree di_ftype_v8qi
12407 = build_function_type (long_long_integer_type_node,
12408 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V8QI_type_node,
12409 endlink));
12410 tree di_ftype_v4hi
12411 = build_function_type (long_long_integer_type_node,
12412 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12413 endlink));
12414 tree di_ftype_v2si
12415 = build_function_type (long_long_integer_type_node,
12416 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V2SI_type_node,
12417 endlink));
12418 tree v2si_ftype_v4hi
12419 = build_function_type (V2SI_type_node,
12420 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12421 endlink));
12422 tree v4hi_ftype_v8qi
12423 = build_function_type (V4HI_type_node,
12424 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V8QI_type_node,
12425 endlink));
12426
12427 tree di_ftype_di_v4hi_v4hi
12428 = build_function_type (long_long_unsigned_type_node,
12429 tree_cons (NULL_TREE,
12430 long_long_unsigned_type_node,
12431 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12432 tree_cons (NULL_TREE,
12433 V4HI_type_node,
12434 endlink))));
12435
12436 tree di_ftype_v4hi_v4hi
12437 = build_function_type (long_long_unsigned_type_node,
12438 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12439 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12440 endlink)));
12441
12442 /* Normal vector binops. */
12443 tree v8qi_ftype_v8qi_v8qi
12444 = build_function_type (V8QI_type_node,
12445 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V8QI_type_node,
12446 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V8QI_type_node,
12447 endlink)));
12448 tree v4hi_ftype_v4hi_v4hi
12449 = build_function_type (V4HI_type_node,
12450 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12451 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V4HI_type_node,
12452 endlink)));
12453 tree v2si_ftype_v2si_v2si
12454 = build_function_type (V2SI_type_node,
12455 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V2SI_type_node,
12456 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, V2SI_type_node,
12457 endlink)));
12458 tree di_ftype_di_di
12459 = build_function_type (long_long_unsigned_type_node,
12460 tree_cons (NULL_TREE, long_long_unsigned_type_node,
12461 tree_cons (NULL_TREE,
12462 long_long_unsigned_type_node,
12463 endlink)));
12464
12465 /* Add all builtins that are more or less simple operations on two
12466 operands. */
12467 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_2arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_2arg); i++, d++)
12468 {
12469 /* Use one of the operands; the target can have a different mode for
12470 mask-generating compares. */
12471 enum machine_mode mode;
12472 tree type;
12473
12474 if (d->name == 0)
12475 continue;
12476
12477 mode = insn_data[d->icode].operand[1].mode;
12478
12479 switch (mode)
12480 {
12481 case V8QImode:
12482 type = v8qi_ftype_v8qi_v8qi;
12483 break;
12484 case V4HImode:
12485 type = v4hi_ftype_v4hi_v4hi;
12486 break;
12487 case V2SImode:
12488 type = v2si_ftype_v2si_v2si;
12489 break;
12490 case DImode:
12491 type = di_ftype_di_di;
12492 break;
12493
12494 default:
12495 gcc_unreachable ();
12496 }
12497
12498 def_mbuiltin (d->mask, d->name, type, d->code);
12499 }
12500
12501 /* Add the remaining MMX insns with somewhat more complicated types. */
12502 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wzero", di_ftype_void, ARM_BUILTIN_WZERO);
12503 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_setwcx", void_ftype_int_int, ARM_BUILTIN_SETWCX);
12504 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_getwcx", int_ftype_int, ARM_BUILTIN_GETWCX);
12505
12506 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsllh", v4hi_ftype_v4hi_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WSLLH);
12507 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsllw", v2si_ftype_v2si_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WSLLW);
12508 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wslld", di_ftype_di_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WSLLD);
12509 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsllhi", v4hi_ftype_v4hi_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WSLLHI);
12510 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsllwi", v2si_ftype_v2si_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WSLLWI);
12511 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wslldi", di_ftype_di_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WSLLDI);
12512
12513 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsrlh", v4hi_ftype_v4hi_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WSRLH);
12514 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsrlw", v2si_ftype_v2si_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WSRLW);
12515 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsrld", di_ftype_di_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WSRLD);
12516 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsrlhi", v4hi_ftype_v4hi_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WSRLHI);
12517 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsrlwi", v2si_ftype_v2si_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WSRLWI);
12518 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsrldi", di_ftype_di_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WSRLDI);
12519
12520 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsrah", v4hi_ftype_v4hi_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WSRAH);
12521 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsraw", v2si_ftype_v2si_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WSRAW);
12522 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsrad", di_ftype_di_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WSRAD);
12523 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsrahi", v4hi_ftype_v4hi_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WSRAHI);
12524 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsrawi", v2si_ftype_v2si_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WSRAWI);
12525 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsradi", di_ftype_di_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WSRADI);
12526
12527 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wrorh", v4hi_ftype_v4hi_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WRORH);
12528 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wrorw", v2si_ftype_v2si_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WRORW);
12529 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wrord", di_ftype_di_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WRORD);
12530 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wrorhi", v4hi_ftype_v4hi_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WRORHI);
12531 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wrorwi", v2si_ftype_v2si_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WRORWI);
12532 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wrordi", di_ftype_di_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WRORDI);
12533
12534 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wshufh", v4hi_ftype_v4hi_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WSHUFH);
12535
12536 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsadb", v2si_ftype_v8qi_v8qi, ARM_BUILTIN_WSADB);
12537 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsadh", v2si_ftype_v4hi_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_WSADH);
12538 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsadbz", v2si_ftype_v8qi_v8qi, ARM_BUILTIN_WSADBZ);
12539 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wsadhz", v2si_ftype_v4hi_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_WSADHZ);
12540
12541 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_textrmsb", int_ftype_v8qi_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMSB);
12542 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_textrmsh", int_ftype_v4hi_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMSH);
12543 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_textrmsw", int_ftype_v2si_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMSW);
12544 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_textrmub", int_ftype_v8qi_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMUB);
12545 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_textrmuh", int_ftype_v4hi_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMUH);
12546 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_textrmuw", int_ftype_v2si_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMUW);
12547 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_tinsrb", v8qi_ftype_v8qi_int_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TINSRB);
12548 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_tinsrh", v4hi_ftype_v4hi_int_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TINSRH);
12549 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_tinsrw", v2si_ftype_v2si_int_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TINSRW);
12550
12551 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_waccb", di_ftype_v8qi, ARM_BUILTIN_WACCB);
12552 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wacch", di_ftype_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_WACCH);
12553 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_waccw", di_ftype_v2si, ARM_BUILTIN_WACCW);
12554
12555 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_tmovmskb", int_ftype_v8qi, ARM_BUILTIN_TMOVMSKB);
12556 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_tmovmskh", int_ftype_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_TMOVMSKH);
12557 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_tmovmskw", int_ftype_v2si, ARM_BUILTIN_TMOVMSKW);
12558
12559 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wpackhss", v8qi_ftype_v4hi_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_WPACKHSS);
12560 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wpackhus", v8qi_ftype_v4hi_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_WPACKHUS);
12561 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wpackwus", v4hi_ftype_v2si_v2si, ARM_BUILTIN_WPACKWUS);
12562 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wpackwss", v4hi_ftype_v2si_v2si, ARM_BUILTIN_WPACKWSS);
12563 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wpackdus", v2si_ftype_di_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WPACKDUS);
12564 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wpackdss", v2si_ftype_di_di, ARM_BUILTIN_WPACKDSS);
12565
12566 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wunpckehub", v4hi_ftype_v8qi, ARM_BUILTIN_WUNPCKEHUB);
12567 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wunpckehuh", v2si_ftype_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_WUNPCKEHUH);
12568 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wunpckehuw", di_ftype_v2si, ARM_BUILTIN_WUNPCKEHUW);
12569 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wunpckehsb", v4hi_ftype_v8qi, ARM_BUILTIN_WUNPCKEHSB);
12570 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wunpckehsh", v2si_ftype_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_WUNPCKEHSH);
12571 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wunpckehsw", di_ftype_v2si, ARM_BUILTIN_WUNPCKEHSW);
12572 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wunpckelub", v4hi_ftype_v8qi, ARM_BUILTIN_WUNPCKELUB);
12573 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wunpckeluh", v2si_ftype_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_WUNPCKELUH);
12574 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wunpckeluw", di_ftype_v2si, ARM_BUILTIN_WUNPCKELUW);
12575 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wunpckelsb", v4hi_ftype_v8qi, ARM_BUILTIN_WUNPCKELSB);
12576 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wunpckelsh", v2si_ftype_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_WUNPCKELSH);
12577 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wunpckelsw", di_ftype_v2si, ARM_BUILTIN_WUNPCKELSW);
12578
12579 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wmacs", di_ftype_di_v4hi_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_WMACS);
12580 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wmacsz", di_ftype_v4hi_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_WMACSZ);
12581 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wmacu", di_ftype_di_v4hi_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_WMACU);
12582 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_wmacuz", di_ftype_v4hi_v4hi, ARM_BUILTIN_WMACUZ);
12583
12584 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_walign", v8qi_ftype_v8qi_v8qi_int, ARM_BUILTIN_WALIGN);
12585 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_tmia", di_ftype_di_int_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TMIA);
12586 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_tmiaph", di_ftype_di_int_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TMIAPH);
12587 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_tmiabb", di_ftype_di_int_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TMIABB);
12588 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_tmiabt", di_ftype_di_int_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TMIABT);
12589 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_tmiatb", di_ftype_di_int_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TMIATB);
12590 def_mbuiltin (FL_IWMMXT, "__builtin_arm_tmiatt", di_ftype_di_int_int, ARM_BUILTIN_TMIATT);
12591 }
12592
12593 static void
arm_init_tls_builtins(void)12594 arm_init_tls_builtins (void)
12595 {
12596 tree ftype;
12597 tree nothrow = tree_cons (get_identifier ("nothrow"), NULL, NULL);
12598 tree const_nothrow = tree_cons (get_identifier ("const"), NULL, nothrow);
12599
12600 ftype = build_function_type (ptr_type_node, void_list_node);
12601 lang_hooks.builtin_function ("__builtin_thread_pointer", ftype,
12602 ARM_BUILTIN_THREAD_POINTER, BUILT_IN_MD,
12603 NULL, const_nothrow);
12604 }
12605
12606 static void
arm_init_builtins(void)12607 arm_init_builtins (void)
12608 {
12609 arm_init_tls_builtins ();
12610
12611 if (TARGET_REALLY_IWMMXT)
12612 arm_init_iwmmxt_builtins ();
12613 }
12614
12615 /* Errors in the source file can cause expand_expr to return const0_rtx
12616 where we expect a vector. To avoid crashing, use one of the vector
12617 clear instructions. */
12618
12619 static rtx
safe_vector_operand(rtx x,enum machine_mode mode)12620 safe_vector_operand (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode)
12621 {
12622 if (x != const0_rtx)
12623 return x;
12624 x = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
12625
12626 emit_insn (gen_iwmmxt_clrdi (mode == DImode ? x
12627 : gen_rtx_SUBREG (DImode, x, 0)));
12628 return x;
12629 }
12630
12631 /* Subroutine of arm_expand_builtin to take care of binop insns. */
12632
12633 static rtx
arm_expand_binop_builtin(enum insn_code icode,tree arglist,rtx target)12634 arm_expand_binop_builtin (enum insn_code icode,
12635 tree arglist, rtx target)
12636 {
12637 rtx pat;
12638 tree arg0 = TREE_VALUE (arglist);
12639 tree arg1 = TREE_VALUE (TREE_CHAIN (arglist));
12640 rtx op0 = expand_normal (arg0);
12641 rtx op1 = expand_normal (arg1);
12642 enum machine_mode tmode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
12643 enum machine_mode mode0 = insn_data[icode].operand[1].mode;
12644 enum machine_mode mode1 = insn_data[icode].operand[2].mode;
12645
12646 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode0))
12647 op0 = safe_vector_operand (op0, mode0);
12648 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode1))
12649 op1 = safe_vector_operand (op1, mode1);
12650
12651 if (! target
12652 || GET_MODE (target) != tmode
12653 || ! (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, tmode))
12654 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode);
12655
12656 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (op0) == mode0 && GET_MODE (op1) == mode1);
12657
12658 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[1].predicate) (op0, mode0))
12659 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode0, op0);
12660 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[2].predicate) (op1, mode1))
12661 op1 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode1, op1);
12662
12663 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
12664 if (! pat)
12665 return 0;
12666 emit_insn (pat);
12667 return target;
12668 }
12669
12670 /* Subroutine of arm_expand_builtin to take care of unop insns. */
12671
12672 static rtx
arm_expand_unop_builtin(enum insn_code icode,tree arglist,rtx target,int do_load)12673 arm_expand_unop_builtin (enum insn_code icode,
12674 tree arglist, rtx target, int do_load)
12675 {
12676 rtx pat;
12677 tree arg0 = TREE_VALUE (arglist);
12678 rtx op0 = expand_normal (arg0);
12679 enum machine_mode tmode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
12680 enum machine_mode mode0 = insn_data[icode].operand[1].mode;
12681
12682 if (! target
12683 || GET_MODE (target) != tmode
12684 || ! (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, tmode))
12685 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode);
12686 if (do_load)
12687 op0 = gen_rtx_MEM (mode0, copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, op0));
12688 else
12689 {
12690 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode0))
12691 op0 = safe_vector_operand (op0, mode0);
12692
12693 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[1].predicate) (op0, mode0))
12694 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode0, op0);
12695 }
12696
12697 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0);
12698 if (! pat)
12699 return 0;
12700 emit_insn (pat);
12701 return target;
12702 }
12703
12704 /* Expand an expression EXP that calls a built-in function,
12705 with result going to TARGET if that's convenient
12706 (and in mode MODE if that's convenient).
12707 SUBTARGET may be used as the target for computing one of EXP's operands.
12708 IGNORE is nonzero if the value is to be ignored. */
12709
12710 static rtx
arm_expand_builtin(tree exp,rtx target,rtx subtarget ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)12711 arm_expand_builtin (tree exp,
12712 rtx target,
12713 rtx subtarget ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12714 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
12715 int ignore ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12716 {
12717 const struct builtin_description * d;
12718 enum insn_code icode;
12719 tree fndecl = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
12720 tree arglist = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
12721 tree arg0;
12722 tree arg1;
12723 tree arg2;
12724 rtx op0;
12725 rtx op1;
12726 rtx op2;
12727 rtx pat;
12728 int fcode = DECL_FUNCTION_CODE (fndecl);
12729 size_t i;
12730 enum machine_mode tmode;
12731 enum machine_mode mode0;
12732 enum machine_mode mode1;
12733 enum machine_mode mode2;
12734
12735 switch (fcode)
12736 {
12737 case ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMSB:
12738 case ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMUB:
12739 case ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMSH:
12740 case ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMUH:
12741 case ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMSW:
12742 case ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMUW:
12743 icode = (fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMSB ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_textrmsb
12744 : fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMUB ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_textrmub
12745 : fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMSH ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_textrmsh
12746 : fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_TEXTRMUH ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_textrmuh
12747 : CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_textrmw);
12748
12749 arg0 = TREE_VALUE (arglist);
12750 arg1 = TREE_VALUE (TREE_CHAIN (arglist));
12751 op0 = expand_normal (arg0);
12752 op1 = expand_normal (arg1);
12753 tmode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
12754 mode0 = insn_data[icode].operand[1].mode;
12755 mode1 = insn_data[icode].operand[2].mode;
12756
12757 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[1].predicate) (op0, mode0))
12758 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode0, op0);
12759 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[2].predicate) (op1, mode1))
12760 {
12761 /* @@@ better error message */
12762 error ("selector must be an immediate");
12763 return gen_reg_rtx (tmode);
12764 }
12765 if (target == 0
12766 || GET_MODE (target) != tmode
12767 || ! (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, tmode))
12768 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode);
12769 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
12770 if (! pat)
12771 return 0;
12772 emit_insn (pat);
12773 return target;
12774
12775 case ARM_BUILTIN_TINSRB:
12776 case ARM_BUILTIN_TINSRH:
12777 case ARM_BUILTIN_TINSRW:
12778 icode = (fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_TINSRB ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_tinsrb
12779 : fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_TINSRH ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_tinsrh
12780 : CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_tinsrw);
12781 arg0 = TREE_VALUE (arglist);
12782 arg1 = TREE_VALUE (TREE_CHAIN (arglist));
12783 arg2 = TREE_VALUE (TREE_CHAIN (TREE_CHAIN (arglist)));
12784 op0 = expand_normal (arg0);
12785 op1 = expand_normal (arg1);
12786 op2 = expand_normal (arg2);
12787 tmode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
12788 mode0 = insn_data[icode].operand[1].mode;
12789 mode1 = insn_data[icode].operand[2].mode;
12790 mode2 = insn_data[icode].operand[3].mode;
12791
12792 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[1].predicate) (op0, mode0))
12793 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode0, op0);
12794 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[2].predicate) (op1, mode1))
12795 op1 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode1, op1);
12796 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[3].predicate) (op2, mode2))
12797 {
12798 /* @@@ better error message */
12799 error ("selector must be an immediate");
12800 return const0_rtx;
12801 }
12802 if (target == 0
12803 || GET_MODE (target) != tmode
12804 || ! (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, tmode))
12805 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode);
12806 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1, op2);
12807 if (! pat)
12808 return 0;
12809 emit_insn (pat);
12810 return target;
12811
12812 case ARM_BUILTIN_SETWCX:
12813 arg0 = TREE_VALUE (arglist);
12814 arg1 = TREE_VALUE (TREE_CHAIN (arglist));
12815 op0 = force_reg (SImode, expand_normal (arg0));
12816 op1 = expand_normal (arg1);
12817 emit_insn (gen_iwmmxt_tmcr (op1, op0));
12818 return 0;
12819
12820 case ARM_BUILTIN_GETWCX:
12821 arg0 = TREE_VALUE (arglist);
12822 op0 = expand_normal (arg0);
12823 target = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
12824 emit_insn (gen_iwmmxt_tmrc (target, op0));
12825 return target;
12826
12827 case ARM_BUILTIN_WSHUFH:
12828 icode = CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_wshufh;
12829 arg0 = TREE_VALUE (arglist);
12830 arg1 = TREE_VALUE (TREE_CHAIN (arglist));
12831 op0 = expand_normal (arg0);
12832 op1 = expand_normal (arg1);
12833 tmode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
12834 mode1 = insn_data[icode].operand[1].mode;
12835 mode2 = insn_data[icode].operand[2].mode;
12836
12837 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[1].predicate) (op0, mode1))
12838 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode1, op0);
12839 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[2].predicate) (op1, mode2))
12840 {
12841 /* @@@ better error message */
12842 error ("mask must be an immediate");
12843 return const0_rtx;
12844 }
12845 if (target == 0
12846 || GET_MODE (target) != tmode
12847 || ! (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, tmode))
12848 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode);
12849 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1);
12850 if (! pat)
12851 return 0;
12852 emit_insn (pat);
12853 return target;
12854
12855 case ARM_BUILTIN_WSADB:
12856 return arm_expand_binop_builtin (CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_wsadb, arglist, target);
12857 case ARM_BUILTIN_WSADH:
12858 return arm_expand_binop_builtin (CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_wsadh, arglist, target);
12859 case ARM_BUILTIN_WSADBZ:
12860 return arm_expand_binop_builtin (CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_wsadbz, arglist, target);
12861 case ARM_BUILTIN_WSADHZ:
12862 return arm_expand_binop_builtin (CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_wsadhz, arglist, target);
12863
12864 /* Several three-argument builtins. */
12865 case ARM_BUILTIN_WMACS:
12866 case ARM_BUILTIN_WMACU:
12867 case ARM_BUILTIN_WALIGN:
12868 case ARM_BUILTIN_TMIA:
12869 case ARM_BUILTIN_TMIAPH:
12870 case ARM_BUILTIN_TMIATT:
12871 case ARM_BUILTIN_TMIATB:
12872 case ARM_BUILTIN_TMIABT:
12873 case ARM_BUILTIN_TMIABB:
12874 icode = (fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_WMACS ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_wmacs
12875 : fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_WMACU ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_wmacu
12876 : fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_TMIA ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_tmia
12877 : fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_TMIAPH ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_tmiaph
12878 : fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_TMIABB ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_tmiabb
12879 : fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_TMIABT ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_tmiabt
12880 : fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_TMIATB ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_tmiatb
12881 : fcode == ARM_BUILTIN_TMIATT ? CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_tmiatt
12882 : CODE_FOR_iwmmxt_walign);
12883 arg0 = TREE_VALUE (arglist);
12884 arg1 = TREE_VALUE (TREE_CHAIN (arglist));
12885 arg2 = TREE_VALUE (TREE_CHAIN (TREE_CHAIN (arglist)));
12886 op0 = expand_normal (arg0);
12887 op1 = expand_normal (arg1);
12888 op2 = expand_normal (arg2);
12889 tmode = insn_data[icode].operand[0].mode;
12890 mode0 = insn_data[icode].operand[1].mode;
12891 mode1 = insn_data[icode].operand[2].mode;
12892 mode2 = insn_data[icode].operand[3].mode;
12893
12894 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[1].predicate) (op0, mode0))
12895 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode0, op0);
12896 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[2].predicate) (op1, mode1))
12897 op1 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode1, op1);
12898 if (! (*insn_data[icode].operand[3].predicate) (op2, mode2))
12899 op2 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode2, op2);
12900 if (target == 0
12901 || GET_MODE (target) != tmode
12902 || ! (*insn_data[icode].operand[0].predicate) (target, tmode))
12903 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode);
12904 pat = GEN_FCN (icode) (target, op0, op1, op2);
12905 if (! pat)
12906 return 0;
12907 emit_insn (pat);
12908 return target;
12909
12910 case ARM_BUILTIN_WZERO:
12911 target = gen_reg_rtx (DImode);
12912 emit_insn (gen_iwmmxt_clrdi (target));
12913 return target;
12914
12915 case ARM_BUILTIN_THREAD_POINTER:
12916 return arm_load_tp (target);
12917
12918 default:
12919 break;
12920 }
12921
12922 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_2arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_2arg); i++, d++)
12923 if (d->code == (const enum arm_builtins) fcode)
12924 return arm_expand_binop_builtin (d->icode, arglist, target);
12925
12926 for (i = 0, d = bdesc_1arg; i < ARRAY_SIZE (bdesc_1arg); i++, d++)
12927 if (d->code == (const enum arm_builtins) fcode)
12928 return arm_expand_unop_builtin (d->icode, arglist, target, 0);
12929
12930 /* @@@ Should really do something sensible here. */
12931 return NULL_RTX;
12932 }
12933
12934 /* Return the number (counting from 0) of
12935 the least significant set bit in MASK. */
12936
12937 inline static int
number_of_first_bit_set(unsigned mask)12938 number_of_first_bit_set (unsigned mask)
12939 {
12940 int bit;
12941
12942 for (bit = 0;
12943 (mask & (1 << bit)) == 0;
12944 ++bit)
12945 continue;
12946
12947 return bit;
12948 }
12949
12950 /* Emit code to push or pop registers to or from the stack. F is the
12951 assembly file. MASK is the registers to push or pop. PUSH is
12952 nonzero if we should push, and zero if we should pop. For debugging
12953 output, if pushing, adjust CFA_OFFSET by the amount of space added
12954 to the stack. REAL_REGS should have the same number of bits set as
12955 MASK, and will be used instead (in the same order) to describe which
12956 registers were saved - this is used to mark the save slots when we
12957 push high registers after moving them to low registers. */
12958 static void
thumb_pushpop(FILE * f,unsigned long mask,int push,int * cfa_offset,unsigned long real_regs)12959 thumb_pushpop (FILE *f, unsigned long mask, int push, int *cfa_offset,
12960 unsigned long real_regs)
12961 {
12962 int regno;
12963 int lo_mask = mask & 0xFF;
12964 int pushed_words = 0;
12965
12966 gcc_assert (mask);
12967
12968 if (lo_mask == 0 && !push && (mask & (1 << PC_REGNUM)))
12969 {
12970 /* Special case. Do not generate a POP PC statement here, do it in
12971 thumb_exit() */
12972 thumb_exit (f, -1);
12973 return;
12974 }
12975
12976 if (ARM_EABI_UNWIND_TABLES && push)
12977 {
12978 fprintf (f, "\t.save\t{");
12979 for (regno = 0; regno < 15; regno++)
12980 {
12981 if (real_regs & (1 << regno))
12982 {
12983 if (real_regs & ((1 << regno) -1))
12984 fprintf (f, ", ");
12985 asm_fprintf (f, "%r", regno);
12986 }
12987 }
12988 fprintf (f, "}\n");
12989 }
12990
12991 fprintf (f, "\t%s\t{", push ? "push" : "pop");
12992
12993 /* Look at the low registers first. */
12994 for (regno = 0; regno <= LAST_LO_REGNUM; regno++, lo_mask >>= 1)
12995 {
12996 if (lo_mask & 1)
12997 {
12998 asm_fprintf (f, "%r", regno);
12999
13000 if ((lo_mask & ~1) != 0)
13001 fprintf (f, ", ");
13002
13003 pushed_words++;
13004 }
13005 }
13006
13007 if (push && (mask & (1 << LR_REGNUM)))
13008 {
13009 /* Catch pushing the LR. */
13010 if (mask & 0xFF)
13011 fprintf (f, ", ");
13012
13013 asm_fprintf (f, "%r", LR_REGNUM);
13014
13015 pushed_words++;
13016 }
13017 else if (!push && (mask & (1 << PC_REGNUM)))
13018 {
13019 /* Catch popping the PC. */
13020 if (TARGET_INTERWORK || TARGET_BACKTRACE
13021 || current_function_calls_eh_return)
13022 {
13023 /* The PC is never poped directly, instead
13024 it is popped into r3 and then BX is used. */
13025 fprintf (f, "}\n");
13026
13027 thumb_exit (f, -1);
13028
13029 return;
13030 }
13031 else
13032 {
13033 if (mask & 0xFF)
13034 fprintf (f, ", ");
13035
13036 asm_fprintf (f, "%r", PC_REGNUM);
13037 }
13038 }
13039
13040 fprintf (f, "}\n");
13041
13042 if (push && pushed_words && dwarf2out_do_frame ())
13043 {
13044 char *l = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
13045 int pushed_mask = real_regs;
13046
13047 *cfa_offset += pushed_words * 4;
13048 dwarf2out_def_cfa (l, SP_REGNUM, *cfa_offset);
13049
13050 pushed_words = 0;
13051 pushed_mask = real_regs;
13052 for (regno = 0; regno <= 14; regno++, pushed_mask >>= 1)
13053 {
13054 if (pushed_mask & 1)
13055 dwarf2out_reg_save (l, regno, 4 * pushed_words++ - *cfa_offset);
13056 }
13057 }
13058 }
13059
13060 /* Generate code to return from a thumb function.
13061 If 'reg_containing_return_addr' is -1, then the return address is
13062 actually on the stack, at the stack pointer. */
13063 static void
thumb_exit(FILE * f,int reg_containing_return_addr)13064 thumb_exit (FILE *f, int reg_containing_return_addr)
13065 {
13066 unsigned regs_available_for_popping;
13067 unsigned regs_to_pop;
13068 int pops_needed;
13069 unsigned available;
13070 unsigned required;
13071 int mode;
13072 int size;
13073 int restore_a4 = FALSE;
13074
13075 /* Compute the registers we need to pop. */
13076 regs_to_pop = 0;
13077 pops_needed = 0;
13078
13079 if (reg_containing_return_addr == -1)
13080 {
13081 regs_to_pop |= 1 << LR_REGNUM;
13082 ++pops_needed;
13083 }
13084
13085 if (TARGET_BACKTRACE)
13086 {
13087 /* Restore the (ARM) frame pointer and stack pointer. */
13088 regs_to_pop |= (1 << ARM_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM) | (1 << SP_REGNUM);
13089 pops_needed += 2;
13090 }
13091
13092 /* If there is nothing to pop then just emit the BX instruction and
13093 return. */
13094 if (pops_needed == 0)
13095 {
13096 if (current_function_calls_eh_return)
13097 asm_fprintf (f, "\tadd\t%r, %r\n", SP_REGNUM, ARM_EH_STACKADJ_REGNUM);
13098
13099 asm_fprintf (f, "\tbx\t%r\n", reg_containing_return_addr);
13100 return;
13101 }
13102 /* Otherwise if we are not supporting interworking and we have not created
13103 a backtrace structure and the function was not entered in ARM mode then
13104 just pop the return address straight into the PC. */
13105 else if (!TARGET_INTERWORK
13106 && !TARGET_BACKTRACE
13107 && !is_called_in_ARM_mode (current_function_decl)
13108 && !current_function_calls_eh_return)
13109 {
13110 asm_fprintf (f, "\tpop\t{%r}\n", PC_REGNUM);
13111 return;
13112 }
13113
13114 /* Find out how many of the (return) argument registers we can corrupt. */
13115 regs_available_for_popping = 0;
13116
13117 /* If returning via __builtin_eh_return, the bottom three registers
13118 all contain information needed for the return. */
13119 if (current_function_calls_eh_return)
13120 size = 12;
13121 else
13122 {
13123 /* If we can deduce the registers used from the function's
13124 return value. This is more reliable that examining
13125 regs_ever_live[] because that will be set if the register is
13126 ever used in the function, not just if the register is used
13127 to hold a return value. */
13128
13129 if (current_function_return_rtx != 0)
13130 mode = GET_MODE (current_function_return_rtx);
13131 else
13132 mode = DECL_MODE (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl));
13133
13134 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
13135
13136 if (size == 0)
13137 {
13138 /* In a void function we can use any argument register.
13139 In a function that returns a structure on the stack
13140 we can use the second and third argument registers. */
13141 if (mode == VOIDmode)
13142 regs_available_for_popping =
13143 (1 << ARG_REGISTER (1))
13144 | (1 << ARG_REGISTER (2))
13145 | (1 << ARG_REGISTER (3));
13146 else
13147 regs_available_for_popping =
13148 (1 << ARG_REGISTER (2))
13149 | (1 << ARG_REGISTER (3));
13150 }
13151 else if (size <= 4)
13152 regs_available_for_popping =
13153 (1 << ARG_REGISTER (2))
13154 | (1 << ARG_REGISTER (3));
13155 else if (size <= 8)
13156 regs_available_for_popping =
13157 (1 << ARG_REGISTER (3));
13158 }
13159
13160 /* Match registers to be popped with registers into which we pop them. */
13161 for (available = regs_available_for_popping,
13162 required = regs_to_pop;
13163 required != 0 && available != 0;
13164 available &= ~(available & - available),
13165 required &= ~(required & - required))
13166 -- pops_needed;
13167
13168 /* If we have any popping registers left over, remove them. */
13169 if (available > 0)
13170 regs_available_for_popping &= ~available;
13171
13172 /* Otherwise if we need another popping register we can use
13173 the fourth argument register. */
13174 else if (pops_needed)
13175 {
13176 /* If we have not found any free argument registers and
13177 reg a4 contains the return address, we must move it. */
13178 if (regs_available_for_popping == 0
13179 && reg_containing_return_addr == LAST_ARG_REGNUM)
13180 {
13181 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", LR_REGNUM, LAST_ARG_REGNUM);
13182 reg_containing_return_addr = LR_REGNUM;
13183 }
13184 else if (size > 12)
13185 {
13186 /* Register a4 is being used to hold part of the return value,
13187 but we have dire need of a free, low register. */
13188 restore_a4 = TRUE;
13189
13190 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n",IP_REGNUM, LAST_ARG_REGNUM);
13191 }
13192
13193 if (reg_containing_return_addr != LAST_ARG_REGNUM)
13194 {
13195 /* The fourth argument register is available. */
13196 regs_available_for_popping |= 1 << LAST_ARG_REGNUM;
13197
13198 --pops_needed;
13199 }
13200 }
13201
13202 /* Pop as many registers as we can. */
13203 thumb_pushpop (f, regs_available_for_popping, FALSE, NULL,
13204 regs_available_for_popping);
13205
13206 /* Process the registers we popped. */
13207 if (reg_containing_return_addr == -1)
13208 {
13209 /* The return address was popped into the lowest numbered register. */
13210 regs_to_pop &= ~(1 << LR_REGNUM);
13211
13212 reg_containing_return_addr =
13213 number_of_first_bit_set (regs_available_for_popping);
13214
13215 /* Remove this register for the mask of available registers, so that
13216 the return address will not be corrupted by further pops. */
13217 regs_available_for_popping &= ~(1 << reg_containing_return_addr);
13218 }
13219
13220 /* If we popped other registers then handle them here. */
13221 if (regs_available_for_popping)
13222 {
13223 int frame_pointer;
13224
13225 /* Work out which register currently contains the frame pointer. */
13226 frame_pointer = number_of_first_bit_set (regs_available_for_popping);
13227
13228 /* Move it into the correct place. */
13229 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n",
13230 ARM_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, frame_pointer);
13231
13232 /* (Temporarily) remove it from the mask of popped registers. */
13233 regs_available_for_popping &= ~(1 << frame_pointer);
13234 regs_to_pop &= ~(1 << ARM_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
13235
13236 if (regs_available_for_popping)
13237 {
13238 int stack_pointer;
13239
13240 /* We popped the stack pointer as well,
13241 find the register that contains it. */
13242 stack_pointer = number_of_first_bit_set (regs_available_for_popping);
13243
13244 /* Move it into the stack register. */
13245 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", SP_REGNUM, stack_pointer);
13246
13247 /* At this point we have popped all necessary registers, so
13248 do not worry about restoring regs_available_for_popping
13249 to its correct value:
13250
13251 assert (pops_needed == 0)
13252 assert (regs_available_for_popping == (1 << frame_pointer))
13253 assert (regs_to_pop == (1 << STACK_POINTER)) */
13254 }
13255 else
13256 {
13257 /* Since we have just move the popped value into the frame
13258 pointer, the popping register is available for reuse, and
13259 we know that we still have the stack pointer left to pop. */
13260 regs_available_for_popping |= (1 << frame_pointer);
13261 }
13262 }
13263
13264 /* If we still have registers left on the stack, but we no longer have
13265 any registers into which we can pop them, then we must move the return
13266 address into the link register and make available the register that
13267 contained it. */
13268 if (regs_available_for_popping == 0 && pops_needed > 0)
13269 {
13270 regs_available_for_popping |= 1 << reg_containing_return_addr;
13271
13272 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", LR_REGNUM,
13273 reg_containing_return_addr);
13274
13275 reg_containing_return_addr = LR_REGNUM;
13276 }
13277
13278 /* If we have registers left on the stack then pop some more.
13279 We know that at most we will want to pop FP and SP. */
13280 if (pops_needed > 0)
13281 {
13282 int popped_into;
13283 int move_to;
13284
13285 thumb_pushpop (f, regs_available_for_popping, FALSE, NULL,
13286 regs_available_for_popping);
13287
13288 /* We have popped either FP or SP.
13289 Move whichever one it is into the correct register. */
13290 popped_into = number_of_first_bit_set (regs_available_for_popping);
13291 move_to = number_of_first_bit_set (regs_to_pop);
13292
13293 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", move_to, popped_into);
13294
13295 regs_to_pop &= ~(1 << move_to);
13296
13297 --pops_needed;
13298 }
13299
13300 /* If we still have not popped everything then we must have only
13301 had one register available to us and we are now popping the SP. */
13302 if (pops_needed > 0)
13303 {
13304 int popped_into;
13305
13306 thumb_pushpop (f, regs_available_for_popping, FALSE, NULL,
13307 regs_available_for_popping);
13308
13309 popped_into = number_of_first_bit_set (regs_available_for_popping);
13310
13311 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", SP_REGNUM, popped_into);
13312 /*
13313 assert (regs_to_pop == (1 << STACK_POINTER))
13314 assert (pops_needed == 1)
13315 */
13316 }
13317
13318 /* If necessary restore the a4 register. */
13319 if (restore_a4)
13320 {
13321 if (reg_containing_return_addr != LR_REGNUM)
13322 {
13323 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", LR_REGNUM, LAST_ARG_REGNUM);
13324 reg_containing_return_addr = LR_REGNUM;
13325 }
13326
13327 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", LAST_ARG_REGNUM, IP_REGNUM);
13328 }
13329
13330 if (current_function_calls_eh_return)
13331 asm_fprintf (f, "\tadd\t%r, %r\n", SP_REGNUM, ARM_EH_STACKADJ_REGNUM);
13332
13333 /* Return to caller. */
13334 asm_fprintf (f, "\tbx\t%r\n", reg_containing_return_addr);
13335 }
13336
13337
13338 void
thumb_final_prescan_insn(rtx insn)13339 thumb_final_prescan_insn (rtx insn)
13340 {
13341 if (flag_print_asm_name)
13342 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "%@ 0x%04x\n",
13343 INSN_ADDRESSES (INSN_UID (insn)));
13344 }
13345
13346 int
thumb_shiftable_const(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT val)13347 thumb_shiftable_const (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT val)
13348 {
13349 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask = 0xff;
13350 int i;
13351
13352 if (val == 0) /* XXX */
13353 return 0;
13354
13355 for (i = 0; i < 25; i++)
13356 if ((val & (mask << i)) == val)
13357 return 1;
13358
13359 return 0;
13360 }
13361
13362 /* Returns nonzero if the current function contains,
13363 or might contain a far jump. */
13364 static int
thumb_far_jump_used_p(void)13365 thumb_far_jump_used_p (void)
13366 {
13367 rtx insn;
13368
13369 /* This test is only important for leaf functions. */
13370 /* assert (!leaf_function_p ()); */
13371
13372 /* If we have already decided that far jumps may be used,
13373 do not bother checking again, and always return true even if
13374 it turns out that they are not being used. Once we have made
13375 the decision that far jumps are present (and that hence the link
13376 register will be pushed onto the stack) we cannot go back on it. */
13377 if (cfun->machine->far_jump_used)
13378 return 1;
13379
13380 /* If this function is not being called from the prologue/epilogue
13381 generation code then it must be being called from the
13382 INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET macro. */
13383 if (!(ARM_DOUBLEWORD_ALIGN || reload_completed))
13384 {
13385 /* In this case we know that we are being asked about the elimination
13386 of the arg pointer register. If that register is not being used,
13387 then there are no arguments on the stack, and we do not have to
13388 worry that a far jump might force the prologue to push the link
13389 register, changing the stack offsets. In this case we can just
13390 return false, since the presence of far jumps in the function will
13391 not affect stack offsets.
13392
13393 If the arg pointer is live (or if it was live, but has now been
13394 eliminated and so set to dead) then we do have to test to see if
13395 the function might contain a far jump. This test can lead to some
13396 false negatives, since before reload is completed, then length of
13397 branch instructions is not known, so gcc defaults to returning their
13398 longest length, which in turn sets the far jump attribute to true.
13399
13400 A false negative will not result in bad code being generated, but it
13401 will result in a needless push and pop of the link register. We
13402 hope that this does not occur too often.
13403
13404 If we need doubleword stack alignment this could affect the other
13405 elimination offsets so we can't risk getting it wrong. */
13406 if (regs_ever_live [ARG_POINTER_REGNUM])
13407 cfun->machine->arg_pointer_live = 1;
13408 else if (!cfun->machine->arg_pointer_live)
13409 return 0;
13410 }
13411
13412 /* Check to see if the function contains a branch
13413 insn with the far jump attribute set. */
13414 for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
13415 {
13416 if (GET_CODE (insn) == JUMP_INSN
13417 /* Ignore tablejump patterns. */
13418 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != ADDR_VEC
13419 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != ADDR_DIFF_VEC
13420 && get_attr_far_jump (insn) == FAR_JUMP_YES
13421 )
13422 {
13423 /* Record the fact that we have decided that
13424 the function does use far jumps. */
13425 cfun->machine->far_jump_used = 1;
13426 return 1;
13427 }
13428 }
13429
13430 return 0;
13431 }
13432
13433 /* Return nonzero if FUNC must be entered in ARM mode. */
13434 int
is_called_in_ARM_mode(tree func)13435 is_called_in_ARM_mode (tree func)
13436 {
13437 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (func) == FUNCTION_DECL);
13438
13439 /* Ignore the problem about functions whose address is taken. */
13440 if (TARGET_CALLEE_INTERWORKING && TREE_PUBLIC (func))
13441 return TRUE;
13442
13443 #ifdef ARM_PE
13444 return lookup_attribute ("interfacearm", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (func)) != NULL_TREE;
13445 #else
13446 return FALSE;
13447 #endif
13448 }
13449
13450 /* The bits which aren't usefully expanded as rtl. */
13451 const char *
thumb_unexpanded_epilogue(void)13452 thumb_unexpanded_epilogue (void)
13453 {
13454 int regno;
13455 unsigned long live_regs_mask = 0;
13456 int high_regs_pushed = 0;
13457 int had_to_push_lr;
13458 int size;
13459
13460 if (return_used_this_function)
13461 return "";
13462
13463 if (IS_NAKED (arm_current_func_type ()))
13464 return "";
13465
13466 live_regs_mask = thumb_compute_save_reg_mask ();
13467 high_regs_pushed = bit_count (live_regs_mask & 0x0f00);
13468
13469 /* If we can deduce the registers used from the function's return value.
13470 This is more reliable that examining regs_ever_live[] because that
13471 will be set if the register is ever used in the function, not just if
13472 the register is used to hold a return value. */
13473 size = arm_size_return_regs ();
13474
13475 /* The prolog may have pushed some high registers to use as
13476 work registers. e.g. the testsuite file:
13477 gcc/testsuite/gcc/gcc.c-torture/execute/complex-2.c
13478 compiles to produce:
13479 push {r4, r5, r6, r7, lr}
13480 mov r7, r9
13481 mov r6, r8
13482 push {r6, r7}
13483 as part of the prolog. We have to undo that pushing here. */
13484
13485 if (high_regs_pushed)
13486 {
13487 unsigned long mask = live_regs_mask & 0xff;
13488 int next_hi_reg;
13489
13490 /* The available low registers depend on the size of the value we are
13491 returning. */
13492 if (size <= 12)
13493 mask |= 1 << 3;
13494 if (size <= 8)
13495 mask |= 1 << 2;
13496
13497 if (mask == 0)
13498 /* Oh dear! We have no low registers into which we can pop
13499 high registers! */
13500 internal_error
13501 ("no low registers available for popping high registers");
13502
13503 for (next_hi_reg = 8; next_hi_reg < 13; next_hi_reg++)
13504 if (live_regs_mask & (1 << next_hi_reg))
13505 break;
13506
13507 while (high_regs_pushed)
13508 {
13509 /* Find lo register(s) into which the high register(s) can
13510 be popped. */
13511 for (regno = 0; regno <= LAST_LO_REGNUM; regno++)
13512 {
13513 if (mask & (1 << regno))
13514 high_regs_pushed--;
13515 if (high_regs_pushed == 0)
13516 break;
13517 }
13518
13519 mask &= (2 << regno) - 1; /* A noop if regno == 8 */
13520
13521 /* Pop the values into the low register(s). */
13522 thumb_pushpop (asm_out_file, mask, 0, NULL, mask);
13523
13524 /* Move the value(s) into the high registers. */
13525 for (regno = 0; regno <= LAST_LO_REGNUM; regno++)
13526 {
13527 if (mask & (1 << regno))
13528 {
13529 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", next_hi_reg,
13530 regno);
13531
13532 for (next_hi_reg++; next_hi_reg < 13; next_hi_reg++)
13533 if (live_regs_mask & (1 << next_hi_reg))
13534 break;
13535 }
13536 }
13537 }
13538 live_regs_mask &= ~0x0f00;
13539 }
13540
13541 had_to_push_lr = (live_regs_mask & (1 << LR_REGNUM)) != 0;
13542 live_regs_mask &= 0xff;
13543
13544 if (current_function_pretend_args_size == 0 || TARGET_BACKTRACE)
13545 {
13546 /* Pop the return address into the PC. */
13547 if (had_to_push_lr)
13548 live_regs_mask |= 1 << PC_REGNUM;
13549
13550 /* Either no argument registers were pushed or a backtrace
13551 structure was created which includes an adjusted stack
13552 pointer, so just pop everything. */
13553 if (live_regs_mask)
13554 thumb_pushpop (asm_out_file, live_regs_mask, FALSE, NULL,
13555 live_regs_mask);
13556
13557 /* We have either just popped the return address into the
13558 PC or it is was kept in LR for the entire function. */
13559 if (!had_to_push_lr)
13560 thumb_exit (asm_out_file, LR_REGNUM);
13561 }
13562 else
13563 {
13564 /* Pop everything but the return address. */
13565 if (live_regs_mask)
13566 thumb_pushpop (asm_out_file, live_regs_mask, FALSE, NULL,
13567 live_regs_mask);
13568
13569 if (had_to_push_lr)
13570 {
13571 if (size > 12)
13572 {
13573 /* We have no free low regs, so save one. */
13574 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", IP_REGNUM,
13575 LAST_ARG_REGNUM);
13576 }
13577
13578 /* Get the return address into a temporary register. */
13579 thumb_pushpop (asm_out_file, 1 << LAST_ARG_REGNUM, 0, NULL,
13580 1 << LAST_ARG_REGNUM);
13581
13582 if (size > 12)
13583 {
13584 /* Move the return address to lr. */
13585 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", LR_REGNUM,
13586 LAST_ARG_REGNUM);
13587 /* Restore the low register. */
13588 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", LAST_ARG_REGNUM,
13589 IP_REGNUM);
13590 regno = LR_REGNUM;
13591 }
13592 else
13593 regno = LAST_ARG_REGNUM;
13594 }
13595 else
13596 regno = LR_REGNUM;
13597
13598 /* Remove the argument registers that were pushed onto the stack. */
13599 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tadd\t%r, %r, #%d\n",
13600 SP_REGNUM, SP_REGNUM,
13601 current_function_pretend_args_size);
13602
13603 thumb_exit (asm_out_file, regno);
13604 }
13605
13606 return "";
13607 }
13608
13609 /* Functions to save and restore machine-specific function data. */
13610 static struct machine_function *
arm_init_machine_status(void)13611 arm_init_machine_status (void)
13612 {
13613 struct machine_function *machine;
13614 machine = (machine_function *) ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (machine_function));
13615
13616 #if ARM_FT_UNKNOWN != 0
13617 machine->func_type = ARM_FT_UNKNOWN;
13618 #endif
13619 return machine;
13620 }
13621
13622 /* Return an RTX indicating where the return address to the
13623 calling function can be found. */
13624 rtx
arm_return_addr(int count,rtx frame ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13625 arm_return_addr (int count, rtx frame ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13626 {
13627 if (count != 0)
13628 return NULL_RTX;
13629
13630 return get_hard_reg_initial_val (Pmode, LR_REGNUM);
13631 }
13632
13633 /* Do anything needed before RTL is emitted for each function. */
13634 void
arm_init_expanders(void)13635 arm_init_expanders (void)
13636 {
13637 /* Arrange to initialize and mark the machine per-function status. */
13638 init_machine_status = arm_init_machine_status;
13639
13640 /* This is to stop the combine pass optimizing away the alignment
13641 adjustment of va_arg. */
13642 /* ??? It is claimed that this should not be necessary. */
13643 if (cfun)
13644 mark_reg_pointer (arg_pointer_rtx, PARM_BOUNDARY);
13645 }
13646
13647
13648 /* Like arm_compute_initial_elimination offset. Simpler because there
13649 isn't an ABI specified frame pointer for Thumb. Instead, we set it
13650 to point at the base of the local variables after static stack
13651 space for a function has been allocated. */
13652
13653 HOST_WIDE_INT
thumb_compute_initial_elimination_offset(unsigned int from,unsigned int to)13654 thumb_compute_initial_elimination_offset (unsigned int from, unsigned int to)
13655 {
13656 arm_stack_offsets *offsets;
13657
13658 offsets = arm_get_frame_offsets ();
13659
13660 switch (from)
13661 {
13662 case ARG_POINTER_REGNUM:
13663 switch (to)
13664 {
13665 case STACK_POINTER_REGNUM:
13666 return offsets->outgoing_args - offsets->saved_args;
13667
13668 case FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
13669 return offsets->soft_frame - offsets->saved_args;
13670
13671 case ARM_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
13672 return offsets->saved_regs - offsets->saved_args;
13673
13674 case THUMB_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
13675 return offsets->locals_base - offsets->saved_args;
13676
13677 default:
13678 gcc_unreachable ();
13679 }
13680 break;
13681
13682 case FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
13683 switch (to)
13684 {
13685 case STACK_POINTER_REGNUM:
13686 return offsets->outgoing_args - offsets->soft_frame;
13687
13688 case ARM_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
13689 return offsets->saved_regs - offsets->soft_frame;
13690
13691 case THUMB_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM:
13692 return offsets->locals_base - offsets->soft_frame;
13693
13694 default:
13695 gcc_unreachable ();
13696 }
13697 break;
13698
13699 default:
13700 gcc_unreachable ();
13701 }
13702 }
13703
13704
13705 /* Generate the rest of a function's prologue. */
13706 void
thumb_expand_prologue(void)13707 thumb_expand_prologue (void)
13708 {
13709 rtx insn, dwarf;
13710
13711 HOST_WIDE_INT amount;
13712 arm_stack_offsets *offsets;
13713 unsigned long func_type;
13714 int regno;
13715 unsigned long live_regs_mask;
13716
13717 func_type = arm_current_func_type ();
13718
13719 /* Naked functions don't have prologues. */
13720 if (IS_NAKED (func_type))
13721 return;
13722
13723 if (IS_INTERRUPT (func_type))
13724 {
13725 error ("interrupt Service Routines cannot be coded in Thumb mode");
13726 return;
13727 }
13728
13729 live_regs_mask = thumb_compute_save_reg_mask ();
13730 /* Load the pic register before setting the frame pointer,
13731 so we can use r7 as a temporary work register. */
13732 if (flag_pic && arm_pic_register != INVALID_REGNUM)
13733 arm_load_pic_register (live_regs_mask);
13734
13735 if (!frame_pointer_needed && CALLER_INTERWORKING_SLOT_SIZE > 0)
13736 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, ARM_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM),
13737 stack_pointer_rtx);
13738
13739 offsets = arm_get_frame_offsets ();
13740 amount = offsets->outgoing_args - offsets->saved_regs;
13741 if (amount)
13742 {
13743 if (amount < 512)
13744 {
13745 insn = emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx,
13746 GEN_INT (- amount)));
13747 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
13748 }
13749 else
13750 {
13751 rtx reg;
13752
13753 /* The stack decrement is too big for an immediate value in a single
13754 insn. In theory we could issue multiple subtracts, but after
13755 three of them it becomes more space efficient to place the full
13756 value in the constant pool and load into a register. (Also the
13757 ARM debugger really likes to see only one stack decrement per
13758 function). So instead we look for a scratch register into which
13759 we can load the decrement, and then we subtract this from the
13760 stack pointer. Unfortunately on the thumb the only available
13761 scratch registers are the argument registers, and we cannot use
13762 these as they may hold arguments to the function. Instead we
13763 attempt to locate a call preserved register which is used by this
13764 function. If we can find one, then we know that it will have
13765 been pushed at the start of the prologue and so we can corrupt
13766 it now. */
13767 for (regno = LAST_ARG_REGNUM + 1; regno <= LAST_LO_REGNUM; regno++)
13768 if (live_regs_mask & (1 << regno)
13769 && !(frame_pointer_needed
13770 && (regno == THUMB_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)))
13771 break;
13772
13773 if (regno > LAST_LO_REGNUM) /* Very unlikely. */
13774 {
13775 rtx spare = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, IP_REGNUM);
13776
13777 /* Choose an arbitrary, non-argument low register. */
13778 reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, LAST_LO_REGNUM);
13779
13780 /* Save it by copying it into a high, scratch register. */
13781 emit_insn (gen_movsi (spare, reg));
13782 /* Add a USE to stop propagate_one_insn() from barfing. */
13783 emit_insn (gen_prologue_use (spare));
13784
13785 /* Decrement the stack. */
13786 emit_insn (gen_movsi (reg, GEN_INT (- amount)));
13787 insn = emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (stack_pointer_rtx,
13788 stack_pointer_rtx, reg));
13789 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
13790 dwarf = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
13791 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx,
13792 -amount));
13793 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (dwarf) = 1;
13794 REG_NOTES (insn)
13795 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, dwarf,
13796 REG_NOTES (insn));
13797
13798 /* Restore the low register's original value. */
13799 emit_insn (gen_movsi (reg, spare));
13800
13801 /* Emit a USE of the restored scratch register, so that flow
13802 analysis will not consider the restore redundant. The
13803 register won't be used again in this function and isn't
13804 restored by the epilogue. */
13805 emit_insn (gen_prologue_use (reg));
13806 }
13807 else
13808 {
13809 reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, regno);
13810
13811 emit_insn (gen_movsi (reg, GEN_INT (- amount)));
13812
13813 insn = emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (stack_pointer_rtx,
13814 stack_pointer_rtx, reg));
13815 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
13816 dwarf = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
13817 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx,
13818 -amount));
13819 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (dwarf) = 1;
13820 REG_NOTES (insn)
13821 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, dwarf,
13822 REG_NOTES (insn));
13823 }
13824 }
13825 }
13826
13827 if (frame_pointer_needed)
13828 {
13829 amount = offsets->outgoing_args - offsets->locals_base;
13830
13831 if (amount < 1024)
13832 insn = emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
13833 stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (amount)));
13834 else
13835 {
13836 emit_insn (gen_movsi (hard_frame_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (amount)));
13837 insn = emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
13838 hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
13839 stack_pointer_rtx));
13840 dwarf = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, hard_frame_pointer_rtx,
13841 plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, amount));
13842 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (dwarf) = 1;
13843 REG_NOTES (insn) = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, dwarf,
13844 REG_NOTES (insn));
13845 }
13846
13847 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn) = 1;
13848 }
13849
13850 /* If we are profiling, make sure no instructions are scheduled before
13851 the call to mcount. Similarly if the user has requested no
13852 scheduling in the prolog. Similarly if we want non-call exceptions
13853 using the EABI unwinder, to prevent faulting instructions from being
13854 swapped with a stack adjustment. */
13855 if (current_function_profile || !TARGET_SCHED_PROLOG
13856 || (ARM_EABI_UNWIND_TABLES && flag_non_call_exceptions))
13857 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
13858
13859 cfun->machine->lr_save_eliminated = !thumb_force_lr_save ();
13860 if (live_regs_mask & 0xff)
13861 cfun->machine->lr_save_eliminated = 0;
13862
13863 /* If the link register is being kept alive, with the return address in it,
13864 then make sure that it does not get reused by the ce2 pass. */
13865 if (cfun->machine->lr_save_eliminated)
13866 emit_insn (gen_prologue_use (gen_rtx_REG (SImode, LR_REGNUM)));
13867 }
13868
13869
13870 void
thumb_expand_epilogue(void)13871 thumb_expand_epilogue (void)
13872 {
13873 HOST_WIDE_INT amount;
13874 arm_stack_offsets *offsets;
13875 int regno;
13876
13877 /* Naked functions don't have prologues. */
13878 if (IS_NAKED (arm_current_func_type ()))
13879 return;
13880
13881 offsets = arm_get_frame_offsets ();
13882 amount = offsets->outgoing_args - offsets->saved_regs;
13883
13884 if (frame_pointer_needed)
13885 {
13886 emit_insn (gen_movsi (stack_pointer_rtx, hard_frame_pointer_rtx));
13887 amount = offsets->locals_base - offsets->saved_regs;
13888 }
13889
13890 gcc_assert (amount >= 0);
13891 if (amount)
13892 {
13893 if (amount < 512)
13894 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx,
13895 GEN_INT (amount)));
13896 else
13897 {
13898 /* r3 is always free in the epilogue. */
13899 rtx reg = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, LAST_ARG_REGNUM);
13900
13901 emit_insn (gen_movsi (reg, GEN_INT (amount)));
13902 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (stack_pointer_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx, reg));
13903 }
13904 }
13905
13906 /* Emit a USE (stack_pointer_rtx), so that
13907 the stack adjustment will not be deleted. */
13908 emit_insn (gen_prologue_use (stack_pointer_rtx));
13909
13910 if (current_function_profile || !TARGET_SCHED_PROLOG)
13911 emit_insn (gen_blockage ());
13912
13913 /* Emit a clobber for each insn that will be restored in the epilogue,
13914 so that flow2 will get register lifetimes correct. */
13915 for (regno = 0; regno < 13; regno++)
13916 if (regs_ever_live[regno] && !call_used_regs[regno])
13917 emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (SImode, regno)));
13918
13919 if (! regs_ever_live[LR_REGNUM])
13920 emit_insn (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_REG (SImode, LR_REGNUM)));
13921 }
13922
13923 static void
thumb_output_function_prologue(FILE * f,HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13924 thumb_output_function_prologue (FILE *f, HOST_WIDE_INT size ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13925 {
13926 unsigned long live_regs_mask = 0;
13927 unsigned long l_mask;
13928 unsigned high_regs_pushed = 0;
13929 int cfa_offset = 0;
13930 int regno;
13931
13932 if (IS_NAKED (arm_current_func_type ()))
13933 return;
13934
13935 if (is_called_in_ARM_mode (current_function_decl))
13936 {
13937 const char * name;
13938
13939 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl)) == MEM);
13940 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0))
13941 == SYMBOL_REF);
13942 name = XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (current_function_decl), 0), 0);
13943
13944 /* Generate code sequence to switch us into Thumb mode. */
13945 /* The .code 32 directive has already been emitted by
13946 ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME. */
13947 asm_fprintf (f, "\torr\t%r, %r, #1\n", IP_REGNUM, PC_REGNUM);
13948 asm_fprintf (f, "\tbx\t%r\n", IP_REGNUM);
13949
13950 /* Generate a label, so that the debugger will notice the
13951 change in instruction sets. This label is also used by
13952 the assembler to bypass the ARM code when this function
13953 is called from a Thumb encoded function elsewhere in the
13954 same file. Hence the definition of STUB_NAME here must
13955 agree with the definition in gas/config/tc-arm.c. */
13956
13957 #define STUB_NAME ".real_start_of"
13958
13959 fprintf (f, "\t.code\t16\n");
13960 #ifdef ARM_PE
13961 if (arm_dllexport_name_p (name))
13962 name = arm_strip_name_encoding (name);
13963 #endif
13964 asm_fprintf (f, "\t.globl %s%U%s\n", STUB_NAME, name);
13965 fprintf (f, "\t.thumb_func\n");
13966 asm_fprintf (f, "%s%U%s:\n", STUB_NAME, name);
13967 }
13968
13969 if (current_function_pretend_args_size)
13970 {
13971 /* Output unwind directive for the stack adjustment. */
13972 if (ARM_EABI_UNWIND_TABLES)
13973 fprintf (f, "\t.pad #%d\n",
13974 current_function_pretend_args_size);
13975
13976 if (cfun->machine->uses_anonymous_args)
13977 {
13978 int num_pushes;
13979
13980 fprintf (f, "\tpush\t{");
13981
13982 num_pushes = ARM_NUM_INTS (current_function_pretend_args_size);
13983
13984 for (regno = LAST_ARG_REGNUM + 1 - num_pushes;
13985 regno <= LAST_ARG_REGNUM;
13986 regno++)
13987 asm_fprintf (f, "%r%s", regno,
13988 regno == LAST_ARG_REGNUM ? "" : ", ");
13989
13990 fprintf (f, "}\n");
13991 }
13992 else
13993 asm_fprintf (f, "\tsub\t%r, %r, #%d\n",
13994 SP_REGNUM, SP_REGNUM,
13995 current_function_pretend_args_size);
13996
13997 /* We don't need to record the stores for unwinding (would it
13998 help the debugger any if we did?), but record the change in
13999 the stack pointer. */
14000 if (dwarf2out_do_frame ())
14001 {
14002 char *l = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
14003
14004 cfa_offset = cfa_offset + current_function_pretend_args_size;
14005 dwarf2out_def_cfa (l, SP_REGNUM, cfa_offset);
14006 }
14007 }
14008
14009 /* Get the registers we are going to push. */
14010 live_regs_mask = thumb_compute_save_reg_mask ();
14011 /* Extract a mask of the ones we can give to the Thumb's push instruction. */
14012 l_mask = live_regs_mask & 0x40ff;
14013 /* Then count how many other high registers will need to be pushed. */
14014 high_regs_pushed = bit_count (live_regs_mask & 0x0f00);
14015
14016 if (TARGET_BACKTRACE)
14017 {
14018 unsigned offset;
14019 unsigned work_register;
14020
14021 /* We have been asked to create a stack backtrace structure.
14022 The code looks like this:
14023
14024 0 .align 2
14025 0 func:
14026 0 sub SP, #16 Reserve space for 4 registers.
14027 2 push {R7} Push low registers.
14028 4 add R7, SP, #20 Get the stack pointer before the push.
14029 6 str R7, [SP, #8] Store the stack pointer (before reserving the space).
14030 8 mov R7, PC Get hold of the start of this code plus 12.
14031 10 str R7, [SP, #16] Store it.
14032 12 mov R7, FP Get hold of the current frame pointer.
14033 14 str R7, [SP, #4] Store it.
14034 16 mov R7, LR Get hold of the current return address.
14035 18 str R7, [SP, #12] Store it.
14036 20 add R7, SP, #16 Point at the start of the backtrace structure.
14037 22 mov FP, R7 Put this value into the frame pointer. */
14038
14039 work_register = thumb_find_work_register (live_regs_mask);
14040
14041 if (ARM_EABI_UNWIND_TABLES)
14042 asm_fprintf (f, "\t.pad #16\n");
14043
14044 asm_fprintf
14045 (f, "\tsub\t%r, %r, #16\t%@ Create stack backtrace structure\n",
14046 SP_REGNUM, SP_REGNUM);
14047
14048 if (dwarf2out_do_frame ())
14049 {
14050 char *l = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
14051
14052 cfa_offset = cfa_offset + 16;
14053 dwarf2out_def_cfa (l, SP_REGNUM, cfa_offset);
14054 }
14055
14056 if (l_mask)
14057 {
14058 thumb_pushpop (f, l_mask, 1, &cfa_offset, l_mask);
14059 offset = bit_count (l_mask) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
14060 }
14061 else
14062 offset = 0;
14063
14064 asm_fprintf (f, "\tadd\t%r, %r, #%d\n", work_register, SP_REGNUM,
14065 offset + 16 + current_function_pretend_args_size);
14066
14067 asm_fprintf (f, "\tstr\t%r, [%r, #%d]\n", work_register, SP_REGNUM,
14068 offset + 4);
14069
14070 /* Make sure that the instruction fetching the PC is in the right place
14071 to calculate "start of backtrace creation code + 12". */
14072 if (l_mask)
14073 {
14074 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", work_register, PC_REGNUM);
14075 asm_fprintf (f, "\tstr\t%r, [%r, #%d]\n", work_register, SP_REGNUM,
14076 offset + 12);
14077 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", work_register,
14078 ARM_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
14079 asm_fprintf (f, "\tstr\t%r, [%r, #%d]\n", work_register, SP_REGNUM,
14080 offset);
14081 }
14082 else
14083 {
14084 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", work_register,
14085 ARM_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
14086 asm_fprintf (f, "\tstr\t%r, [%r, #%d]\n", work_register, SP_REGNUM,
14087 offset);
14088 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", work_register, PC_REGNUM);
14089 asm_fprintf (f, "\tstr\t%r, [%r, #%d]\n", work_register, SP_REGNUM,
14090 offset + 12);
14091 }
14092
14093 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", work_register, LR_REGNUM);
14094 asm_fprintf (f, "\tstr\t%r, [%r, #%d]\n", work_register, SP_REGNUM,
14095 offset + 8);
14096 asm_fprintf (f, "\tadd\t%r, %r, #%d\n", work_register, SP_REGNUM,
14097 offset + 12);
14098 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\t\t%@ Backtrace structure created\n",
14099 ARM_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, work_register);
14100 }
14101 /* Optimization: If we are not pushing any low registers but we are going
14102 to push some high registers then delay our first push. This will just
14103 be a push of LR and we can combine it with the push of the first high
14104 register. */
14105 else if ((l_mask & 0xff) != 0
14106 || (high_regs_pushed == 0 && l_mask))
14107 thumb_pushpop (f, l_mask, 1, &cfa_offset, l_mask);
14108
14109 if (high_regs_pushed)
14110 {
14111 unsigned pushable_regs;
14112 unsigned next_hi_reg;
14113
14114 for (next_hi_reg = 12; next_hi_reg > LAST_LO_REGNUM; next_hi_reg--)
14115 if (live_regs_mask & (1 << next_hi_reg))
14116 break;
14117
14118 pushable_regs = l_mask & 0xff;
14119
14120 if (pushable_regs == 0)
14121 pushable_regs = 1 << thumb_find_work_register (live_regs_mask);
14122
14123 while (high_regs_pushed > 0)
14124 {
14125 unsigned long real_regs_mask = 0;
14126
14127 for (regno = LAST_LO_REGNUM; regno >= 0; regno --)
14128 {
14129 if (pushable_regs & (1 << regno))
14130 {
14131 asm_fprintf (f, "\tmov\t%r, %r\n", regno, next_hi_reg);
14132
14133 high_regs_pushed --;
14134 real_regs_mask |= (1 << next_hi_reg);
14135
14136 if (high_regs_pushed)
14137 {
14138 for (next_hi_reg --; next_hi_reg > LAST_LO_REGNUM;
14139 next_hi_reg --)
14140 if (live_regs_mask & (1 << next_hi_reg))
14141 break;
14142 }
14143 else
14144 {
14145 pushable_regs &= ~((1 << regno) - 1);
14146 break;
14147 }
14148 }
14149 }
14150
14151 /* If we had to find a work register and we have not yet
14152 saved the LR then add it to the list of regs to push. */
14153 if (l_mask == (1 << LR_REGNUM))
14154 {
14155 thumb_pushpop (f, pushable_regs | (1 << LR_REGNUM),
14156 1, &cfa_offset,
14157 real_regs_mask | (1 << LR_REGNUM));
14158 l_mask = 0;
14159 }
14160 else
14161 thumb_pushpop (f, pushable_regs, 1, &cfa_offset, real_regs_mask);
14162 }
14163 }
14164 }
14165
14166 /* Handle the case of a double word load into a low register from
14167 a computed memory address. The computed address may involve a
14168 register which is overwritten by the load. */
14169 const char *
thumb_load_double_from_address(rtx * operands)14170 thumb_load_double_from_address (rtx *operands)
14171 {
14172 rtx addr;
14173 rtx base;
14174 rtx offset;
14175 rtx arg1;
14176 rtx arg2;
14177
14178 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (operands[0]) == REG);
14179 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (operands[1]) == MEM);
14180
14181 /* Get the memory address. */
14182 addr = XEXP (operands[1], 0);
14183
14184 /* Work out how the memory address is computed. */
14185 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
14186 {
14187 case REG:
14188 operands[2] = adjust_address (operands[1], SImode, 4);
14189
14190 if (REGNO (operands[0]) == REGNO (addr))
14191 {
14192 output_asm_insn ("ldr\t%H0, %2", operands);
14193 output_asm_insn ("ldr\t%0, %1", operands);
14194 }
14195 else
14196 {
14197 output_asm_insn ("ldr\t%0, %1", operands);
14198 output_asm_insn ("ldr\t%H0, %2", operands);
14199 }
14200 break;
14201
14202 case CONST:
14203 /* Compute <address> + 4 for the high order load. */
14204 operands[2] = adjust_address (operands[1], SImode, 4);
14205
14206 output_asm_insn ("ldr\t%0, %1", operands);
14207 output_asm_insn ("ldr\t%H0, %2", operands);
14208 break;
14209
14210 case PLUS:
14211 arg1 = XEXP (addr, 0);
14212 arg2 = XEXP (addr, 1);
14213
14214 if (CONSTANT_P (arg1))
14215 base = arg2, offset = arg1;
14216 else
14217 base = arg1, offset = arg2;
14218
14219 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (base) == REG);
14220
14221 /* Catch the case of <address> = <reg> + <reg> */
14222 if (GET_CODE (offset) == REG)
14223 {
14224 int reg_offset = REGNO (offset);
14225 int reg_base = REGNO (base);
14226 int reg_dest = REGNO (operands[0]);
14227
14228 /* Add the base and offset registers together into the
14229 higher destination register. */
14230 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tadd\t%r, %r, %r",
14231 reg_dest + 1, reg_base, reg_offset);
14232
14233 /* Load the lower destination register from the address in
14234 the higher destination register. */
14235 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tldr\t%r, [%r, #0]",
14236 reg_dest, reg_dest + 1);
14237
14238 /* Load the higher destination register from its own address
14239 plus 4. */
14240 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tldr\t%r, [%r, #4]",
14241 reg_dest + 1, reg_dest + 1);
14242 }
14243 else
14244 {
14245 /* Compute <address> + 4 for the high order load. */
14246 operands[2] = adjust_address (operands[1], SImode, 4);
14247
14248 /* If the computed address is held in the low order register
14249 then load the high order register first, otherwise always
14250 load the low order register first. */
14251 if (REGNO (operands[0]) == REGNO (base))
14252 {
14253 output_asm_insn ("ldr\t%H0, %2", operands);
14254 output_asm_insn ("ldr\t%0, %1", operands);
14255 }
14256 else
14257 {
14258 output_asm_insn ("ldr\t%0, %1", operands);
14259 output_asm_insn ("ldr\t%H0, %2", operands);
14260 }
14261 }
14262 break;
14263
14264 case LABEL_REF:
14265 /* With no registers to worry about we can just load the value
14266 directly. */
14267 operands[2] = adjust_address (operands[1], SImode, 4);
14268
14269 output_asm_insn ("ldr\t%H0, %2", operands);
14270 output_asm_insn ("ldr\t%0, %1", operands);
14271 break;
14272
14273 default:
14274 gcc_unreachable ();
14275 }
14276
14277 return "";
14278 }
14279
14280 const char *
thumb_output_move_mem_multiple(int n,rtx * operands)14281 thumb_output_move_mem_multiple (int n, rtx *operands)
14282 {
14283 rtx tmp;
14284
14285 switch (n)
14286 {
14287 case 2:
14288 if (REGNO (operands[4]) > REGNO (operands[5]))
14289 {
14290 tmp = operands[4];
14291 operands[4] = operands[5];
14292 operands[5] = tmp;
14293 }
14294 output_asm_insn ("ldmia\t%1!, {%4, %5}", operands);
14295 output_asm_insn ("stmia\t%0!, {%4, %5}", operands);
14296 break;
14297
14298 case 3:
14299 if (REGNO (operands[4]) > REGNO (operands[5]))
14300 {
14301 tmp = operands[4];
14302 operands[4] = operands[5];
14303 operands[5] = tmp;
14304 }
14305 if (REGNO (operands[5]) > REGNO (operands[6]))
14306 {
14307 tmp = operands[5];
14308 operands[5] = operands[6];
14309 operands[6] = tmp;
14310 }
14311 if (REGNO (operands[4]) > REGNO (operands[5]))
14312 {
14313 tmp = operands[4];
14314 operands[4] = operands[5];
14315 operands[5] = tmp;
14316 }
14317
14318 output_asm_insn ("ldmia\t%1!, {%4, %5, %6}", operands);
14319 output_asm_insn ("stmia\t%0!, {%4, %5, %6}", operands);
14320 break;
14321
14322 default:
14323 gcc_unreachable ();
14324 }
14325
14326 return "";
14327 }
14328
14329 /* Output a call-via instruction for thumb state. */
14330 const char *
thumb_call_via_reg(rtx reg)14331 thumb_call_via_reg (rtx reg)
14332 {
14333 int regno = REGNO (reg);
14334 rtx *labelp;
14335
14336 gcc_assert (regno < LR_REGNUM);
14337
14338 /* If we are in the normal text section we can use a single instance
14339 per compilation unit. If we are doing function sections, then we need
14340 an entry per section, since we can't rely on reachability. */
14341 if (in_section == text_section)
14342 {
14343 thumb_call_reg_needed = 1;
14344
14345 if (thumb_call_via_label[regno] == NULL)
14346 thumb_call_via_label[regno] = gen_label_rtx ();
14347 labelp = thumb_call_via_label + regno;
14348 }
14349 else
14350 {
14351 if (cfun->machine->call_via[regno] == NULL)
14352 cfun->machine->call_via[regno] = gen_label_rtx ();
14353 labelp = cfun->machine->call_via + regno;
14354 }
14355
14356 output_asm_insn ("bl\t%a0", labelp);
14357 return "";
14358 }
14359
14360 /* Routines for generating rtl. */
14361 void
thumb_expand_movmemqi(rtx * operands)14362 thumb_expand_movmemqi (rtx *operands)
14363 {
14364 rtx out = copy_to_mode_reg (SImode, XEXP (operands[0], 0));
14365 rtx in = copy_to_mode_reg (SImode, XEXP (operands[1], 0));
14366 HOST_WIDE_INT len = INTVAL (operands[2]);
14367 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
14368
14369 while (len >= 12)
14370 {
14371 emit_insn (gen_movmem12b (out, in, out, in));
14372 len -= 12;
14373 }
14374
14375 if (len >= 8)
14376 {
14377 emit_insn (gen_movmem8b (out, in, out, in));
14378 len -= 8;
14379 }
14380
14381 if (len >= 4)
14382 {
14383 rtx reg = gen_reg_rtx (SImode);
14384 emit_insn (gen_movsi (reg, gen_rtx_MEM (SImode, in)));
14385 emit_insn (gen_movsi (gen_rtx_MEM (SImode, out), reg));
14386 len -= 4;
14387 offset += 4;
14388 }
14389
14390 if (len >= 2)
14391 {
14392 rtx reg = gen_reg_rtx (HImode);
14393 emit_insn (gen_movhi (reg, gen_rtx_MEM (HImode,
14394 plus_constant (in, offset))));
14395 emit_insn (gen_movhi (gen_rtx_MEM (HImode, plus_constant (out, offset)),
14396 reg));
14397 len -= 2;
14398 offset += 2;
14399 }
14400
14401 if (len)
14402 {
14403 rtx reg = gen_reg_rtx (QImode);
14404 emit_insn (gen_movqi (reg, gen_rtx_MEM (QImode,
14405 plus_constant (in, offset))));
14406 emit_insn (gen_movqi (gen_rtx_MEM (QImode, plus_constant (out, offset)),
14407 reg));
14408 }
14409 }
14410
14411 void
thumb_reload_out_hi(rtx * operands)14412 thumb_reload_out_hi (rtx *operands)
14413 {
14414 emit_insn (gen_thumb_movhi_clobber (operands[0], operands[1], operands[2]));
14415 }
14416
14417 /* Handle reading a half-word from memory during reload. */
14418 void
thumb_reload_in_hi(rtx * operands ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)14419 thumb_reload_in_hi (rtx *operands ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14420 {
14421 gcc_unreachable ();
14422 }
14423
14424 /* Return the length of a function name prefix
14425 that starts with the character 'c'. */
14426 static int
arm_get_strip_length(int c)14427 arm_get_strip_length (int c)
14428 {
14429 switch (c)
14430 {
14431 ARM_NAME_ENCODING_LENGTHS
14432 default: return 0;
14433 }
14434 }
14435
14436 /* Return a pointer to a function's name with any
14437 and all prefix encodings stripped from it. */
14438 const char *
arm_strip_name_encoding(const char * name)14439 arm_strip_name_encoding (const char *name)
14440 {
14441 int skip;
14442
14443 while ((skip = arm_get_strip_length (* name)))
14444 name += skip;
14445
14446 return name;
14447 }
14448
14449 /* If there is a '*' anywhere in the name's prefix, then
14450 emit the stripped name verbatim, otherwise prepend an
14451 underscore if leading underscores are being used. */
14452 void
arm_asm_output_labelref(FILE * stream,const char * name)14453 arm_asm_output_labelref (FILE *stream, const char *name)
14454 {
14455 int skip;
14456 int verbatim = 0;
14457
14458 while ((skip = arm_get_strip_length (* name)))
14459 {
14460 verbatim |= (*name == '*');
14461 name += skip;
14462 }
14463
14464 if (verbatim)
14465 fputs (name, stream);
14466 else
14467 asm_fprintf (stream, "%U%s", name);
14468 }
14469
14470 static void
arm_file_start(void)14471 arm_file_start (void)
14472 {
14473 int val;
14474
14475 if (TARGET_BPABI)
14476 {
14477 const char *fpu_name;
14478 if (arm_select[0].string)
14479 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cpu %s\n", arm_select[0].string);
14480 else if (arm_select[1].string)
14481 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.arch %s\n", arm_select[1].string);
14482 else
14483 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cpu %s\n",
14484 all_cores[arm_default_cpu].name);
14485
14486 if (TARGET_SOFT_FLOAT)
14487 {
14488 if (TARGET_VFP)
14489 fpu_name = "softvfp";
14490 else
14491 fpu_name = "softfpa";
14492 }
14493 else
14494 {
14495 switch (arm_fpu_arch)
14496 {
14497 case FPUTYPE_FPA:
14498 fpu_name = "fpa";
14499 break;
14500 case FPUTYPE_FPA_EMU2:
14501 fpu_name = "fpe2";
14502 break;
14503 case FPUTYPE_FPA_EMU3:
14504 fpu_name = "fpe3";
14505 break;
14506 case FPUTYPE_MAVERICK:
14507 fpu_name = "maverick";
14508 break;
14509 case FPUTYPE_VFP:
14510 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT)
14511 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.eabi_attribute 27, 3\n");
14512 if (TARGET_HARD_FLOAT_ABI)
14513 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.eabi_attribute 28, 1\n");
14514 fpu_name = "vfp";
14515 break;
14516 default:
14517 abort();
14518 }
14519 }
14520 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.fpu %s\n", fpu_name);
14521
14522 /* Some of these attributes only apply when the corresponding features
14523 are used. However we don't have any easy way of figuring this out.
14524 Conservatively record the setting that would have been used. */
14525
14526 /* Tag_ABI_PCS_wchar_t. */
14527 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.eabi_attribute 18, %d\n",
14528 (int)WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT);
14529
14530 /* Tag_ABI_FP_rounding. */
14531 if (flag_rounding_math)
14532 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.eabi_attribute 19, 1\n");
14533 if (!flag_unsafe_math_optimizations)
14534 {
14535 /* Tag_ABI_FP_denomal. */
14536 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.eabi_attribute 20, 1\n");
14537 /* Tag_ABI_FP_exceptions. */
14538 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.eabi_attribute 21, 1\n");
14539 }
14540 /* Tag_ABI_FP_user_exceptions. */
14541 if (flag_signaling_nans)
14542 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.eabi_attribute 22, 1\n");
14543 /* Tag_ABI_FP_number_model. */
14544 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.eabi_attribute 23, %d\n",
14545 flag_finite_math_only ? 1 : 3);
14546
14547 /* Tag_ABI_align8_needed. */
14548 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.eabi_attribute 24, 1\n");
14549 /* Tag_ABI_align8_preserved. */
14550 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.eabi_attribute 25, 1\n");
14551 /* Tag_ABI_enum_size. */
14552 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.eabi_attribute 26, %d\n",
14553 flag_short_enums ? 1 : 2);
14554
14555 /* Tag_ABI_optimization_goals. */
14556 if (optimize_size)
14557 val = 4;
14558 else if (optimize >= 2)
14559 val = 2;
14560 else if (optimize)
14561 val = 1;
14562 else
14563 val = 6;
14564 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.eabi_attribute 30, %d\n", val);
14565 }
14566 default_file_start();
14567 }
14568
14569 static void
arm_file_end(void)14570 arm_file_end (void)
14571 {
14572 int regno;
14573
14574 if (! thumb_call_reg_needed)
14575 return;
14576
14577 switch_to_section (text_section);
14578 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.code 16\n");
14579 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 1);
14580
14581 for (regno = 0; regno < LR_REGNUM; regno++)
14582 {
14583 rtx label = thumb_call_via_label[regno];
14584
14585 if (label != 0)
14586 {
14587 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, "L",
14588 CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (label));
14589 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tbx\t%r\n", regno);
14590 }
14591 }
14592 }
14593
14594 rtx aof_pic_label;
14595
14596 #ifdef AOF_ASSEMBLER
14597 /* Special functions only needed when producing AOF syntax assembler. */
14598
14599 struct pic_chain
14600 {
14601 struct pic_chain * next;
14602 const char * symname;
14603 };
14604
14605 static struct pic_chain * aof_pic_chain = NULL;
14606
14607 rtx
aof_pic_entry(rtx x)14608 aof_pic_entry (rtx x)
14609 {
14610 struct pic_chain ** chainp;
14611 int offset;
14612
14613 if (aof_pic_label == NULL_RTX)
14614 {
14615 aof_pic_label = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, "x$adcons");
14616 }
14617
14618 for (offset = 0, chainp = &aof_pic_chain; *chainp;
14619 offset += 4, chainp = &(*chainp)->next)
14620 if ((*chainp)->symname == XSTR (x, 0))
14621 return plus_constant (aof_pic_label, offset);
14622
14623 *chainp = (struct pic_chain *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct pic_chain));
14624 (*chainp)->next = NULL;
14625 (*chainp)->symname = XSTR (x, 0);
14626 return plus_constant (aof_pic_label, offset);
14627 }
14628
14629 void
aof_dump_pic_table(FILE * f)14630 aof_dump_pic_table (FILE *f)
14631 {
14632 struct pic_chain * chain;
14633
14634 if (aof_pic_chain == NULL)
14635 return;
14636
14637 asm_fprintf (f, "\tAREA |%r$$adcons|, BASED %r\n",
14638 PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM,
14639 PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM);
14640 fputs ("|x$adcons|\n", f);
14641
14642 for (chain = aof_pic_chain; chain; chain = chain->next)
14643 {
14644 fputs ("\tDCD\t", f);
14645 assemble_name (f, chain->symname);
14646 fputs ("\n", f);
14647 }
14648 }
14649
14650 int arm_text_section_count = 1;
14651
14652 /* A get_unnamed_section callback for switching to the text section. */
14653
14654 static void
aof_output_text_section_asm_op(const void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)14655 aof_output_text_section_asm_op (const void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14656 {
14657 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tAREA |C$$code%d|, CODE, READONLY",
14658 arm_text_section_count++);
14659 if (flag_pic)
14660 fprintf (asm_out_file, ", PIC, REENTRANT");
14661 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\n");
14662 }
14663
14664 static int arm_data_section_count = 1;
14665
14666 /* A get_unnamed_section callback for switching to the data section. */
14667
14668 static void
aof_output_data_section_asm_op(const void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)14669 aof_output_data_section_asm_op (const void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14670 {
14671 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tAREA |C$$data%d|, DATA\n",
14672 arm_data_section_count++);
14673 }
14674
14675 /* Implement TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS.
14676
14677 AOF Assembler syntax is a nightmare when it comes to areas, since once
14678 we change from one area to another, we can't go back again. Instead,
14679 we must create a new area with the same attributes and add the new output
14680 to that. Unfortunately, there is nothing we can do here to guarantee that
14681 two areas with the same attributes will be linked adjacently in the
14682 resulting executable, so we have to be careful not to do pc-relative
14683 addressing across such boundaries. */
14684
14685 static void
aof_asm_init_sections(void)14686 aof_asm_init_sections (void)
14687 {
14688 text_section = get_unnamed_section (SECTION_CODE,
14689 aof_output_text_section_asm_op, NULL);
14690 data_section = get_unnamed_section (SECTION_WRITE,
14691 aof_output_data_section_asm_op, NULL);
14692 readonly_data_section = text_section;
14693 }
14694
14695 void
zero_init_section(void)14696 zero_init_section (void)
14697 {
14698 static int zero_init_count = 1;
14699
14700 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\tAREA |C$$zidata%d|,NOINIT\n", zero_init_count++);
14701 in_section = NULL;
14702 }
14703
14704 /* The AOF assembler is religiously strict about declarations of
14705 imported and exported symbols, so that it is impossible to declare
14706 a function as imported near the beginning of the file, and then to
14707 export it later on. It is, however, possible to delay the decision
14708 until all the functions in the file have been compiled. To get
14709 around this, we maintain a list of the imports and exports, and
14710 delete from it any that are subsequently defined. At the end of
14711 compilation we spit the remainder of the list out before the END
14712 directive. */
14713
14714 struct import
14715 {
14716 struct import * next;
14717 const char * name;
14718 };
14719
14720 static struct import * imports_list = NULL;
14721
14722 void
aof_add_import(const char * name)14723 aof_add_import (const char *name)
14724 {
14725 struct import * new;
14726
14727 for (new = imports_list; new; new = new->next)
14728 if (new->name == name)
14729 return;
14730
14731 new = (struct import *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct import));
14732 new->next = imports_list;
14733 imports_list = new;
14734 new->name = name;
14735 }
14736
14737 void
aof_delete_import(const char * name)14738 aof_delete_import (const char *name)
14739 {
14740 struct import ** old;
14741
14742 for (old = &imports_list; *old; old = & (*old)->next)
14743 {
14744 if ((*old)->name == name)
14745 {
14746 *old = (*old)->next;
14747 return;
14748 }
14749 }
14750 }
14751
14752 int arm_main_function = 0;
14753
14754 static void
aof_dump_imports(FILE * f)14755 aof_dump_imports (FILE *f)
14756 {
14757 /* The AOF assembler needs this to cause the startup code to be extracted
14758 from the library. Brining in __main causes the whole thing to work
14759 automagically. */
14760 if (arm_main_function)
14761 {
14762 switch_to_section (text_section);
14763 fputs ("\tIMPORT __main\n", f);
14764 fputs ("\tDCD __main\n", f);
14765 }
14766
14767 /* Now dump the remaining imports. */
14768 while (imports_list)
14769 {
14770 fprintf (f, "\tIMPORT\t");
14771 assemble_name (f, imports_list->name);
14772 fputc ('\n', f);
14773 imports_list = imports_list->next;
14774 }
14775 }
14776
14777 static void
aof_globalize_label(FILE * stream,const char * name)14778 aof_globalize_label (FILE *stream, const char *name)
14779 {
14780 default_globalize_label (stream, name);
14781 if (! strcmp (name, "main"))
14782 arm_main_function = 1;
14783 }
14784
14785 static void
aof_file_start(void)14786 aof_file_start (void)
14787 {
14788 fputs ("__r0\tRN\t0\n", asm_out_file);
14789 fputs ("__a1\tRN\t0\n", asm_out_file);
14790 fputs ("__a2\tRN\t1\n", asm_out_file);
14791 fputs ("__a3\tRN\t2\n", asm_out_file);
14792 fputs ("__a4\tRN\t3\n", asm_out_file);
14793 fputs ("__v1\tRN\t4\n", asm_out_file);
14794 fputs ("__v2\tRN\t5\n", asm_out_file);
14795 fputs ("__v3\tRN\t6\n", asm_out_file);
14796 fputs ("__v4\tRN\t7\n", asm_out_file);
14797 fputs ("__v5\tRN\t8\n", asm_out_file);
14798 fputs ("__v6\tRN\t9\n", asm_out_file);
14799 fputs ("__sl\tRN\t10\n", asm_out_file);
14800 fputs ("__fp\tRN\t11\n", asm_out_file);
14801 fputs ("__ip\tRN\t12\n", asm_out_file);
14802 fputs ("__sp\tRN\t13\n", asm_out_file);
14803 fputs ("__lr\tRN\t14\n", asm_out_file);
14804 fputs ("__pc\tRN\t15\n", asm_out_file);
14805 fputs ("__f0\tFN\t0\n", asm_out_file);
14806 fputs ("__f1\tFN\t1\n", asm_out_file);
14807 fputs ("__f2\tFN\t2\n", asm_out_file);
14808 fputs ("__f3\tFN\t3\n", asm_out_file);
14809 fputs ("__f4\tFN\t4\n", asm_out_file);
14810 fputs ("__f5\tFN\t5\n", asm_out_file);
14811 fputs ("__f6\tFN\t6\n", asm_out_file);
14812 fputs ("__f7\tFN\t7\n", asm_out_file);
14813 switch_to_section (text_section);
14814 }
14815
14816 static void
aof_file_end(void)14817 aof_file_end (void)
14818 {
14819 if (flag_pic)
14820 aof_dump_pic_table (asm_out_file);
14821 arm_file_end ();
14822 aof_dump_imports (asm_out_file);
14823 fputs ("\tEND\n", asm_out_file);
14824 }
14825 #endif /* AOF_ASSEMBLER */
14826
14827 #ifndef ARM_PE
14828 /* Symbols in the text segment can be accessed without indirecting via the
14829 constant pool; it may take an extra binary operation, but this is still
14830 faster than indirecting via memory. Don't do this when not optimizing,
14831 since we won't be calculating al of the offsets necessary to do this
14832 simplification. */
14833
14834 static void
arm_encode_section_info(tree decl,rtx rtl,int first)14835 arm_encode_section_info (tree decl, rtx rtl, int first)
14836 {
14837 /* This doesn't work with AOF syntax, since the string table may be in
14838 a different AREA. */
14839 #ifndef AOF_ASSEMBLER
14840 if (optimize > 0 && TREE_CONSTANT (decl))
14841 SYMBOL_REF_FLAG (XEXP (rtl, 0)) = 1;
14842 #endif
14843
14844 /* If we are referencing a function that is weak then encode a long call
14845 flag in the function name, otherwise if the function is static or
14846 or known to be defined in this file then encode a short call flag. */
14847 if (first && DECL_P (decl))
14848 {
14849 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && DECL_WEAK (decl))
14850 arm_encode_call_attribute (decl, LONG_CALL_FLAG_CHAR);
14851 else if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
14852 arm_encode_call_attribute (decl, SHORT_CALL_FLAG_CHAR);
14853 }
14854
14855 default_encode_section_info (decl, rtl, first);
14856 }
14857 #endif /* !ARM_PE */
14858
14859 static void
arm_internal_label(FILE * stream,const char * prefix,unsigned long labelno)14860 arm_internal_label (FILE *stream, const char *prefix, unsigned long labelno)
14861 {
14862 if (arm_ccfsm_state == 3 && (unsigned) arm_target_label == labelno
14863 && !strcmp (prefix, "L"))
14864 {
14865 arm_ccfsm_state = 0;
14866 arm_target_insn = NULL;
14867 }
14868 default_internal_label (stream, prefix, labelno);
14869 }
14870
14871 /* Output code to add DELTA to the first argument, and then jump
14872 to FUNCTION. Used for C++ multiple inheritance. */
14873 static void
arm_output_mi_thunk(FILE * file,tree thunk ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,HOST_WIDE_INT delta,HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,tree function)14874 arm_output_mi_thunk (FILE *file, tree thunk ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
14875 HOST_WIDE_INT delta,
14876 HOST_WIDE_INT vcall_offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
14877 tree function)
14878 {
14879 static int thunk_label = 0;
14880 char label[256];
14881 char labelpc[256];
14882 int mi_delta = delta;
14883 const char *const mi_op = mi_delta < 0 ? "sub" : "add";
14884 int shift = 0;
14885 int this_regno = (aggregate_value_p (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (function)), function)
14886 ? 1 : 0);
14887 if (mi_delta < 0)
14888 mi_delta = - mi_delta;
14889 if (TARGET_THUMB)
14890 {
14891 int labelno = thunk_label++;
14892 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LTHUMBFUNC", labelno);
14893 fputs ("\tldr\tr12, ", file);
14894 assemble_name (file, label);
14895 fputc ('\n', file);
14896 if (flag_pic)
14897 {
14898 /* If we are generating PIC, the ldr instruction below loads
14899 "(target - 7) - .LTHUNKPCn" into r12. The pc reads as
14900 the address of the add + 8, so we have:
14901
14902 r12 = (target - 7) - .LTHUNKPCn + (.LTHUNKPCn + 8)
14903 = target + 1.
14904
14905 Note that we have "+ 1" because some versions of GNU ld
14906 don't set the low bit of the result for R_ARM_REL32
14907 relocations against thumb function symbols. */
14908 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (labelpc, "LTHUNKPC", labelno);
14909 assemble_name (file, labelpc);
14910 fputs (":\n", file);
14911 fputs ("\tadd\tr12, pc, r12\n", file);
14912 }
14913 }
14914 while (mi_delta != 0)
14915 {
14916 if ((mi_delta & (3 << shift)) == 0)
14917 shift += 2;
14918 else
14919 {
14920 asm_fprintf (file, "\t%s\t%r, %r, #%d\n",
14921 mi_op, this_regno, this_regno,
14922 mi_delta & (0xff << shift));
14923 mi_delta &= ~(0xff << shift);
14924 shift += 8;
14925 }
14926 }
14927 if (TARGET_THUMB)
14928 {
14929 fprintf (file, "\tbx\tr12\n");
14930 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (file, 2);
14931 assemble_name (file, label);
14932 fputs (":\n", file);
14933 if (flag_pic)
14934 {
14935 /* Output ".word .LTHUNKn-7-.LTHUNKPCn". */
14936 rtx tem = XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0);
14937 tem = gen_rtx_PLUS (GET_MODE (tem), tem, GEN_INT (-7));
14938 tem = gen_rtx_MINUS (GET_MODE (tem),
14939 tem,
14940 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
14941 ggc_strdup (labelpc)));
14942 assemble_integer (tem, 4, BITS_PER_WORD, 1);
14943 }
14944 else
14945 /* Output ".word .LTHUNKn". */
14946 assemble_integer (XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0), 4, BITS_PER_WORD, 1);
14947 }
14948 else
14949 {
14950 fputs ("\tb\t", file);
14951 assemble_name (file, XSTR (XEXP (DECL_RTL (function), 0), 0));
14952 if (NEED_PLT_RELOC)
14953 fputs ("(PLT)", file);
14954 fputc ('\n', file);
14955 }
14956 }
14957
14958 int
arm_emit_vector_const(FILE * file,rtx x)14959 arm_emit_vector_const (FILE *file, rtx x)
14960 {
14961 int i;
14962 const char * pattern;
14963
14964 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_VECTOR);
14965
14966 switch (GET_MODE (x))
14967 {
14968 case V2SImode: pattern = "%08x"; break;
14969 case V4HImode: pattern = "%04x"; break;
14970 case V8QImode: pattern = "%02x"; break;
14971 default: gcc_unreachable ();
14972 }
14973
14974 fprintf (file, "0x");
14975 for (i = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (x); i--;)
14976 {
14977 rtx element;
14978
14979 element = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (x, i);
14980 fprintf (file, pattern, INTVAL (element));
14981 }
14982
14983 return 1;
14984 }
14985
14986 const char *
arm_output_load_gr(rtx * operands)14987 arm_output_load_gr (rtx *operands)
14988 {
14989 rtx reg;
14990 rtx offset;
14991 rtx wcgr;
14992 rtx sum;
14993
14994 if (GET_CODE (operands [1]) != MEM
14995 || GET_CODE (sum = XEXP (operands [1], 0)) != PLUS
14996 || GET_CODE (reg = XEXP (sum, 0)) != REG
14997 || GET_CODE (offset = XEXP (sum, 1)) != CONST_INT
14998 || ((INTVAL (offset) < 1024) && (INTVAL (offset) > -1024)))
14999 return "wldrw%?\t%0, %1";
15000
15001 /* Fix up an out-of-range load of a GR register. */
15002 output_asm_insn ("str%?\t%0, [sp, #-4]!\t@ Start of GR load expansion", & reg);
15003 wcgr = operands[0];
15004 operands[0] = reg;
15005 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, %1", operands);
15006
15007 operands[0] = wcgr;
15008 operands[1] = reg;
15009 output_asm_insn ("tmcr%?\t%0, %1", operands);
15010 output_asm_insn ("ldr%?\t%0, [sp], #4\t@ End of GR load expansion", & reg);
15011
15012 return "";
15013 }
15014
15015 /* Worker function for TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS.
15016
15017 On the ARM, PRETEND_SIZE is set in order to have the prologue push the last
15018 named arg and all anonymous args onto the stack.
15019 XXX I know the prologue shouldn't be pushing registers, but it is faster
15020 that way. */
15021
15022 static void
arm_setup_incoming_varargs(CUMULATIVE_ARGS * cum,enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,int * pretend_size,int second_time ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)15023 arm_setup_incoming_varargs (CUMULATIVE_ARGS *cum,
15024 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
15025 tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
15026 int *pretend_size,
15027 int second_time ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
15028 {
15029 cfun->machine->uses_anonymous_args = 1;
15030 if (cum->nregs < NUM_ARG_REGS)
15031 *pretend_size = (NUM_ARG_REGS - cum->nregs) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
15032 }
15033
15034 /* Return nonzero if the CONSUMER instruction (a store) does not need
15035 PRODUCER's value to calculate the address. */
15036
15037 int
arm_no_early_store_addr_dep(rtx producer,rtx consumer)15038 arm_no_early_store_addr_dep (rtx producer, rtx consumer)
15039 {
15040 rtx value = PATTERN (producer);
15041 rtx addr = PATTERN (consumer);
15042
15043 if (GET_CODE (value) == COND_EXEC)
15044 value = COND_EXEC_CODE (value);
15045 if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
15046 value = XVECEXP (value, 0, 0);
15047 value = XEXP (value, 0);
15048 if (GET_CODE (addr) == COND_EXEC)
15049 addr = COND_EXEC_CODE (addr);
15050 if (GET_CODE (addr) == PARALLEL)
15051 addr = XVECEXP (addr, 0, 0);
15052 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
15053
15054 return !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (value, addr);
15055 }
15056
15057 /* Return nonzero if the CONSUMER instruction (an ALU op) does not
15058 have an early register shift value or amount dependency on the
15059 result of PRODUCER. */
15060
15061 int
arm_no_early_alu_shift_dep(rtx producer,rtx consumer)15062 arm_no_early_alu_shift_dep (rtx producer, rtx consumer)
15063 {
15064 rtx value = PATTERN (producer);
15065 rtx op = PATTERN (consumer);
15066 rtx early_op;
15067
15068 if (GET_CODE (value) == COND_EXEC)
15069 value = COND_EXEC_CODE (value);
15070 if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
15071 value = XVECEXP (value, 0, 0);
15072 value = XEXP (value, 0);
15073 if (GET_CODE (op) == COND_EXEC)
15074 op = COND_EXEC_CODE (op);
15075 if (GET_CODE (op) == PARALLEL)
15076 op = XVECEXP (op, 0, 0);
15077 op = XEXP (op, 1);
15078
15079 early_op = XEXP (op, 0);
15080 /* This is either an actual independent shift, or a shift applied to
15081 the first operand of another operation. We want the whole shift
15082 operation. */
15083 if (GET_CODE (early_op) == REG)
15084 early_op = op;
15085
15086 return !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (value, early_op);
15087 }
15088
15089 /* Return nonzero if the CONSUMER instruction (an ALU op) does not
15090 have an early register shift value dependency on the result of
15091 PRODUCER. */
15092
15093 int
arm_no_early_alu_shift_value_dep(rtx producer,rtx consumer)15094 arm_no_early_alu_shift_value_dep (rtx producer, rtx consumer)
15095 {
15096 rtx value = PATTERN (producer);
15097 rtx op = PATTERN (consumer);
15098 rtx early_op;
15099
15100 if (GET_CODE (value) == COND_EXEC)
15101 value = COND_EXEC_CODE (value);
15102 if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
15103 value = XVECEXP (value, 0, 0);
15104 value = XEXP (value, 0);
15105 if (GET_CODE (op) == COND_EXEC)
15106 op = COND_EXEC_CODE (op);
15107 if (GET_CODE (op) == PARALLEL)
15108 op = XVECEXP (op, 0, 0);
15109 op = XEXP (op, 1);
15110
15111 early_op = XEXP (op, 0);
15112
15113 /* This is either an actual independent shift, or a shift applied to
15114 the first operand of another operation. We want the value being
15115 shifted, in either case. */
15116 if (GET_CODE (early_op) != REG)
15117 early_op = XEXP (early_op, 0);
15118
15119 return !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (value, early_op);
15120 }
15121
15122 /* Return nonzero if the CONSUMER (a mul or mac op) does not
15123 have an early register mult dependency on the result of
15124 PRODUCER. */
15125
15126 int
arm_no_early_mul_dep(rtx producer,rtx consumer)15127 arm_no_early_mul_dep (rtx producer, rtx consumer)
15128 {
15129 rtx value = PATTERN (producer);
15130 rtx op = PATTERN (consumer);
15131
15132 if (GET_CODE (value) == COND_EXEC)
15133 value = COND_EXEC_CODE (value);
15134 if (GET_CODE (value) == PARALLEL)
15135 value = XVECEXP (value, 0, 0);
15136 value = XEXP (value, 0);
15137 if (GET_CODE (op) == COND_EXEC)
15138 op = COND_EXEC_CODE (op);
15139 if (GET_CODE (op) == PARALLEL)
15140 op = XVECEXP (op, 0, 0);
15141 op = XEXP (op, 1);
15142
15143 return (GET_CODE (op) == PLUS
15144 && !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (value, XEXP (op, 0)));
15145 }
15146
15147
15148 /* We can't rely on the caller doing the proper promotion when
15149 using APCS or ATPCS. */
15150
15151 static bool
arm_promote_prototypes(tree t ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)15152 arm_promote_prototypes (tree t ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
15153 {
15154 return !TARGET_AAPCS_BASED;
15155 }
15156
15157
15158 /* AAPCS based ABIs use short enums by default. */
15159
15160 static bool
arm_default_short_enums(void)15161 arm_default_short_enums (void)
15162 {
15163 return TARGET_AAPCS_BASED && arm_abi != ARM_ABI_AAPCS_LINUX;
15164 }
15165
15166
15167 /* AAPCS requires that anonymous bitfields affect structure alignment. */
15168
15169 static bool
arm_align_anon_bitfield(void)15170 arm_align_anon_bitfield (void)
15171 {
15172 return TARGET_AAPCS_BASED;
15173 }
15174
15175
15176 /* The generic C++ ABI says 64-bit (long long). The EABI says 32-bit. */
15177
15178 static tree
arm_cxx_guard_type(void)15179 arm_cxx_guard_type (void)
15180 {
15181 return TARGET_AAPCS_BASED ? integer_type_node : long_long_integer_type_node;
15182 }
15183
15184
15185 /* The EABI says test the least significant bit of a guard variable. */
15186
15187 static bool
arm_cxx_guard_mask_bit(void)15188 arm_cxx_guard_mask_bit (void)
15189 {
15190 return TARGET_AAPCS_BASED;
15191 }
15192
15193
15194 /* The EABI specifies that all array cookies are 8 bytes long. */
15195
15196 static tree
arm_get_cookie_size(tree type)15197 arm_get_cookie_size (tree type)
15198 {
15199 tree size;
15200
15201 if (!TARGET_AAPCS_BASED)
15202 return default_cxx_get_cookie_size (type);
15203
15204 size = build_int_cst (sizetype, 8);
15205 return size;
15206 }
15207
15208
15209 /* The EABI says that array cookies should also contain the element size. */
15210
15211 static bool
arm_cookie_has_size(void)15212 arm_cookie_has_size (void)
15213 {
15214 return TARGET_AAPCS_BASED;
15215 }
15216
15217
15218 /* The EABI says constructors and destructors should return a pointer to
15219 the object constructed/destroyed. */
15220
15221 static bool
arm_cxx_cdtor_returns_this(void)15222 arm_cxx_cdtor_returns_this (void)
15223 {
15224 return TARGET_AAPCS_BASED;
15225 }
15226
15227 /* The EABI says that an inline function may never be the key
15228 method. */
15229
15230 static bool
arm_cxx_key_method_may_be_inline(void)15231 arm_cxx_key_method_may_be_inline (void)
15232 {
15233 return !TARGET_AAPCS_BASED;
15234 }
15235
15236 static void
arm_cxx_determine_class_data_visibility(tree decl)15237 arm_cxx_determine_class_data_visibility (tree decl)
15238 {
15239 if (!TARGET_AAPCS_BASED)
15240 return;
15241
15242 /* In general, \S 3.2.5.5 of the ARM EABI requires that class data
15243 is exported. However, on systems without dynamic vague linkage,
15244 \S 3.2.5.6 says that COMDAT class data has hidden linkage. */
15245 if (!TARGET_ARM_DYNAMIC_VAGUE_LINKAGE_P && DECL_COMDAT (decl))
15246 DECL_VISIBILITY (decl) = VISIBILITY_HIDDEN;
15247 else
15248 DECL_VISIBILITY (decl) = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
15249 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (decl) = 1;
15250 }
15251
15252 static bool
arm_cxx_class_data_always_comdat(void)15253 arm_cxx_class_data_always_comdat (void)
15254 {
15255 /* \S 3.2.5.4 of the ARM C++ ABI says that class data only have
15256 vague linkage if the class has no key function. */
15257 return !TARGET_AAPCS_BASED;
15258 }
15259
15260
15261 /* The EABI says __aeabi_atexit should be used to register static
15262 destructors. */
15263
15264 static bool
arm_cxx_use_aeabi_atexit(void)15265 arm_cxx_use_aeabi_atexit (void)
15266 {
15267 return TARGET_AAPCS_BASED;
15268 }
15269
15270
15271 void
arm_set_return_address(rtx source,rtx scratch)15272 arm_set_return_address (rtx source, rtx scratch)
15273 {
15274 arm_stack_offsets *offsets;
15275 HOST_WIDE_INT delta;
15276 rtx addr;
15277 unsigned long saved_regs;
15278
15279 saved_regs = arm_compute_save_reg_mask ();
15280
15281 if ((saved_regs & (1 << LR_REGNUM)) == 0)
15282 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNUM), source);
15283 else
15284 {
15285 if (frame_pointer_needed)
15286 addr = plus_constant(hard_frame_pointer_rtx, -4);
15287 else
15288 {
15289 /* LR will be the first saved register. */
15290 offsets = arm_get_frame_offsets ();
15291 delta = offsets->outgoing_args - (offsets->frame + 4);
15292
15293
15294 if (delta >= 4096)
15295 {
15296 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (scratch, stack_pointer_rtx,
15297 GEN_INT (delta & ~4095)));
15298 addr = scratch;
15299 delta &= 4095;
15300 }
15301 else
15302 addr = stack_pointer_rtx;
15303
15304 addr = plus_constant (addr, delta);
15305 }
15306 emit_move_insn (gen_frame_mem (Pmode, addr), source);
15307 }
15308 }
15309
15310
15311 void
thumb_set_return_address(rtx source,rtx scratch)15312 thumb_set_return_address (rtx source, rtx scratch)
15313 {
15314 arm_stack_offsets *offsets;
15315 HOST_WIDE_INT delta;
15316 int reg;
15317 rtx addr;
15318 unsigned long mask;
15319
15320 emit_insn (gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, source));
15321
15322 mask = thumb_compute_save_reg_mask ();
15323 if (mask & (1 << LR_REGNUM))
15324 {
15325 offsets = arm_get_frame_offsets ();
15326
15327 /* Find the saved regs. */
15328 if (frame_pointer_needed)
15329 {
15330 delta = offsets->soft_frame - offsets->saved_args;
15331 reg = THUMB_HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
15332 }
15333 else
15334 {
15335 delta = offsets->outgoing_args - offsets->saved_args;
15336 reg = SP_REGNUM;
15337 }
15338 /* Allow for the stack frame. */
15339 if (TARGET_BACKTRACE)
15340 delta -= 16;
15341 /* The link register is always the first saved register. */
15342 delta -= 4;
15343
15344 /* Construct the address. */
15345 addr = gen_rtx_REG (SImode, reg);
15346 if ((reg != SP_REGNUM && delta >= 128)
15347 || delta >= 1024)
15348 {
15349 emit_insn (gen_movsi (scratch, GEN_INT (delta)));
15350 emit_insn (gen_addsi3 (scratch, scratch, stack_pointer_rtx));
15351 addr = scratch;
15352 }
15353 else
15354 addr = plus_constant (addr, delta);
15355
15356 emit_move_insn (gen_frame_mem (Pmode, addr), source);
15357 }
15358 else
15359 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (Pmode, LR_REGNUM), source);
15360 }
15361
15362 /* Implements target hook vector_mode_supported_p. */
15363 bool
arm_vector_mode_supported_p(enum machine_mode mode)15364 arm_vector_mode_supported_p (enum machine_mode mode)
15365 {
15366 if ((mode == V2SImode)
15367 || (mode == V4HImode)
15368 || (mode == V8QImode))
15369 return true;
15370
15371 return false;
15372 }
15373
15374 /* Implement TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK. SImode shifts use normal
15375 ARM insns and therefore guarantee that the shift count is modulo 256.
15376 DImode shifts (those implemented by lib1funcs.asm or by optabs.c)
15377 guarantee no particular behavior for out-of-range counts. */
15378
15379 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
arm_shift_truncation_mask(enum machine_mode mode)15380 arm_shift_truncation_mask (enum machine_mode mode)
15381 {
15382 return mode == SImode ? 255 : 0;
15383 }
15384
15385
15386 /* Map internal gcc register numbers to DWARF2 register numbers. */
15387
15388 unsigned int
arm_dbx_register_number(unsigned int regno)15389 arm_dbx_register_number (unsigned int regno)
15390 {
15391 if (regno < 16)
15392 return regno;
15393
15394 /* TODO: Legacy targets output FPA regs as registers 16-23 for backwards
15395 compatibility. The EABI defines them as registers 96-103. */
15396 if (IS_FPA_REGNUM (regno))
15397 return (TARGET_AAPCS_BASED ? 96 : 16) + regno - FIRST_FPA_REGNUM;
15398
15399 if (IS_VFP_REGNUM (regno))
15400 return 64 + regno - FIRST_VFP_REGNUM;
15401
15402 if (IS_IWMMXT_GR_REGNUM (regno))
15403 return 104 + regno - FIRST_IWMMXT_GR_REGNUM;
15404
15405 if (IS_IWMMXT_REGNUM (regno))
15406 return 112 + regno - FIRST_IWMMXT_REGNUM;
15407
15408 gcc_unreachable ();
15409 }
15410
15411
15412 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
15413 /* Emit unwind directives for a store-multiple instruction. This should
15414 only ever be generated by the function prologue code, so we expect it
15415 to have a particular form. */
15416
15417 static void
arm_unwind_emit_stm(FILE * asm_out_file,rtx p)15418 arm_unwind_emit_stm (FILE * asm_out_file, rtx p)
15419 {
15420 int i;
15421 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
15422 HOST_WIDE_INT nregs;
15423 int reg_size;
15424 unsigned reg;
15425 unsigned lastreg;
15426 rtx e;
15427
15428 /* First insn will adjust the stack pointer. */
15429 e = XVECEXP (p, 0, 0);
15430 if (GET_CODE (e) != SET
15431 || GET_CODE (XEXP (e, 0)) != REG
15432 || REGNO (XEXP (e, 0)) != SP_REGNUM
15433 || GET_CODE (XEXP (e, 1)) != PLUS)
15434 abort ();
15435
15436 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (e, 1), 1));
15437 nregs = XVECLEN (p, 0) - 1;
15438
15439 reg = REGNO (XEXP (XVECEXP (p, 0, 1), 1));
15440 if (reg < 16)
15441 {
15442 /* The function prologue may also push pc, but not annotate it as it is
15443 never restored. We turn this into a stack pointer adjustment. */
15444 if (nregs * 4 == offset - 4)
15445 {
15446 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.pad #4\n");
15447 offset -= 4;
15448 }
15449 reg_size = 4;
15450 }
15451 else if (IS_VFP_REGNUM (reg))
15452 {
15453 /* FPA register saves use an additional word. */
15454 offset -= 4;
15455 reg_size = 8;
15456 }
15457 else if (reg >= FIRST_FPA_REGNUM && reg <= LAST_FPA_REGNUM)
15458 {
15459 /* FPA registers are done differently. */
15460 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.save %r, %wd\n", reg, nregs);
15461 return;
15462 }
15463 else
15464 /* Unknown register type. */
15465 abort ();
15466
15467 /* If the stack increment doesn't match the size of the saved registers,
15468 something has gone horribly wrong. */
15469 if (offset != nregs * reg_size)
15470 abort ();
15471
15472 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.save {");
15473
15474 offset = 0;
15475 lastreg = 0;
15476 /* The remaining insns will describe the stores. */
15477 for (i = 1; i <= nregs; i++)
15478 {
15479 /* Expect (set (mem <addr>) (reg)).
15480 Where <addr> is (reg:SP) or (plus (reg:SP) (const_int)). */
15481 e = XVECEXP (p, 0, i);
15482 if (GET_CODE (e) != SET
15483 || GET_CODE (XEXP (e, 0)) != MEM
15484 || GET_CODE (XEXP (e, 1)) != REG)
15485 abort ();
15486
15487 reg = REGNO (XEXP (e, 1));
15488 if (reg < lastreg)
15489 abort ();
15490
15491 if (i != 1)
15492 fprintf (asm_out_file, ", ");
15493 /* We can't use %r for vfp because we need to use the
15494 double precision register names. */
15495 if (IS_VFP_REGNUM (reg))
15496 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "d%d", (reg - FIRST_VFP_REGNUM) / 2);
15497 else
15498 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "%r", reg);
15499
15500 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
15501 /* Check that the addresses are consecutive. */
15502 e = XEXP (XEXP (e, 0), 0);
15503 if (GET_CODE (e) == PLUS)
15504 {
15505 offset += reg_size;
15506 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (e, 0)) != REG
15507 || REGNO (XEXP (e, 0)) != SP_REGNUM
15508 || GET_CODE (XEXP (e, 1)) != CONST_INT
15509 || offset != INTVAL (XEXP (e, 1)))
15510 abort ();
15511 }
15512 else if (i != 1
15513 || GET_CODE (e) != REG
15514 || REGNO (e) != SP_REGNUM)
15515 abort ();
15516 #endif
15517 }
15518 fprintf (asm_out_file, "}\n");
15519 }
15520
15521 /* Emit unwind directives for a SET. */
15522
15523 static void
arm_unwind_emit_set(FILE * asm_out_file,rtx p)15524 arm_unwind_emit_set (FILE * asm_out_file, rtx p)
15525 {
15526 rtx e0;
15527 rtx e1;
15528
15529 e0 = XEXP (p, 0);
15530 e1 = XEXP (p, 1);
15531 switch (GET_CODE (e0))
15532 {
15533 case MEM:
15534 /* Pushing a single register. */
15535 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (e0, 0)) != PRE_DEC
15536 || GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (e0, 0), 0)) != REG
15537 || REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (e0, 0), 0)) != SP_REGNUM)
15538 abort ();
15539
15540 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.save ");
15541 if (IS_VFP_REGNUM (REGNO (e1)))
15542 asm_fprintf(asm_out_file, "{d%d}\n",
15543 (REGNO (e1) - FIRST_VFP_REGNUM) / 2);
15544 else
15545 asm_fprintf(asm_out_file, "{%r}\n", REGNO (e1));
15546 break;
15547
15548 case REG:
15549 if (REGNO (e0) == SP_REGNUM)
15550 {
15551 /* A stack increment. */
15552 if (GET_CODE (e1) != PLUS
15553 || GET_CODE (XEXP (e1, 0)) != REG
15554 || REGNO (XEXP (e1, 0)) != SP_REGNUM
15555 || GET_CODE (XEXP (e1, 1)) != CONST_INT)
15556 abort ();
15557
15558 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.pad #%wd\n",
15559 -INTVAL (XEXP (e1, 1)));
15560 }
15561 else if (REGNO (e0) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
15562 {
15563 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
15564 unsigned reg;
15565
15566 if (GET_CODE (e1) == PLUS)
15567 {
15568 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (e1, 0)) != REG
15569 || GET_CODE (XEXP (e1, 1)) != CONST_INT)
15570 abort ();
15571 reg = REGNO (XEXP (e1, 0));
15572 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (e1, 1));
15573 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.setfp %r, %r, #%wd\n",
15574 HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, reg,
15575 INTVAL (XEXP (e1, 1)));
15576 }
15577 else if (GET_CODE (e1) == REG)
15578 {
15579 reg = REGNO (e1);
15580 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.setfp %r, %r\n",
15581 HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, reg);
15582 }
15583 else
15584 abort ();
15585 }
15586 else if (GET_CODE (e1) == REG && REGNO (e1) == SP_REGNUM)
15587 {
15588 /* Move from sp to reg. */
15589 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.movsp %r\n", REGNO (e0));
15590 }
15591 else if (GET_CODE (e1) == PLUS
15592 && GET_CODE (XEXP (e1, 0)) == REG
15593 && REGNO (XEXP (e1, 0)) == SP_REGNUM
15594 && GET_CODE (XEXP (e1, 1)) == CONST_INT)
15595 {
15596 /* Set reg to offset from sp. */
15597 asm_fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.movsp %r, #%d\n",
15598 REGNO (e0), (int)INTVAL(XEXP (e1, 1)));
15599 }
15600 else
15601 abort ();
15602 break;
15603
15604 default:
15605 abort ();
15606 }
15607 }
15608
15609
15610 /* Emit unwind directives for the given insn. */
15611
15612 static void
arm_unwind_emit(FILE * asm_out_file,rtx insn)15613 arm_unwind_emit (FILE * asm_out_file, rtx insn)
15614 {
15615 rtx pat;
15616
15617 if (!ARM_EABI_UNWIND_TABLES)
15618 return;
15619
15620 if (GET_CODE (insn) == NOTE || !RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
15621 return;
15622
15623 pat = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
15624 if (pat)
15625 pat = XEXP (pat, 0);
15626 else
15627 pat = PATTERN (insn);
15628
15629 switch (GET_CODE (pat))
15630 {
15631 case SET:
15632 arm_unwind_emit_set (asm_out_file, pat);
15633 break;
15634
15635 case SEQUENCE:
15636 /* Store multiple. */
15637 arm_unwind_emit_stm (asm_out_file, pat);
15638 break;
15639
15640 default:
15641 abort();
15642 }
15643 }
15644
15645
15646 /* Output a reference from a function exception table to the type_info
15647 object X. The EABI specifies that the symbol should be relocated by
15648 an R_ARM_TARGET2 relocation. */
15649
15650 static bool
arm_output_ttype(rtx x)15651 arm_output_ttype (rtx x)
15652 {
15653 fputs ("\t.word\t", asm_out_file);
15654 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, x);
15655 /* Use special relocations for symbol references. */
15656 if (GET_CODE (x) != CONST_INT)
15657 fputs ("(TARGET2)", asm_out_file);
15658 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
15659
15660 return TRUE;
15661 }
15662 #endif /* TARGET_UNWIND_INFO */
15663
15664
15665 /* Output unwind directives for the start/end of a function. */
15666
15667 void
arm_output_fn_unwind(FILE * f,bool prologue)15668 arm_output_fn_unwind (FILE * f, bool prologue)
15669 {
15670 if (!ARM_EABI_UNWIND_TABLES)
15671 return;
15672
15673 if (prologue)
15674 fputs ("\t.fnstart\n", f);
15675 else
15676 fputs ("\t.fnend\n", f);
15677 }
15678
15679 static bool
arm_emit_tls_decoration(FILE * fp,rtx x)15680 arm_emit_tls_decoration (FILE *fp, rtx x)
15681 {
15682 enum tls_reloc reloc;
15683 rtx val;
15684
15685 val = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
15686 reloc = INTVAL (XVECEXP (x, 0, 1));
15687
15688 output_addr_const (fp, val);
15689
15690 switch (reloc)
15691 {
15692 case TLS_GD32:
15693 fputs ("(tlsgd)", fp);
15694 break;
15695 case TLS_LDM32:
15696 fputs ("(tlsldm)", fp);
15697 break;
15698 case TLS_LDO32:
15699 fputs ("(tlsldo)", fp);
15700 break;
15701 case TLS_IE32:
15702 fputs ("(gottpoff)", fp);
15703 break;
15704 case TLS_LE32:
15705 fputs ("(tpoff)", fp);
15706 break;
15707 default:
15708 gcc_unreachable ();
15709 }
15710
15711 switch (reloc)
15712 {
15713 case TLS_GD32:
15714 case TLS_LDM32:
15715 case TLS_IE32:
15716 fputs (" + (. - ", fp);
15717 output_addr_const (fp, XVECEXP (x, 0, 2));
15718 fputs (" - ", fp);
15719 output_addr_const (fp, XVECEXP (x, 0, 3));
15720 fputc (')', fp);
15721 break;
15722 default:
15723 break;
15724 }
15725
15726 return TRUE;
15727 }
15728
15729 bool
arm_output_addr_const_extra(FILE * fp,rtx x)15730 arm_output_addr_const_extra (FILE *fp, rtx x)
15731 {
15732 if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_TLS)
15733 return arm_emit_tls_decoration (fp, x);
15734 else if (GET_CODE (x) == UNSPEC && XINT (x, 1) == UNSPEC_PIC_LABEL)
15735 {
15736 char label[256];
15737 int labelno = INTVAL (XVECEXP (x, 0, 0));
15738
15739 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LPIC", labelno);
15740 assemble_name_raw (fp, label);
15741
15742 return TRUE;
15743 }
15744 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_VECTOR)
15745 return arm_emit_vector_const (fp, x);
15746
15747 return FALSE;
15748 }
15749
15750 #include "gt-arm.h"
15751